Renesas HD6413002 High-performance single-chip microcontroller Datasheet

To all our customers
Regarding the change of names mentioned in the document, such as Hitachi
Electric and Hitachi XX, to Renesas Technology Corp.
The semiconductor operations of Mitsubishi Electric and Hitachi were transferred to Renesas
Technology Corporation on April 1st 2003. These operations include microcomputer, logic, analog
and discrete devices, and memory chips other than DRAMs (flash memory, SRAMs etc.)
Accordingly, although Hitachi, Hitachi, Ltd., Hitachi Semiconductors, and other Hitachi brand
names are mentioned in the document, these names have in fact all been changed to Renesas
Technology Corp. Thank you for your understanding. Except for our corporate trademark, logo and
corporate statement, no changes whatsoever have been made to the contents of the document, and
these changes do not constitute any alteration to the contents of the document itself.
Renesas Technology Home Page: http://www.renesas.com
Renesas Technology Corp.
Customer Support Dept.
April 1, 2003
Cautions
Keep safety first in your circuit designs!
1.
Renesas Technology Corporation puts the maximum effort into making semiconductor products better and more reliable, but
there is always the possibility that trouble may occur with them. Trouble with semiconductors may lead to personal injury, fire
or property damage.
Remember to give due consideration to safety when making your circuit designs, with appropriate measures such as (i)
placement of substitutive, auxiliary circuits, (ii) use of nonflammable material or (iii) prevention against any malfunction or
mishap.
Notes regarding these materials
1.
These materials are intended as a reference to assist our customers in the selection of the Renesas Technology Corporation
product best suited to the customer's application; they do not convey any license under any intellectual property rights, or any
other rights, belonging to Renesas Technology Corporation or a third party.
2.
Renesas Technology Corporation assumes no responsibility for any damage, or infringement of any third-party's rights,
originating in the use of any product data, diagrams, charts, programs, algorithms, or circuit application examples contained in
these materials.
3.
All information contained in these materials, including product data, diagrams, charts, programs and algorithms represents
information on products at the time of publication of these materials, and are subject to change by Renesas Technology
Corporation without notice due to product improvements or other reasons. It is therefore recommended that customers contact
Renesas Technology Corporation or an authorized Renesas Technology Corporation product distributor for the latest product
information before purchasing a product listed herein.
The information described here may contain technical inaccuracies or typographical errors.
Renesas Technology Corporation assumes no responsibility for any damage, liability, or other loss rising from these
inaccuracies or errors.
Please also pay attention to information published by Renesas Technology Corporation by various means, including the
Renesas Technology Corporation Semiconductor home page (http://www.renesas.com).
4.
When using any or all of the information contained in these materials, including product data, diagrams, charts, programs, and
algorithms, please be sure to evaluate all information as a total system before making a final decision on the applicability of
the information and products. Renesas Technology Corporation assumes no responsibility for any damage, liability or other
loss resulting from the information contained herein.
5.
Renesas Technology Corporation semiconductors are not designed or manufactured for use in a device or system that is used
under circumstances in which human life is potentially at stake. Please contact Renesas Technology Corporation or an
authorized Renesas Technology Corporation product distributor when considering the use of a product contained herein for
any specific purposes, such as apparatus or systems for transportation, vehicular, medical, aerospace, nuclear, or undersea
repeater use.
6.
The prior written approval of Renesas Technology Corporation is necessary to reprint or reproduce in whole or in part these
materials.
7.
If these products or technologies are subject to the Japanese export control restrictions, they must be exported under a license
from the Japanese government and cannot be imported into a country other than the approved destination.
Any diversion or reexport contrary to the export control laws and regulations of Japan and/or the country of destination is
prohibited.
8.
Please contact Renesas Technology Corporation for further details on these materials or the products contained therein.
Hitachi Microcomputer
H8/3002
HD6413002
Hardware Manual
ADE-602-066
Preface
The H8/3002 is a high-performance single-chip microcontroller that integrates system supporting
functions together with an H8/300H CPU core.
The H8/300H CPU has a 32-bit internal architecture with sixteen 16-bit general registers, and a
concise, optimized instruction set designed for speed. It can address a 16-Mbyte linear address
space.
The on-chip system supporting functions include RAM, a 16-bit integrated timer unit (ITU), a
programmable timing pattern controller (TPC), a watchdog timer (WDT), two serial
communication interfaces (SCI), an A/D converter, I/O ports, a direct memory access controller
(DMAC), a refresh controller, and other facilities.
The address space is divided into eight areas. The data bus width and access cycle length can be
selected independently in each area, simplifying the connection of different types of memory. Four
operating modes (modes 1 to 4) are provided, offering a choice of initial data bus width and
address space size.
With these features, the H8/3002 can be used to implement compact, high-performance systems
easily.
This manual describes the H8/3002 hardware. For details of the instruction set, refer to the
H8/300H Series Programming Manual.
Contents
Section 1
1.1
1.2
1.3
1.4
Overview ........................................................................................................................
Block Diagram................................................................................................................
Pin Description ...............................................................................................................
1.3.1
Pin Arrangement.............................................................................................
1.3.2
Pin Functions ..................................................................................................
Pin Functions ..................................................................................................................
Section 2
2.1
2.2
2.3
2.4
2.5
2.6
2.7
2.8
Overview .....................................................................................................
1
1
5
6
6
8
12
CPU ............................................................................................................... 17
Overview ........................................................................................................................
2.1.1
Features...........................................................................................................
2.1.2
Differences from H8/300 CPU .......................................................................
CPU Operating Modes....................................................................................................
Address Space.................................................................................................................
Register Configuration....................................................................................................
2.4.1
Overview.........................................................................................................
2.4.2
General Registers............................................................................................
2.4.3
Control Registers ............................................................................................
2.4.4
Initial CPU Register Values ............................................................................
Data Formats...................................................................................................................
2.5.1
General Register Data Formats.......................................................................
2.5.2
Memory Data Formats....................................................................................
Instruction Set.................................................................................................................
2.6.1
Instruction Set Overview ................................................................................
2.6.2
Instructions and Addressing Modes................................................................
2.6.3
Tables of Instructions Classified by Function ................................................
2.6.4
Basic Instruction Formats ...............................................................................
2.6.5
Notes on Use of Bit Manipulation Instructions ..............................................
Addressing Modes and Effective Address Calculation ..................................................
2.7.1
Addressing Modes ..........................................................................................
2.7.2
Effective Address Calculation ........................................................................
Processing States ............................................................................................................
2.8.1
Overview.........................................................................................................
2.8.2
Program Execution State ................................................................................
2.8.3
Exception-Handling State...............................................................................
2.8.4
Exception-Handling Sequences ......................................................................
2.8.5
Bus-Released State .........................................................................................
2.8.6
Reset State ......................................................................................................
2.8.7
Power-Down State ..........................................................................................
17
17
18
19
20
21
21
22
23
24
25
25
26
28
28
29
30
40
41
41
41
44
48
48
49
49
51
52
52
52
2.9
Basic Operational Timing...............................................................................................
2.9.1
Overview.........................................................................................................
2.9.2
On-Chip Memory Access Timing...................................................................
2.9.3
On-Chip Supporting Module Access Timing .................................................
2.9.4
Access to External Address Space..................................................................
Section 3
3.1
3.2
3.3
3.4
3.5
3.6
MCU Operating Modes ...........................................................................
Overview ........................................................................................................................
3.1.1
Operating Mode Selection ..............................................................................
3.1.2
Register Configuration....................................................................................
Mode Control Register (MDCR) ....................................................................................
System Control Register (SYSCR).................................................................................
Operating Mode Descriptions.........................................................................................
3.4.1
Mode 1 ............................................................................................................
3.4.2
Mode 2 ............................................................................................................
3.4.3
Mode 3 ............................................................................................................
3.4.4
Mode 4 ............................................................................................................
Pin Functions in Each Operating Mode..........................................................................
Memory Map in Each Operating Mode..........................................................................
Section 4
4.1
4.2
4.3
4.4
4.5
4.6
Exception Handling ..................................................................................
Overview ........................................................................................................................
4.1.1
Exception Handling Types and Priority..........................................................
4.1.2
Exception Handling Operation .......................................................................
4.1.3
Exception Vector Table...................................................................................
Reset
........................................................................................................................
4.2.1
Overview.........................................................................................................
4.2.2
Reset Sequence ...............................................................................................
4.2.3
Interrupts after Reset.......................................................................................
Interrupts ........................................................................................................................
Trap Instruction...............................................................................................................
Stack Status after Exception Handling ...........................................................................
Notes on Stack Usage .....................................................................................................
Section 5
5.1
53
53
53
55
56
57
57
57
58
59
60
62
62
62
62
62
63
63
65
65
65
65
66
67
67
67
69
70
71
71
72
Interrupt Controller................................................................................... 73
Overview ........................................................................................................................
5.1.1
Features...........................................................................................................
5.1.2
Block Diagram................................................................................................
5.1.3
Pin Configuration............................................................................................
5.1.4
Register Configuration....................................................................................
73
73
74
75
75
5.2
5.3
5.4
5.5
Register Descriptions......................................................................................................
5.2.1
System Control Register (SYSCR).................................................................
5.2.2
Interrupt Priority Registers A and B (IPRA, IPRB) .......................................
5.2.3
IRQ Status Register (ISR) ..............................................................................
5.2.4
IRQ Enable Register (IER).............................................................................
5.2.5
IRQ Sense Control Register (ISCR) ...............................................................
Interrupt Sources.............................................................................................................
5.3.1
External Interrupts ..........................................................................................
5.3.2
Internal Interrupts ...........................................................................................
5.3.3
Interrupt Vector Table .....................................................................................
Interrupt Operation .........................................................................................................
5.4.1
Interrupt Handling Process .............................................................................
5.4.2
Interrupt Sequence ..........................................................................................
5.4.3
Interrupt Response Time.................................................................................
Usage Notes ....................................................................................................................
5.5.1
Contention between Interrupt and Interrupt-Disabling Instruction ................
5.5.2
Instructions that Inhibit Interrupts ..................................................................
5.5.3
Interrupts during EEPMOV Instruction Execution ........................................
5.5.4
Usage Notes ....................................................................................................
Section 6
6.1
6.2
6.3
6.4
76
76
77
84
85
86
87
87
88
88
91
91
96
97
98
98
99
99
99
Bus Controller ............................................................................................ 103
Overview ........................................................................................................................ 103
6.1.1
Features........................................................................................................... 103
6.1.2
Block Diagram................................................................................................ 104
6.1.3
Input/Output Pins............................................................................................ 105
6.1.4
Register Configuration.................................................................................... 105
Register Descriptions...................................................................................................... 106
6.2.1
Bus Width Control Register (ABWCR) ......................................................... 106
6.2.2
Access State Control Register (ASTCR)........................................................ 107
6.2.3
Wait Control Register (WCR)......................................................................... 108
6.2.4
Wait State Control Enable Register (WCER) ................................................. 109
6.2.5
Bus Release Control Register (BRCR)........................................................... 110
Operation ........................................................................................................................ 112
6.3.1
Area Division.................................................................................................. 112
6.3.2
Chip Select Signals ......................................................................................... 114
6.3.3
Data Bus.......................................................................................................... 115
6.3.4
Bus Control Signal Timing ............................................................................. 116
6.3.5
Wait Modes ..................................................................................................... 124
6.3.6
Interconnections with Memory (Example)..................................................... 130
6.3.7
Bus Arbiter Operation..................................................................................... 132
Usage Notes .................................................................................................................... 135
6.4.1
6.4.2
6.4.3
Connection to Dynamic RAM and Pseudo-Static RAM ................................ 135
Register Write Timing .................................................................................... 135
BREQ Input Timing........................................................................................ 137
Section 7
7.1
7.2
7.3
7.4
7.5
Refresh Controller .................................................................................... 139
Overview ........................................................................................................................ 139
7.1.1
Features........................................................................................................... 139
7.1.2
Block Diagram................................................................................................ 140
7.1.3
Input/Output Pins............................................................................................ 141
7.1.4
Register Configuration.................................................................................... 141
Register Descriptions...................................................................................................... 142
7.2.1
Refresh Control Register (RFSHCR) ............................................................. 142
7.2.2
Refresh Timer Control/Status Register (RTMCSR) ....................................... 145
7.2.3
Refresh Timer Counter (RTCNT)................................................................... 147
7.2.4
Refresh Time Constant Register (RTCOR) .................................................... 147
Operation ........................................................................................................................ 148
7.3.1
Area Division.................................................................................................. 148
7.3.2
DRAM Refresh Control.................................................................................. 149
7.3.3
Pseudo-Static RAM Refresh Control.............................................................. 164
7.3.4
Interval Timing ............................................................................................... 169
Interrupt Source .............................................................................................................. 175
Usage Notes .................................................................................................................... 175
Section 8
8.1
8.2
8.3
8.4
DMA Controller ........................................................................................ 179
Overview ........................................................................................................................ 179
8.1.1
Features........................................................................................................... 179
8.1.2
Block Diagram................................................................................................ 180
8.1.3
Functional Overview ...................................................................................... 181
8.1.4
Input/Output Pins............................................................................................ 182
8.1.5
Register Configuration.................................................................................... 182
Register Descriptions (1) (Short Address Mode) ........................................................... 184
8.2.1
Memory Address Registers (MAR)................................................................ 185
8.2.2
I/O Address Registers (IOAR)........................................................................ 186
8.2.3
Execute Transfer Count Registers (ETCR) .................................................... 186
8.2.4
Data Transfer Control Registers (DTCR) ....................................................... 188
Register Descriptions (2) (Full Address Mode).............................................................. 192
8.3.1
Memory Address Registers (MAR)................................................................ 192
8.3.2
I/O Address Registers (IOAR)........................................................................ 192
8.3.3
Execute Transfer Count Registers (ETCR) .................................................... 193
8.3.4
Data Transfer Control Registers (DTCR) ....................................................... 195
Operation ........................................................................................................................ 201
8.5
8.6
8.4.1
Overview......................................................................................................... 201
8.4.2
I/O Mode......................................................................................................... 203
8.4.3
Idle Mode........................................................................................................ 205
8.4.4
Repeat Mode................................................................................................... 208
8.4.5
Normal Mode.................................................................................................. 211
8.4.6
Block Transfer Mode ...................................................................................... 214
8.4.7
DMAC Activation .......................................................................................... 219
8.4.8
DMAC Bus Cycle........................................................................................... 221
8.4.9
Multiple-Channel Operation........................................................................... 227
8.4.10
External Bus Requests, Refresh Controller, and DMAC................................ 229
8.4.11
NMI Interrupts and DMAC ............................................................................ 230
8.4.12
Aborting a DMA Transfer .............................................................................. 231
8.4.13
Exiting Full Address Mode............................................................................. 232
8.4.14
DMAC States in Reset State, Standby Modes, and Sleep Mode.................... 233
Interrupts ........................................................................................................................ 234
Usage Notes .................................................................................................................... 235
8.6.1
Note on Word Data Transfer........................................................................... 235
8.6.2
DMAC Self-Access ........................................................................................ 235
8.6.3
Longword Access to Memory Address Registers .......................................... 235
8.6.4
Note on Full Address Mode Setup.................................................................. 235
8.6.5
Note on Activating DMAC by Internal Interrupts.......................................... 236
8.6.6
NMI Interrupts and Block Transfer Mode ...................................................... 237
8.6.7
Memory and I/O Address Register Values ..................................................... 238
8.6.8
Bus Cycle when Transfer is Aborted .............................................................. 238
Section 9
9.1
9.2
9.3
9.4
I/O Ports ....................................................................................................... 239
Overview ........................................................................................................................ 239
Port 4
........................................................................................................................ 242
9.2.1
Overview......................................................................................................... 242
9.2.2
Register Descriptions...................................................................................... 243
9.2.3
Pin Functions in Each Mode........................................................................... 245
9.2.4
Input Pull-Up Transistors................................................................................ 246
Port 6
........................................................................................................................ 247
9.3.1
Overview......................................................................................................... 247
9.3.2
Register Descriptions...................................................................................... 247
9.3.3
Pin Functions .................................................................................................. 249
Port 7
........................................................................................................................ 249
9.4.1
Overview......................................................................................................... 249
9.4.2
Register Description ....................................................................................... 250
9.5
9.6
9.7
9.8
Port 8
9.5.1
9.5.2
9.5.3
Port 9
9.6.1
9.6.2
9.6.3
Port A
9.7.1
9.7.2
9.7.3
Port B
9.8.1
9.8.2
9.8.3
Section 10
10.1
10.2
10.3
........................................................................................................................ 251
Overview......................................................................................................... 251
Register Descriptions...................................................................................... 251
Pin Functions .................................................................................................. 253
........................................................................................................................ 254
Overview......................................................................................................... 254
Register Descriptions...................................................................................... 254
Pin Functions .................................................................................................. 256
........................................................................................................................ 258
Overview......................................................................................................... 258
Register Descriptions...................................................................................... 259
Pin Functions .................................................................................................. 261
........................................................................................................................ 269
Overview......................................................................................................... 269
Register Descriptions...................................................................................... 269
Pin Functions .................................................................................................. 271
16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU)..................................................... 277
Overview ........................................................................................................................ 277
10.1.1
Features........................................................................................................... 277
10.1.2
Block Diagrams .............................................................................................. 280
10.1.3
Input/Output Pins............................................................................................ 285
10.1.4
Register Configuration.................................................................................... 286
Register Descriptions...................................................................................................... 289
10.2.1
Timer Start Register (TSTR) .......................................................................... 289
10.2.2
Timer Synchro Register (TSNC) .................................................................... 290
10.2.3
Timer Mode Register (TMDR)....................................................................... 292
10.2.4
Timer Function Control Register (TFCR) ...................................................... 295
10.2.5
Timer Output Master Enable Register (TOER) .............................................. 297
10.2.6
Timer Output Control Register (TOCR)......................................................... 300
10.2.7
Timer Counters (TCNT) ................................................................................. 301
10.2.8
General Registers (GRA, GRB) ..................................................................... 302
10.2.9
Buffer Registers (BRA, BRB) ........................................................................ 303
10.2.10 Timer Control Registers (TCR) ...................................................................... 304
10.2.11 Timer I/O Control Register (TIOR)................................................................ 306
10.2.12 Timer Status Register (TSR)........................................................................... 308
10.2.13 Timer Interrupt Enable Register (TIER)......................................................... 311
CPU Interface ................................................................................................................. 313
10.3.1
16-Bit Accessible Registers............................................................................ 313
10.3.2
8-Bit Accessible Registers.............................................................................. 315
10.4
10.5
10.6
Operation ........................................................................................................................ 317
10.4.1
Overview......................................................................................................... 317
10.4.2
Basic Functions............................................................................................... 318
10.4.3
Synchronization .............................................................................................. 328
10.4.4
PWM Mode .................................................................................................... 330
10.4.5
Reset-Synchronized PWM Mode ................................................................... 334
10.4.6
Complementary PWM Mode.......................................................................... 337
10.4.7
Phase Counting Mode..................................................................................... 347
10.4.8
Buffering......................................................................................................... 349
10.4.9
ITU Output Timing......................................................................................... 356
Interrupts ........................................................................................................................ 358
10.5.1
Setting of Status Flags .................................................................................... 358
10.5.2
Clearing of Status Flags.................................................................................. 360
10.5.3
Interrupt Sources and DMA Controller Activation ........................................ 361
Usage Notes .................................................................................................................... 362
Section 11
11.1
11.2
11.3
11.4
Programmable Timing Pattern Controller ......................................... 377
Overview ........................................................................................................................ 377
11.1.1
Features........................................................................................................... 377
11.1.2
Block Diagram................................................................................................ 378
11.1.3
TPC Pins ......................................................................................................... 379
11.1.4
Registers ......................................................................................................... 380
Register Descriptions...................................................................................................... 381
11.2.1
Port A Data Direction Register (PADDR) ...................................................... 381
11.2.2
Port A Data Register (PADR) ......................................................................... 381
11.2.3
Port B Data Direction Register (PBDDR) ...................................................... 382
11.2.4
Port B Data Register (PBDR) ......................................................................... 382
11.2.5
Next Data Register A (NDRA)....................................................................... 383
11.2.6
Next Data Register B (NDRB) ....................................................................... 385
11.2.7
Next Data Enable Register A (NDERA) ........................................................ 387
11.2.8
Next Data Enable Register B (NDERB)......................................................... 388
11.2.9
TPC Output Control Register (TPCR)............................................................ 389
11.2.10 TPC Output Mode Register (TPMR).............................................................. 392
Operation ........................................................................................................................ 394
11.3.1
Overview......................................................................................................... 394
11.3.2
Output Timing................................................................................................. 395
11.3.3
Normal TPC Output........................................................................................ 396
11.3.4
Non-Overlapping TPC Output........................................................................ 398
11.3.5
TPC Output Triggering by Input Capture....................................................... 400
Usage Notes .................................................................................................................... 401
11.4.1
Operation of TPC Output Pins........................................................................ 401
11.4.2
Note on Non-Overlapping Output .................................................................. 401
Section 12
12.1
12.2
12.3
12.4
12.5
Watchdog Timer ........................................................................................ 403
Overview ........................................................................................................................ 403
12.1.1
Features........................................................................................................... 403
12.1.2
Block Diagram................................................................................................ 404
12.1.3
Pin Configuration............................................................................................ 404
12.1.4
Register Configuration.................................................................................... 405
Register Descriptions...................................................................................................... 406
12.2.1
Timer Counter (TCNT)................................................................................... 406
12.2.2
Timer Control/Status Register (TCSR)........................................................... 407
12.2.3
Reset Control/Status Register (RSTCSR) ...................................................... 409
12.2.4
Notes on Register Access ............................................................................... 411
Operation ........................................................................................................................ 413
12.3.1
Watchdog Timer Operation............................................................................. 413
12.3.2
Interval Timer Operation ................................................................................ 414
12.3.3
Timing of Setting of Overflow Flag (OVF).................................................... 415
12.3.4
Timing of Setting of Watchdog Timer Reset Bit (WRST) ............................. 416
Interrupts ........................................................................................................................ 417
Usage Notes .................................................................................................................... 417
Section 13
13.1
13.2
13.3
13.4
13.5
Serial Communication Interface ........................................................... 419
Overview ........................................................................................................................ 419
13.1.1
Features........................................................................................................... 419
13.1.2
Block Diagram................................................................................................ 421
13.1.3
Input/Output Pins............................................................................................ 422
13.1.4
Register Configuration.................................................................................... 422
Register Descriptions...................................................................................................... 423
13.2.1
Receive Shift Register (RSR) ......................................................................... 423
13.2.2
Receive Data Register (RDR)......................................................................... 423
13.2.3
Transmit Shift Register (TSR)........................................................................ 424
13.2.4
Transmit Data Register (TDR) ....................................................................... 424
13.2.5
Serial Mode Register (SMR) .......................................................................... 425
13.2.6
Serial Control Register (SCR) ........................................................................ 429
13.2.7
Serial Status Register (SSR) ........................................................................... 433
13.2.8
Bit Rate Register (BRR) ................................................................................. 437
Operation ........................................................................................................................ 446
13.3.1
Overview......................................................................................................... 446
13.3.2
Operation in Asynchronous Mode.................................................................. 448
13.3.3
Multiprocessor Communication ..................................................................... 457
13.3.4
Synchronous Operation .................................................................................. 464
SCI Interrupts.................................................................................................................. 473
Usage Notes .................................................................................................................... 474
Section 14
14.1
14.2
14.3
14.4
14.5
14.6
A/D Converter............................................................................................ 479
Overview ........................................................................................................................ 479
14.1.1
Features........................................................................................................... 479
14.1.2
Block Diagram................................................................................................ 480
14.1.3
Input Pins ........................................................................................................ 481
14.1.4
Register Configuration.................................................................................... 482
Register Descriptions...................................................................................................... 483
14.2.1
A/D Data Registers A to D (ADDRA to ADDRD)........................................ 483
14.2.2
A/D Control/Status Register (ADCSR) .......................................................... 484
14.2.3
A/D Control Register (ADCR) ....................................................................... 487
CPU Interface ................................................................................................................. 488
Operation ........................................................................................................................ 489
14.4.1
Single Mode (SCAN = 0) ............................................................................... 489
14.4.2
Scan Mode (SCAN = 1).................................................................................. 491
14.4.3
Input Sampling and A/D Conversion Time .................................................... 493
14.4.4
External Trigger Input Timing........................................................................ 494
Interrupts ........................................................................................................................ 495
Usage Notes .................................................................................................................... 495
Section 15
15.1
15.2
15.3
RAM ............................................................................................................. 501
Overview ........................................................................................................................ 501
15.1.1
Block Diagram................................................................................................ 501
15.1.2
Register Configuration.................................................................................... 502
System Control Register (SYSCR)................................................................................. 502
Operation ........................................................................................................................ 503
Section 16
16.1
16.2
16.3
16.4
Clock Pulse Generator ............................................................................. 505
Overview ........................................................................................................................ 505
16.1.1
Block Diagram................................................................................................ 505
Oscillator Circuit ............................................................................................................ 506
16.2.1
Connecting a Crystal Resonator ..................................................................... 506
16.2.2
External Clock Input....................................................................................... 508
Duty Adjustment Circuit................................................................................................. 511
Prescalers ........................................................................................................................ 511
Section 17
17.1
17.2
Power-Down State .................................................................................... 513
Overview ........................................................................................................................ 513
Register Configuration.................................................................................................... 514
17.2.1
System Control Register (SYSCR)................................................................. 514
17.3
17.4
17.5
Sleep Mode ..................................................................................................................... 516
17.3.1
Transition to Sleep Mode................................................................................ 516
17.3.2
Exit from Sleep Mode..................................................................................... 516
Software Standby Mode ................................................................................................. 517
17.4.1
Transition to Software Standby Mode ............................................................ 517
17.4.2
Exit from Software Standby Mode ................................................................. 517
17.4.3
Selection of Waiting Time for Exit from Software Standby Mode ................ 518
17.4.4
Sample Application of Software Standby Mode ............................................ 519
17.4.5
Note................................................................................................................. 519
Hardware Standby Mode ................................................................................................ 520
17.5.1
Transition to Hardware Standby Mode........................................................... 520
17.5.2
Exit from Hardware Standby Mode................................................................ 520
17.5.3
Timing for Hardware Standby Mode.............................................................. 520
Section 18
18.1
18.2
18.3
Electrical Characteristics ........................................................................ 521
Absolute Maximum Ratings ........................................................................................... 521
Electrical Characteristics ................................................................................................ 522
18.2.1
DC Characteristics .......................................................................................... 522
18.2.2
AC Characteristics .......................................................................................... 532
18.2.3
A/D Conversion Characteristics ..................................................................... 539
Operational Timing......................................................................................................... 540
18.3.1
Bus Timing ..................................................................................................... 540
18.3.2
Refresh Controller Bus Timing....................................................................... 544
18.3.3
Control Signal Timing .................................................................................... 549
18.3.4
Clock Timing .................................................................................................. 551
18.3.5
TPC and I/O Port Timing................................................................................ 551
18.3.6
ITU Timing ..................................................................................................... 552
18.3.7
SCI Input/Output Timing................................................................................ 553
18.3.8
DMAC Timing................................................................................................ 554
Appendix A Instruction Set ............................................................................................ 557
A.1
A.2
A.3
Instruction List................................................................................................................ 557
Operation Code Map....................................................................................................... 572
Number of States Required for Execution...................................................................... 575
Appendix B Register Field ............................................................................................. 584
B.1
B.2
Register Addresses and Bit Names................................................................................. 584
Register Descriptions...................................................................................................... 593
Appendix C I/O Port Block Diagrams ........................................................................ 662
C.1
C.2
C.3
C.4
C.5
C.6
C.7
Port 4 Block Diagram .....................................................................................................
Port 6 Block Diagrams....................................................................................................
Port 7 Block Diagram .....................................................................................................
Port 8 Block Diagrams....................................................................................................
Port 9 Block Diagrams....................................................................................................
Port A Block Diagrams...................................................................................................
Port B Block Diagrams...................................................................................................
662
663
666
667
670
673
676
Appendix D Pin States ..................................................................................................... 680
D.1
D.2
Port States in Each Mode................................................................................................ 680
Pin States at Reset........................................................................................................... 682
Appendix E
Timing of Transition to and Recovery
from Hardware Standby Mode.............................................................. 685
Appendix F
Package Dimensions ................................................................................ 686
Section 1 Overview
1.1 Overview
The H8/3002 is a microcontroller (MCU) that integrates system supporting functions together
with an H8/300H CPU core having an original Hitachi architecture.
The H8/300H CPU has a 32-bit internal architecture with sixteen 16-bit general registers, and a
concise, optimized instruction set designed for speed. It can address a 16-Mbyte linear address
space. Its instruction set is upward-compatible at the object-code level with the H8/300 CPU,
enabling easy porting of software from the H8/300 Series.
The on-chip system supporting functions include RAM, a 16-bit integrated timer unit (ITU), a
programmable timing pattern controller (TPC), a watchdog timer (WDT), two serial
communication interfaces (SCI), an A/D converter, I/O ports, a direct memory access controller
(DMAC), a refresh controller, and other facilities. Four MCU operating modes offer a choice of
data bus width and address space size.
Table 1-1 summarizes the H8/3002 features.
Table 1-1 Features
Feature
Description
CPU
Upward-compatible with the H8/300 CPU at the object-code level
General-register machine
• Sixteen 16-bit general registers
(also useable as sixteen 8-bit registers or eight 32-bit registers)
High-speed operation
• Maximum clock rate: 17 MHz
• Add/subtract: 118 ns
• Multiply/divide: 824 ns
Two CPU operating modes
• Normal mode (64-kbyte address space, not available in the H8/3002)
• Advanced mode (16-Mbyte address space)
Instruction features
•
•
•
•
•
8/16/32-bit data transfer, arithmetic, and logic instructions
Signed and unsigned multiply instructions (8 bits × 8 bits, 16 bits × 16 bits)
Signed and unsigned divide instructions (16 bits ÷ 8 bits, 32 bits ÷ 16 bits)
Bit accumulator function
Bit manipulation instructions with register-indirect specification of bit positions
1
Table 1-1 Features (cont)
Feature
Description
Memory
RAM: 512 bytes
Interrupt
controller
• Seven external interrupt pins: NMI, IRQ0 to IRQ5
• 30 internal interrupts
• Three selectable interrupt priority levels
Bus controller
• Address space can be partitioned into eight areas, with independent bus
specifications in each area
• Chip select output available for areas 0 to 3
• 8-bit access or 16-bit access selectable for each area
• Two-state or three-state access selectable for each area
• Selection of four wait modes
• Bus arbitration function
Refresh
controller
DRAM refresh
• Directly connectable to 16-bit-wide DRAM
• CAS-before-RAS refresh
• Self-refresh mode selectable
Pseudo-static RAM refresh
• Self-refresh mode selectable
Usable as an interval timer
DMA controller
(DMAC)
Short address mode
• Maximum four channels available
• Selection of I/O mode, idle mode, or repeat mode
• Can be activated by compare match/input capture A interrupts from ITU
channels 0 to 3, SCI transmit-data-empty and receive-data-full interrupts, or
external requests
Full address mode
• Maximum two channels available
• Selection of normal mode or block transfer mode
• Can be activated by compare match/input capture A interrupts from ITU
channels 0 to 3, external requests, or auto-request
2
Table 1-1 Features (cont)
Feature
Description
16-bit integrated
timer unit (ITU)
• Five 16-bit timer channels, capable of processing up to 12 pulse outputs or 10
pulse inputs
• 16-bit timer counter (channels 0 to 4)
• Two multiplexed output compare/input capture pins (channels 0 to 4)
• Operation can be synchronized (channels 0 to 4)
• PWM mode available (channels 0 to 4)
• Phase counting mode available (channel 2)
• Buffering available (channels 3 and 4)
• Reset-synchronized PWM mode available (channels 3 and 4)
• Complementary PWM mode available (channels 3 and 4)
• DMAC can be activated by compare match/input capture A interrupt
(channels 0 to 3)
Programmable
timing pattern
controller (TPC)
•
•
•
•
Watchdog
timer (WDT),
1 channel
• Reset signal can be generated by overflow
• Reset signal can be output externally
• Usable as an interval timer
Serial
communication
interface (SCI),
2 channels
• Selection of asynchronous or synchronous mode
• Full duplex: can transmit and receive simultaneously
• On-chip baud-rate generator
A/D converter
•
•
•
•
•
I/O ports
• 38 input/output pins
• 8 input-only pins
Maximum 16-bit pulse output, using ITU as time base
Up to four 4-bit pulse output groups (or one 16-bit group, or two 8-bit groups)
Non-overlap mode available
Output data can be transferred by DMAC
Resolution: 10 bits
Eight channels, with selection of single or scan mode
Variable analog conversion voltage range
Sample-and-hold function
Can be externally triggered
3
Table 1-1 Features (cont)
Feature
Description
Operating modes Four MCU operating modes
Mode
Address
Space
Address
Pins
Initial Bus Max. Bus
Width
Width
Mode 1
1 Mbyte
A0 to A19
8 bits
16 bits
Mode 2
1 Mbyte
A0 to A19
16 bits
16 bits
Mode 3
16 Mbyte
A0 to A23
8 bits
16 bits
Mode 4
16 Mbyte
A0 to A23
16 bits
16 bits
Power-down
state
• Sleep mode
• Software standby mode
• Hardware standby mode
Other features
• On-chip clock oscillator
Product lineup
Model
Package
Power Supply Voltage
HD6413002F
100-pin QFP
(FP-100B)
5 V ±10%
HD6413002VF
HD6413002TF
HD6413002VTF
HD6413002FP
HD6413002VFP
2.7 V to 5.5 V
100-pin TQFP
(TFP-100B)
5 V ±10%
100-pin QFP
(FP-100A)
5 V ±10%
4
2.7 V to 5.5 V
2.7 V to 5.5 V
1.2 Block Diagram
Data bus
P40/D0
P41/D1
P42/D2
P43/D3
P44/D4
P45/D5
P46/D6
P47/D7
D8
D9
D10
D11
D12
D13
D15
D14
VSS
VSS
VSS
VSS
VSS
VSS
VCC
VCC
VCC
Figure 1-1 shows an internal block diagram.
Port 4
MD2
MD1
Clock
osc.
STBY
H8/300H CPU
RES
A19
Address bus
Data bus (lower)
XTAL
ø
Data bus (upper)
MD0
EXTAL
A18
A17
A16
A15
RESO
LWR
DMA controller
(DMAC)
RD
A13
A12
Address bus
Interrupt controller
HWR
A14
Bus controller
NMI
AS
P61/BREQ
P60/WAIT
Port 6
P62/BACK
RAM
512 bytes
A11
A10
A9
A8
A7
Refresh
controller
A6
A5
P84/CS0
P80/RFSH/IRQ0
A3
A2
A1
Serial communication
interface
(SCI) × 2 channels
A0
P95/SCK1/IRQ5
Port 9
P94/SCK0/IRQ4
Programmable
timing pattern
controller (TPC)
A/D converter
P93/RxD1
P92/RxD0
P91/TxD1
P90/TxD0
Figure 1-1 Block Diagram
5
P70/AN0
P71/AN1
P73/AN2
P73/AN3
P74/AN4
P75/AN5
P76/AN6
P77/AN7
AVSS
AVCC
VREF
PA0/TP0/TEND0/TCLKA
PA1/TP1/TEND1/TCLKB
Port 7
PA2/TP2/TIOCA0/TCLKC
PA3/TP3/TIOCB0/TCLKD
PA4/TP4/TIOCA1/A23
PA5/TP5/TIOCB1/A22
PB0/TP8/TIOCA3
PB1/TP9/TIOCB3
Port A
PB2/TP10/TIOCA4
PB3/TP11/TIOCB4
PB4/TP12/TOCXA4
PB5/TP13/TOCXB4
PB6/TP14/DREQ0
PB7/TP15/DREQ1/ADTRG
Port B
PA6/TP6/TIOCA2/A21
P81/CS3/IRQ1
Watchdog timer
(WDT)
16-bit
integrated
timer unit
(ITU)
PA7/TP7/TIOCB2/A20
P82/CS2/IRQ2
A4
Port 8
P83/CS1/IRQ3
1.3 Pin Description
1.3.1 Pin Arrangement
ø
P62/BACK
P61/BREQ
P60/WAIT
61
60
59
58
A14
STBY
62
A15
RES
63
51
NMI
64
A16
VSS
65
52
EXTAL
66
A17
XTAL
67
53
VCC
68
A18
AS
69
54
RD
70
55
HWR
71
VSS
LWR
72
A19
MD0
73
56
MD1
74
57
MD2
75
Figure 1-2 shows the pin arrangement of the H8/3002’s FP-100B, TFP-100B package.
AVCC
76
50
A13
VREF
77
49
A12
AN0/P70
78
48
A11
AN1/P71
79
47
A10
AN2/P72
80
46
A9
AN3/P73
81
45
A8
AN4/P74
82
44
VSS
AN5/P75
83
43
A7
AN6/P76
84
42
A6
AN7/P77
85
41
A5
AVSS
86
40
A4
IRQ0/RFSH/P80
87
39
A3
IRQ1/CS3/P81
88
38
A2
IRQ2/CS2/P82
89
37
A1
IRQ3/CS1/P83
90
36
A0
CS0/P84
91
35
VCC
VSS
92
34
D15
TCLKA/TEND0/TP0/PA0
93
33
D14
Top view
(FP-100B, TFP-100B)
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
TxD1/P91
RxD0/P92
RxD1/P93
IRQ4/SCK0/P94
IRQ5/SCK1/P95
D0/P40
D1/P41
D2/P42
D3/P43
VSS
D4/P44
D5/P45
D6/P46
11
VSS
TxD0/P90
10
P47/D7
RESO
26
9
100
ADTRG/DREQ1/TP15/PB7
D8
A20/TIOCB2/TP7/PA7
8
27
DREQ0/TP14/PB6
99
7
D9
A21/TIOCA2/TP6/PA6
TOCXB4/TP13/PB5
28
6
98
TOCXA4/TP12/PB4
D10
A22/TIOCB1/TP5/PA5
5
29
TIOCB4/TP11/PB3
97
4
D11
A23/TIOCA1/TP4/PA4
TIOCA4/TP10/PB2
30
3
96
TIOCB3/TP9/PB1
D12
TCLKD/TIOCB0/TP3/PA3
2
D13
31
1
32
95
VCC
94
TIOCA3/TP8/PB0
TCLKB/TEND1/TP1/PA1
TCLKC/TIOCA0/TP2/PA2
Figure 1-2 Pin Arrangement (FP-100B, TFP-100B, Top View)
6
42
A4
IRQ1/CS3/P81
90
41
A3
IRQ2/CS2/P82
91
40
A2
IRQ3/CS1/P83
92
39
A1
CS0/P84
93
38
A0
VSS
94
37
VCC
TCLKA/TEND0/TP0/PA0
95
36
D15
TCLKB/TEND1/TP1/PA1
96
35
D14
TCLKC/TIOCA0/TP2/PA2
97
34
D13
TCLKD/TIOCB0/TP3/PA3
98
33
D12
A23/TIOCA1/TP4/PA4
99
32
D11
A22/TIOCB1/TP5/PA5
100
31
D10
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
VSS
TxD0/P90
TxD1/P91
RxD0/P92
RxD1/P93
IRQ4/SCK0/P94
IRQ5/SCK1/P95
D0/P40
D1/P41
D2/P42
D3/P43
VSS
D4/P44
D5/P45
D6/P46
D7/P47
D8
D9
12
89
RESO
A5
IRQ0/RFSH/P80
11
43
ADTRG/DREQ1/TP15/PB7
88
10
A6
AVSS
DREQ0/TP14/PB6
44
9
87
TOCXB4/TP13/PB5
A7
AN7/P77
8
45
TOCXA4/TP12/PB4
86
7
VSS
AN6/P76
TIOCB4/TP11/PB3
46
6
85
TIOCA4/TP10/PB2
A8
AN5/P75
5
A9
47
TIOCB3/TP9/PB1
48
84
4
83
AN4/P74
TIOCA3/TP8/PB0
AN3/P73
3
A10
VCC
A11
49
2
50
82
1
81
AN2/P72
A20/TIOCB2/TP7/PA7
AN1/P71
A21/TIOCA2/TP6/PA6
7
A15
A14
A13
A12
53
52
51
ø
63
A16
STBY
64
54
RES
65
A17
NMI
66
55
VSS
67
A18
EXTAL
68
56
XTAL
69
A19
VCC
70
57
AS
71
VSS
RD
72
58
HWR
73
P60/WAIT
LWR
74
59
MD0
75
60
MD1
76
P62/BACK
MD2
77
P61/BREQ
AVCC
78
61
VREF
79
62
P70/AN0
80
Figure 1-3 shows the pin arrangement of the H8/3002’s FP-100A package.
Top view
(FP-100A)
Figure 1-3 Pin Arrangement (FP-100A, TopView)
1.3.2 Pin Functions
Pin Assignments in Each Mode: Table 1-2 lists the pin assignments in each mode.
Table 1-2 Pin Assignments in Each Mode
Pin No.
Pin Name
FP-100B,
TFP-100B FP-100A Mode 1
Mode 2
Mode 3
Mode 4
1
3
VCC
VCC
VCC
VCC
2
4
PB0/TP8/TIOCA3
PB0/TP8/TIOCA3
PB0/TP8/TIOCA3
PB0/TP8/TIOCA3
3
5
PB1/TP9/TIOCB3
PB1/TP9/TIOCB3
PB1/TP9/TIOCB3
PB1/TP9/TIOCB3
4
6
PB2/TP10/TIOCA4
PB2/TP10/TIOCA4
PB2/TP10/TIOCA4
PB2/TP10/TIOCA4
5
7
PB3/TP11/TIOCB4
PB3/TP11/TIOCB4
PB3/TP11/TIOCB4
PB3/TP11/TIOCB4
6
8
PB4/TP12/TOCXA4
PB4/TP12/TOCXA4
PB4/TP12/TOCXA4
PB4/TP12/TOCXA4
7
9
PB5/TP13/TOCXB4
PB5/TP13/TOCXB4
PB5/TP13/TOCXB4
PB5/TP13/TOCXB4
8
10
PB6/TP14/DREQ0
PB6/TP14/DREQ0
PB6/TP14/DREQ0
PB6/TP14/DREQ0
9
11
PB7/TP15/DREQ1/ADTRG PB7/TP15/DREQ1/ADTRG PB7/TP15/DREQ1/ADTRG PB7/TP15/DREQ1/ADTRG
10
12
RESO
RESO
RESO
RESO
11
13
VSS
VSS
VSS
VSS
12
14
P90/TxD0
P90/TxD0
P90/TxD0
P90/TxD0
13
15
P91/TxD1
P91/TxD1
P91/TxD1
P91/TxD1
14
16
P92/RxD0
P92/RxD0
P92/RxD0
P92/RxD0
15
17
P93/RxD1
P93/RxD1
P93/RxD1
P93/RxD1
16
18
P94/SCK0/IRQ4
P94/SCK0/IRQ4
P94/SCK0/IRQ4
P94/SCK0/IRQ4
17
19
P95/SCK1/IRQ5
P95/SCK1/IRQ5
P95/SCK1/IRQ5
P95/SCK1/IRQ5
18
20
P40/D0*1
P40/D0*2
P40/D0*1
P40/D0*2
19
21
P41/D1*1
P41/D1*2
P41/D1*1
P41/D1*2
20
22
P42/D2*1
P42/D2*2
P42/D2*1
P42/D2*2
21
23
P43/D3*1
P43/D3*2
P43/D3*1
P43/D3*2
22
24
VSS
VSS
VSS
VSS
23
25
P44/D4*1
P44/D4*2
P44/D4*1
P44/D4*2
24
26
P45/D5*1
P45/D5*2
P45/D5*1
P45/D5*2
25
27
P46/D6*1
P46/D6*2
P46/D6*1
P46/D6*2
26
28
P47/D7*1
P47/D7*2
P47/D7*1
P47/D7*2
Notes: 1. In modes 1 and 3 the P40 to P47 functions of pins P40/D0 to P47/D7 are selected after a reset,
but they can be changed by software.
2. In modes 2 and 4 the D0 to D7 functions of pins P40/D0 to D47/D7 are selected after a reset, but
they can be changed by software.
8
Table 1-2 Pin Assignments in Each Mode (cont)
Pin No.
Pin Name
FP-100B,
TFP-100B FP-100A Mode 1
Mode 2
Mode 3
Mode 4
27
29
D8
D8
D8
D8
28
30
D9
D9
D9
D9
29
31
D10
D10
D10
D10
30
32
D11
D11
D11
D11
31
33
D12
D12
D12
D12
32
34
D13
D13
D13
D13
33
35
D14
D14
D14
D14
34
36
D15
D15
D15
D15
35
37
VCC
VCC
VCC
VCC
36
38
A0
A0
A0
A0
37
39
A1
A1
A1
A1
38
40
A2
A2
A2
A2
39
41
A3
A3
A3
A3
40
42
A4
A4
A4
A4
41
43
A5
A5
A5
A5
42
44
A6
A6
A6
A6
43
45
A7
A7
A7
A7
44
46
VSS
VSS
VSS
VSS
45
47
A8
A8
A8
A8
46
48
A9
A9
A9
A9
47
49
A10
A10
A10
A10
48
50
A11
A11
A11
A11
49
51
A12
A12
A12
A12
50
52
A13
A13
A13
A13
51
53
A14
A14
A14
A14
52
54
A15
A15
A15
A15
53
55
A16
A16
A16
A16
54
56
A17
A17
A17
A17
55
57
A18
A18
A18
A18
56
58
A19
A19
A19
A19
9
Table 1-2 Pin Assignments in Each Mode (cont)
Pin No.
Pin Name
FP-100B,
TFP-100B FP-100A Mode 1
Mode 2
Mode 3
Mode 4
57
59
VSS
VSS
VSS
VSS
58
60
P60/WAIT
P60/WAIT
P60/WAIT
P60/WAIT
59
61
P61/BREQ
P61/BREQ
P61/BREQ
P61/BREQ
60
62
P62/BACK
P62/BACK
P62/BACK
P62/BACK
61
63
ø
ø
ø
ø
62
64
STBY
STBY
STBY
STBY
63
65
RES
RES
RES
RES
64
66
NMI
NMI
NMI
NMI
65
67
VSS
VSS
VSS
VSS
66
68
EXTAL
EXTAL
EXTAL
EXTAL
67
69
XTAL
XTAL
XTAL
XTAL
68
70
VCC
VCC
VCC
VCC
69
71
AS
AS
AS
AS
70
72
RD
RD
RD
RD
71
73
HWR
HWR
HWR
HWR
72
74
LWR
LWR
LWR
LWR
73
75
MD0
MD0
MD0
MD0
74
76
MD1
MD1
MD1
MD1
75
77
MD2
MD2
MD2
MD2
76
78
AVCC
AVCC
AVCC
AVCC
77
79
VREF
VREF
VREF
VREF
78
80
P70/AN0
P70/AN0
P70/AN0
P70/AN0
79
81
P71/AN1
P71/AN1
P71/AN1
P71/AN1
80
82
P72/AN2
P72/AN2
P72/AN2
P72/AN2
81
83
P73/AN3
P73/AN3
P73/AN3
P73/AN3
82
84
P74/AN4
P74/AN4
P74/AN4
P74/AN4
83
85
P75/AN5
P75/AN5
P75/AN5
P75/AN5
84
86
P76/AN6
P76/AN6
P76/AN6
P76/AN6
85
87
P77/AN7
P77/AN7
P77/AN7
P77/AN7
10
Table 1-2 Pin Assignments in Each Mode (cont)
Pin No.
Pin Name
FP-100B,
TFP-100B FP-100A Mode 1
Mode 2
Mode 3
Mode 4
86
88
AVSS
AVSS
AVSS
AVSS
87
89
P80/RFSH/IRQ0
P80/RFSH/IRQ0
P80/RFSH/IRQ0
P80/RFSH/IRQ0
88
90
P81/CS3/IRQ1
P81/CS3/IRQ1
P81/CS3/IRQ1
P81/CS3/IRQ1
89
91
P82/CS2/IRQ2
P82/CS2/IRQ2
P82/CS2/IRQ2
P82/CS2/IRQ2
90
92
P83/CS1/IRQ3
P83/CS1/IRQ3
P83/CS1/IRQ3
P83/CS1/IRQ3
91
93
P84/CS0
P84/CS0
P84/CS0
P84/CS0
92
94
VSS
VSS
VSS
VSS
93
95
PA0/TP0/TEND0/TCLKA PA0/TP0/TEND0/TCLKA PA0/TP0/TEND0/TCLKA PA0/TP0/TEND0/TCLKA
94
96
PA1/TP1/TEND1/TCLKB PA1/TP1/TEND1/TCLKB PA1/TP1/TEND1/TCLKB PA1/TP1/TEND1/TCLKB
95
97
PA2/TP2/TIOCA0/TCLKC PA2/TP2/TIOCA0/TCLKC PA2/TP2/TIOCA0/TCLKC PA2/TP2/TIOCA0/TCLKC
96
98
PA3/TP3/TIOCB0/TCLKD PA3/TP3/TIOCB0/TCLKD PA3/TP3/TIOCB0/TCLKD PA3/TP3/TIOCB0/TCLKD
97
99
PA4/TP4/TIOCA1
PA4/TP4/TIOCA1
PA4/TP4/TIOCA1/A23
PA4/TP4/TIOCA1/A23
98
100
PA5/TP5/TIOCB1
PA5/TP5/TIOCB1
PA5/TP5/TIOCB1/A22
PA5/TP5/TIOCB1/A22
99
1
PA6/TP6/TIOCA2
PA6/TP6/TIOCA2
PA6/TP6/TIOCA2/A21
PA6/TP6/TIOCA2/A21
100
2
PA7/TP7/TIOCB2
PA7/TP7/TIOCB2
A20
A20
11
1.4 Pin Functions
Table 1-3 summarizes the pin functions.
Table 1-3 Pin Functions
Pin No.
Type
Symbol
FP-100B,
TFP-100B
FP-100A
I/O
Name and Function
Power
VCC
1, 35, 68
3, 37, 70
Input
Power: For connection to the power supply.
Connect all VCC pins to the system power supply.
VSS
11, 22, 44,
57, 65, 92
13, 24, 46, Input
59, 67, 94
Ground: For connection to ground (0 V).
Connect all VSS pins to the 0-V system power
supply.
XTAL
67
69
Input
For connection to a crystal resonator.
For examples of crystal resonator and external
clock input, see section 16, Clock Pulse
Generator.
EXTAL
66
68
Input
For connection to a crystal resonator or input
of an external clock signal. For examples of
crystal resonator and external clock input,
see section 16, Clock Pulse Generator.
ø
61
63
Output
System clock: Supplies the system clock to
external devices
MD2 to MD0
75 to 73
77 to 75
Input
Mode 2 to 0: For setting the operating
mode, as follows. Inputs at these pins must
not be changed during operation.
Clock
Operating
12
MD2
MD1
MD0
Operating Mode
0
0
0
—
0
0
1
Mode 1
0
1
0
Mode 2
0
1
1
Mode 3
1
0
0
Mode 4
1
0
1
—
1
1
0
—
1
1
1
—
Table 1-3 Pin Functions (cont)
Pin No.
Type
Symbol
FP-100B,
TFP-100B
FP-100A
I/O
Name and Function
System
control
RES
63
65
Input
Reset input: When driven low, this pin
resets control the H8/3002
RESO
10
12
Output
Reset output: Outputs the reset signal
generated by the watchdog timer to external
devices.
STBY
62
64
Input
Standby: When driven low, this pin forces a
transition to hardware standby mode
BREQ
59
61
Input
Bus request: Used by an external bus
master to request the bus right from the
H8/3002
BACK
60
62
Output
Bus request acknowledge: Indicates that
the bus has been granted to an external bus
master
NMI
64
66
Input
Nonmaskable interrupt: Requests a
nonmaskable interrupt
IRQ5 to
IRQ0
17, 16,
90 to 87
19, 18
92 to 89
Input
Interrupt request 5 to 0: Maskable
interrupt request pins
Modes A19 to 56 to 45,
1 and 2 A0
43 to 36
58 to 47
45 to38
Output
Address bus: Outputs address signals
Modes A23 to 100 to 97,
3 and 4 A0
56 to 45,
43 to 36
99, 100,
1, 2,
58 to 47
45 to 38
D15 to D0
34 to 23,
21 to 18
36 to 25
23 to 20
Input/
output
Data bus: Bidirectional data bus
Interrupts
Address
bus
Data bus
Bus control CS3 to CS0
91 to 88
90 to 93
Output
Chip select: Select signals for areas 3 to 0
AS
69
71
Output
Address strobe: Goes low to indicate valid
address output on the address bus
RD
70
72
Output
Read: Goes low to indicate reading from the
external address space
HWR
71
73
Output
High write: Goes low to indicate writing to
the external address space; indicates valid
data on the upper data bus (D15 to D8).
LWR
72
74
Output
Low write: Goes low to indicate writing to
the external address space; indicates valid
data on the lower data bus (D7 to D0).
WAIT
58
60
Input
Wait: Requests insertion of wait states in
bus cycles during access to the external
address space
13
Table 1-3 Pin Functions (cont)
Pin No.
Type
Refresh
controller
Symbol
FP-100B,
TFP-100B
FP-100A
I/O
Name and Function
RFSH
87
89
Output
Refresh: Indicates a refresh cycle
CS3
88
90
Output
Row address strobe RAS: Row address
strobe signal for DRAM connected to area 3
RD
70
72
Output
Column address strobe CAS: Column
address strobe signal for DRAM connected
to area 3; used with 2WE DRAM.
Write enable: Write enable signal for DRAM
connected to area 3; used with 2CAS DRAM.
HWR
71
73
Output
Upper write: Write enable signal for DRAM
connected to area 3; used with 2WE DRAM.
Upper column address strobe: Column
address strobe signal for DRAM connected
to area 3; used with 2CAS DRAM.
LWR
72
74
Output
Lower write: Write enable signal for DRAM
connected to area 3; used with 2WE DRAM.
Lower column address strobe: Column
address strobe signal for DRAM connected
to area 3; used with 2CAS DRAM.
DREQ1,
DREQ0
9, 8
11, 10
Input
DMA request 1 and 0: DMAC activation
requests
TEND1,
TEND0
94, 93
96, 95
Output
Transfer end 1 and 0: These signals indicate
that the DMAC has ended a data transfer
TCLKD to
TCLKA
96 to 93
98 to 95
Input
Clock input D to A: External clock inputs
TIOCA4 to
TIOCA0
4, 2, 99,
97, 95
6, 4, 1,
99, 97
Input/
output
Input capture/output compare A4 to A0:
GRA4 to GRA0 output compare or input
capture, or PWM output
TIOCB4 to
TIOCB0
5, 3, 100,
98, 96
7, 5, 2,
100, 98
Input/
output
Input capture/output compare B4 to B0:
GRB4 to GRB0 output compare or input
capture, or PWM output
TOCXA4
6
8
Output
Output compare XA4: PWM output
TOCXB4
7
9
Output
Output compare XB4: PWM output
14
Table 1-3 Pin Functions (cont)
Pin No.
FP-100B,
TFP-100B
FP-100A
I/O
Name and Function
Programmable TP15 to
timing pattern
TP0
controller (TPC)
9 to 2,
100 to 93
11 to 4
2 to 95
Output
TPC output 15 to 0: Pulse output
Serial communication
interface (SCI)
TxD1,
TxD0
13, 12
15, 14
Output
Transmit data (channels 0 and 1): SCI data
output
RxD1,
RxD0
15, 14
17, 16
Input
Receive data (channels 0 and 1): SCI data
input
SCK1,
SCK0
17, 16
19, 18
Input/
output
Serial clock (channels 0 and 1): SCI clock
input/output
AN7 to AN0 85 to 78
45 to 38
Input
Analog 7 to 0: Analog input pins
ADTRG
9
11
Input
A/D trigger: External trigger input for starting
A/D conversion
AVCC
76
78
Input
Power supply pin for the A/D converter.
Connect to the system power supply when
not using the A/D converter.
AVSS
86
88
Input
Ground pin for the A/D converter. Connect to
system ground (0 V).
VREF
77
79
Input
Reference voltage input pin for the A/D
converter. Connect to the system power
supply when not using the A/D converter.
P47 to P40
26 to 23,
21 to 18
28 to 25
23 to 20
Input/
output
Port 4: Eight input/output pins. The
direction of each pin can be selected in the
port 4 data direction register (P4DDR).
P62 to P60
60 to 58
62 to 60
Input/
output
Port 6: Three input/output pins. The direction
of each pin can be selected in the port 6 data
direction register (P6DDR).
P77 to P70
85 to 78
87 to 80
Input
Port 7: Eight input pins
P84 to P80
91 to 87
93 to 89
Input/
output
Port 8: Five input/output pins. The direction
of each pin can be selected in the port 8 data
direction register (P8DDR).
Type
A/D
converter
I/O ports
Symbol
15
Table 1-3 Pin Functions (cont)
Pin No.
Type
Symbol
FP-100B,
TFP-100B
FP-100A
I/O
Name and Function
I/O ports
P95 to P90
17 to 12
19 to 14
Input/
output
Port 9: Six input/output pins. The direction
of each pin can be selected in the port 9
data direction register (P9DDR).
PA7 to PA0
100 to 93
2, 1,
100 to 95
Input/
output
Port A: Eight input/output pins. The direction
of each pin can be selected in the port A
data direction register (PADDR).
PB7 to PB0
9 to 2
11 to 4
Input/
output
Port B: Eight input/output pins. The direction
of each pin can be selected in the port B
data direction register (PBDDR).
16
Section 2 CPU
2.1 Overview
The H8/300H CPU is a high-speed central processing unit with an internal 32-bit architecture that
is upward-compatible with the H8/300 CPU. The H8/300H CPU has sixteen 16-bit general
registers, can address a 16-Mbyte linear address space, and is ideal for realtime control.
2.1.1 Features
The H8/300H CPU has the following features.
•
Upward compatibility with H8/300 CPU
Can execute H8/300 series object programs
•
General-register architecture
Sixteen 16-bit general registers (also usable as sixteen 8-bit registers or eight 32-bit registers)
•
Sixty-two basic instructions
— 8/16/32-bit arithmetic and logic instructions
— Multiply and divide instructions
— Powerful bit-manipulation instructions
•
Eight addressing modes
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
•
Register direct [Rn]
Register indirect [@ERn]
Register indirect with displacement [@(d:16, ERn) or @(d:24, ERn)]
Register indirect with post-increment or pre-decrement [@ERn+ or @–ERn]
Absolute address [@aa:8, @aa:16, or @aa:24]
Immediate [#xx:8, #xx:16, or #xx:32]
Program-counter relative [@(d:8, PC) or @(d:16, PC)]
Memory indirect [@@aa:8]
16-Mbyte linear address space
17
•
High-speed operation
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
•
All frequently-used instructions execute in two to four states
Maximum clock frequency:
17 MHz
8/16/32-bit register-register add/subtract: 118 ns
8 × 8-bit register-register multiply:
824 ns
16 ÷ 8-bit register-register divide:
824 ns
16 × 16-bit register-register multiply:
1,294 ns
32 ÷ 16-bit register-register divide:
1,294 ns
Two CPU operating modes
— Normal mode (not available in H8/3002)
— Advanced mode
•
Low-power mode
Transition to power-down state by SLEEP instruction
2.1.2 Differences from H8/300 CPU
In comparison to the H8/300 CPU, the H8/300H has the following enhancements.
•
More general registers
Eight 16-bit registers have been added.
•
Expanded address space
— Advanced mode supports a maximum 16-Mbyte address space.
— Normal mode supports the same 64-kbyte address space as the H8/300 CPU.
•
Enhanced addressing
The addressing modes have been enhanced to make effective use of the 16-Mbyte address
space.
•
Enhanced instructions
— Data transfer, arithmetic, and logic instructions can operate on 32-bit data.
— Signed multiply/divide instructions and other instructions have been added.
18
2.2 CPU Operating Modes
The H8/300H CPU has two operating modes: normal and advanced. Normal mode supports a
maximum 64-kbyte address space. Advanced mode supports up to 16 Mbytes. See figure 2-1.
The H8/3002 uses only advanced mode.
Normal mode *
Maximum 64 kbytes, program
and data areas combined
Advanced mode
Maximum 16 Mbytes, program
and data areas combined
CPU operating modes
Note: * Normal mode is not available in the H8/3002 .
Figure 2-1 CPU Operating Modes
19
2.3 Address Space
The maximum address space of the H8/300H CPU is 16 Mbytes. The H8/3002 has two operating
modes (MCU modes), one providing a 1-Mbyte address space, the other supporting the full
16 Mbytes.
Figure 2-2 shows the H8/3002’s address ranges. For further details see section 3.6, Memory Map
in Each Operating Mode.
The 1-Mbyte operating mode uses 20-bit addressing. The upper 4 bits of effective addresses are
ignored.
H'00000
H'000000
H'FFFFF
H'FFFFFF
a. 1-Mbyte mode
b. 16-Mbyte mode
Figure 2-2 Memory Map
20
2.4 Register Configuration
2.4.1 Overview
The H8/300H CPU has the internal registers shown in figure 2-3. There are two types of registers:
general registers and control registers.
General Registers (ERn)
15
0 7
0 7
0
ER0
E0
R0H
R0L
ER1
E1
R1H
R1L
ER2
E2
R2H
R2L
ER3
E3
R3H
R3L
ER4
E4
R4H
R4L
ER5
E5
R5H
R5L
ER6
E6
R6H
R6L
ER7
E7
R7H
R7L
(SP)
Control Registers (CR)
23
0
PC
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
CCR I UI H U N Z V C
Legend
SP: Stack pointer
PC: Program counter
CCR: Condition code register
Interrupt mask bit
I:
User bit or interrupt mask bit
UI:
Half-carry flag
H:
User bit
U:
Negative flag
N:
Zero flag
Z:
Overflow flag
V:
Carry flag
C:
Figure 2-3 CPU Registers
21
2.4.2 General Registers
The H8/300H CPU has eight 32-bit general registers. These general registers are all functionally
alike and can be used without distinction between data registers and address registers. When a
general register is used as a data register, it can be accessed as a 32-bit, 16-bit, or 8-bit register.
When the general registers are used as 32-bit registers or as address registers, they are designated
by the letters ER (ER0 to ER7).
The ER registers divide into 16-bit general registers designated by the letters E (E0 to E7) and R
(R0 to R7). These registers are functionally equivalent, providing a maximum sixteen 16-bit
registers. The E registers (E0 to E7) are also referred to as extended registers.
The R registers divide into 8-bit general registers designated by the letters RH (R0H to R7H) and
RL (R0L to R7L). These registers are functionally equivalent, providing a maximum sixteen 8-bit
registers.
Figure 2-4 illustrates the usage of the general registers. The usage of each register can be selected
independently.
• Address registers
• 32-bit registers
• 16-bit registers
• 8-bit registers
E registers
(extended registers)
E0 to E7
RH registers
R0H to R7H
ER registers
ER0 to ER7
R registers
R0 to R7
RL registers
R0L to R7L
Figure 2-4 Usage of General Registers
22
General register ER7 has the function of stack pointer (SP) in addition to its general-register
function, and is used implicitly in exception handling and subroutine calls. Figure 2-5 shows the
stack.
Free area
SP (ER7)
Stack area
Figure 2-5 Stack
2.4.3 Control Registers
The control registers are the 24-bit program counter (PC) and the 8-bit condition code register
(CCR).
Program Counter (PC): This 24-bit counter indicates the address of the next instruction the CPU
will execute. The length of all CPU instructions is 2 bytes (one word) or a multiple of 2 bytes, so
the least significant PC bit is ignored. When an instruction is fetched, the least significant PC bit is
regarded as 0.
Condition Code Register (CCR): This 8-bit register contains internal CPU status information,
including the interrupt mask bit (I) and half-carry (H), negative (N), zero (Z), overflow (V), and
carry (C) flags.
Bit 7—Interrupt Mask Bit (I): Masks interrupts other than NMI when set to 1. NMI is accepted
regardless of the I bit setting. The I bit is set to 1 at the start of an exception-handling sequence.
Bit 6—User Bit or Interrupt Mask Bit (UI): Can be written and read by software using the
LDC, STC, ANDC, ORC, and XORC instructions. This bit can also be used as an interrupt mask
bit. For details see section 5, Interrupt Controller.
23
Bit 5—Half-Carry Flag (H): When the ADD.B, ADDX.B, SUB.B, SUBX.B, CMP.B, or NEG.B
instruction is executed, this flag is set to 1 if there is a carry or borrow at bit 3, and cleared to 0
otherwise. When the ADD.W, SUB.W, CMP.W, or NEG.W instruction is executed, the H flag is
set to 1 if there is a carry or borrow at bit 11, and cleared to 0 otherwise. When the ADD.L,
SUB.L, CMP.L, or NEG.L instruction is executed, the H flag is set to 1 if there is a carry or
borrow at bit 27, and cleared to 0 otherwise.
Bit 4—User Bit (U): Can be written and read by software using the LDC, STC, ANDC, ORC,
and XORC instructions.
Bit 3—Negative Flag (N): Indicates the most significant bit (sign bit) of data.
Bit 2—Zero Flag (Z): Set to 1 to indicate zero data, and cleared to 0 to indicate non-zero data.
Bit 1—Overflow Flag (V): Set to 1 when an arithmetic overflow occurs, and cleared to 0 at other
times.
Bit 0—Carry Flag (C): Set to 1 when a carry occurs, and cleared to 0 otherwise. Used by:
•
•
•
Add instructions, to indicate a carry
Subtract instructions, to indicate a borrow
Shift and rotate instructions, to store the value shifted out of the end bit
The carry flag is also used as a bit accumulator by bit manipulation instructions.
Some instructions leave flag bits unchanged. Operations can be performed on CCR by the LDC,
STC, ANDC, ORC, and XORC instructions. The N, Z, V, and C flags are used by conditional
branch (Bcc) instructions.
For the action of each instruction on the flag bits, see appendix A.1, Instruction List. For the I and
UI bits, see section 5, Interrupt Controller.
2.4.4 Initial CPU Register Values
In reset exception handling, PC is initialized to a value loaded from the vector table, and the I bit
in CCR is set to 1. The other CCR bits and the general registers are not initialized. In particular,
the stack pointer (ER7) is not initialized. The stack pointer must therefore be initialized by an
MOV.L instruction executed immediately after a reset.
24
2.5 Data Formats
The H8/300H CPU can process 1-bit, 4-bit (BCD), 8-bit (byte), 16-bit (word), and 32-bit
(longword) data. Bit-manipulation instructions operate on 1-bit data by accessing bit n (n = 0, 1,
2, …, 7) of byte operand data. The DAA and DAS decimal-adjust instructions treat byte data as
two digits of 4-bit BCD data.
2.5.1 General Register Data Formats
Figures 2-6 and 2-7 show the data formats in general registers.
Data Type
General
Register
Data Format
7
1-bit data
RnH
0
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Don’t care
7
1-bit data
7
4-bit BCD data
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Don’t care
RnL
RnH
4 3
0
Don’t care
Upper digit Lower digit
7
4-bit BCD data
Byte data
Byte data
Don’t care
RnL
0
4 3
0
Upper digit Lower digit
7
0
MSB
LSB
Don’t care
RnH
7
0
MSB
LSB
Don’t care
RnL
Figure 2-6 General Register Data Formats (1)
25
Data Type
General
Register
Word data
Rn
Word data
Data Format
15
0
MSB
LSB
15
0
MSB
LSB
En
31
16 15
0
Longword data ERn
MSB
LSB
Legend
ERn: General register
En:
General register E
Rn:
General register R
RnH: General register RH
RnL: General register RL
MSB: Most significant bit
LSB: Least significant bit
Figure 2-7 General Register Data Formats (2)
2.5.2 Memory Data Formats
Figure 2-8 shows the data formats on memory. The H8/300H CPU can access word data and
longword data on memory, but word or longword data must begin at an even address. If an
attempt is made to access word or longword data at an odd address, no address error occurs but
the least significant bit of the address is regarded as 0, so the access starts at the preceding
address. This also applies to instruction fetches.
26
Data Type
Address
Data Format
7
1-bit data
Address L
7
Byte data
Address L
MSB
Word data
Address 2M
MSB
0
6
5
4
Address 2M + 1
2
1
0
LSB
LSB
Address 2N
Longword data
3
MSB
Address 2N + 1
Address 2N + 2
Address 2N + 3
LSB
Figure 2-8 Memory Data Formats
When ER7 (SP) is used as an address register to access the stack, the operand size should be word
size or longword size.
27
2.6 Instruction Set
2.6.1 Instruction Set Overview
The H8/300H CPU has 62 types of instructions, which are classified in table 2-1.
Table 2-1 Instruction Classification
Function
Instruction
PUSH*1,
Types
POP*1,
MOVTPE*2,
MOVFPE*2
3
Data transfer
MOV,
Arithmetic operations
ADD, SUB, ADDX, SUBX, INC, DEC, ADDS, SUBS, DAA, DAS,
MULXU, DIVXU, MULXS, DIVXS, CMP, NEG, EXTS, EXTU
18
Logic operations
AND, OR, XOR, NOT
4
Shift operations
SHAL, SHAR, SHLL, SHLR, ROTL, ROTR, ROTXL, ROTXR
8
Bit manipulation
BSET, BCLR, BNOT, BTST, BAND, BIAND, BOR, BIOR, BXOR,
BIXOR, BLD, BILD, BST, BIST
14
Branch
Bcc*3, JMP, BSR, JSR, RTS
5
System control
TRAPA, RTE, SLEEP, LDC, STC, ANDC, ORC, XORC, NOP
9
Block data transfer
EEPMOV
1
Total 62 types
Notes: 1. POP.W Rn is identical to MOV.W @SP+, Rn.
PUSH.W Rn is identical to MOV.W Rn, @–SP.
POP.L ERn is identical to MOV.L @SP+, Rn.
PUSH.L ERn is identical to MOV.L Rn, @–SP.
2. Not available in the H8/3002.
3. Bcc is a generic branching instruction.
28
2.6.2 Instructions and Addressing Modes
Table 2-2 indicates the instructions available in the H8/300H CPU.
Table 2-2 Instructions and Addressing Modes
Addressing Modes
Rn
@
@
(d:16, (d:24, @ERn+/ @
@ERn ERn) ERn) @–ERn aa:8
Function
Instruction
#xx
Data
transfer
MOV
BWL BWL BWL
BWL
BWL
BWL
B
@
aa:16
@
@
(d:8,
aa:24 PC)
@
(d:16, @@
PC)
aa:8
—
BWL
BWL
—
—
—
—
POP, PUSH
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
WL
MOVFPE,
MOVTPE
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
B
—
—
—
—
—
Arithmetic ADD, CMP
operations SUB
BWL BWL —
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
WL
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
BWL —
ADDX, SUBX B
B
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
ADDS, SUBS —
L
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
INC, DEC
—
BWL —
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
DAA, DAS
—
B
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
DIVXU,
MULXS,
MULXU,
DIVXS
—
BW
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
NEG
—
BWL —
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
EXTU, EXTS
—
WL
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
BWL BWL —
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Logic
AND, OR,
operations XOR
NOT
—
BWL —
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Shift instructions
—
BWL —
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Bit manipulation
—
B
—
—
—
B
—
—
—
—
—
—
Branch
System
control
B
Bcc, BSR
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
o
o
—
—
JMP, JSR
—
—
o
—
—
—
—
—
o
—
—
o
—
RTS
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
o
TRAPA
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
o
RTE
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
o
SLEEP
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
o
LDC
B
B
W
W
W
W
—
W
W
—
—
—
—
STC
—
B
W
W
W
W
—
W
W
—
—
—
—
ANDC, ORC, B
XORC
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
NOP
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
o
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
BW
Block data transfer
Legend
B: Byte
W: Word
L: Longword
29
2.6.3 Tables of Instructions Classified by Function
Tables 2-3 to 2-10 summarize the instructions in each functional category. The operation notation
used in these tables is defined next.
Operation Notation
Rd
General register (destination)*
Rs
General register (source)*
Rn
General register*
ERn
General register (32-bit register or address register)
(EAd)
Destination operand
(EAs)
Source operand
CCR
Condition code register
N
N (negative) flag of CCR
Z
Z (zero) flag of CCR
V
V (overflow) flag of CCR
C
C (carry) flag of CCR
PC
Program counter
SP
Stack pointer
#IMM
Immediate data
disp
Displacement
+
Addition
–
Subtraction
×
Multiplication
÷
Division
∧
AND logical
∨
OR logical
⊕
Exclusive OR logical
→
Move
¬
NOT (logical complement)
:3/:8/:16/:24
3-, 8-, 16-, or 24-bit length
Note: * General registers include 8-bit registers (R0H to R7H, R0L to R7L), 16-bit registers (R0 to
R7, E0 to E7), and 32-bit data or address registers (ER0 to ER7).
30
Table 2-3 Data Transfer Instructions
Instruction Size*
Function
MOV
(EAs) → Rd, Rs → (EAd)
B/W/L
Moves data between two general registers or between a general register
and memory, or moves immediate data to a general register.
MOVFPE
B
(EAs) → Rd
Cannot be used in the H8/3002.
MOVTPE
B
Rs → (EAs)
Cannot be used in the H8/3002.
POP
W/L
@SP+ → Rn
Pops a general register from the stack. POP.W Rn is identical to MOV.W
@SP+, Rn. Similarly, POP.L ERn is identical to MOV.L @SP+, ERn.
PUSH
W/L
Rn → @–SP
Pushes a general register onto the stack. PUSH.W Rn is identical to MOV.W
Rn, @–SP. Similarly, PUSH.L ERn is identical to MOV.L ERn, @–SP.
Note: * Size refers to the operand size.
B: Byte
W: Word
L: Longword
31
Table 2-4 Arithmetic Operation Instructions
Instruction Size*
Function
ADD,
SUB
B/W/L
Rd ± Rs → Rd, Rd ± #IMM → Rd
ADDX,
SUBX
B
INC,
DEC
B/W/L
ADDS,
SUBS
L
DAA,
DAS
B
MULXU
B/W
Performs addition or subtraction on data in two general registers, or on
immediate data and data in a general register. (Immediate byte data cannot
be subtracted from data in a general register. Use the SUBX or ADD
instruction.)
Rd ± Rs ± C → Rd, Rd ± #IMM ± C → Rd
Performs addition or subtraction with carry or borrow on data in two general
registers, or on immediate data and data in a general register.
Rd ± 1 → Rd, Rd ± 2 → Rd
Increments or decrements a general register by 1 or 2. (Byte operands can
be incremented or decremented by 1 only.)
Rd ± 1 → Rd, Rd ± 2 → Rd, Rd ± 4 → Rd
Adds or subtracts the value 1, 2, or 4 to or from data in a 32-bit register.
Rd decimal adjust → Rd
Decimal-adjusts an addition or subtraction result in a general register by
referring to CCR to produce 4-bit BCD data.
Rd × Rs → Rd
Performs unsigned multiplication on data in two general registers: either
8 bits × 8 bits → 16 bits or 16 bits × 16 bits → 32 bits.
MULXS
B/W
Rd × Rs → Rd
Performs signed multiplication on data in two general registers: either
8 bits × 8 bits → 16 bits or 16 bits × 16 bits → 32 bits.
Note: * Size refers to the operand size.
B: Byte
W: Word
L: Longword
32
Table 2-4 Arithmetic Operation Instructions (cont)
Instruction Size*
Function
DIVXU
Rd ÷ Rs → Rd
B/W
Performs unsigned division on data in two general registers: either
16 bits ÷ 8 bits → 8-bit quotient and 8-bit remainder or 32 bits ÷ 16 bits →
16-bit quotient and 16-bit remainder.
DIVXS
B/W
Rd ÷ Rs → Rd
Performs signed division on data in two general registers: either
16 bits ÷ 8 bits → 8-bit quotient and 8-bit remainder, or 32 bits ÷ 16 bits →
16-bit quotient and 16-bit remainder.
CMP
B/W/L
Rd – Rs, Rd – #IMM
Compares data in a general register with data in another general register or
with immediate data, and sets CCR according to the result.
NEG
B/W/L
0 – Rd → Rd
Takes the two’s complement (arithmetic complement) of data in a general
register.
EXTS
W/L
Rd (sign extension) → Rd
Extends byte data in the lower 8 bits of a 16-bit register to word data, or
extends word data in the lower 16 bits of a 32-bit register to longword data,
by extending the sign bit.
EXTU
W/L
Rd (zero extension) → Rd
Extends byte data in the lower 8 bits of a 16-bit register to word data, or
extends word data in the lower 16 bits of a 32-bit register to longword data,
by padding with zeros.
Note: * Size refers to the operand size.
B: Byte
W: Word
L: Longword
33
Table 2-5 Logic Operation Instructions
Instruction Size*
Function
AND
Rd ∧ Rs → Rd, Rd ∧ #IMM → Rd
B/W/L
Performs a logical AND operation on a general register and another general
register or immediate data.
OR
B/W/L
Rd ∨ Rs → Rd, Rd ∨ #IMM → Rd
Performs a logical OR operation on a general register and another general
register or immediate data.
XOR
B/W/L
Rd ⊕ Rs → Rd, Rd ⊕ #IMM → Rd
Performs a logical exclusive OR operation on a general register and another
general register or immediate data.
NOT
B/W/L
¬ Rd → Rd
Takes the one’s complement of general register contents.
Note: * Size refers to the operand size.
B: Byte
W: Word
L: Longword
Table 2-6 Shift Instructions
Instruction Size*
Function
SHAL,
SHAR
B/W/L
Rd (shift) → Rd
SHLL,
SHLR
B/W/L
ROTL,
ROTR
B/W/L
ROTXL,
ROTXR
B/W/L
Performs an arithmetic shift on general register contents.
Rd (shift) → Rd
Performs a logical shift on general register contents.
Rd (rotate) → Rd
Rotates general register contents.
Rd (rotate) → Rd
Rotates general register contents through the carry bit.
Note: * Size refers to the operand size.
B: Byte
W: Word
L: Longword
34
Table 2-7 Bit Manipulation Instructions
Instruction Size*
Function
BSET
1 → (<bit-No.> of <EAd>)
B
Sets a specified bit in a general register or memory operand to 1. The bit
number is specified by 3-bit immediate data or the lower 3 bits of a general
register.
BCLR
B
0 → (<bit-No.> of <EAd>)
Clears a specified bit in a general register or memory operand to 0. The bit
number is specified by 3-bit immediate data or the lower 3 bits of a general
register.
BNOT
B
¬ (<bit-No.> of <EAd>) → (<bit-No.> of <EAd>)
Inverts a specified bit in a general register or memory operand. The bit
number is specified by 3-bit immediate data or the lower 3 bits of a general
register.
BTST
B
¬ (<bit-No.> of <EAd>) → Z
Tests a specified bit in a general register or memory operand and sets or
clears the Z flag accordingly. The bit number is specified by 3-bit immediate
data or the lower 3 bits of a general register.
BAND
B
C ∧ (<bit-No.> of <EAd>) → C
ANDs the carry flag with a specified bit in a general register or memory
operand and stores the result in the carry flag.
BIAND
B
C ∧ [¬ (<bit-No.> of <EAd>)] → C
ANDs the carry flag with the inverse of a specified bit in a general register or
memory operand and stores the result in the carry flag.
The bit number is specified by 3-bit immediate data.
Note: * Size refers to the operand size.
B: Byte
35
Table 2-7 Bit Manipulation Instructions (cont)
Instruction Size*
Function
BOR
C ∨ (<bit-No.> of <EAd>) → C
B
ORs the carry flag with a specified bit in a general register or memory
operand and stores the result in the carry flag.
BIOR
B
C ∨ [¬ (<bit-No.> of <EAd>)] → C
ORs the carry flag with the inverse of a specified bit in a general register or
memory operand and stores the result in the carry flag.
The bit number is specified by 3-bit immediate data.
BXOR
B
C ⊕ (<bit-No.> of <EAd>) → C
Exclusive-ORs the carry flag with a specified bit in a general register or
memory operand and stores the result in the carry flag.
BIXOR
B
C ⊕ [¬ (<bit-No.> of <EAd>)] → C
Exclusive-ORs the carry flag with the inverse of a specified bit in a general
register or memory operand and stores the result in the carry flag.
The bit number is specified by 3-bit immediate data.
BLD
B
(<bit-No.> of <EAd>) → C
Transfers a specified bit in a general register or memory operand to the
carry flag.
BILD
B
¬ (<bit-No.> of <EAd>) → C
Transfers the inverse of a specified bit in a general register or memory
operand to the carry flag.
The bit number is specified by 3-bit immediate data.
BST
B
C → (<bit-No.> of <EAd>)
Transfers the carry flag value to a specified bit in a general register or
memory operand.
BIST
B
C → ¬ (<bit-No.> of <EAd>)
Transfers the inverse of the carry flag value to a specified bit in a general
register or memory operand.
The bit number is specified by 3-bit immediate data.
Note: * Size refers to the operand size.
B: Byte
36
Table 2-8 Branching Instructions
Instruction Size
Function
Bcc
Branches to a specified address if a specified condition is true. The
branching conditions are listed below.
—
Mnemonic
Description
Condition
BRA (BT)
Always (true)
Always
BRN (BF)
Never (false)
Never
BHI
High
C∨Z=0
BLS
Low or same
C∨Z=1
Bcc (BHS)
Carry clear (high or same)
C=0
BCS (BLO)
Carry set (low)
C=1
BNE
Not equal
Z=0
BEQ
Equal
Z=1
BVC
Overflow clear
V=0
BVS
Overflow set
V=1
BPL
Plus
N=0
BMI
Minus
N=1
BGE
Greater or equal
N⊕V=0
BLT
Less than
N⊕V=1
BGT
Greater than
Z ∨ (N ⊕ V) = 0
BLE
Less or equal
Z ∨ (N ⊕ V) = 1
JMP
—
Branches unconditionally to a specified address
BSR
—
Branches to a subroutine at a specified address
JSR
—
Branches to a subroutine at a specified address
RTS
—
Returns from a subroutine
37
Table 2-9 System Control Instructions
Instruction Size*
Function
TRAPA
—
Starts trap-instruction exception handling
RTE
—
Returns from an exception-handling routine
SLEEP
—
Causes a transition to the power-down state
LDC
B/W
(EAs) → CCR
Moves the source operand contents to the condition code register. The
condition code register size is one byte, but in transfer from memory, data is
read by word access.
STC
B/W
CCR → (EAd)
Transfers the CCR contents to a destination location. The condition code
register size is one byte, but in transfer to memory, data is written by word
access.
ANDC
B
CCR ∧ #IMM → CCR
Logically ANDs the condition code register with immediate data.
ORC
B
CCR ∨ #IMM → CCR
Logically ORs the condition code register with immediate data.
XORC
B
CCR ⊕ #IMM → CCR
Logically exclusive-ORs the condition code register with immediate data.
NOP
—
PC + 2 → PC
Only increments the program counter.
Note: * Size refers to the operand size.
B: Byte
W: Word
38
Table 2-10 Block Transfer Instruction
Instruction Size
Function
EEPMOV.B —
if R4L ≠ 0 then
repeat @ER5+ → @ER6+, R4L – 1 → R4L
until
R4L = 0
else next;
EEPMOV.W —
if R4 ≠ 0 then
repeat @ER5+ → @ER6+, R4 – 1 → R4
until
R4 = 0
else next;
Transfers a data block according to parameters set in general registers R4L
or R4, ER5, and ER6.
R4L or R4: Size of block (bytes)
ER5:
Starting source address
ER6:
Starting destination address
Execution of the next instruction begins as soon as the transfer is
completed.
39
2.6.4 Basic Instruction Formats
The H8/300H instructions consist of 2-byte (1-word) units. An instruction consists of an operation
field (OP field), a register field (r field), an effective address extension (EA field), and a condition
field (cc).
Operation Field: Indicates the function of the instruction, the addressing mode, and the operation
to be carried out on the operand. The operation field always includes the first 4 bits of the
instruction. Some instructions have two operation fields.
Register Field: Specifies a general register. Address registers are specified by 3 bits, data
registers by 3 bits or 4 bits. Some instructions have two register fields. Some have no register
field.
Effective Address Extension: Eight, 16, or 32 bits specifying immediate data, an absolute
address, or a displacement. A 24-bit address or displacement is treated as 32-bit data in which the
first 8 bits are 0 (H'00).
Condition Field: Specifies the branching condition of Bcc instructions.
Figure 2-9 shows examples of instruction formats.
Operation field only
op
NOP, RTS, etc.
Operation field and register fields
op
rn
rm
ADD.B Rn, Rm, etc.
Operation field, register fields, and effective address extension
op
rn
rm
MOV.B @(d:16, Rn), Rm
EA (disp)
Operation field, effective address extension, and condition field
op
cc
EA (disp)
Figure 2-9 Instruction Formats
40
BRA d:8
2.6.5 Notes on Use of Bit Manipulation Instructions
The BSET, BCLR, BNOT, BST, and BIST instructions read a byte of data, modify a bit in the
byte, then write the byte back. Care is required when these instructions are used to access registers
with write-only bits, or to access ports.
The BCLR instruction can be used to clear flags in the on-chip registers. In an interrupt-handling
routine, for example, if it is known that the flag is set to 1, it is not necessary to read the flag
ahead of time.
2.7 Addressing Modes and Effective Address Calculation
2.7.1 Addressing Modes
The H8/300H CPU supports the eight addressing modes listed in table 2-11. Each instruction uses
a subset of these addressing modes. Arithmetic and logic instructions can use the register direct
and immediate modes. Data transfer instructions can use all addressing modes except programcounter relative and memory indirect. Bit manipulation instructions use register direct, register
indirect, or absolute (@aa:8) addressing mode to specify an operand, and register direct (BSET,
BCLR, BNOT, and BTST instructions) or immediate (3-bit) addressing mode to specify a bit
number in the operand.
Table 2-11 Addressing Modes
No.
Addressing Mode
Symbol
1
Register direct
Rn
2
Register indirect
@ERn
3
Register indirect with displacement
@(d:16, ERn)/@(d:24, ERn)
4
Register indirect with post-increment
Register indirect with pre-decrement
@ERn+
@–ERn
5
Absolute address
@aa:8/@aa:16/@aa:24
6
Immediate
#xx:8/#xx:16/#xx:32
7
Program-counter relative
@(d:8, PC)/@(d:16, PC)
8
Memory indirect
@@aa:8
41
1 Register Direct—Rn: The register field of the instruction code specifies an 8-, 16-, or 32-bit
register containing the operand. R0H to R7H and R0L to R7L can be specified as 8-bit registers.
R0 to R7 and E0 to E7 can be specified as 16-bit registers. ER0 to ER7 can be specified as 32-bit
registers.
2 Register Indirect—@ERn: The register field of the instruction code specifies an address
register (ERn), the lower 24 bits of which contain the address of the operand.
3 Register Indirect with Displacement—@(d:16, ERn) or @(d:24, ERn): A 16-bit or 24-bit
displacement contained in the instruction code is added to the contents of an address register
(ERn) specified by the register field of the instruction, and the lower 24 bits of the sum specify the
address of a memory operand. A 16-bit displacement is sign-extended when added.
4 Register Indirect with Post-Increment or Pre-Decrement—@ERn+ or @–ERn:
•
Register indirect with post-increment—@ERn+
The register field of the instruction code specifies an address register (ERn) the lower 24 bits
of which contain the address of a memory operand. After the operand is accessed, 1, 2, or 4 is
added to the address register contents (32 bits) and the sum is stored in the address register.
The value added is 1 for byte access, 2 for word access, or 4 for longword access. For word or
longword access, the register value should be even.
•
Register indirect with pre-decrement—@–ERn
The value 1, 2, or 4 is subtracted from an address register (ERn) specified by the register field
in the instruction code, and the lower 24 bits of the result become the address of a memory
operand. The result is also stored in the address register. The value subtracted is 1 for byte
access, 2 for word access, or 4 for longword access. For word or longword access, the
resulting register value should be even.
5 Absolute Address—@aa:8, @aa:16, or @aa:24: The instruction code contains the absolute
address of a memory operand. The absolute address may be 8 bits long (@aa:8), 16 bits long
(@aa:16), or 24 bits long (@aa:24). For an 8-bit absolute address, the upper 16 bits are all
assumed to be 1 (H'FFFF). For a 16-bit absolute address the upper 8 bits are a sign extension. A
24-bit absolute address can access the entire address space. Table 2-12 indicates the accessible
address ranges.
42
Table 2-12 Absolute Address Access Ranges
Absolute
Address
1-Mbyte Modes
16-Mbyte Modes
8 bits (@aa:8)
H'FFF00 to H'FFFFF
(1048320 to 1048575)
H'FFFF00 to H'FFFFFF
(16776960 to 16777215)
16 bits (@aa:16)
H'00000 to H'07FFF,
H'F8000 to H'FFFFF
(0 to 32767, 1015808 to 1048575)
H'000000 to H'007FFF,
H'FF8000 to H'FFFFFF
(0 to 32767, 16744448 to 16777215)
24 bits (@aa:24)
H'00000 to H'FFFFF
(0 to 1048575)
H'000000 to H'FFFFFF
(0 to 16777215)
6 Immediate—#xx:8, #xx:16, or #xx:32: The instruction code contains 8-bit (#xx:8), 16-bit
(#xx:16), or 32-bit (#xx:32) immediate data as an operand.
The instruction codes of the ADDS, SUBS, INC, and DEC instructions contain immediate data
implicitly. The instruction codes of some bit manipulation instructions contain 3-bit immediate
data specifying a bit number. The TRAPA instruction code contains 2-bit immediate data
specifying a vector address.
7 Program-Counter Relative—@(d:8, PC) or @(d:16, PC): This mode is used in the Bcc and
BSR instructions. An 8-bit or 16-bit displacement contained in the instruction code is signextended to 24 bits and added to the 24-bit PC contents to generate a 24-bit branch address. The
PC value to which the displacement is added is the address of the first byte of the next instruction,
so the possible branching range is –126 to +128 bytes (–63 to +64 words) or –32766 to +32768
bytes (–16383 to +16384 words) from the branch instruction. The resulting value should be an
even number.
8 Memory Indirect—@@aa:8: This mode can be used by the JMP and JSR instructions. The
instruction code contains an 8-bit absolute address specifying a memory operand. This memory
operand contains a branch address. The memory operand is accessed by longword access. The
first byte of the memory operand is ignored, generating a 24-bit branch address. See figure 2-10.
The upper bits of the 8-bit absolute address are assumed to be 0 (H'0000), so the address range is
0 to 255 (H'000000 to H'0000FF). Note that the first part of this range is also the exception vector
area. For further details see section 5, Interrupt Controller.
43
Reserved
Specified by @aa:8
Branch address
Figure 2-10 Memory-Indirect Branch Address Specification
When a word-size or longword-size memory operand is specified, or when a branch address is
specified, if the specified memory address is odd, the least significant bit is regarded as 0. The
accessed data or instruction code therefore begins at the preceding address. See section 2.5.2,
Memory Data Formats.
2.7.2 Effective Address Calculation
Table 2-13 explains how an effective address is calculated in each addressing mode. In the
1-Mbyte operating modes the upper 4 bits of the calculated address are ignored in order to
generate a 20-bit effective address.
44
45
4
3
2
r
r
disp
r
op
r
Register indirect with pre-decrement
@–ERn
op
Register indirect with post-increment
@ERn+
Register indirect with post-increment
or pre-decrement
op
Register indirect with displacement
@(d:16, ERn)/@(d:24, ERn)
op
Register indirect (@ERn)
rm rn
Register direct (Rn)
1
op
Addressing Mode and
Instruction Format
No.
1, 2, or 4
General register contents
1, 2, or 4
General register contents
1 for a byte operand, 2 for a word
operand, 4 for a longword operand
31
31
disp
General register contents
General register contents
Sign extension
31
31
Effective Address Calculation
Table 2-13 Effective Address Calculation
0
0
0
0
23
23
23
23
Operand is general
register contents
Effective Address
0
0
0
0
46
7
6
5
No.
abs
abs
abs
IMM
op
disp
Program-counter relative
@(d:8, PC) or @(d:16, PC)
op
Immediate
#xx:8, #xx:16, or #xx:32
op
@aa:24
op
@aa:16
op
Absolute address
@aa:8
Addressing Mode and
Instruction Format
disp
PC contents
Sign
extension
23
Effective Address Calculation
Table 2-13 Effective Address Calculation (cont)
0
16 15
H'FFFF
8 7
23
Operand is immediate data
23
Sign
extension
23
23
Effective Address
0
0
0
0
47
abs
Register field
Operation field
Displacement
Immediate data
Absolute address
op
Memory indirect
@@aa:8
Addressing Mode and
Instruction Format
Legend
r, rm, rn:
op:
disp:
IMM:
abs:
8
No.
31
H'0000
8 7
Memory contents
23
Effective Address Calculation
Table 2-13 Effective Address Calculation (cont)
abs
0
0
23
Effective Address
0
2.8 Processing States
2.8.1 Overview
The H8/300H CPU has five processing states: the program execution state, exception-handling
state, power-down state, reset state, and bus-released state. The power-down state includes sleep
mode, software standby mode, and hardware standby mode. Figure 2-11 classifies the processing
states. Figure 2-13 indicates the state transitions.
Processing states
Program execution state
The CPU executes program instructions in sequence
Exception-handling state
A transient state in which the CPU executes a hardware sequence
(saving PC and CCR, fetching a vector, etc.) in response to a reset,
interrupt, or other exception
Bus-released state
The external bus has been released in response to a bus request
signal from a bus master other than the CPU
Reset state
The CPU and all on-chip supporting modules are initialized and halted
Power-down state
Sleep mode
The CPU is halted to conserve power
Software standby mode
Hardware standby mode
Figure 2-11 Processing States
48
2.8.2 Program Execution State
In this state the CPU executes program instructions in normal sequence.
2.8.3 Exception-Handling State
The exception-handling state is a transient state that occurs when the CPU alters the normal
program flow due to a reset, interrupt, or trap instruction. The CPU fetches a starting address from
the exception vector table and branches to that address. In interrupt and trap exception handling
the CPU references the stack pointer (ER7) and saves the program counter and condition code
register.
Types of Exception Handling and Their Priority: Exception handling is performed for resets,
interrupts, and trap instructions. Table 2-14 indicates the types of exception handling and their
priority. Trap instruction exceptions are accepted at all times in the program execution state.
Table 2-14 Exception Handling Types and Priority
Priority Type of Exception Detection Timing
Start of Exception Handling
High
Low
Reset
Synchronized with clock
Exception handling starts immediately
when RES changes from low to high
Interrupt
End of instruction
execution or end of
exception handling*
When an interrupt is requested,
exception handling starts at the end of
the current instruction or current
exception-handling sequence
Trap instruction
When TRAPA instruction
is executed
Exception handling starts when a trap
(TRAPA) instruction is executed
Note: * Interrupts are not detected at the end of the ANDC, ORC, XORC, and LDC instructions, or
immediately after reset exception handling.
Figure 2-12 classifies the exception sources. For further details about exception sources, vector
numbers, and vector addresses, see section 4, Exception Handling, and section 5, Interrupt
Controller.
49
Reset
External interrupts
Exception
sources
Interrupt
Internal interrupts (from on-chip supporting modules)
Trap instruction
Figure 2-12 Classification of Exception Sources
End of bus release
Bus request
Program execution state
End of bus
release
Bus
request
Exception
SLEEP
instruction
with SSBY = 0
Bus-released state
End of
exception
handling
Exception-handling state
Sleep mode
SLEEP instruction
with SSBY = 1
Interrupt
NMI, IRQ 0 , IRQ 1,
or IRQ 2 interrupt
Software standby mode
RES = high
STBY = high, RES = low
Reset state*1
*2
Hardware standby mode
Power-down state
Notes: 1. From any state except hardware standby mode, a transition to the reset state occurs
whenever RES goes low.
2. From any state, a transition to hardware standby mode occurs when STBY goes low.
Figure 2-13 State Transitions
50
2.8.4 Exception-Handling Sequences
Reset Exception Handling: Reset exception handling has the highest priority. The reset state is
entered when the RES signal goes low. Reset exception handling starts after that, when RES
changes from low to high. When reset exception handling starts the CPU fetches a start address
from the exception vector table and starts program execution from that address. All interrupts,
including NMI, are disabled during the reset exception-handling sequence and immediately after it
ends.
Interrupt Exception Handling and Trap Instruction Exception Handling: When these
exception-handling sequences begin, the CPU references the stack pointer (ER7) and pushes the
program counter and condition code register on the stack. Next, if the UE bit in the system control
register (SYSCR) is set to 1, the CPU sets the I bit in the condition code register to 1. If the UE bit
is cleared to 0, the CPU sets both the I bit and the UI bit in the condition code register to 1. Then
the CPU fetches a start address from the exception vector table and execution branches to that
address.
Figure 2-14 shows the stack after the exception-handling sequence.
SP–4
SP (ER7)
SP–3
SP+1
SP–2
SP+2
SP–1
SP+3
SP (ER7)
Stack area
Before exception
handling starts
CCR
PC
SP+4
Pushed on stack
Even
address
After exception
handling ends
Legend
CCR: Condition code register
SP:
Stack pointer
Notes: 1. PC is the address of the first instruction executed after the return from the
exception-handling routine.
2. Registers must be saved and restored by word access or longword access,
starting at an even address.
Figure 2-14 Stack Structure after Exception Handling
51
2.8.5 Bus-Released State
In this state the bus is released to a bus master other than the CPU, in response to a bus request.
The bus masters other than the CPU are the DMA controller, the refresh controller, and an
external bus master. While the bus is released, the CPU halts except for internal operations.
Interrupt requests are not accepted. For details see section 6.3.7, Bus Arbiter Operation
2.8.6 Reset State
When the RES input goes low all current processing stops and the CPU enters the reset state. The
I bit in the condition code register is set to 1 by a reset. All interrupts are masked in the reset state.
Reset exception handling starts when the RES signal changes from low to high.
The reset state can also be entered by a watchdog timer overflow. For details see section 12,
Watchdog Timer.
2.8.7 Power-Down State
In the power-down state the CPU stops operating to conserve power. There are three modes: sleep
mode, software standby mode, and hardware standby mode.
Sleep Mode: A transition to sleep mode is made if the SLEEP instruction is executed while the
SSBY bit is cleared to 0 in the system control register (SYSCR). CPU operations stop
immediately after execution of the SLEEP instruction, but the contents of CPU registers are
retained.
Software Standby Mode: A transition to software standby mode is made if the SLEEP
instruction is executed while the SSBY bit is set to 1 in SYSCR. The CPU and clock halt and all
on-chip supporting modules stop operating. The on-chip supporting modules are reset, but as long
as a specified voltage is supplied the contents of CPU registers and on-chip RAM are retained.
The I/O ports also remain in their existing states.
Hardware Standby Mode: A transition to hardware standby mode is made when the STBY input
goes low. As in software standby mode, the CPU and all clocks halt and the on-chip supporting
modules are reset, but as long as a specified voltage is supplied, on-chip RAM contents are
retained.
For further information see section 17, Power-Down State.
52
2.9 Basic Operational Timing
2.9.1 Overview
The H8/300H CPU operates according to the system clock (ø). The interval from one rise of the
system clock to the next rise is referred to as a “state.” A memory cycle or bus cycle consists of
two or three states. The CPU uses different methods to access on-chip memory, the on-chip
supporting modules, and the external address space. Access to the external address space can be
controlled by the bus controller.
2.9.2 On-Chip Memory Access Timing
On-chip memory is accessed in two states. The data bus is 16 bits wide, permitting both byte and
word access. Figure 2-15 shows the on-chip memory access cycle. Figure 2-16 indicates the pin
states.
Bus cycle
T1 state
T2 state
ø
Internal address bus
Address
Internal read signal
Internal data bus
(read access)
Read data
Internal write signal
Internal data bus
(write access)
Write data
Figure 2-15 On-Chip Memory Access Cycle
53
T1
T2
ø
Address bus
AS , RD, HWR , LWR
Address
High
High impedance
D15 to D0
Figure 2-16 Pin States during On-Chip Memory Access
54
2.9.3 On-Chip Supporting Module Access Timing
The on-chip supporting modules are accessed in three states. The data bus is 8 or 16 bits wide,
depending on the register being accessed. Figure 2-17 shows the on-chip supporting module
access timing. Figure 2-18 indicates the pin states.
Bus cycle
T1 state
T2 state
T3 state
ø
Address
Address bus
Read
access
Internal read signal
Internal data bus
Read data
Internal write signal
Write
access
Internal data bus
Write data
Figure 2-17 Access Cycle for On-Chip Supporting Modules
55
T1
T2
T3
ø
Address bus
AS , RD, HWR , LWR
Address
High
High impedance
D15 to D0
Figure 2-18 Pin States during Access to On-Chip Supporting Modules
2.9.4 Access to External Address Space
The external address space is divided into eight areas (areas 0 to 7). Bus-controller settings
determine whether each area is accessed via an 8-bit or 16-bit bus, and whether it is accessed in
two or three states. For details see section 6, Bus Controller.
56
Section 3 MCU Operating Modes
3.1 Overview
3.1.1 Operating Mode Selection
The H8/3002 has four operating modes (modes 1 to 4) that are selected by the mode pins (MD2 to
MD0) as indicated in table 3-1. The input at these pins determines the size of the address space
and the initial bus mode.
Table 3-1 Operating Mode Selection
Mode Pins
Description
Operating Mode
MD2 MD1 MD0
Address Space
Initial Bus Mode*1
On-Chip RAM
—
0
0
0
—
—
—
Mode 1
0
0
1
1 Mbyte
8 bits
Enabled*2
Mode 2
0
1
0
1 Mbyte
16 bits
Enabled*2
Mode 3
0
1
1
16 Mbytes
8 bits
Enabled*2
Mode 4
1
0
0
16 Mbytes
16 bits
Enabled*2
—
1
0
1
—
—
—
—
1
1
0
—
—
—
—
1
1
1
—
—
—
Notes: 1. In all modes, an 8-bit or 16-bit data bus can be selected on a per-area basis by settings
made in the area bus width control register (ABWCR). For details see section 6, Bus
Controller.
2. If the RAME in SYSCR is cleared to 0, these addresses become external addresses.
For the address space size there are two choices: 1 Mbyte or 16 Mbytes. The external data bus is
either 8 or 16 bits wide depending on the settings in the area bus width control register (ABWCR).
If 8-bit access is selected for all areas, the external data bus is 8 bits wide. For details see
section 6, Bus Controller.
Modes 1 to 4 are externally expanded modes that enable access to external memory and peripheral
devices. Modes 1 and 2 support a maximum address space of 1 Mbyte. Modes 3 and 4 support a
maximum address space of 16 Mbytes.
The H8/3002 can only be used in modes 1 to 4. The inputs at the mode pins must select one of
these four modes. The inputs at the mode pins must not be changed during operation.
57
3.1.2 Register Configuration
The H8/3002 has a mode control register (MDCR) that indicates the inputs at the mode pins
(MD2 to MD0), and a system control register (SYSCR). Table 3-2 summarizes these registers.
Table 3-2 Registers
Address*
Name
Abbreviation
R/W
Initial Value
H'FFF1
Mode control register
MDCR
R
Undetermined
H'FFF2
System control register
SYSCR
R/W
H'0B
Note: * The lower 16 bits of the address are indicated.
58
3.2 Mode Control Register (MDCR)
MDCR is an 8-bit read-only register that indicates the current operating mode of the H8/3002.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
—
—
—
—
MDS2
MDS1
MDS0
Initial value
1
1
0
0
0
—*
—*
—*
Read/Write
—
—
—
—
—
R
R
R
Reserved bits
Reserved bits
Mode select 2 to 0
Bits indicating the current
operating mode
Note: * Determined by pins MD 2 to MD0 .
Bits 7 and 6—Reserved: These bits cannot be modified and are always read as 1.
Bits 5 to 3—Reserved: These bits cannot be modified and are always read as 0.
Bits 2 to 0—Mode Select 2 to 0 (MDS2 to MDS0): These bits indicate the logic levels at pins
MD2 to MD0 (the current operating mode). MDS2 to MDS0 correspond to MD2 to MD0. MDS2
to MDS0 are read-only bits. The mode pin (MD2 to MD0) levels are latched when MDCR is read.
59
3.3 System Control Register (SYSCR)
SYSCR is an 8-bit register that controls the operation of the H8/3002.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
SSBY
STS2
STS1
STS0
UE
NMIEG
—
RAME
Initial value
0
0
0
0
1
0
1
1
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
—
R/W
RAM enable
Enables or
disables
on-chip RAM
Reserved bit
NMI edge select
Selects the valid edge
of the NMI input
User bit enable
Selects whether to use the UI bit in CCR
as a user bit or an interrupt mask bit
Standby timer select 2 to 0
These bits select the waiting time at
recovery from software standby mode
Software standby
Enables transition to software standby mode
Bit 7—Software Standby (SSBY): Enables transition to software standby mode. (For further
information about software standby mode see section 17, Power-Down State.)
When software standby mode is exited by an external interrupt, this bit remains set to 1. To clear
this bit, write 0.
Bit 7
SSBY
Description
0
SLEEP instruction causes transition to sleep mode
1
SLEEP instruction causes transition to software standby mode
60
(Initial value)
Bits 6 to 4—Standby Timer Select (STS2 to STS0): These bits select the length of time the CPU
and on-chip supporting modules wait for the internal clock oscillator to settle when software
standby mode is exited by an external interrupt. Set these bits so that the waiting time will be at
least 8 ms at the system clock rate. For further information about waiting time selection, see
section 17.4.3, Selection of Oscillator Waiting Time after Exit from Software Standby Mode.
Bit 6
STS2
Bit 5
STS1
Bit 4
STS0
Description
0
0
0
Waiting time = 8192 states
0
0
1
Waiting time = 16384 states
0
1
0
Waiting time = 32768 states
0
1
1
Waiting time = 65536 states
1
0
—
Waiting time = 131072 states
1
1
—
Illegal setting
(Initial value)
Bit 3—User Bit Enable (UE): Selects whether to use the UI bit in the condition code register as a
user bit or an interrupt mask bit.
Bit 3
UE
Description
0
UI bit in CCR is used as an interrupt mask bit
1
UI bit in CCR is used as a user bit
(Initial value)
Bit 2—NMI Edge Select (NMIEG): Selects the valid edge of the NMI input.
Bit 2
NMIEG
Description
0
An interrupt is requested at the falling edge of NMI
1
An interrupt is requested at the rising edge of NMI
(Initial value)
Bit 1—Reserved: This bit cannot be modified and is always read as 1.
Bit 0—RAM Enable (RAME): Enables or disables the on-chip RAM. The RAME bit is
initialized by the rising edge of the RES signal. It is not initialized in software standby mode.
Bit 0
RAME
Description
0
On-chip RAM is disabled
1
On-chip RAM is enabled
(Initial value)
61
3.4 Operating Mode Descriptions
3.4.1 Mode 1
Address pins A19 to A0 are enabled, permitting access to a maximum 1-Mbyte address space. The
initial bus mode after a reset is 8 bits, with 8-bit access to all areas. If at least one area is
designated for 16-bit access in ABWCR, the bus mode switches to 16 bits.
3.4.2 Mode 2
Address pins A19 to A0 are enabled, permitting access to a maximum 1-Mbyte address space. The
initial bus mode after a reset is 16 bits, with 16-bit access to all areas. If all areas are designated
for 8-bit access in ABWCR, the bus mode switches to 8 bits.
3.4.3 Mode 3
Address pins A23 to A0 are enabled, permitting access to a maximum 16-Mbyte address space.
The initial bus mode after a reset is 8 bits, with 8-bit access to all areas. If at least one area is
designated for 16-bit access in ABWCR, the bus mode switches to 16 bits. A23 to A21 are valid
when 0 is written in bits 7 to 5 of the bus release control register (BRCR).
3.4.4 Mode 4
Address pins A23 to A0 are enabled, permitting access to a maximum 16-Mbyte address space.
The initial bus mode after a reset is 16 bits, with 16-bit access to all areas. If all areas are
designated for 8-bit access in ABWCR, the bus mode switches to 8 bits. A23 to A21 are valid
when 0 is written in bits 7 to 5 of BRCR.
62
3.5 Pin Functions in Each Operating Mode
The pin functions of ports 4 and A vary depending on the operating mode. Table 3-3 indicates
their functions in each operating mode.
Table 3-3 Pin Functions in Each Mode
Port
Mode 1
Mode 2
Mode 3
Mode 4
Port 4
P47 to P40*1
D7 to D0*1
P47 to P40*1
D7 to D0*1
Port A
PA7 to PA4
PA7 to PA4
A23 to A20*2
A23 to A20*2
Notes: 1. Initial state. The bus mode can be switched by settings in ABWCR.
These pins function as P47 to P40 in 8-bit bus mode, and as D7 to
D0 in 16-bit bus mode.
2. A20 is always an address output pin. A23 to A21 become valid when
0 is written in bits 7 to 5 of BRCR; initially, they function as PA4 to
PA6.
3.6 Memory Map in Each Operating Mode
Figure 3-1 shows a memory map for modes 1 to 4. The address space is divided into eight areas.
The initial bus mode differs between modes 1 and 2, and also between modes 3 and 4. The address
locations of the on-chip RAM and on-chip registers differ between the 1-Mbyte modes (modes 1
and 2) and 16-Mbyte modes (modes 3 and 4). The address range specifiable by the CPU in its
8- and 16-bit absolute addressing modes (@aa:8 and @aa:16) also differs.
63
Modes 1 and 2 (1-Mbyte modes)
H'00000
Modes 3 and 4 (16-Mbyte modes)
H'000000
Vector table
Vector table
16-bit
absolute
addresses
16-bit
absolute
addresses
H'007FFF
H'07FFF
H'1FFFF
H'20000
H'3FFFF
H'40000
H'5FFFF
H'60000 External address space
H'7FFFF
H'80000
H'9FFFF
H'A0000
H'BFFFF
H'C0000
H'DFFFF
H'E0000
Area 0
Area 0
H'1FFFFF
H'200000
Area 1
Area 2
Area 1
H'3FFFFF
H'400000
Area 3
Area 4
Area 2
H'5FFFFF
H'600000
Area 5
Area 6
H'7FFFFF
H'800000
Area 7
External address
space
Area 3
Area 4
H'9FFFFF
H'A00000
H'F8000
H'FFD0F
H'FFD10
H'FFF00
H'FFF0F
H'FFF10
H'FFF1B
H'FFF1C
Area 5
H'BFFFFF
H'C00000
On-chip RAM*
External address
space
16-bit
absolute
addresses
Area 6
H'DFFFFF
H'E00000
8-bit
absolute
addresses
Area 7
On-chip registers
H'FF8000
F'FFFFF
H'FFFD0F
H'FFFD10
H'FFFF00
H'FFFF0F
H'FFFF10
On-chip RAM*
External address
space
H'FFFF1B
H'FFFF1C
On-chip registers
H'FFFFFF
Note: * External addresses can be accessed by clearing the RAME bit to 0 in SYSCR.
Figure 3-1 Memory Map in Each Operating Mode
64
16-bit
absolute
addresses
8-bit
absolute
addresses
Section 4 Exception Handling
4.1 Overview
4.1.1 Exception Handling Types and Priority
As table 4-1 indicates, exception handling may be caused by a reset, trap instruction, or interrupt.
Exception handling is prioritized as shown in table 4-1. If two or more exceptions occur
simultaneously, they are accepted and processed in priority order. Trap instruction exceptions are
accepted at all times in the program execution state.
Table 4-1 Exception Types and Priority
Priority Exception Type
Start of Exception Handling
High
Reset
Starts immediately after a low-to-high transition at the RES pin
Interrupt
Interrupt requests are handled when execution of the current
instruction or handling of the current exception is completed
Low
Trap instruction (TRAPA) Started by execution of a trap instruction (TRAPA)
4.1.2 Exception Handling Operation
Exceptions originate from various sources. Trap instructions and interrupts are handled as follows.
1.
The program counter (PC) and condition code register (CCR) are pushed onto the stack.
2.
The CCR interrupt mask bit is set to 1.
3.
A vector address corresponding to the exception source is generated, and program execution
starts from that address.
For a reset exception, steps 2 and 3 above are carried out.
65
4.1.3 Exception Vector Table
The exception sources are classified as shown in figure 4-1. Different vectors are assigned to
different exception sources. Table 4-2 lists the exception sources and their vector addresses.
• Reset
External interrupts: NMI, IRQ 0 to IRQ5
Exception
sources
• Interrupts
• Trap instruction
Internal interrupts: 30 interrupts from on-chip
supporting modules
Figure 4-1 Exception Sources
Table 4-2 Exception Vector Table
Exception Source
Reset
Reserved for system use
External interrupt (NMI)
Trap instruction (4 sources)
External interrupt IRQ0
External interrupt IRQ1
External interrupt IRQ2
External interrupt IRQ3
External interrupt IRQ4
External interrupt IRQ5
Reserved for system use
Internal interrupts*2
Vector Number
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
to
60
Vector Address*1
H'0000 to H'0003
H'0004 to H'0007
H'0008 to H'000B
H'000C to H'000F
H'0010 to H'0013
H'0014 to H'0017
H'0018 to H'001B
H'001C to H'001F
H'0020 to H'0023
H'0024 to H'0027
H'0028 to H'002B
H'002C to H'002F
H'0030 to H'0033
H'0034 to H'0037
H'0038 to H'003B
H'003C to H'003F
H'0040 to H'0043
H'0044 to H'0047
H'0048 to H'004B
H'004C to H'004F
H'0050 to H'0053
to
H'00F0 to H'00F3
Notes: 1. Lower 16 bits of the address.
2. For the internal interrupt vectors, see section 5.3.3, Interrupt Vector Table.
66
4.2 Reset
4.2.1 Overview
A reset is the highest-priority exception. When the RES pin goes low, all processing halts and the
H8/3002 enters the reset state. A reset initializes the internal state of the CPU and the registers of
the on-chip supporting modules. Reset exception handling begins when the RES pin changes from
low to high.
The H8/3002 can also be reset by overflow of the watchdog timer. For details see section 12,
Watchdog Timer.
4.2.2 Reset Sequence
The H8/3002 enters the reset state when the RES pin goes low.
To ensure that the H8/3002 is reset, hold the RES pin low for at least 20 ms at power-up. To reset
the H8/3002 during operation, hold the RES pin low for at least 10 system clock (ø) cycles. See
appendix D.2, Pin States at Reset, for the states of the pins in the reset state.
When the RES pin goes high after being held low for the necessary time, the H8/3002 starts reset
exception handling as follows.
•
The internal state of the CPU and the registers of the on-chip supporting modules are
initialized, and the I bit is set to 1 in CCR.
•
The contents of the reset vector address (H'0000 to H'0003) are read, and program execution
starts from the address indicated in the vector address.
Figure 4-2 shows the reset sequence in modes 1 and 3. Figure 4-3 shows the reset sequence in
modes 2 and 4.
67
Figure 4-2 Reset Sequence (Modes 1 and 3)
68
(2)
(4)
(3)
(6)
(5)
(8)
(7)
Internal
processing
Address of reset vector: (1) = H'00000, (3) = H'00001, (5) = H'00002, (7) = H'00003
Start address (contents of reset vector)
Start address
First instruction of program
High
(1)
Note: After a reset, the wait-state controller inserts three wait states in every bus cycle.
(1), (3), (5), (7)
(2), (4), (6), (8)
(9)
(10)
D15 to D8
HWR , LWR
RD
Address
bus
RES
ø
Vector fetch
(10)
(9)
Prefetch of
first program
instruction
Internal
processing
Vector fetch
Prefetch of first
program instruction
ø
RES
Address bus
(1)
(3)
(5)
RD
HWR , LWR
High
(2)
D15 to D0
(1), (3)
(2), (4)
(5)
(6)
(4)
(6)
Address of reset vector: (1) = H'00000, (3) = H'00002
Start address (contents of reset vector)
Start address
First instruction of program
Note: After a reset, the wait-state controller inserts three wait states in every bus cycle.
Figure 4-3 Reset Sequence (Modes 2 and 4)
4.2.3 Interrupts after Reset
If an interrupt is accepted after a reset but before the stack pointer (SP) is initialized, PC and CCR
will not be saved correctly, leading to a program crash. To prevent this, all interrupt requests,
including NMI, are disabled immediately after a reset. The first instruction of the program is
always executed immediately after the reset state ends. This instruction should initialize the stack
pointer (example: MOV.L #xx:32, SP).
69
4.3 Interrupts
Interrupt exception handling can be requested by seven external sources (NMI, IRQ0 to IRQ5) and
30 internal sources in the on-chip supporting modules. Figure 4-4 classifies the interrupt sources
and indicates the number of interrupts of each type.
The on-chip supporting modules that can request interrupts are the watchdog timer (WDT),
refresh controller, 16-bit integrated timer-pulse unit (ITU), DMA controller (DMAC), serial
communication interface (SCI), and A/D converter. Each interrupt source has a separate vector
address.
NMI is the highest-priority interrupt and is always accepted. Interrupts are controlled by the
interrupt controller. The interrupt controller can assign interrupts other than NMI to two priority
levels, and arbitrate between simultaneous interrupts. Interrupt priorities are assigned in interrupt
priority registers A and B (IPRA and IPRB) in the interrupt controller.
For details on interrupts see section 5, Interrupt Controller.
External interrupts
NMI (1)
IRQ 0 to IRQ 5 (6)
Internal interrupts
WDT *1 (1)
Refresh controller *2 (1)
ITU (15)
DMAC (4)
SCI (8)
A/D converter (1)
Interrupts
Notes: Numbers in parentheses are the number of interrupt sources.
1. When the watchdog timer is used as an interval timer, it generates an interrupt
request at every counter overflow.
2. When the refresh controller is used as an interval timer, it generates an interrupt
request at compare match.
Figure 4-4 Interrupt Sources and Number of Interrupts
70
4.4 Trap Instruction
Trap instruction exception handling starts when a TRAPA instruction is executed. If the UE bit is
set to 1 in the system control register (SYSCR), the exception handling sequence sets the I bit to 1
in CCR. If the UE bit is 0, the I and UI bits are both set to 1. The TRAPA instruction fetches a
start address from a vector table entry corresponding to a vector number from 0 to 3, which is
specified in the instruction code.
4.5 Stack Status after Exception Handling
Figure 4-5 shows the stack after completion of trap instruction exception handling and interrupt
exception handling.
SP
CCR
PC
Note: In modes 1 and 2 only 20 PC bits are valid; the upper 4 bits are ignored.
Figure 4-5 Stack after Completion of Exception Handling
71
4.6 Notes on Stack Usage
When accessing word data or longword data, the H8/3002 regards the lowest address bit as 0. The
stack should always be accessed by word access or longword access, and the value of the stack
pointer (SP, ER7) should always be kept even. Use the following instructions to save registers:
PUSH.W Rn (or MOV.W Rn, @–SP)
PUSH.L ERn (or MOV.L ERn, @–SP)
Use the following instructions to restore registers:
POP.W Rn
POP.L ERn
(or MOV.W @SP+, Rn)
(or MOV.L @SP+, ERn)
Setting SP to an odd value may lead to a malfunction. Figure 4-6 shows an example of what
happens when the SP value is odd.
CCR
SP
RIL
H'FFFEFA
H'FFFEFB
SP
PC
PC
H'FFFEFC
H'FFFEFD
H'FFFEFF
SP
TRAPA instruction executed
SP set to H'FFFEFF
MOV. B RIL, @-ER7
Data saved above SP
CCR contents lost
Legend
CCR: Condition code register
PC: Program counter
R1L: General register R1L
SP: Stack pointer
Note: The diagram illustrates modes 3 and 4.
Figure 4-6 Operation when SP Value is Odd
72
Section 5 Interrupt Controller
5.1 Overview
5.1.1 Features
The interrupt controller has the following features:
•
Interrupt priority registers (IPRs) for setting interrupt priorities
Interrupts other than NMI can be assigned to two priority levels on a module-by-module basis
in interrupt priority registers A and B (IPRA and IPRB).
•
Three-level masking by the I and UI bits in the CPU condition code register (CCR)
•
Independent vector addresses
All interrupts are independently vectored; the interrupt service routine does not have to
identify the interrupt source.
•
Seven external interrupt pins
NMI has the highest priority and is always accepted; either the rising or falling edge can be
selected. For each of IRQ0 to IRQ5, sensing of the falling edge or level sensing can be
selected independently.
73
5.1.2 Block Diagram
Figure 5-1 shows a block diagram of the interrupt controller.
CPU
ISCR
IER
IPRA, IPRB
NMI
input
IRQ input
section ISR
IRQ input
OVF
TME
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
ADI
ADIE
Priority
decision logic
Interrupt
request
Vector
number
.
.
.
I
UI
Interrupt controller
UE
SYSCR
Legend
ISCR:
IER:
ISR:
IPRA:
IPRB:
SYSCR:
IRQ sense control register
IRQ enable register
IRQ status register
Interrupt priority register A
Interrupt priority register B
System control register
Figure 5-1 Interrupt Controller Block Diagram
74
CCR
5.1.3 Pin Configuration
Table 5-1 lists the interrupt pins.
Table 5-1 Interrupt Pins
Name
Abbreviation
I/O
Function
Nonmaskable interrupt
NMI
Input
Nonmaskable interrupt, rising edge or
falling edge selectable
Input
Maskable interrupts, falling edge or
level sensing selectable
External interrupt request 5 to 0 IRQ5 to IRQ0
5.1.4 Register Configuration
Table 5-2 lists the registers of the interrupt controller.
Table 5-2 Interrupt Controller Registers
Address*1
Name
Abbreviation
R/W
Initial Value
H'FFF2
System control register
SYSCR
R/W
H'0B
H'FFF4
IRQ sense control register
ISCR
R/W
H'00
H'FFF5
IRQ enable register
IER
R/W
H'00
H'FFF6
IRQ status register
ISR
R/(W)*2
H'00
H'FFF8
Interrupt priority register A
IPRA
R/W
H'00
H'FFF9
Interrupt priority register B
IPRB
R/W
H'00
Notes: 1. Lower 16 bits of the address.
2. Only 0 can be written, to clear flags.
75
5.2 Register Descriptions
5.2.1 System Control Register (SYSCR)
SYSCR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that controls software standby mode, selects the
action of the UI bit in CCR, selects the NMI edge, and enables or disables the on-chip RAM.
Only bits 3 and 2 are described here. For the other bits, see section 3.3, System Control Register
(SYSCR).
SYSCR is initialized to H'0B by a reset and in hardware standby mode. It is not initialized in
software standby mode.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
SSBY
STS2
STS1
STS0
UE
NMIEG
—
RAME
Initial value
0
0
0
0
1
0
1
1
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
—
R/W
RAM enable
Reserved bit
NMI edge select
Selects the NMI input edge
Standby timer
select 2 to 0
Software standby
User bit enable
Selects whether to use the UI bit in
CCR as a user bit or interrupt mask bit
76
Bit 3—User Bit Enable (UE): Selects whether to use the UI bit in CCR as a user bit or an
interrupt mask bit.
Bit 3
UE
Description
0
UI bit in CCR is used as interrupt mask bit
1
UI bit in CCR is used as user bit
(Initial value)
Bit 2—NMI Edge Select (NMIEG): Selects the NMI input edge.
Bit 2
NMIEG
Description
0
Interrupt is requested at falling edge of NMI input
1
Interrupt is requested at rising edge of NMI input
5.2.2 Interrupt Priority Registers A and B (IPRA, IPRB)
IPRA and IPRB are 8-bit readable/writable registers that control interrupt priority.
77
(Initial value)
Interrupt Priority Register A (IPRA): IPRA is an 8-bit readable/writable register in which
interrupt priority levels can be set.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
IPRA7
IPRA6
IPRA5
IPRA4
IPRA3
IPRA2
IPRA1
IPRA0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Priority
level A0
Selects the
priority level
of ITU
channel 2
interrupt
requests
Priority level A1
Selects the priority level
of ITU channel 1
interrupt requests
Priority level A2
Selects the priority level of
ITU channel 0 interrupt requests
Priority level A3
Selects the priority level of WDT and
refresh controller interrupt requests
Priority level A4
Selects the priority level of IRQ4 and IRQ 5
interrupt requests
Priority level A5
Selects the priority level of IRQ 2 and IRQ 3 interrupt requests
Priority level A6
Selects the priority level of IRQ1 interrupt requests
Priority level A7
Selects the priority level of IRQ 0 interrupt requests
IPRA is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in hardware standby mode.
78
Bit 7—Priority Level A7 (IPRA7): Selects the priority level of IRQ0 interrupt requests.
Bit 7
IPRA7
Description
0
IRQ0 interrupt requests have priority level 0 (low priority)
1
IRQ0 interrupt requests have priority level 1 (high priority)
(Initial value)
Bit 6—Priority Level A6 (IPRA6): Selects the priority level of IRQ1 interrupt requests.
Bit 6
IPRA6
Description
0
IRQ1 interrupt requests have priority level 0 (low priority)
1
IRQ1 interrupt requests have priority level 1 (high priority)
(Initial value)
Bit 5—Priority Level A5 (IPRA5): Selects the priority level of IRQ2 and IRQ3 interrupt
requests.
Bit 5
IPRA5
Description
0
IRQ2 and IRQ3 interrupt requests have priority level 0 (low priority)
1
IRQ2 and IRQ3 interrupt requests have priority level 1 (high priority)
(Initial value)
Bit 4—Priority Level A4 (IPRA4): Selects the priority level of IRQ4 and IRQ5 interrupt
requests.
Bit 4
IPRA4
Description
0
IRQ4 and IRQ5 interrupt requests have priority level 0 (low priority)
1
IRQ4 and IRQ5 interrupt requests have priority level 1 (high priority)
79
(Initial value)
Bit 3—Priority Level A3 (IPRA3): Selects the priority level of WDT and refresh controller
interrupt requests.
Bit 3
IPRA3
Description
0
WDT and refresh controller interrupt requests have priority level 0
(low priority)
(Initial value)
1
WDT and refresh controller interrupt requests have priority level 1 (high priority)
Bit 2—Priority Level A2 (IPRA2): Selects the priority level of ITU channel 0 interrupt requests.
Bit 2
IPRA2
Description
0
ITU channel 0 interrupt requests have priority level 0 (low priority)
1
ITU channel 0 interrupt requests have priority level 1 (high priority)
(Initial value)
Bit 1—Priority Level A1 (IPRA1): Selects the priority level of ITU channel 1 interrupt requests.
Bit 1
IPRA1
Description
0
ITU channel 1 interrupt requests have priority level 0 (low priority)
1
ITU channel 1 interrupt requests have priority level 1 (high priority)
(Initial value)
Bit 0—Priority Level A0 (IPRA0): Selects the priority level of ITU channel 2 interrupt requests.
Bit 0
IPRA0
Description
0
ITU channel 2 interrupt requests have priority level 0 (low priority)
1
ITU channel 2 interrupt requests have priority level 1 (high priority)
80
(Initial value)
Interrupt Priority Register B (IPRB): IPRB is an 8-bit readable/writable register in which
interrupt priority levels can be set.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
IPRB7
IPRB6
IPRB5
—
IPRB3
IPRB2
IPRB1
—
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Reserved bit
Priority level B1
Selects the priority level
of A/D converter
interrupt request
Priority level B2
Selects the priority level of
SCI channel 1 interrupt requests
Priority level B3
Selects the priority level of SCI
channel 0 interrupt requests
Reserved bit
Priority level B5
Selects the priority level of DMAC interrupt requests
(channels 0 and 1)
Priority level B6
Selects the priority level of ITU channel 4 interrupt requests
Priority level B7
Selects the priority level of ITU channel 3 interrupt requests
IPRB is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in hardware standby mode.
81
Bit 7—Priority Level B7 (IPRB7): Selects the priority level of ITU channel 3 interrupt requests.
Bit 7
IPRB7
Description
0
ITU channel 3 interrupt requests have priority level 0 (low priority)
1
ITU channel 3 interrupt requests have priority level 1 (high priority)
(Initial value)
Bit 6—Priority Level B6 (IPRB6): Selects the priority level of ITU channel 4 interrupt requests.
Bit 6
IPRB6
Description
0
ITU channel 4 interrupt requests have priority level 0 (low priority)
1
ITU channel 4 interrupt requests have priority level 1 (high priority)
(Initial value)
Bit 5—Priority Level B5 (IPRB5): Selects the priority level of DMAC interrupt requests
(channels 0 and 1).
Bit 5
IPRB5
Description
0
DMAC interrupt requests (channels 0 and 1) have priority level 0
(low priority)
(Initial value)
1
DMAC interrupt requests (channels 0 and 1) have priority level 1 (high priority)
Bit 4—Reserved: This bit can be written and read, but it does not affect interrupt priority.
82
Bit 3—Priority Level B3 (IPRB3): Selects the priority level of SCI channel 0 interrupt requests.
Bit 3
IPRB3
Description
0
SCI0 interrupt requests have priority level 0 (low priority)
1
SCI0 interrupt requests have priority level 1 (high priority)
(Initial value)
Bit 2—Priority Level B2 (IPRB2): Selects the priority level of SCI channel 1 interrupt requests.
Bit 2
IPRB2
Description
0
SCI1 interrupt requests have priority level 0 (low priority)
1
SCI1 interrupt requests have priority level 1 (high priority)
(Initial value)
Bit 1—Priority Level B1 (IPRB1): Selects the priority level of A/D converter interrupt requests.
Bit 1
IPRB1
Description
0
A/D converter interrupt requests have priority level 0 (low priority)
1
A/D converter interrupt requests have priority level 1 (high priority)
(Initial value)
Bit 0—Reserved: This bit can be written and read, but it does not affect interrupt priority.
83
5.2.3 IRQ Status Register (ISR)
ISR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that indicates the status of IRQ0 to IRQ5 interrupt
requests.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
—
IRQ5F
IRQ4F
IRQ3F
IRQ2F
IRQ1F
IRQ0F
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
—
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
Reserved bits
IRQ 5 to IRQ0 flags
These bits indicate IRQ 5 to IRQ 0 interrupt request status
Note: * Only 0 can be written, to clear flags.
ISR is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in hardware standby mode.
Bits 7 and 6—Reserved: These bits cannot be modified and are always read as 0.
Bits 5 to 0—IRQ5 to IRQ0 Flags (IRQ5F to IRQ0F): These bits indicate the status of IRQ5 to
IRQ0 interrupt requests.
Bits 5 to 0
IRQ5F to IRQ0F
Description
0
[Clearing conditions]
(Initial value)
0 is written in IRQnF after reading the IRQnF flag when IRQnF = 1.
IRQnSC = 0, IRQn input is high, and interrupt exception handling is carried out.
IRQnSC = 1 and IRQn interrupt exception handling is carried out.
1
[Setting conditions]
IRQnSC = 0 and IRQn input is low.
IRQnSC = 1 and IRQn input changes from high to low.
Note: n = 5 to 0
84
5.2.4 IRQ Enable Register (IER)
IER is an 8-bit readable/writable register that enables or disables IRQ0 to IRQ5 interrupt requests.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
—
IRQ5E
IRQ4E
IRQ3E
IRQ2E
IRQ1E
IRQ0E
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Reserved bits
IRQ 5 to IRQ0 enable
These bits enable or disable IRQ 5 to IRQ 0 interrupts
IER is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in hardware standby mode.
Bits 7 and 6—Reserved: These bits can be written and read, but they do not enable or disable
interrupts.
Bits 5 to 0—IRQ5 to IRQ0 Enable (IRQ5E to IRQ0E): These bits enable or disable IRQ5 to
IRQ0 interrupts.
Bits 5 to 0
IRQ5E to IRQ0E
Description
0
IRQ5 to IRQ0 interrupts are disabled
1
IRQ5 to IRQ0 interrupts are enabled
85
(Initial value)
5.2.5 IRQ Sense Control Register (ISCR)
ISCR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that selects level sensing or falling-edge sensing of the
inputs at pins IRQ5 to IRQ0.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
—
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
IRQ5SC IRQ4SC IRQ3SC IRQ2SC IRQ1SC IRQ0SC
Reserved bits IRQ 5 to IRQ0 sense control
These bits select level sensing or falling-edge sensing for
IRQ 5 to IRQ 0 interrupts
ISCR is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in hardware standby mode.
Bits 7 and 6—Reserved: These bits can be written and read, but they do not select level or
falling-edge sensing.
Bits 5 to 0—IRQ5 to IRQ0 Sense Control (IRQ5SC to IRQ0SC): These bits select whether
interrupts IRQ5 to IRQ0 are requested by level sensing of pins IRQ5 to IRQ0, or by falling-edge
sensing.
Bits 5 to 0
IRQ5SC to IRQ0SC
Description
0
Interrupts are requested when IRQ5 to IRQ0 inputs are low
1
Interrupts are requested by falling-edge input at IRQ5 to IRQ0
86
(Initial value)
5.3 Interrupt Sources
The interrupt sources include external interrupts (NMI, IRQ0 to IRQ5) and 30 internal interrupts.
5.3.1 External Interrupts
There are seven external interrupts: NMI, and IRQ0 to IRQ5. Of these, NMI, IRQ0, IRQ1, and
IRQ2 can be used to exit software standby mode.
NMI: NMI is the highest-priority interrupt and is always accepted, regardless of the states of the
I and UI bits in CCR. The NMIEG bit in SYSCR selects whether an interrupt is requested by the
rising or falling edge of the input at the NMI pin. NMI interrupt exception handling has vector
number 7.
IRQ0 to IRQ5 Interrupts: These interrupts are requested by input signals at pins IRQ0 to IRQ5.
The IRQ0 to IRQ5 interrupts have the following features.
•
ISCR settings can select whether an interrupt is requested by the low level of the input at pins
IRQ0 to IRQ5, or by the falling edge.
•
IER settings can enable or disable the IRQ0 to IRQ5 interrupts. Interrupt priority levels can be
assigned by four bits in IPRA (IPRA7 to IPRA4).
•
The status of IRQ0 to IRQ5 interrupt requests is indicated in ISR. The ISR flags can be
cleared to 0 by software.
Figure 5-2 shows a block diagram of interrupts IRQ0 to IRQ5.
IRQnSC
IRQnE
IRQnF
Edge/level
sense circuit
S
Q
R
IRQn input
Clear signal
Note: n = 5 to 0
Figure 5-2 Block Diagram of Interrupts IRQ0 to IRQ5
87
IRQn interrupt
request
Figure 5-3 shows the timing of the setting of the interrupt flags (IRQnF).
ø
IRQn
input pin
IRQnF
Note: n = 5 to 0
Figure 5-3 Timing of Setting of IRQnF
Interrupts IRQ0 to IRQ5 have vector numbers 12 to 17. These interrupts are detected regardless of
whether the corresponding pin is set for input or output. When using a pin for external interrupt
input, clear its DDR bit to 0 and do not use the pin for chip select output, refresh output, or SCI
input or output.
5.3.2 Internal Interrupts
Thirty internal interrupts are requested from the on-chip supporting modules.
•
Each on-chip supporting module has status flags for indicating interrupt status, and enable
bits for enabling or disabling interrupts.
•
Interrupt priority levels can be assigned in IPRA and IPRB.
•
ITU and SCI interrupt requests can activate the DMAC, in which case no interrupt request is
sent to the interrupt controller, and the I and UI bits are disregarded.
5.3.3 Interrupt Vector Table
Table 5-3 lists the interrupt sources, their vector addresses, and their default priority order. In the
default priority order, smaller vector numbers have higher priority. The priority of interrupts other
than NMI can be changed in IPRA and IPRB. The priority order after a reset is the default order
shown in table 5-3.
88
Table 5-3 Interrupt Sources, Vector Addresses, and Priority
Interrupt Source
Origin
Vector
Number
Vector Address*
IPR
Priority
NMI
External pins
7
H'001C to H'001F
—
High
IRQ0
12
H'0030 to H'0033
IPRA7
IRQ1
13
H'0034 to H0037
IPRA6
IRQ2
14
H'0038 to H'003B
IPRA5
IRQ3
15
H'003C to H'003F
IRQ4
16
H'0040 to H'0043
IRQ5
17
H'0044 to H'0047
18
H'0048 to H'004B
19
H'004C to H'004F
Reserved
—
WOVI (interval timer)
Watchdog timer
20
H'0050 to H'0053
CMI (compare match)
Refresh controller
21
H'0054 to H'0057
Reserved
—
22
H'0058 to H'005B
23
H'005C to H'005F
24
H'0060 to H'0063
IMIB0 (compare match/input
capture B0)
25
H'0064 to H'0067
OVI0 (overflow 0)
26
H'0068 to H'006B
IMIA0 (compare match/input
capture A0)
ITU channel 0
Reserved
—
27
H'006C to H'006F
IMIA1 (compare match/input
capture A1)
ITU channel 1
28
H'0070 to H'0073
IMIB1 (compare match/input
capture B1)
29
H'0074 to H'0077
OVI1 (overflow 1)
30
H'0078 to H'007B
Reserved
—
31
H'007C to H'007F
IMIA2 (compare match/input
capture A2)
ITU channel 2
32
H'0080 to H'0083
IMIB2 (compare match/input
capture B2)
33
H'0084 to H'0087
OVI2 (overflow 2)
34
H'0088 to H'008B
35
H'008C to H'008F
Reserved
—
Note: * Lower 16 bits of the address.
89
IPRA4
IPRA3
IPRA2
IPRA1
IPRA0
Low
Table 5-3 Interrupt Sources, Vector Addresses, and Priority (cont)
Interrupt Source
Origin
Vector
Number
Vector Address*
IPR
IMIA3 (compare match/input
capture A3)
ITU channel 3
36
H'0090 to H'0093
IPRB7 High
IMIB3 (compare match/input
capture B3)
37
H'0094 to H'0097
OVI3 (overflow 3)
38
H'0098 to H'009B
Reserved
—
39
H'009C to H'009F
IMIA4 (compare match/input
capture A4)
ITU channel 4
40
H'00A0 to H'00A3
IMIB4 (compare match/input
capture B4)
41
H'00A4 to H'00A7
OVI4 (overflow 4)
42
H'00A8 to H'00AB
IPRB6
Reserved
—
43
H'00AC to H'00AF
DEND0A
DMAC
44
H'00B0 to H'00B3
DEND0B
45
H'00B4 to H'00B7
DEND1A
46
H'00B8 to H'00BB
DEND1B
47
H'00BC to H'00BF
48
H'00C0 to H'00C3 —
49
H'00C4 to H'00C7
50
H'00C8 to H'00CB
51
H'00CC to H'00CF
52
H'00D0 to H'00D3 IPRB3
RXI0 (receive data full 0)
53
H'00D4 to H'00D7
TXI0 (transmit data empty 0)
54
H'00D8 to H'00DB
TEI0 (transmit end 0)
55
H'00DC to H'00DF
56
H'00E0 to H'00E3
RXI1 (receive data full 1)
57
H'00E4 to H'00E7
TXI1 (transmit data empty 1)
58
H'00E8 to H'00EB
TEI1 (transmit end 1)
59
H'00EC to H'00EF
60
H'00F0 to H'00F3
Reserved
ERI0 (receive error 0)
ERI1 (receive error 1)
ADI (A/D end)
—
SCI channel 0
SCI channel 1
A/D
Note: * Lower 16 bits of the address.
90
Priority
IPRB5
IPRB2
IPRB1 Low
5.4 Interrupt Operation
5.4.1 Interrupt Handling Process
The H8/3002 handles interrupts differently depending on the setting of the UE bit. When UE = 1,
interrupts are controlled by the I bit. When UE = 0, interrupts are controlled by the I and UI bits.
Table 5-4 indicates how interrupts are handled for all setting combinations of the UE, I, and
UI bits.
NMI interrupts are always accepted except in the reset and hardware standby states. IRQ
interrupts and interrupts from the on-chip supporting modules have their own enable bits.
Interrupt requests are ignored when the enable bits are cleared to 0.
Table 5-4 UE, I, and UI Bit Settings and Interrupt Handling
SYSCR
CCR
UE
I
UI
Description
1
0
—
All interrupts are accepted. Interrupts with priority level 1 have higher
priority.
1
—
No interrupts are accepted except NMI.
0
—
All interrupts are accepted. Interrupts with priority level 1 have higher
priority.
1
0
NMI and interrupts with priority level 1 are accepted.
1
No interrupts are accepted except NMI.
0
UE = 1: Interrupts IRQ0 to IRQ5 and interrupts from the on-chip supporting modules can all be
masked by the I bit in the CPU’s CCR. Interrupts are masked when the I bit is set to 1, and
unmasked when the I bit is cleared to 0. Interrupts with priority level 1 have higher priority.
Figure 5-4 is a flowchart showing how interrupts are accepted when UE = 1.
91
Program execution state
No
Interrupt requested?
Yes
Yes
NMI
No
No
Pending
Priority level 1?
Yes
IRQ 0
No
Yes
IRQ 1
IRQ 0
No
Yes
No
IRQ 1
Yes
No
Yes
ADI
ADI
Yes
Yes
No
I=0
Yes
Save PC and CCR
I ←1
Read vector address
Branch to interrupt
service routine
Figure 5-4 Process Up to Interrupt Acceptance when UE = 1
92
•
If an interrupt condition occurs and the corresponding interrupt enable bit is set to 1, an
interrupt request is sent to the interrupt controller.
•
When the interrupt controller receives one or more interrupt requests, it selects the highestpriority request, following the IPR interrupt priority settings, and holds other requests
pending. If two or more interrupts with the same IPR setting are requested simultaneously, the
interrupt controller follows the priority order shown in table 5-3.
•
The interrupt controller checks the I bit. If the I bit is cleared to 0, the selected interrupt
request is accepted. If the I bit is set to 1, only NMI is accepted; other interrupt requests are
held pending.
•
When an interrupt request is accepted, interrupt exception handling starts after execution of
the current instruction has been completed.
•
In interrupt exception handling, PC and CCR are saved to the stack area. The PC value that is
saved indicates the address of the first instruction that will be executed after the return from
the interrupt service routine.
•
Next the I bit is set to 1 in CCR, masking all interrupts except NMI.
•
The vector address of the accepted interrupt is generated, and the interrupt service routine
starts executing from the address indicated by the contents of the vector address.
UE = 0: The I and UI bits in the CPU’s CCR and the IPR bits enable three-level masking of IRQ0
to IRQ5 interrupts and interrupts from the on-chip supporting modules.
•
Interrupt requests with priority level 0 are masked when the I bit is set to 1, and are unmasked
when the I bit is cleared to 0.
•
Interrupt requests with priority level 1 are masked when the I and UI bits are both set to 1,
and are unmasked when either the I bit or the UI bit is cleared to 0.
For example, if the interrupt enable bits of all interrupt requests are set to 1, IPRA is set to
H'20, and IPRB is set to H'00 (giving IRQ2 and IRQ3 interrupt requests priority over other
interrupts), interrupts are masked as follows:
a. If I = 0, all interrupts are unmasked (priority order: NMI > IRQ2 > IRQ3 >IRQ0 …).
b. If I = 1 and UI = 0, only NMI, IRQ2, and IRQ3 are unmasked.
c. If I = 1 and UI = 1, all interrupts are masked except NMI.
93
Figure 5-5 shows the transitions among the above states.
I←0
a. All interrupts are
unmasked
I←0
b. Only NMI, IRQ 2 , and
IRQ 3 are unmasked
I ← 1, UI ← 0
Exception handling,
or I ← 1, UI ← 1
UI ← 0
Exception handling,
or UI ← 1
c. All interrupts are
masked except NMI
Figure 5-5 Interrupt Masking State Transitions (Example)
Figure 5-6 is a flowchart showing how interrupts are accepted when UE = 0.
•
If an interrupt condition occurs and the corresponding interrupt enable bit is set to 1, an
interrupt request is sent to the interrupt controller.
•
When the interrupt controller receives one or more interrupt requests, it selects the highestpriority request, following the IPR interrupt priority settings, and holds other requests
pending. If two or more interrupts with the same IPR setting are requested simultaneously, the
interrupt controller follows the priority order shown in table 5-3.
•
The interrupt controller checks the I bit. If the I bit is cleared to 0, the selected interrupt
request is accepted regardless of its IPR setting, and regardless of the UI bit. If the I bit is set
to 1 and the UI bit is cleared to 0, only NMI and interrupts with priority level 1 are accepted;
interrupt requests with priority level 0 are held pending. If the I bit and UI bit are both set to
1, only NMI is accepted; all other interrupt requests are held pending.
•
When an interrupt request is accepted, interrupt exception handling starts after execution of
the current instruction has been completed.
•
In interrupt exception handling, PC and CCR are saved to the stack area. The PC value that is
saved indicates the address of the first instruction that will be executed after the return from
the interrupt service routine.
•
The I and UI bits are set to 1 in CCR, masking all interrupts except NMI.
•
The vector address of the accepted interrupt is generated, and the interrupt service routine
starts executing from the address indicated by the contents of the vector address.
94
Program execution state
No
Interrupt requested?
Yes
Yes
NMI
No
No
Pending
Priority level 1?
IRQ 0
No
IRQ 0
Yes
IRQ 1
No
Yes
No
IRQ 1
Yes
No
Yes
ADI
ADI
Yes
Yes
No
I=0
No
I=0
Yes
Yes
No
UI = 0
Yes
Save PC and CCR
I → 1, UI → 1
Read vector address
Branch to interrupt
service routine
Figure 5-6 Process Up to Interrupt Acceptance when UE = 0
95
96
(2)
(1)
(4)
High
(3)
Instruction Internal
prefetch
processing
(8)
(7)
(10)
(9)
(12)
(11)
Vector fetch
(14)
(13)
(6), (8)
PC and CCR saved to stack
(9), (11) Vector address
(10), (12) Starting address of interrupt service routine (contents of
vector address)
(13)
Starting address of interrupt service routine; (13) = (10), (12)
(14)
First instruction of interrupt service routine
(6)
(5)
Stack
Prefetch of
interrupt
Internal
service routine
processing instruction
Note: Mode 2, with program code and stack in external memory area accessed in two states via 16-bit bus.
(1)
Instruction prefetch address (not executed;
return address, same as PC contents)
(2), (4) Instruction code (not executed)
Instruction prefetch address (not executed)
(3)
SP – 2
(5)
SP – 4
(7)
D15 to D0
HWR , LWR
RD
Address
bus
Interrupt
request
signal
ø
Interrupt level
decision and wait
for end of instruction
Interrupt accepted
5.4.2 Interrupt Sequence
Figure 5-7 shows the interrupt sequence in mode 2 when the program code and stack are in an
external memory area accessed in two states via a 16-bit bus.
Figure 5-7 Interrupt Sequence (Mode 2, Two-State Access,
Stack in External Memory)
5.4.3 Interrupt Response Time
Table 5-5 indicates the interrupt response time from the occurrence of an interrupt request until
the first instruction of the interrupt service routine is executed.
Table 5-5 Interrupt Response Time
External Memory
8-Bit Bus
16-Bit Bus
No. Item
On-Chip
Memory
2 States
3 States
2 States
3 States
1
Interrupt priority decision
2*1
2*1
2*1
2*1
2*1
2
Maximum number of states
until end of current instruction
1 to 23
1 to 27
1 to 31*4
1 to 23
1 to 25*4
3
Saving PC and CCR to stack
4
8
12*4
4
6*4
4
Vector fetch
4
8
12*4
4
6*4
5
Instruction prefetch*2
4
8
12*4
4
6*4
6
Internal processing*3
4
4
4
4
4
19 to 41
31 to 57
43 to 73
19 to 41
25 to 49
Total
Notes: 1. 1 state for internal interrupts.
2. Prefetch after the interrupt is accepted and prefetch of the first instruction in the interrupt
service routine.
3. Internal processing after the interrupt is accepted and internal processing after prefetch.
4. The number of states increases if wait states are inserted in external memory access.
97
5.5 Usage Notes
5.5.1 Contention between Interrupt and Interrupt-Disabling Instruction
When an instruction clears an interrupt enable bit to 0 to disable the interrupt, the interrupt is not
disabled until after execution of the instruction is completed. If an interrupt occurs while a BCLR,
MOV, or other instruction is being executed to clear its interrupt enable bit to 0, at the instant
when execution of the instruction ends the interrupt is still enabled, so its interrupt exception
handling is carried out. If a higher-priority interrupt is also requested, however, interrupt exception
handling for the higher-priority interrupt is carried out, and the lower-priority interrupt is ignored.
This also applies to the clearing of an interrupt flag.
Figure 5-8 shows an example in which an IMIEA bit is cleared to 0 in the ITU.
TIER write cycle by CPU
IMIA exception handling
ø
Internal
address bus
TIER address
Internal
write signal
IMIEA
IMIA
IMFA interrupt
signal
Figure 5-8 Contention between Interrupt and Interrupt-Disabling Instruction
This type of contention will not occur if the interrupt is masked when the interrupt enable bit or
flag is cleared to 0.
98
5.5.2 Instructions that Inhibit Interrupts
The LDC, ANDC, ORC, and XORC instructions inhibit interrupts. When an interrupt occurs,
after determining the interrupt priority, the interrupt controller requests a CPU interrupt. If the
CPU is currently executing one of these interrupt-inhibiting instructions, however, when the
instruction is completed the CPU always continues by executing the next instruction.
5.5.3 Interrupts during EEPMOV Instruction Execution
The EEPMOV.B and EEPMOV.W instructions differ in their reaction to interrupt requests.
When the EEPMOV.B instruction is executing a transfer, no interrupts are accepted until the
transfer is completed, not even NMI.
When the EEPMOV.W instruction is executing a transfer, interrupt requests other than NMI are
not accepted until the transfer is completed. If NMI is requested, NMI exception handling starts at
a transfer cycle boundary. The PC value saved on the stack is the address of the next instruction.
Programs should be coded as follows to allow for NMI interrupts during EEPMOV.W execution:
L1: EEPMOV.W
MOV.W R4,R4
BNE L1
5.5.4 Usage Notes
The IRQnF flag specification calls for the flag to be cleared by writing 0 to it after it has been read
while set to 1. However, it is possible for the IRQnF flag to be cleared by mistake simply by
writing 0 to it, irrespective of whether it has been read while set to 1, with the result that interrupt
exception handling is not executed. This will occur when the following conditions are met.
1. Setting conditions
(1) Multiple external interrupts (IRQa, IRQb) are being used.
(2) Different clearing methods are being used: clearing by writing 0 for the IRQaF flag, and
clearing by hardware for the IRQbF flag.
(3) A bit-manipulation instruction is used on the IRQ status register for clearing the IRQaF flag,
or else ISR is read as a byte unit, the IRQaF flag bit is cleard, and the values read in the other
bits are written as a byte unit.
2. Generation conditions
(1) A read of the ISR register is executed to clear the IRQaF flag while it is set to1, then the
99
IRQbF flag is cleared by the execution of interrupt exception handling.
(2) When the IRQaF flag is cleared, there is contention with IRQb generation (IRQaF flag
setting). (IRQbF was 0 when ISR was read to clear the IRQaF flag, but IRQbF is set to 1
before ISR is written to.)
If the above setting conditions (1) to (3) and generation conditions (1) and (3) are all fulfilled,
when the ISR write in generation condition (2) is performed the IRQbF flag will be cleared
inadvertently, and interrupt exception handling will not be executed.
However, this inadvertent clearing of the IRQbF flag will not occur if 0 is written to this flag even
once between generation conditions (1) and (2).
TIER write cycle by CPU
IMIA exception handling
IRQaF
1 read 0 written
1 read 0 written
1 read
1 read 0 written
IRQbF
0 IRQb
written executed
(Inadvertent clearing)
Generation condition (1)
Generation condition (2)
Figure 5-9 IRQnF Flag when Interrupt Exception Handling is not Executed
Either of the methods shown below should be used to prevent this problem.
Method 1
When clearing the IRQaF flag, read ISR as a byte unit instead of using a bit-manipulation
instruction, and write a byte value that clears the IRQaF flag to 0 and sets the other bits to 1.
Example: When a = 0
MOV.B @ISR, R0L
MOV.B #HFE, R0L
MOV.B R0L, @ISR
100
Method 2
Perform dummy processing within the IRQb interrupt exception handling routine to clear the
IRQbF flag.
Example: When b = 1
IRQB
MOV.B #HFD, R0L
MOV.B R0L, @ISR
.
.
.
101
102
Section 6 Bus Controller
6.1 Overview
The H8/3002 has an on-chip bus controller that divides the address space into eight areas and can
assign different bus specifications to each. This enables different types of memory to be connected
easily.
A bus arbitration function of the bus controller controls the operation of the DMA controller
(DMAC) and refresh controller. The bus controller can also release the bus to an external device.
6.1.1 Features
Features of the bus controller are listed below.
•
Independent settings for address areas 0 to 7
—
—
—
—
•
128-kbyte areas in 1-Mbyte modes; 2-Mbyte areas in 16-Mbyte modes.
Chip select signals (CS0 to CS3) can be output for areas 0 to 3.
Areas can be designated for 8-bit or 16-bit access.
Areas can be designated for two-state or three-state access.
Four wait modes
— Programmable wait mode, pin auto-wait mode, and pin wait modes 0 and 1 can be
selected.
— Zero to three wait states can be inserted automatically.
•
Bus arbitration function
— A built-in bus arbiter grants the bus right to the CPU, DMAC, refresh controller, or an
external bus master.
103
6.1.2 Block Diagram
Figure 6-1 shows a block diagram of the bus controller.
CS0 to CS3
ABWCR
Internal
address bus
ASTCR
Area
decoder
WCER
Internal signals
Bus mode control signal
Bus control
circuit
Bus size control signal
Access state control signal
Internal data bus
Wait request signal
Wait-state
controller
WAIT
WCR
Internal signals
CPU bus request signal
DMAC bus request signal
Refresh controller bus request signal
CPU bus acknowledge signal
DMAC bus acknowledge signal
Refresh controller bus acknowledge signal
BRCR
Bus arbiter
BACK
Legend
ABWCR:
ASTCR:
WCER:
WCR:
BRCR:
BREQ
Bus width control register
Access state control register
Wait state controller enable register
Wait control register
Bus release control register
Figure 6-1 Block Diagram of Bus Controller
104
6.1.3 Input/Output Pins
Table 6-1 summarizes the bus controller’s input/output pins.
Table 6-1 Bus Controller Pins
Name
Abbreviation
I/O
Function
Chip select 0 to 3
CS0 to CS3
Output
Strobe signals selecting areas 0 to 3
Address strobe
AS
Output
Strobe signal indicating valid address output on the
address bus
Read
RD
Output
Strobe signal indicating reading from the external
address space
High write
HWR
Output
Strobe signal indicating writing to the external
address space, with valid data on the upper data
bus (D15 to D8)
Low write
LWR
Output
Strobe signal indicating writing to the external
address space, with valid data on the lower data
bus (D7 to D0)
Wait
WAIT
Input
Wait request signal for access to external threestate-access areas
Bus request
BREQ
Input
Request signal for releasing the bus to an external
device
Bus acknowledge
BACK
Output
Acknowledge signal indicating the bus is released
to an external device
6.1.4 Register Configuration
Table 6-2 summarizes the bus controller’s registers.
Table 6-2 Bus Controller Registers
Initial Value
Address*
Name
Abbreviation
R/W
H'FFEC
Bus width control register
ABWCR
R/W
H'FF
H'00
H'FFED
Access state control register
ASTCR
R/W
H'FF
H'FF
H'FFEE
Wait control register
WCR
R/W
H'F3
H'F3
H'FFEF
Wait state controller enable register
WCER
R/W
H'FF
H'FF
H'FFF3
Bus release control register
BRCR
R/W
H'FE
H'FE
Note: * Lower 16 bits of the address.
105
Modes 1 & 3 Modes 2 & 4
6.2 Register Descriptions
6.2.1 Bus Width Control Register (ABWCR)
ABWCR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that selects 8-bit or 16-bit access for each area.
Bit
Initial Modes 1, 3
value Modes 2, 4
Read/Write
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
ABW7
ABW6
ABW5
ABW4
ABW3
ABW2
ABW1
ABW0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Bits selecting bus width for each area
When ABWCR contains H'FF (selecting 8-bit access for all areas), the H8/3002 operates in 8-bit
bus mode: the upper data bus (D15 to D8) is valid, and port 4 is an input/output port. When at least
one bit is cleared to 0 in ABWCR, the H8/3002 operates in 16-bit bus mode with a 16-bit data bus
(D15 to D0). In modes 1 and 3, ABWCR is initialized to H'FF by a reset and in hardware standby
mode. In modes 2 and 4, ABWCR is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in hardware standby mode.
ABWCR is not initialized in software standby mode.
Bits 7 to 0—Area 7 to 0 Bus Width Control (ABW7 to ABW0): These bits select 8-bit access
or 16-bit access to the corresponding address areas.
Bits 7 to 0
ABW7 to ABW0
Description
0
Areas 7 to 0 are 16-bit access areas
1
Areas 7 to 0 are 8-bit access areas
ABWCR specifies the bus width of external memory areas. The bus width of on-chip memory and
registers is fixed and does not depend on ABWCR settings.
106
6.2.2 Access State Control Register (ASTCR)
ASTCR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that selects whether each area is accessed in two
states or three states.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
AST7
AST6
AST5
AST4
AST3
AST2
AST1
AST0
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Bits selecting number of states for access to each area
ASTCR is initialized to H'FF by a reset and in hardware standby mode. It is not initialized in
software standby mode.
Bits 7 to 0—Area 7 to 0 Access State Control (AST7 to AST0): These bits select whether the
corresponding area is accessed in two or three states.
Bits 7 to 0
AST7 to AST0
Description
0
Areas 7 to 0 are accessed in two states
1
Areas 7 to 0 are accessed in three states
(Initial value)
ASTCR specifies the number of states in which external areas are accessed. On-chip memory and
registers are accessed in a fixed number of states that does not depend on ASTCR settings.
107
6.2.3 Wait Control Register (WCR)
WCR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that selects the wait mode for the wait-state controller
(WSC) and specifies the number of wait states.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
—
—
—
WMS1
WMS0
WC1
WC0
Initial value
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
Read/Write
—
—
—
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Reserved bits
Wait count 1/0
These bits select the
number of wait states
inserted
Wait mode select 1/0
These bits select the wait mode
WCR is initialized to H'F3 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. It is not initialized in
software standby mode.
Bits 7 to 4—Reserved: These bits cannot be modified and are always read as 1.
Bits 3 and 2—Wait Mode Select 1 and 0 (WMS1/0): These bits select the wait mode.
Bit 3
WMS1
Bit 2
WMS0
Description
0
0
Programmable wait mode
1
No wait states inserted by wait-state controller
0
Pin wait mode 1
1
Pin auto-wait mode
1
(Initial value)
108
Bits 1 and 0—Wait Count 1 and 0 (WC1/0): These bits select the number of wait states inserted
in access to external three-state-access areas.
Bit 1
WC1
Bit 0
WC0
Description
0
0
No wait states inserted by wait-state controller
1
1 state inserted
0
2 states inserted
1
3 states inserted
1
(Initial value)
6.2.4 Wait State Control Enable Register (WCER)
WCER is an 8-bit readable/writable register that enables or disables wait-state control of external
three-state-access areas by the wait-state controller.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
WCE7
WCE6
WCE5
WCE4
WCE3
WCE2
WCE1
WCE0
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Wait state controller enable 7 to 0
These bits enable or disable wait-state control
WCER is initialized to H'FF by a reset and in hardware standby mode. It is not initialized in
software standby mode.
Bits 7 to 0—Wait-State Controller Enable 7 to 0 (WCE7 to WCE0): These bits enable or
disable wait-state control of external three-state-access areas.
Bits 7 to 0
WCE7 to WCE0
Description
0
Wait-state control disabled (pin wait mode 0)
1
Wait-state control enabled
(Initial value)
109
6.2.5 Bus Release Control Register (BRCR)
BRCR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that enables address output on bus lines A23 to A21
and enables or disables release of the bus to an external device.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
A23E
A22E
A21E
—
—
—
—
BRLE
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
—
—
—
—
—
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
—
—
—
—
R/W
Initial value
Read/ Modes 1, 2 —
Write Modes 3, 4 R/W
Address 23 to 21 enable
These bits enable PA 6 to
PA 4 to be used for A 23 to
A 21 address output
Reserved bits
Bus release enable
Enables or disables
release of the bus
to an external device
BRCR is initialized to H'FE by a reset and in hardware standby mode. It is not initialized in
software standby mode.
Bit 7—Address 23 Enable (A23E): Enables PA4 to be used as the A23 address output pin.
Writing 0 in this bit enables A23 address output from PA4. In modes other than 3 and 4 this bit
cannot be modified and PA4 has its ordinary input/output functions.
Bit 7
A23E
Description
0
PA4 is the A23 address output pin
1
PA4 is the PA4/TP4/TIOCA1 input/output pin
110
(Initial value)
Bit 6—Address 22 Enable (A22E): Enables PA5 to be used as the A22 address output pin.
Writing 0 in this bit enables A22 address output from PA5. In modes other than 3 and 4 this bit
cannot be modified and PA5 has its ordinary input/output functions.
Bit 6
A22E
Description
0
PA5 is the A22 address output pin
1
PA5 is the PA5/TP5/TIOCB1 input/output pin
(Initial value)
Bit 5—Address 21 Enable (A21E): Enables PA6 to be used as the A21 address output pin.
Writing 0 in this bit enables A21 address output from PA6. In modes other than 3 and 4 this bit
cannot be modified and PA6 has its ordinary input/output functions.
Bit 5
A21E
Description
0
PA6 is the A21 address output pin
1
PA6 is the PA6/TP6/TIOCA2 input/output pin
(Initial value)
Bits 4 to 1—Reserved: These bits cannot be modified and are always read as 1.
Bit 0—Bus Release Enable (BRLE): Enables or disables release of the bus to an external device.
Bit 0
BRLE
Description
0
The bus cannot be released to an external device; BREQ and BACK
can be used as input/output pins
1
The bus can be released to an external device
111
(Initial value)
6.3 Operation
6.3.1 Area Division
The external address space is divided into areas 0 to 7. Each area has a size of 128 kbytes in the
1-Mbyte modes, or 2 Mbytes in the 16-Mbyte modes. Figure 6-2 shows a general view of the
memory map.
H'00000
H'000000
Area 0 (2 Mbytes)
Area 0 (128 kbytes)
H'1FFFF
H'1FFFFF
H'20000
H'200000
Area 1 (2 Mbytes)
Area 1 (128 kbytes)
H'3FFFF
H'3FFFFF
H'40000
H'400000
Area 2 (2 Mbytes)
Area 2 (128 kbytes)
H'5FFFF
H'60000
H'5FFFFF
H'600000
Area 3 (2 Mbytes)
Area 3 (128 kbytes)
H'7FFFF
H'7FFFFF
H'80000
H'800000
Area 4 (2 Mbytes)
Area 4 (128 kbytes)
H'9FFFF
H'9FFFFF
H'A0000
H'A00000
Area 5 (2 Mbytes)
Area 5 (128 kbytes)
H'BFFFF
H'BFFFFF
H'C0000
H'C00000
Area 6 (2 Mbytes)
Area 6 (128 kbytes)
H'DFFFF
H'E0000
H'DFFFFF
H'E00000
Area 7 (128 kbytes)
On-chip RAM
* 1, *2
On-chip RAM * 1, *2
External address space*3
H'FFFFF
Area 7 (2 Mbytes)
External address space*3
On-chip registers *1
H'FFFFFF
a. 1-Mbyte modes (modes 1 and 2)
On-chip registers*1
b. 16-Mbyte modes (modes 3 and 4)
Notes: 1. The on-chip RAM and on-chip registers have a fixed bus width and are accessed in a fixed
number of states.
2. When the RAME bit is cleared to 0 in SYSCR, this area conforms to the specifications of area 7.
3. The 12-byte external address space conforms to the specifications of area 7.
Figure 6-2 Access Area Map for Modes 1 to 4
112
Chip select signals (CS0 to CS3) can be output for each area. The bus specifications for each area
can be selected in ABWCR, ASTCR, WCER, and WCR as shown in table 6-3.
Table 6-3 Bus Specifications
ABWCR ASTCR WCER
WCR
Bus Specifications
ABWn
ASTn
WCEn
WMS1
WMS0
Bus
Width
Access
States Wait Mode
0
0
—
—
—
16
2
Disabled
1
0
—
—
16
3
Pin wait mode 0
1
0
0
16
3
Programmable wait mode
1
16
3
Disabled
0
16
3
Pin wait mode 1
1
16
3
Pin auto-wait mode
1
1
0
—
—
—
8
2
Disabled
1
0
—
—
8
3
Pin wait mode 0
1
0
0
8
3
Programmable wait mode
1
8
3
Disabled
0
8
3
Pin wait mode 1
1
8
3
Pin auto-wait mode
1
Note: n = 0 to 7
113
6.3.2 Chip Select Signals
For each of areas 0 to 3, the H8/3002 can output a chip select signal (CS0 to CS3) that goes low to
indicate when the area is selected. Figure 6-3 shows the output timing of a CSn signal (n = 0 to 3).
Output of the CSn signal is enabled or disabled in the data direction register (DDR) of the
corresponding port. A reset leaves pin CS0 in the output state and pins CS1 to CS3 in the input
state. To output chip select signals CS1 to CS3, the corresponding DDR bits must be set to 1.
For details see section 9, I/O Ports.
The CSn signals are decoded from the address signals. They can be used as chip select signals for
SRAM and other devices.
T1
T2
T3
ø
Address
bus
External address in area n
CSn
Figure 6-3 CSn Output Timing (n = 0 to 3)
114
6.3.3 Data Bus
The H8/3002 allows either 8-bit access or 16-bit access to be designated for each of areas 0 to 7.
An 8-bit-access area uses the upper data bus (D15 to D8). A 16-bit-access area uses both the upper
data bus (D15 to D8) and lower data bus (D7 to D0).
In read access the RD signal applies without distinction to both the upper and lower data bus. In
write access the HWR signal applies to the upper data bus, and the LWR signal applies to the
lower data bus.
Table 6-4 indicates how the two parts of the data bus are used under different access conditions.
Table 6-4 Access Conditions and Data Bus Usage
Area
8-bit-access
area
Access Read/
Size
Write
Valid
Address Strobe
—
Read
—
RD
Write
—
HWR
Read
Even
RD
16-bit-access Byte
area
Odd
Lower Data Bus
(D7 to D0)
Valid
Invalid
Undetermined data
Valid
Invalid
Invalid
Valid
Undetermined data
Even
HWR
Valid
Odd
LWR
Undetermined data Valid
Read
—
RD
Valid
Valid
Write
—
HWR, LWR Valid
Valid
Write
Word
Upper Data Bus
(D15 to D8)
Note: Undetermined data means that unpredictable data is output.
Invalid means that the bus is in the input state and the input is ignored.
115
6.3.4 Bus Control Signal Timing
8-Bit, Three-State-Access Areas: Figure 6-4 shows the timing of bus control signals for an 8-bit,
three-state-access area. The upper address bus (D15 to D8) is used to access these areas. The LWR
pin is always high. Wait states can be inserted.
Bus cycle
T1
T2
T3
ø
Address bus
External address in area n
CS n
AS
RD
Read
access
D15 to D8
Valid
D 7 to D 0
Invalid
HWR
Write
access
LWR
High
D15 to D8
Valid
D 7 to D 0
Undetermined data
Note: n = 7 to 0 (but for CS n , n = 3 to 0)
Figure 6-4 Bus Control Signal Timing for 8-Bit, Three-State-Access Area
116
8-Bit, Two-State-Access Areas: Figure 6-5 shows the timing of bus control signals for an 8-bit,
two-state-access area. The upper address bus (D15 to D8) is used to access these areas. The LWR
pin is always high. Wait states cannot be inserted.
Bus cycle
T1
T2
ø
Address bus
External address in area n
CS n
AS
RD
Read
access
D15 to D8
Valid
D 7 to D 0
Invalid
HWR
LWR
High
Write
access
D15 to D8
Valid
D 7 to D 0
Undetermined data
Note: n = 7 to 0 (but for CS n , n = 3 to 0)
Figure 6-5 Bus Control Signal Timing for 8-Bit, Two-State-Access Area
117
16-Bit, Three-State-Access Areas: Figures 6-6 to 6-8 show the timing of bus control signals for a
16-bit, three-state-access area. In these areas, the upper address bus (D15 to D8) is used to access
even addresses and the lower address bus (D7 to D0) is used to access odd addresses. Wait states
can be inserted.
Bus cycle
T1
T2
T3
ø
Address bus
Even external address in area n
CS n
AS
RD
Read
access
D15 to D8
Valid
D 7 to D 0
Invalid
HWR
LWR
High
Write
access
D15 to D8
Valid
D 7 to D 0
Undetermined data
Note: n = 7 to 0 (but for CS n , n = 3 to 0)
Figure 6-6 Bus Control Signal Timing for 16-Bit, Three-State-Access Area (1)
(Byte Access to Even Address)
118
Bus cycle
T1
T2
T3
ø
Address bus
Odd external address in area n
CS n
AS
RD
Read
access
D15 to D8
Invalid
D 7 to D 0
Valid
HWR
High
LWR
Write
access
D15 to D8
Undetermined data
D 7 to D 0
Valid
Note: n = 7 to 0 (but for CS n , n = 3 to 0)
Figure 6-7 Bus Control Signal Timing for 16-Bit, Three-State-Access Area (2)
(Byte Access to Odd Address)
119
Bus cycle
T1
T2
T3
ø
Address bus
External address in area n
CS n
AS
RD
Read
access
D15 to D8
Valid
D 7 to D 0
Valid
HWR
LWR
Write
access
D15 to D8
Valid
D 7 to D 0
Valid
Note: n = 7 to 0 (but for CS n , n = 3 to 0)
Figure 6-8 Bus Control Signal Timing for 16-Bit, Three-State-Access Area (3)
(Word Access)
120
16-Bit, Two-State-Access Areas: Figures 6-9 to 6-11 show the timing of bus control signals for a
16-bit, two-state-access area. In these areas, the upper address bus (D15 to D8) is used to access
even addresses and the lower address bus (D7 to D0) is used to access odd addresses. Wait states
cannot be inserted.
Bus cycle
T1
T2
ø
Address bus
Even external address in area n
CS n
AS
RD
Read
access
D15 to D8
Valid
D 7 to D 0
Invalid
HWR
LWR
High
Write
access
D15 to D8
Valid
D 7 to D 0
Undetermined data
Note: n = 7 to 0 (but for CS n , n = 3 to 0)
Figure 6-9 Bus Control Signal Timing for 16-Bit, Two-State-Access Area (1)
(Byte Access to Even Address)
121
Bus cycle
T1
T2
ø
Address bus
Odd external address in area n
CS n
AS
RD
Read
access
D15 to D8
Invalid
D 7 to D 0
Valid
HWR
High
LWR
Write
access
D15 to D8
Undetermined data
D 7 to D 0
Valid
Note: n = 7 to 0 (but for CS n , n = 3 to 0)
Figure 6-10 Bus Control Signal Timing for 16-Bit, Two-State-Access Area (2)
(Byte Access to Odd Address)
122
Bus cycle
T1
T2
ø
Address bus
External address in area n
CS n
AS
RD
Read
access
D15 to D8
Valid
D 7 to D 0
Valid
HWR
LWR
Write
access
D15 to D8
Valid
D 7 to D 0
Valid
Note: n = 7 to 0 (but for CS n , n = 3 to 0)
Figure 6-11 Bus Control Signal Timing for 16-Bit, Two-State-Access Area (3)
(Word Access)
123
6.3.5 Wait Modes
Four wait modes can be selected for each area as shown in table 6-5.
Table 6-5 Wait Mode Selection
ASTCR
WCER
WCR
ASTn Bit WCEn Bit WMS1 Bit WMS0 Bit WSC Control
Wait Mode
0
—
—
—
Disabled
No wait states
1
0
—
—
Disabled
Pin wait mode 0
1
0
0
Enabled
Programmable wait mode
1
Enabled
No wait states
0
Enabled
Pin wait mode 1
1
Enabled
Pin auto-wait mode
1
Note: n = 7 to 0
The ASTn and WCEn bits can be set independently for each area. Bits WMS1 and WMS0 apply
to all areas. All areas for which WSC control is enabled operate in the same wait mode.
124
Pin Wait Mode 0: The wait state controller is disabled. Wait states can only be inserted by WAIT
pin control. During access to an external three-state-access area, if the WAIT pin is low at the fall
of the system clock (ø) in the T2 state, a wait state (TW) is inserted. If the WAIT pin remains low,
wait states continue to be inserted until the WAIT signal goes high. Figure 6-12 shows the timing.
Inserted by WAIT signal
T1
ø
T2
TW
*
*
TW
T3
*
WAIT pin
Address bus
External address
AS
RD
Read
access
Read data
Data bus
HWR , LWR
Write
access
Data bus
Write data
Note: * Arrows indicate time of sampling of the WAIT pin.
Figure 6-12 Pin Wait Mode 0
125
Pin Wait Mode 1: In all accesses to external three-state-access areas, the number of wait states
(TW) selected by bits WC1 and WC0 are inserted. If the WAIT pin is low at the fall of the system
clock (ø) in the last of these wait states, an additional wait state is inserted. If the WAIT pin
remains low, wait states continue to be inserted until the WAIT signal goes high.
Pin wait mode 1 is useful for inserting four or more wait states, or for inserting different numbers
of wait states for different external devices.
If the wait count is 0, this mode operates in the same way as pin wait mode 0.
Figure 6-13 shows the timing when the wait count is 1 (WC1 = 0, WC0 = 1) and one additional
wait state is inserted by WAIT input.
T1
Inserted by
wait count
Inserted by
WAIT signal
TW
TW
T2
ø
*
T3
*
WAIT pin
Address bus
External address
AS
Read
access
RD
Read data
Data bus
HWR, LWR
Write
access
Data bus
Write data
Note: * Arrows indicate time of sampling of the WAIT pin.
Figure 6-13 Pin Wait Mode 1
126
Pin Auto-Wait Mode: If the WAIT pin is low, the number of wait states (TW) selected by bits
WC1 and WC0 are inserted.
In pin auto-wait mode, if the WAIT pin is low at the fall of the system clock (ø) in the T2 state,
the number of wait states (TW) selected by bits WC1 and WC0 are inserted. No additional wait
states are inserted even if the WAIT pin remains low. Pin auto-wait mode can be used for an easy
interface to low-speed memory, simply by routing the chip select signal to the WAIT pin.
Figure 6-14 shows the timing when the wait count is 1.
T1
ø
T2
T3
*
T1
T2
TW
T3
*
WAIT
Address bus
External address
External address
AS
RD, RS
Read
access
Read data
Read data
Data bus
HWR , LWR
Write
access
Data bus
Write data
Write data
Note: * Arrows indicate time of sampling of the WAIT pin.
Figure 6-14 Pin Auto-Wait Mode
127
Programmable Wait Mode: The number of wait states (TW) selected by bits WC1 and WC0 are
inserted in all accesses to external three-state-access areas. Figure 6-15 shows the timing when the
wait count is 1 (WC1 = 0, WC0 = 1).
T1
T2
TW
T3
ø
External address
Address bus
AS
RD
Read
access
Read data
Data bus
HWR, LWR
Write
access
Write data
Data bus
Figure 6-15 Programmable Wait Mode
128
Example of Wait State Control Settings: A reset initializes ASTCR and WCER to H'FF and
WCR to H'F3, selecting programmable wait mode and three wait states for all areas. Software can
select other wait modes for individual areas by modifying the ASTCR, WCER, and WCR settings.
Figure 6-16 shows an example of wait mode settings.
Area 0
3-state-access area,
programmable wait mode
Area 1
3-state-access area,
programmable wait mode
Area 2
3-state-access area,
pin wait mode 0
Area 3
3-state-access area,
pin wait mode 0
Area 4
2-state-access area,
no wait states inserted
Area 5
2-state-access area,
no wait states inserted
Area 6
2-state-access area,
no wait states inserted
Area 7
2-state-access area,
no wait states inserted
Bit:
ASTCR H'0F:
7
0
6
0
5
0
4
0
3
1
2
1
1
1
0
1
WCER H'33:
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
WCR H'F3:
—
—
—
—
0
0
1
1
Note: Wait states cannot be inserted in areas designated for two-state access by ASTCR.
Figure 6-16 Wait Mode Settings (Example)
129
6.3.6 Interconnections with Memory (Example)
For each area, the bus controller can select two- or three-state access and an 8- or 16-bit data bus
width. In three-state-access areas, wait states can be inserted in a variety of modes, simplifying the
connection of both high-speed and low-speed devices.
Figure 6-18 shows an example of interconnections between the H8/3002 and memory. Figure 6-17
shows a memory map for this example.
A 256-kword × 16-bit EPROM is connected to area 0. This device is accessed in three states via a
16-bit bus.
Two 32-kword × 8-bit SRAM devices (SRAM1 and SRAM2) are connected to area 1. These
devices are accessed in two states via a 16-bit bus.
One 32-kword × 8-bit SRAM (SRAM3) is connected to area 2. This device is accessed via an
8-bit bus, using three-state access with an additional wait state inserted in pin auto-wait mode.
H'000000
EPROM
H'03FFFF
Area 0
16-bit, three-state-access area
Not used
H'1FFFFF
H'200000
SRAM 1, 2
Area 1
16-bit, two-state-access area
H'20FFFF
H'210000
Not used
H'3FFFFF
H'400000
SRAM 3
H'407FFF
Area 2
8-bit, three-state-access area
(one pin auto-wait state)
Not used
H'5FFFFF
On-chip RAM
H'FFFFFF
On-chip registers
Figure 6-17 Memory Map (Example)
130
EPROM
A19 to A 1
A 18 to A 0
I/O 15 to I/O8
H8/3002
I/O 7 to I/O 0
CE
OE
CS 0
CS 1
CS 2
SRAM1 (even addresses)
A15 to A 1
A14 to A 0
I/O 7 to I/O 0
WAIT
CS
RD
OE
WE
HWR
LWR
SRAM2 (odd addresses)
A15 to A 1
A 14 to A 0
A 23 to A 0
I/O 7 to I/O 0
CS
OE
WE
D15 to D 8
SRAM3
D 7 to D 0
A14 to A 0
A 14 to A 0
I/O 7 to I/O 0
CS
OE
WE
Figure 6-18 External-Bus-Released State (Two-State-Access Area, During Read Cycle)
131
6.3.7 Bus Arbiter Operation
The bus controller has a built-in bus arbiter that arbitrates between different bus masters. There
are four bus masters: the CPU, DMA controller (DMAC), refresh controller, and an external bus
master. When a bus master has the bus right it can carry out read, write, or refresh access. Each
bus master uses a bus request signal to request the bus right. At fixed times the bus arbiter
determines priority and uses a bus acknowledge signal to grant the bus to a bus master, which can
then operate using the bus.
The bus arbiter checks whether the bus request signal from a bus master is active or inactive, and
returns an acknowledge signal to the bus master if the bus request signal is active. When two or
more bus masters request the bus, the highest-priority bus master receives an acknowledge signal.
The bus master that receives an acknowledge signal can continue to use the bus until the
acknowledge signal is deactivated.
The bus master priority order is:
(High)
External bus master > refresh controller > DMAC > CPU
(Low)
The bus arbiter samples the bus request signals and determines priority at all times, but it does not
always grant the bus immediately, even when it receives a bus request from a bus master with
higher priority than the current bus master. Each bus master has certain times at which it can
release the bus to a higher-priority bus master.
CPU: The CPU is the lowest-priority bus master. If the DMAC, refresh controller, or an external
bus master requests the bus while the CPU has the bus right, the bus arbiter transfers the bus right
to the bus master that requested it. The bus right is transferred at the following times:
•
The bus right is transferred at the boundary of a bus cycle. If word data is accessed by two
consecutive byte accesses, however, the bus right is not transferred between the two byte
accesses.
•
If another bus master requests the bus while the CPU is performing internal operations, such
as executing a multiply or divide instruction, the bus right is transferred immediately. The
CPU continues its internal operations.
•
If another bus master requests the bus while the CPU is in sleep mode, the bus right is
transferred immediately.
132
DMAC: When the DMAC receives an activation request, it requests the bus right from the bus
arbiter. If the DMAC is bus master and the refresh controller or an external bus master requests
the bus, the bus arbiter transfers the bus right from the DMAC to the bus master that requested the
bus. The bus right is transferred at the following times.
The bus right is transferred when the DMAC finishes transferring 1 byte or 1 word. A DMAC
transfer cycle consists of a read cycle and a write cycle. The bus right is not transferred between
the read cycle and the write cycle.
There is a priority order among the DMAC channels. For details see section 8.4.9, MultipleChannel Operation.
Refresh Controller: When a refresh cycle is requested, the refresh controller requests the bus
right from the bus arbiter. When the refresh cycle is completed, the refresh controller releases the
bus. For details see section 7, Refresh Controller.
External Bus Master: When the BRLE bit is set to 1 in BRCR, the bus can be released to an
external bus master. The external bus master has highest priority, and requests the bus right from
the bus arbiter by driving the BREQ signal low. Once the external bus master gets the bus, it keeps
the bus right until the BREQ signal goes high. While the bus is released to an external bus master,
the H8/3002 holds the address bus and data bus control signals (AS, RD, HWR, and LWR) in the
high-impedance state, and holds the BACK pin in the low output state.
The bus arbiter samples the BREQ pin at the rise of the system clock (ø). If BREQ is low, the bus
is released to the external bus master at the appropriate opportunity. The BREQ signal should be
held low until the BACK signal goes low.
When the BREQ pin is high in two consecutive samples, the BACK signal is driven high to end
the bus-release cycle.
133
Figure 6-19 shows the timing when the bus right is requested by an external bus master during a
read cycle in a two-state-access area. There is a minimum interval of two states from when the
BREQ signal goes low until the bus is released.
CPU cycles
T1
External bus released
CPU cycles
T2
ø
High-impedance
Address
bus
Address
High-impedance
Data bus
(D15 to D0 )
AS , RD
High-impedance
High
High-impedance
HWR , LWR
BREQ
BACK
Minimum 2 cycles
1
1
2
3
4, 5
6
2
3
4
5
6
Low BREQ signal is sampled at rise of T1 state.
BACK signal goes low at end of CPU read cycle, releasing bus right to external bus master.
BREQ pin continues to be sampled while bus is released to external bus master.
High BREQ signal is sampled twice consecutively.
BREQ signal goes high, ending bus-release cycle.
Figure 6-19 Interconnections with Memory (Example)
134
6.4 Usage Notes
6.4.1 Connection to Dynamic RAM and Pseudo-Static RAM
A different bus control signal timing applies when dynamic RAM or pseudo-static RAM is
connected to area 3. For details see section 7, Refresh Controller.
6.4.2 Register Write Timing
ABWCR, ASTCR, and WCER Write Timing: Data written to ABWCR, ASTCR, or WCER
takes effect starting from the next bus cycle. Figure 6-20 shows the timing when an instruction
fetched from area 0 changes area 0 from three-state access to two-state access.
T1
T2
T3
T1
T2
T3
T1
T2
ø
Address
bus
ASTCR address
3-state access to area 0
2-state access
to area 0
Figure 6-20 ASTCR Write Timing
135
DDR Write Timing: Data written to a data direction register (DDR) to change a CSn pin from
CSn output to generic input, or vice versa, takes effect starting from the T3 state of the DDR write
cycle. Figure 6-21 shows the timing when the CS1 pin is changed from generic input to CS1
output.
T1
T2
T3
ø
Address
bus
CS1
P8DDR address
High impedance
Figure 6-21 DDR Write Timing
BRCR Write Timing: Data written to switch between A23, A22, or A21 output and generic input
or output takes effect starting from the T3 state of the BRCR write cycle. Figure 6-22 shows the
timing when a pin is changed from generic input to A23, A22, or A21 output.
T1
T2
ø
Address
bus
BRCR address
A 21 to A 23
High impedance
Figure 6-22 BRCR Write Timing
136
T3
6.4.3 BREQ Input Timing
After driving the BREQ pin low, hold it low until BACK goes low. If BREQ returns to the high
level before BACK goes low, the bus arbiter may operate incorrectly.
To terminate the external-bus-released state, hold the BREQ signal high for at least three states.
If BREQ is high for too short an interval, the bus arbiter may operate incorrectly.
•
If contention occurs between a transition to software standby mode and a bus request from an
external bus master, the bus may be released for one state just before the transition to
software standby mode (see figure 6-23). When using software standby mode, clear the
BRLE bit to 0 in BRCR before executing the SLEEP instruction.
Bus-released state
Software standby mode
ø
BREQ
BACK
Address
bus
strobe
Figure 6-23 Contention between Bus-Released State and Software Standby Mode
137
138
Section 7 Refresh Controller
7.1 Overview
The H8/3002 has an on-chip refresh controller that enables direct connection of 16-bit-wide
DRAM or pseudo-static RAM (PSRAM).
DRAM or pseudo-static RAM can be directly connected to area 3 of the external address space.
A maximum 128 kbytes can be connected in modes 1 and 2 (1-Mbyte modes). A maximum
2 Mbytes can be connected in modes 3 and 4 (16-Mbyte modes).
Systems that do not need to refresh DRAM or pseudo-static RAM can use the refresh controller as
an 8-bit interval timer.
7.1.1 Features
The refresh controller can be used for one of three functions: DRAM refresh control, pseudo-static
RAM refresh control, or interval timing. Features of the refresh controller are listed below.
Features as a DRAM Refresh Controller
•
Enables direct connection of 16-bit-wide DRAM
•
Selection of 2CAS or 2WE mode
•
Selection of 8-bit or 9-bit column address multiplexing for DRAM address input
Examples:
— 1-Mbit DRAM: 8-bit row address × 8-bit column address
— 4-Mbit DRAM: 9-bit row address × 9-bit column address
— 4-Mbit DRAM: 10-bit row address × 8-bit column address
•
CAS-before-RAS refresh control
•
Software-selectable refresh interval
•
Software-selectable self-refresh mode
•
Wait states can be inserted
Features as a Pseudo-Static RAM Refresh Controller
•
RFSH signal output for refresh control
•
Software-selectable refresh interval
•
Software-selectable self-refresh mode
•
Wait states can be inserted
139
Features as an Interval Timer
•
Refresh timer counter (RTCNT) can be used as an 8-bit up-counter
•
Selection of seven counter clock sources: ø/2, ø/8, ø/32, ø/128, ø/512, ø/2048, ø/4096
•
Interrupts can be generated by compare match between RTCNT and the refresh time constant
register (RTCOR)
7.1.2 Block Diagram
Figure 7-1 shows a block diagram of the refresh controller.
ø/2, ø/8, ø/32,
ø/128, ø/512,
ø/2048, ø/4096
Refresh signal
Clock selector
Control logic
CMI interrupt
Module data bus
Legend
RTCNT:
RTCOR:
RTMCSR:
RFSHCR:
Refresh timer counter
Refresh time constant register
Refresh timer control/status register
Refresh control register
Figure 7-1 Block Diagram of Refresh Controller
140
Internal data bus
Bus interface
RFSHCR
RTMCSR
RTCOR
RTCNT
Comparator
7.1.3 Input/Output Pins
Table 7-1 summarizes the refresh controller’s input/output pins.
Table 7-1 Refresh Controller Pins
Signal
Pin
Name
Abbr.
I/O
Function
RFSH
Refresh
RFSH
Output
Goes low during refresh cycles; used
to refresh DRAM and PSRAM
HWR
Upper write/upper column
address strobe
UW/UCAS
Output
Connects to the UW pin of 2WE
DRAM or UCAS pin of 2CAS DRAM
LWR
Lower write/lower column
address strobe
LW/LCAS
Output
Connects to the LW pin of 2WE DRAM
or LCAS pin of 2CAS DRAM
RD
Column address strobe/
write enable
CAS/WE
Output
Connects to the CAS pin of 2WE
DRAM or WE pin of 2CAS DRAM
CS3
Row address strobe
RAS
Output
Connects to the RAS pin of DRAM
7.1.4 Register Configuration
Table 7-2 summarizes the refresh controller’s registers.
Table 7-2 Refresh Controller Registers
Address*
Name
Abbreviation
R/W
Initial Value
H'FFAC
Refresh control register
RFSHCR
R/W
H'02
H'FFAD
Refresh timer control/status register
RTMCSR
R/W
H'07
H'FFAE
Refresh timer counter
RTCNT
R/W
H'00
H'FFAF
Refresh time constant register
RTCOR
R/W
H'FF
Note: * Lower 16 bits of the address.
141
7.2 Register Descriptions
7.2.1 Refresh Control Register (RFSHCR)
RFSHCR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that selects the operating mode of the refresh
controller.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
SRFMD PSRAME DRAME CAS/WE M9/M8
2
1
0
RFSHE
—
RCYCE
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
—
R/W
Refresh cycle
enable
Enables or
disables
insertion of
refresh cycles
Reserved bit
Refresh pin enable
Enables refresh signal output
from the refresh pin
Address multiplex mode select
Selects the number of column address bits
Strobe mode select
Selects 2CAS or 2WE strobing of DRAM
PSRAM enable and DRAM enable
These bits enable or disable connection of pseudo-static RAM and DRAM
Self-refresh mode
Selects self-refresh mode
RFSHCR is initialized to H'02 by a reset and in hardware standby mode.
142
Bit 7—Self-Refresh Mode (SRFMD): Specifies DRAM or pseudo-static RAM self-refresh
during software standby mode. When PSRAME = 1 and DRAME = 0, after the SRFMD bit is set
to 1, pseudo-static RAM can be self-refreshed when the H8/3002 enters software standby mode.
When PSRAME = 0 and DRAME = 1, after the SRFMD bit is set to 1, DRAM can be selfrefreshed when the H8/3002 enters software standby mode. In either case, the normal access state
resumes on exit from software standby mode.
Bit 7
SRFMD Description
0
DRAM or PSRAM self-refresh is disabled in software standby mode
1
DRAM or PSRAM self-refresh is enabled in software standby mode
(Initial value)
Bit 6—PSRAM Enable (PSRAME) and Bit 5—DRAM Enable (DRAME): These bits enable
or disable connection of pseudo-static RAM and DRAM to area 3 of the external address space.
When DRAM or pseudo-static RAM is connected, the bus cycle and refresh cycle of area 3
consist of three states, regardless of the setting in the access state control register (ASTCR). If
AST3 = 0 in ASTCR, wait states cannot be inserted.
When the PSRAME or DRAME bit is set to 1, bits 0, 2, 3, and 4 in RFSHCR and registers
RTMCSR, RTCNT, and RTCOR are write-disabled, except that the CMF flag in RTMCSR can be
cleared by writing 0.
Bit 6
PSRAME
Bit 5
DRAME
Description
0
0
Can be used as an interval timer
(DRAM and PSRAM cannot be directly connected)
1
1
DRAM can be directly connected
0
PSRAM can be directly connected
1
Illegal setting
143
(Initial value)
Bit 4—Strobe Mode Select (CAS/WE): Selects 2CAS or 2WE mode. The setting of this bit is
valid when PSRAME = 0 and DRAME = 1. This bit is write-disabled when the PSRAME or
DRAME bit is set to 1.
Bit 4
CAS/WE
Description
0
2WE mode
1
2CAS mode
(Initial value)
Bit 3—Address Multiplex Mode Select (M9/M8): Selects 8-bit or 9-bit column addressing.
The setting of this bit is valid when PSRAME = 0 and DRAME = 1. This bit is write-disabled
when the PSRAME or DRAME bit is set to 1.
Bit 3
M9/M8
Description
0
8-bit column address mode
1
9-bit column address mode
(Initial value)
Bit 2—Refresh Pin Enable (RFSHE): Enables or disables refresh signal output from the
RFSH pin. This bit is write-disabled when the PSRAME or DRAME bit is set to 1.
Bit 2
RFSHE
Description
0
Refresh signal output at the RFSH pin is disabled
(the RFSH pin can be used as a generic input/output port)
1
Refresh signal output at the RFSH pin is enabled
(Initial value)
Bit 1—Reserved: This bit cannot be modified and is always read as 1.
Bit 0—Refresh Cycle Enable (RCYCE): Enables or disables insertion of refresh cycles.
The setting of this bit is valid when PSRAME = 1 or DRAME = 1.This bit cannot be written to
when the PSRAME bit or DRAME bit is set to 1. When PSRAME = 0 and DRAME = 0, refresh
cycles are not inserted regardless of the setting of this bit.
Bit 0
RCYCE Description
0
Refresh cycles are disabled
(Initial value)
1
Refresh cycles are enabled for area 3
144
7.2.2 Refresh Timer Control/Status Register (RTMCSR)
RTMCSR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that selects the clock source for RTCNT. It also
enables or disables interrupt requests when the refresh controller is used as an interval timer.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
CMF
CMIE
CKS2
CKS1
CKS0
—
—
—
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
Read/Write
R/(W)*
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
—
—
—
Clock select 2 to 0
These bits select an
internal clock source
for input to RTCNT
Reserved bits
Compare match interrupt enable
Enables or disables the CMI interrupt requested by CMF
Compare match flag
Status flag indicating that RTCNT has matched RTCOR
Note: * Only 0 can be written, to clear the flag.
Bits 7 and 6 are initialized by a reset and in standby mode. Bits 5 to 3 are initialized by a reset and
in hardware standby mode, but retain their previous values on transition to software standby
mode.
Bit 7—Compare Match Flag (CMF): This status flag indicates that the RTCNT and RTCOR
values have matched.
Bit 7
CMF
Description
0
[Clearing condition]
Cleared by reading CMF when CMF = 1, then writing 0 in CMF
1
[Setting condition]
When RTCNT = RTCOR
145
Bit 6—Compare Match Interrupt Enable (CMIE): Enables or disables the CMI interrupt
requested when the CMF flag is set to 1 in RTMCSR. The CMIE bit is always cleared to 0 when
PSRAME = 1 or DRAME = 1.
Bit 6
CMIE
Description
0
The CMI interrupt requested by CMF is disabled
1
The CMI interrupt requested by CMF is enabled
(Initial value)
Bits 5 to 3—Clock Select 2 to 0 (CKS2 to CKS0): These bits select an internal clock source for
input to RTCNT. When used for refresh control, the refresh controller outputs a refresh request at
periodic intervals determined by compare match between RTCNT and RTCOR. When used as an
interval timer, the refresh controller generates CMI interrupts at periodic intervals determined by
compare match. These bits are write-disabled when the PSRAME bit or DRAME bit is set to 1.
Bit 5
CKS2
Bit 4
CKS1
Bit 3
CKS0
Description
0
0
0
Clock input is disabled
1
ø/2 clock source
0
ø/8 clock source
1
ø/32 clock source
0
ø/128 clock source
1
ø/512 clock source
0
ø/2048 clock source
1
ø/4096 clock source
1
1
0
1
Bits 2 to 0—Reserved: These bits cannot be modified and are always read as 1.
146
(Initial value)
7.2.3 Refresh Timer Counter (RTCNT)
RTCNT is an 8-bit readable/writable up-counter.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
RTCNT is an up-counter that is incremented by an internal clock selected by bits CKS2 to CKS0
in RTMCSR. When RTCNT matches RTCOR (compare match), the CMF flag is set to 1 and
RTCNT is cleared to H'00.
RTCNT is write-disabled when the PSRAME bit or DRAME bit is set to 1. RTCNT is initialized
to H'00 by a reset and in standby mode.
7.2.4 Refresh Time Constant Register (RTCOR)
RTCOR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that determines the interval at which RTCNT is
cleared.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
RTCOR and RTCNT are constantly compared. When their values match, the CMF flag is set to 1
in RTMCSR, and RTCNT is simultaneously cleared to H'00.
RTCOR is write-disabled when the PSRAME bit or DRAME bit is set to 1. RTCOR is initialized
to H'FF by a reset and in hardware standby mode. In software standby mode it retains its previous
value.
147
7.3 Operation
7.3.1 Area Division
One of three functions can be selected for the H8/3002 refresh controller: interfacing to
DRAM connected to area 3, interfacing to pseudo-static RAM connected to area 3, or interval
timing. Table 7-3 summarizes the register settings when these three functions are used.
Table 7-3 Refresh Controller Settings
Usage
Register Settings
DRAM Interface
RFSHCR
SRFMD
Selects self-refresh mode
Cleared to 0
PSRAME
Cleared to 0
Set to 1
Cleared to 0
DRAME
Set to 1
Cleared to 0
Cleared to 0
CAS/WE
Selects 2CAS or
2WE mode
—
—
M9/M8
Selects column
addressing mode
—
—
RFSHE
Selects RFSH signal output
Cleared to 0
RCYCE
Selects insertion of refresh cycles
—
Refresh interval setting
Interrupt interval setting
RTCOR
RTMCSR
PSRAM Interface
Interval Timer
CKS2 to CKS0
CMF
Set to 1 when RTCNT = RTCOR
CMIE
Cleared to 0
Enables or disables
interrupt requests
P8DDR
P81DDR
Set to 1 (CS3 output)
Set to 0 or 1
ABWCR
ABW3
Cleared to 0
—
—
DRAM Interface: To set up area 3 for connection to 16-bit-wide DRAM, initialize RTCOR,
RTMCSR, and RFSHCR in that order, clearing bit PSRAME to 0 and setting bit DRAME to 1.
Set bit P81DDR to 1 in the port 8 data direction register (P8DDR) to enable CS3 output. In
ABWCR, make area 3 a 16-bit-access area.
Pseudo-Static RAM Interface: To set up area 3 for connection to pseudo-static RAM, initialize
RTCOR, RTMCSR, and RFSHCR in that order, setting bit PSRAME to 1 and clearing bit
DRAME to 0. Set bit P81DDR to 1 in P8DDR to enable CS3 output.
148
Interval Timer: When PSRAME = 0 and DRAME = 0, the refresh controller operates as an
interval timer. After setting RTCOR, select an input clock in RTMCSR and set the CMIE bit to 1.
CMI interrupts will be requested at compare match intervals determined by RTCOR and bits
CKS2 to CKS0 in RTMCSR.
When setting RTCOR, RTMCSR, and RFSHCR, make sure that PSRAME = 0 and DRAME = 0.
Writing is disabled when either of these bits is set to 1.
7.3.2 DRAM Refresh Control
Refresh Request Interval and Refresh Cycle Execution: The refresh request interval is
determined by the settings of RTCOR and bits CKS2 to CKS0 in RTMCSR. Figure 7-2 illustrates
the refresh request interval.
RTCOR
RTCNT
H'00
Refresh request
Figure 7-2 Refresh Request Interval (RCYCE = 1)
Refresh requests are generated at regular intervals as shown in figure 7-2, but the refresh cycle is
not actually executed until the refresh controller gets the bus right.
Table 7-4 summarizes the relationship among area 3 settings, DRAM read/write cycles, and
refresh cycles.
149
Table 7-4 Area 3 Settings, DRAM Access Cycles, and Refresh Cycles
Area 3 Settings
Read/Write Cycle by CPU or DMAC
Refresh Cycle
2-state-access area
(AST3 = 0)
• 3 states
• Wait states cannot be inserted
• 3 states
• Wait states cannot be inserted
3-state-access area
(AST3 = 1)
• 3 states
• Wait states can be inserted
• 3 states
• Wait states can be inserted
To insert refresh cycles, set the RCYCE bit to 1 in RFSHCR. Figure 7-3 shows the state
transitions for execution of refresh cycles.
When the first refresh request occurs after exit from the reset state or standby mode, the refresh
controller does not execute a refresh cycle, but goes into the refresh request pending state. Note
this point when using a DRAM that requires a refresh cycle for initialization.
When a refresh request occurs in the refresh request pending state, the refresh controller acquires
the bus right, then executes a refresh cycle. If another refresh request occurs during execution of
the refresh cycle, it is ignored.
Exit from reset or standby mode
Refresh request
Refresh request pending state
End of refresh
cycle*
Refresh request
Refresh
request*
Requesting bus right
Bus granted
Refresh
request*
Executing refresh cycle
Note: * A refresh request is ignored if it occurs while the refresh controller is requesting the
bus right or executing a refresh cycle.
Figure 7-3 State Transitions for Refresh Cycle Execution
150
Address Multiplexing: Address multiplexing depends on the setting of the M9/M8 bit in
RFSHCR, as described in table 7-5. Figure 7-4 shows the address output timing. Address output is
multiplexed only in area 3.
Table 7-5 Address Multiplexing
Address Pins
A23 to A10 A9
A8
A7
A6
A5
A4
A3
A2
A1
A0
Address signals during row
address output
A23 to A10
A9
A8
A7
A6
A5
A4
A3
A2
A1
A0
Address signals during M9/M8 = 0 A23 to A10
column address output
M9/M8 = 1 A23 to A10
A9
A9
A16 A15 A14 A13 A12 A11 A10 A0
A18 A17 A16 A15 A14 A13 A12 A11 A10 A0
T1
T2
T3
ø
A 23 to A 9, A 0
A 23 to A 9 , A 0
Address
bus
A 8 to A 1
A 8 to A1
A 16 to A 9
Row address
Column address
a. M9/ M8 = 0
T1
T2
T3
ø
A 23 to A10 , A 0
A 23 to A10 , A 0
Address
bus
A 9 to A 1
A 9 to A1
A 18 to A 10
Row address
Column address
b. M9/ M8 = 1
Figure 7-4 Multiplexed Address Output (Example without Wait States)
151
2CAS and 2WE Modes: The CAS/WE bit in RFSHCR can select two control modes for 16-bitwide DRAM: one using UCAS and LCAS; the other using UW and LW. These DRAM pins
correspond to H8/3002 pins as shown in table 7-6.
Table 7-6 DRAM Pins and H8/3002 Pins
DRAM Pin
H8/3002 Pin
CAS/WE = 0 (2WE mode)
CAS/WE = 1 (2CAS mode)
HWR
UW
UCAS
LWR
LW
LCAS
RD
CAS
WE
CS3
RAS
RAS
Figure 7-5 (1) shows the interface timing for 2WE DRAM. Figure 7-5 (2) shows the interface
timing for 2CAS DRAM.
Read cycle
Write cycle*
Refresh cycle
ø
Address
bus
Row
Column
Row
Column
CS 3
(RAS )
RD
(CAS )
HWR
(UW )
LWR
(LW )
RFSH
AS
Note: * 16-bit access
152
Area 3 top address
Read cycle
Write cycle*
Refresh cycle
ø
Address
bus
Row
Column
Row
Column
Area 3 top address
CS3
(RAS )
HWR
(UCAS )
LWR
(LCAS )
RD
(WE )
RFSH
AS
Note: * 16-bit access
Figure 7-5 DRAM Control Signal Output Timing (1) (2WE Mode)
Figure 7-5 DRAM Control Signal Output Timing (2) (2CAS Mode)
Refresh Cycle Priority Order: When there are simultaneous bus requests, the priority order is:
(High)
External bus master > refresh controller > DMA controller > CPU
(Low)
For details see section 6.3.7, Bus Arbiter Operation.
Wait State Insertion: When bit AST3 is set to 1 in ASTCR, bus controller settings can cause
wait states to be inserted into bus cycles and refresh cycles. For details see section 6.3.5, Wait
Modes.
153
Self-Refresh Mode: Some DRAM devices have a self-refresh function. After the SRFMD bit is
set to 1 in RFSHCR, when a transition to software standby mode occurs, the CAS and RAS
outputs go low in that order so that the DRAM self-refresh function can be used. On exit from
software standby mode, the CAS and RAS outputs both go high.
Table 7-7 shows the pin states in software standby mode. Figure 7-6 shows the signal output
timing.
Table 7-7 Pin States in Software Standby Mode (1) (PSRAME = 0, DRAME = 1)
Software Standby Mode
SRFMD = 0
SRFMD = 1 (self-refresh mode)
Signal
CAS/WE = 0
CAS/WE = 1
CAS/WE = 0
CAS/WE = 1
HWR
High-impedance
High-impedance
High
Low
LWR
High-impedance
High-impedance
High
Low
RD
High-impedance
High-impedance
Low
High
CS3
High
High
Low
Low
RFSH
High
High
Low
Low
154
Software
standby mode
Oscillator
settling time
ø
High-impedance
Address
bus
CS 3 (RAS)
RD (CAS)
HWR (UW)
High
LWR (LW)
High
RFSH
a. 2 WE mode (SRFMD = 1)
Software
standby mode
Oscillator
settling time
ø
Address
bus
High-impedance
CS 3 (RAS)
HWR (UCAS)
LWR (LCAS)
RD (WE)
RFSH
b. 2 CAS mode (SRFMD = 1)
Figure 7-6 Signal Output Timing in Self-Refresh Mode (PSRAME = 0, DRAME = 1)
155
Operation in Power-Down State: The refresh controller operates in sleep mode. It does not
operate in hardware standby mode. In software standby mode RTCNT is initialized, but RFSHCR,
RTMCSR bits 5 to 3, and RTCOR retain their settings prior to the transition to software standby
mode.
Example 1: Connection to 2WE 1-Mbit DRAM (1-Mbyte Mode): Figure 7-7 shows typical
interconnections to a 2WE 1-Mbit DRAM, and the corresponding address map. Figure 7-8 shows
a setup procedure to be followed by a program for this example. After power-up the DRAM must
be refreshed to initialize its internal state. Initialization takes a certain length of time, which can be
measured by using an interrupt from another timer module, or by counting the number of times
RTMCSR bit 7 (CMF) is set. Note that no refresh cycle is executed for the first refresh request
after exit from the reset state or standby mode (the first time the CMF flag is set; see figure 7-3).
When using this example, check the DRAM device characteristics carefully and use a procedure
that fits them.
2 WE 1-Mbit DRAM with
× 16-bit organization
H8/3002
A8
A7
A6
A5
A4
A3
A2
A1
A7
A6
A5
A4
A3
A2
A1
A0
CS 3
RD
HWR
LWR
RAS
CAS
UW
LW
OE
D15 to D 0
I/O 15 to I/O 0
a. Interconnections (example)
H'60000
DRAM area
Area 3 (1-Mbyte mode)
H'7FFFF
b. Address map
156
Set area 3 for 16-bit access
Set P81 DDR to 1 for CS3 output
Set RTCOR
Set bits CKS2 to CKS0 in RTMCSR
Write H'23 in RFSHCR
Wait for DRAM to be initialized
DRAM can be accessed
Figure 7-7 Interconnections and Address Map for 2WE 1-Mbit DRAM (Example)
Figure 7-8 Setup Procedure for 2WE 1-Mbit DRAM (1-Mbyte Mode)
157
Example 2: Connection to 2WE 4-Mbit DRAM (16-Mbyte Mode): Figure 7-9 shows typical
interconnections to a single 2WE 4-Mbit DRAM, and the corresponding address map. Figure 7-10
shows a setup procedure to be followed by a program for this example.
The DRAM in this example has 10-bit row addresses and 8-bit column addresses. Its address area
is H'600000 to H'67FFFF.
2 WE 4-Mbit DRAM with 10-bit
row address, 8-bit column address,
and × 16-bit organization
H8/3002
A18
A17
A9
A8
A8
A7
A6
A5
A4
A3
A2
A1
A7
A6
A5
A4
A3
A2
A1
A0
CS 3
RD
HWR
LWR
RAS
CAS
UW
LW
OE
D15 to D 0
I/O 15 to I/O 0
a. Interconnections (example)
H'600000
DRAM area
H'67FFFF
H'680000
Area 3 (16-Mbyte mode)
Not used
H'7FFFFF
b. Address map
Figure 7-9 Interconnections and Address Map for 2WE 4-Mbit DRAM (Example)
158
Set area 3 for 16-bit access
Set P81 DDR to 1 for CS3 output
Set RTCOR
Set bits CKS2 to CKS0 in RTMCSR
Write H'23 in RFSHCR
Wait for DRAM to be initialized
DRAM can be accessed
Figure 7-10 Setup Procedure for 2WE 4-Mbit DRAM with 10-Bit Row Address and
8-Bit Column Address (16-Mbyte Mode)
159
Example 3: Connection to 2CAS 4-Mbit DRAM (16-Mbyte Mode): Figure 7-11 shows typical
interconnections to a single 2CAS 4-Mbit DRAM, and the corresponding address map.
Figure 7-12 shows a setup procedure to be followed by a program for this example.
The DRAM in this example has 9-bit row addresses and 9-bit column addresses. Its address area
is H'600000 to H'67FFFF.
2 CAS 4-Mbit DRAM with 9-bit
row address, 9-bit column address,
and × 16-bit organization
A9
A8
A7
A6
A5
A4
A3
A2
A1
H8/3002
A8
A7
A6
A5
A4
A3
A2
A1
A0
CS 3
HWR
LWR
RD
RAS
UCAS
LCAS
WE
OE
D15 to D 0
I/O 15 to I/O 0
a. Interconnections (example)
H'600000
DRAM area
H'67FFFF
H'680000
Area 3 (16-Mbyte mode)
Not used
H'7FFFFF
b. Address map
Figure 7-11 Interconnections and Address Map for 2CAS 4-Mbit DRAM (Example)
160
Set area 3 for 16-bit access
Set P81 DDR to 1 for CS3 output
Set RTCOR
Set bits CKS2 to CKS0 in RTMCSR
Write H'3B in RFSHCR
Wait for DRAM to be initialized
DRAM can be accessed
Figure 7-12 Setup Procedure for 2CAS 4-Mbit DRAM with 9-Bit Row Address and
9-Bit Column Address (16-Mbyte Mode)
161
Example 4: Connection to Two 4-Mbit DRAM Chips (16-Mbyte Mode): Figure 7-13 shows
an example of interconnections to two 2CAS 4-Mbit DRAM chips, and the corresponding address
map. Up to four DRAM chips can be connected to area 3 by decoding upper address bits A19
and A20.
Figure 7-14 shows a setup procedure to be followed by a program for this example. The DRAM
in this example has 9-bit row addresses and 9-bit column addresses. Both chips must be refreshed
simultaneously, so the RFSH pin must be used.
2 CAS 4-Mbit DRAM with 9-bit
row address, 9-bit column
address, and × 16-bit organization
A 8 to A 0
H8/3002
RAS
A19
A 9 to A 1
UCAS
No. 1
LCAS
WE
OE
I/O15 to I/O 0
A 8 to A 0
CS 3
RAS
HWR
UCAS
LWR
RD
LCAS
WE
RFSH
No. 2
OE
D15 to D 0
I/O15 to I/O 0
a. Interconnections (example)
H'600000
H'67FFFF
H'680000
H'6FFFFF
H'700000
No. 1
DRAM area
No. 2
DRAM area
Area 3 (16-Mbyte mode)
Not used
H'7FFFFF
b. Address map
Figure 7-13 Interconnections and Address Map for Multiple 2CAS 4-Mbit DRAM Chips
(Example)
162
Set area 3 for 16-bit access
Set P81 DDR to 1 for CS 3 output
Set RTCOR
Set bits CKS2 to CKS0 in RTMCSR
Write H'3F in RFSHCR
Wait for DRAM to be initialized
DRAM can be accessed
Figure 7-14 Setup Procedure for Multiple 2CAS 4-Mbit DRAM Chips with 9-Bit
Row Address and 9-Bit Column Address (16-Mbyte Mode)
163
7.3.3 Pseudo-Static RAM Refresh Control
Refresh Request Interval and Refresh Cycle Execution: The refresh request interval is
determined as in a DRAM interface, by the settings of RTCOR and bits CKS2 to CKS0 in
RTMCSR. The numbers of states required for pseudo-static RAM read/write cycles and refresh
cycles are the same as for DRAM (see table 7-4). The state transitions are as shown in figure 7-3.
Pseudo-Static RAM Control Signals: Figure 7-15 shows the control signals for pseudo-static
RAM read, write, and refresh cycles.
Read cycle
Write cycle *
Refresh cycle
ø
Address
bus
Area 3 top address
CS 3
RD
HWR
LWR
RFSH
AS
Note: * 16-bit access
Figure 7-15 Pseudo-Static RAM Control Signal Output Timing
164
Refresh Cycle Priority Order: When there are simultaneous bus requests, the priority order is:
(High)
External bus master > refresh controller > DMA controller > CPU
(Low)
For details see section 6.3.7, Bus Arbiter Operation.
Wait State Insertion: When bit AST3 is set to 1 in ASTCR, the wait state controller (WSC) can
insert wait states into bus cycles and refresh cycles. For details see section 6.3.5, Wait Modes.
Self-Refresh Mode: Some pseudo-static RAM devices have a self-refresh function. After the
SRFMD bit is set to 1 in RFSHCR, when a transition to software standby mode occurs, the
H8/3002’s CS3 output goes high and its RFSH output goes low so that the pseudo-static RAM
self-refresh function can be used. On exit from software standby mode, the RFSH output goes
high.
Table 7-8 shows the pin states in software standby mode. Figure 7-16 shows the signal output
timing.
Table 7-8 Pin States in Software Standby Mode (2) (PSRAME = 1, DRAME = 0)
Software Standby Mode
Signal
SRFMD = 0
SRFMD = 1 (self-refresh mode)
CS3
High
High
RD
High-impedance
High-impedance
HWR
High-impedance
High-impedance
LWR
High-impedance
High-impedance
RFSH
High
Low
165
Software standby mode
Oscillator
settling time
ø
High-impedance
Address
bus
CS 3
RD
HWR
LWR
High
High-impedance
High-impedance
High-impedance
RFSH
Figure 7-16 Signal Output Timing in Self-Refresh Mode (PSRAME = 1, DRAME = 0)
Operation in Power-Down State: The refresh controller operates in sleep mode. It does not
operate in hardware standby mode. In software standby mode RTCNT is initialized, but RFSHCR,
RTMCSR bits 5 to 3, and RTCOR retain their settings prior to the transition to software standby
mode.
166
Example: Pseudo-static RAM may have separate OE and RFSH pins, or these may be combined
into a single OE/RFSH pin. Figure 7-17 shows an example of a circuit for generating an
OE/RFSH signal. Check the device characteristics carefully, and design a circuit that fits them.
Figure 7-18 shows a setup procedure to be followed by a program.
H8/3002
PSRAM
RD
OE / RFSH
RFSH
Figure 7-17 Interconnection to Pseudo-Static RAM with OE/RFSH Signal (Example)
167
Set P81 DDR to 1 for CS 3 output
Set RTCOR
Set bits CKS2 to CKS0 in RTMCSR
Write H'47 in RFSHCR
Wait for PSRAM to be initialized
PSRAM can be accessed
Figure 7-18 Setup Procedure for Pseudo-Static RAM
168
7.3.4 Interval Timing
To use the refresh controller as an interval timer, clear the PSRAME and DRAME both to 0. After
setting RTCOR, select a clock source with bits CKS2 to CKS0 in RTMCSR, and set the CMIE bit
to 1.
Timing of Setting of Compare Match Flag and Clearing by Compare Match: The CMF flag
in RTCSR is set to 1 by a compare match signal output when the RTCOR and RTCNT values
match. The compare match signal is generated in the last state in which the values match (when
RTCNT is updated from the matching value to a new value). Accordingly, when RTCNT and
RTCOR match, the compare match signal is not generated until the next counter clock pulse.
Figure 7-19 shows the timing.
ø
RTCNT
N
H'00
RTCOR
N
Compare
match signal
CMF flag
Figure 7-19 Timing of Setting of CMF Flag
Operation in Power-Down State: The interval timer function operates in sleep mode. It does not
operate in hardware standby mode. In software standby mode RTCNT and RTMCSR bits 7 and 6
are initialized, but RTMCSR bits 5 to 3 and RTCOR retain their settings prior to the transition to
software standby mode.
169
Contention between RTCNT Write and Counter Clear: If a counter clear signal occurs in the
T3 state of an RTCNT write cycle, clearing of the counter takes priority and the write is not
performed. See figure 7-20.
RTCNT write cycle by CPU
T2
T1
T3
ø
Address bus
RTCNT address
Internal
write signal
Counter
clear signal
RTCNT
N
H'00
Figure 7-20 Contention between RTCNT Write and Clear
170
Contention between RTCNT Write and Increment: If an increment pulse occurs in the T3 state
of an RTCNT write cycle, writing takes priority and RTCNT is not incremented. See figure 7-21.
RTCNT write cycle by CPU
T1
T2
T3
ø
Address bus
RTCNT address
Internal
write signal
RTCNT
input clock
RTCNT
N
M
Counter write data
Figure 7-21 Contention between RTCNT Write and Increment
171
Contention between RTCOR Write and Compare Match: If a compare match occurs in the T3
state of an RTCOR write cycle, writing takes priority and the compare match signal is inhibited.
See figure 7-22.
RTCOR write cycle by CPU
T1
T2
T3
ø
Address bus
RTCOR address
Internal
write signal
RTCNT
N
N+1
RTCOR
N
M
RTCOR write data
Compare
match signal
Inhibited
Figure 7-22 Contention between RTCOR Write and Compare Match
RTCNT Operation at Internal Clock Source Switchover: Switching internal clock sources may
cause RTCNT to increment, depending on the switchover timing. Table 7-9 shows the relation
between the time of the switchover (by writing to bits CKS2 to CKS0) and the operation of
RTCNT.
The RTCNT input clock is generated from the internal clock source by detecting the falling edge
of the internal clock. If a switchover is made from a high clock source to a low clock source, as in
case No. 3 in table 7-9, the switchover will be regarded as a falling edge, an RTCNT clock pulse
will be generated, and RTCNT will be incremented.
172
Table 7-9 Internal Clock Switchover and RTCNT Operation
No.
CKS2 to CKS0
Write Timing
1
Low → low
RTCNT Operation
switchover*1
Old clock
source
New clock
source
RTCNT
clock
RTCNT
N
N+1
CKS bits rewritten
2
Low → high switchover*2
Old clock
source
New clock
source
RTCNT
clock
RTCNT
N
N+1
N+2
CKS bits rewritten
Notes: 1. Including switchovers from a low clock source to the halted state, and from the halted
state to a low clock source.
2. Including switchover from the halted state to a high clock source.
173
Table 7-9 Internal Clock Switchover and RTCNT Operation (cont)
No.
CKS2 to CKS0
Write Timing
3
High → low
RTCNT Operation
switchover*1
Old clock
source
New clock
source
*2
RTCNT
clock
RTCNT
N
N+1
N+2
CKS bits rewritten
4
High → high switchover
Old clock
source
New clock
source
RTCNT
clock
RTCNT
N
N+1
N+2
CKS bits rewritten
Notes: 1. Including switchover from a high clock source to the halted state.
2. The switchover is regarded as a falling edge, causing RTCNT to increment.
174
7.4 Interrupt Source
Compare match interrupts (CMI) can be generated when the refresh controller is used as an
interval timer. Compare match interrupt requests are masked/unmasked with the CMIE bit of
RTMCSR.
7.5 Usage Notes
When using the DRAM or pseudo-static RAM refresh function, note the following points:
•
With the refresh controller, if directly connected DRAM or PSRAM is disconnected*, the
P80/RFSH/IRQ0 pin and the P81/CS3/IRQ1 pin may both become low-level outputs
simultaneously.
Note: * When the DRAM enable bit (DRAME) or PSRAM enable bit (PSRAME) in the refresh
control register (RFSHCR) is cleared to 0 after being set to 1.
Area 3 start address
Address bus
P80/RFSH/IRQ0
P81/CS3/IRQ1
Figure 7-23 Operation when DRAM/PSRAM Connection is Switched
175
•
Refresh cycles are not executed while the bus is released, during software standby mode, and
when a bus cycle is greatly prolonged by insertion of wait states. When these conditions
occur, other means of refreshing are required.
•
If refresh requests occur while the bus is released, the first request is held and one refresh
cycle is executed after the bus-released state ends. Figure 7-24 shows the bus cycles in this
case.
Bus-released state
Refresh cycle
CPU cycle
Refresh cycle
ø
RFSH
Refresh
request
BACK
Figure 7-24 Refresh Cycles when Bus is Released
176
•
If a bus cycle is prolonged by insertion of wait states, the first refresh request is held, as in the
bus-released state.
•
If contention occurs between a transition to software standby mode and a bus request from an
external bus master, the bus may be released for one state just before the transition to
software standby mode (see figure 7-25). When using software standby mode, clear the
BRLE bit to 0 in BRCR before executing the SLEEP instruction.
If similar contention occurs in a transition to self-refresh mode, strobe waveforms may not be
output correctly. This can also be prevented by clearing the BRLE bit to 0 in BRCR.
Bus-released state
Software standby mode
ø
BREQ
BACK
Address
bus
Strobe
Figure 7-25 Contention between Bus-Released State and Software Standby Mode
177
Section 8 DMA Controller
8.1 Overview
The H8/3002 has an on-chip DMA controller (DMAC) that can transfer data on up to four
channels.
8.1.1 Features
DMAC features are listed below.
•
Selection of short address mode or full address mode
Short address mode
— 8-bit source address and 24-bit destination address, or vice versa
— Maximum four channels available
— Selection of I/O mode, idle mode, or repeat mode
Full address mode
— 24-bit source and destination addresses
— Maximum two channels available
— Selection of normal mode or block transfer mode
•
Directly addressable 16-Mbyte address space
•
Selection of byte or word transfer
•
Activation by internal interrupts, external requests, or auto-request (depending on transfer
mode)
—
—
—
—
16-bit integrated timer unit (ITU) compare match/input capture interrupts (four)
Serial communication interface (SCI) transmit-data-empty/receive-data-full interrupts
External requests
Auto-request
179
8.1.2 Block Diagram
Figure 8-1 shows a DMAC block diagram.
Internal address bus
External
requests
Address buffer
IMIA0
IMIA1
IMIA2
IMIA3
TXI0
RXI0
DREQ0
DREQ1
TEND0
TEND1
Arithmetic-logic unit
MAR0A
Channel
0A
Control logic
ETCR0A
Channel
0
MAR0B
Channel
0B
DTCR0A
Interrupt DEND0A
DEND0B
signals
DEND1A
DEND1B
IOAR0B
ETCR0B
MAR1A
DTCR0B
Channel
1A
DTCR1A
DTCR1B
IOAR0A
Channel
1
MAR1B
Channel
1B
Data buffer
Internal data bus
Legend
DTCR: Data transfer control register
MAR: Memory address register
IOAR: I/O address register
ETCR: Execute transfer count register
Figure 8-1 Block Diagram of DMAC
180
IOAR1A
ETCR1A
IOAR1B
ETCR1B
Module data bus
Internal
interrupts
8.1.3 Functional Overview
Table 8-1 gives an overview of the DMAC functions.
Table 8-1 DMAC Functional Overview
Address
Reg. Length
Transfer Mode
Short
I/O mode
address
• Transfers one byte or one word
mode
per request
• Increments or decrements the
memory address by 1 or 2
• Executes 1 to 65,536 transfers
Idle mode
• Transfers one byte or one word
per request
• Holds the memory address fixed
• Executes 1 to 65,536 transfers
Repeat mode
• Transfers one byte or one word
per request
• Increments or decrements the
memory address by 1 or 2
• Executes a specified number (1 to
255) of transfers, then returns to
the initial state and continues
Full
address
mode
Normal mode
• Auto-request
— Retains the transfer request
internally
— Executes a specified number
(1 to 65,536) of transfers
continuously
— Selection of burst mode or
cycle-steal mode
• External request
— Transfers one byte or one word
per request
— Executes 1 to 65,536 transfers
Block transfer
• Transfers one block of a specified
size per request
• Executes 1 to 65,536 transfers
• Allows either the source or
destination to be a fixed block
area
• Block size can be 1 to 255 bytes
or words
181
Activation
DestinaSource tion
• Compare match/input 24
capture A interrupts
from ITU channels
0 to 3
• Transmit-data-empty
interrupt from SCI
channel 0
8
• Receive-data-full
interrupt from SCI
channel 0
24
8
• External request
• Auto-request
• External request
24
24
• Compare match/
input capture A
interrupts from ITU
channels 0 to 3
• External request
24
24
8.1.4 Input/Output Pins
Table 8-2 lists the DMAC pins.
Table 8-2 DMAC Pins
Channel
Name
Abbreviation
Input/
Output
Function
0
DMA request 0
DREQ0
Input
External request for DMAC channel 0
Transfer end 0
TEND0
Output
Transfer end on DMAC channel 0
DMA request 1
DREQ1
Input
External request for DMAC channel 1
Transfer end 1
TEND1
Output
Transfer end on DMAC channel 1
1
Note: External requests cannot be made to channel A in short address mode.
8.1.5 Register Configuration
Table 8-3 lists the DMAC registers.
182
Table 8-3 DMAC Registers
Channel
Address*
Name
Abbreviation
R/W
Initial Value
0
H'FF20
Memory address register 0AR
MAR0AR
R/W
Undetermined
H'FF21
Memory address register 0AE
MAR0AE
R/W
Undetermined
H'FF22
Memory address register 0AH
MAR0AH
R/W
Undetermined
H'FF23
Memory address register 0AL
MAR0AL
R/W
Undetermined
H'FF26
I/O address register 0A
IOAR0A
R/W
Undetermined
H'FF24
Execute transfer count register 0AH
ETCR0AH
R/W
Undetermined
H'FF25
Execute transfer count register 0AL
ETCR0AL
R/W
Undetermined
H'FF27
Data transfer control register 0A
DTCR0A
R/W
H'00
H'FF28
Memory address register 0BR
MAR0BR
R/W
Undetermined
1
H'FF29
Memory address register 0BE
MAR0BE
R/W
Undetermined
H'FF2A
Memory address register 0BH
MAR0BH
R/W
Undetermined
H'FF2B
Memory address register 0BL
MAR0BL
R/W
Undetermined
H'FF2E
I/O address register 0B
IOAR0B
R/W
Undetermined
H'FF2C
Execute transfer count register 0BH
ETCR0BH
R/W
Undetermined
H'FF2D
Execute transfer count register 0BL
ETCR0BL
R/W
Undetermined
H'FF2F
Data transfer control register 0B
DTCR0B
R/W
H'00
H'FF30
Memory address register 1AR
MAR1AR
R/W
Undetermined
H'FF31
Memory address register 1AE
MAR1AE
R/W
Undetermined
H'FF32
Memory address register 1AH
MAR1AH
R/W
Undetermined
H'FF33
Memory address register 1AL
MAR1AL
R/W
Undetermined
H'FF36
I/O address register 1A
IOAR1A
R/W
Undetermined
H'FF34
Execute transfer count register 1AH
ETCR1AH
R/W
Undetermined
H'FF35
Execute transfer count register 1AL
ETCR1AL
R/W
Undetermined
H'FF37
Data transfer control register 1A
DTCR1A
R/W
H'00
H'FF38
Memory address register 1BR
MAR1BR
R/W
Undetermined
H'FF39
Memory address register 1BE
MAR1BE
R/W
Undetermined
H'FF3A
Memory address register 1BH
MAR1BH
R/W
Undetermined
H'FF3B
Memory address register 1BL
MAR1BL
R/W
Undetermined
H'FF3E
I/O address register 1B
IOAR1B
R/W
Undetermined
H'FF3C
Execute transfer count register 1BH
ETCR1BH
R/W
Undetermined
H'FF3D
Execute transfer count register 1BL
ETCR1BL
R/W
Undetermined
H'FF3F
Data transfer control register 1B
DTCR1B
R/W
H'00
Note: * The lower 16 bits of the address are indicated.
183
8.2 Register Descriptions (1) (Short Address Mode)
In short address mode, transfers can be carried out independently on channels A and B. Short
address mode is selected by bits DTS2A and DTS1A in data transfer control register A (DTCRA)
as indicated in table 8-4.
Table 8-4 Selection of Short and Full Address Modes
Channel
Bit 2
DTS2A
Bit 1
DTS1A
Description
0
1
1
DMAC channel 0 operates as one channel in full address mode
1
Other than above
DMAC channels 0A and 0B operate as two independent channels
in short address mode
1
DMAC channel 1 operates as one channel in full address mode
1
Other than above
DMAC channels 1A and 1B operate as two independent channels
in short address mode
184
8.2.1 Memory Address Registers (MAR)
A memory address register (MAR) is a 32-bit readable/writable register that specifies a source or
destination address. The transfer direction is determined automatically from the activation source.
An MAR consists of four 8-bit registers designated MARR, MARE, MARH, and MARL. All bits
of MARR are reserved: they cannot be modified and always read 1.
Bit
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
1
1
1
1
1
1
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Initial value
1
Read/Write
— — — — — — — — R/WR/WR/WR/WR/WR/WR/WR/WR/WR/WR/WR/WR/WR/WR/WR/WR/WR/WR/WR/WR/WR/WR/WR/W
MARR
1
8
Undetermined
MARE
MARH
MARL
Source or destination address
An MAR functions as a source or destination address register depending on how the DMAC is
activated: as a destination address register if activation is by a receive-data-full interrupt from the
serial communication interface (SCI)channel 0, and as a source address register otherwise.
The MAR value is incremented or decremented each time one byte or word is transferred,
automatically updating the source or destination memory address. For details, see section 8.2.4,
Data Transfer Control Registers (DTCR).
The MARs are not initialized by a reset or in standby mode.
185
8.2.2 I/O Address Registers (IOAR)
An I/O address register (IOAR) is an 8-bit readable/writable register that specifies a source or
destination address. The IOAR value is the lower 8 bits of the address. The upper 16 address bits
are all 1 (H'FFFF).
Bit
7
6
5
4
R/W
R/W
R/W
2
1
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
Undetermined
Initial value
Read/Write
3
R/W
R/W
Source or destination address
An IOAR functions as a source or destination address register depending on how the DMAC is
activated: as a source address register if activation is by a receive-data-full interrupt from the SCI
channel 0, and as a destination address register otherwise.
The IOAR value is held fixed. It is not incremented or decremented when a transfer is executed.
The IOARs are not initialized by a reset or in standby mode.
8.2.3 Execute Transfer Count Registers (ETCR)
An execute transfer count register (ETCR) is a 16-bit readable/writable register that specifies the
number of transfers to be executed. These registers function in one way in I/O mode and idle
mode, and another way in repeat mode.
•
I/O mode and idle mode
Bit
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Initial value
Undetermined
Read/Write
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Transfer counter
In I/O mode and idle mode, ETCR functions as a 16-bit counter. The count is decremented by
1 each time one transfer is executed. The transfer ends when the count reaches H'0000.
186
•
Repeat mode
Bit
7
6
5
Initial value
Read/Write
4
3
2
1
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
2
1
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
Undetermined
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
ETCRH
Transfer counter
Bit
7
6
5
Initial value
Read/Write
4
3
Undetermined
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
ETCRL
Initial count
In repeat mode, ETCRH functions as an 8-bit transfer counter and ETCRL holds the initial
transfer count. ETCRH is decremented by 1 each time one transfer is executed. When ETCRH
reaches H'00, the value in ETCRL is reloaded into ETCRH and the same operation is repeated.
The ETCRs are not initialized by a reset or in standby mode.
187
8.2.4 Data Transfer Control Registers (DTCR)
A data transfer control register (DTCR) is an 8-bit readable/writable register that controls the
operation of one DMAC channel.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
DTE
DTSZ
DTID
RPE
DTIE
DTS2
DTS1
DTS0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Data transfer enable
Enables or disables
data transfer
Data transfer select
These bits select the data
transfer activation source
Data transfer size
Selects byte or
word size
Data transfer interrupt enable
Enables or disables the CPU interrupt
at the end of the transfer
Data transfer
increment/decrement
Selects whether to
increment or decrement
the memory address
register
Repeat enable
Selects repeat
mode
The DTCRs are initialized to H'00 by a reset and in standby mode.
Bit 7—Data Transfer Enable (DTE): Enables or disables data transfer on a channel. When the
DTE bit is set to 1, the channel waits for a transfer to be requested, and executes the transfer when
activated as specified by bits DTS2 to DTS0. When DTE is 0, the channel is disabled and does not
accept transfer requests. DTE is set to 1 by reading the register when DTE is 0, then writing 1.
Bit 7
DTE
Description
0
Data transfer is disabled. In I/O mode or idle mode, DTE is cleared to 0
when the specified number of transfers have been completed.
1
Data transfer is enabled
If DTIE is set to 1, a CPU interrupt is requested when DTE is cleared to 0.
188
(Initial value)
Bit 6—Data Transfer Size (DTSZ): Selects the data size of each transfer.
Bit 6
DTSZ
Description
0
Byte-size transfer
1
Word-size transfer
(Initial value)
Bit 5—Data Transfer Increment/Decrement (DTID): Selects whether to increment or
decrement the memory address register (MAR) after a data transfer in I/O mode or repeat mode.
Bit 5
DTID
Description
0
MAR is incremented after each data transfer
(Initial value)
• If DTSZ = 0, MAR is incremented by 1 after each transfer
• If DTSZ = 1, MAR is incremented by 2 after each transfer
1
MAR is decremented after each data transfer
• If DTSZ = 0, MAR is decremented by 1 after each transfer
• If DTSZ = 1, MAR is decremented by 2 after each transfer
MAR is not incremented or decremented in idle mode.
Bit 4—Repeat Enable (RPE): Selects whether to transfer data in I/O mode, idle mode, or repeat
mode.
Bit 4
RPE
Bit 3
DTIE
Description
0
0
I/O mode
(Initial value)
1
1
0
Repeat mode
1
Idle mode
Operations in these modes are described in sections 8.4.2, I/O Mode, 8.4.3, Idle Mode, and 8.4.4,
Repeat Mode.
189
Bit 3—Data Transfer Interrupt Enable (DTIE): Enables or disables the CPU interrupt (DEND)
requested when the DTE bit is cleared to 0.
Bit 3
DTIE
Description
0
The DEND interrupt requested by DTE is disabled
1
The DEND interrupt requested by DTE is enabled
(Initial value)
Bits 2 to 0—Data Transfer Select (DTS2, DTS1, DTS0): These bits select the data transfer
activation source. Some of the selectable sources differ between channels A and B.
Channel A
Bit 2
DTS2A
Bit 1
DTS1A
Bit 0
DTS0A
0
0
0
Compare match/input capture A interrupt from ITU
channel 0
1
Compare match/input capture A interrupt from ITU channel 1
0
Compare match/input capture A interrupt from ITU channel 2
1
Compare match/input capture A interrupt from ITU channel 3
0
Transmit-data-empty interrupt from SCI channel 0
1
Receive-data-full interrupt from SCI channel 0
—*
Transfer in full address mode
1
1
0
1
Description
Note: * See section 8.3.4, Data Transfer Control Register (DTCR).
190
(Initial value)
Channel B
Bit 2
DTS2B
Bit 1
DTS1B
Bit 0
DTS0B
0
0
0
Compare match/input capture A interrupt from ITU
channel 0
1
Compare match/input capture A interrupt from ITU channel 1
0
Compare match/input capture A interrupt from ITU channel 2
1
Compare match/input capture A interrupt from ITU channel 3
0
Transmit-data-empty interrupt from SCI channel 0
1
Receive-data-full interrupt from SCI channel 0
0
Falling edge of DREQ input
1
Low level of DREQ input
1
1
0
1
Description
(Initial value)
The same internal interrupt can be selected as an activation source for two or more channels at
once. In that case the channels are activated in a priority order, highest-priority channel first. For
the priority order, see section 8.4.9, Multiple-Channel Operation.
When a channel is enabled (DTE = 1), its selected DMAC activation source cannot generate a
CPU interrupt.
191
8.3 Register Descriptions (2) (Full Address Mode)
In full address mode the A and B channels operate together. Full address mode is selected as
indicated in table 8-4.
8.3.1 Memory Address Registers (MAR)
A memory address register (MAR) is a 32-bit readable/writable register. MARA functions as the
source address register of the transfer, and MARB as the destination address register.
An MAR consists of four 8-bit registers designated MARR, MARE, MARH, and MARL. All bits
of MARR are reserved: they cannot be modified and always read 1.
Bit
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
Initial value
1
Read/Write
— — — — — — — — R/WR/WR/WR/WR/WR/WR/WR/WR/WR/WR/WR/WR/WR/WR/WR/WR/WR/WR/WR/WR/WR/WR/WR/W
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
MARR
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Undetermined
MARE
MARH
MARL
Source or destination address
The MAR value is incremented or decremented each time one byte or word is transferred,
automatically updating the source or destination memory address. For details, see section 8.3.4,
Data Transfer Control Registers (DTCR).
The MARs are not initialized by a reset or in standby mode.
8.3.2 I/O Address Registers (IOAR)
The I/O address registers (IOARs) are not used in full address mode.
192
8.3.3 Execute Transfer Count Registers (ETCR)
An execute transfer count register (ETCR) is a 16-bit readable/writable register that specifies the
number of transfers to be executed. The functions of these registers differ between normal mode
and block transfer mode.
•
Normal mode
ETCRA
Bit
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Initial value
Undetermined
Read/Write
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Transfer counter
ETCRB: Is not used in normal mode.
In normal mode ETCRA functions as a 16-bit transfer counter. The count is decremented by 1
each time one transfer is executed. The transfer ends when the count reaches H'0000. ETCRB is
not used.
193
•
Block transfer mode
ETCRA
Bit
7
6
5
4
R/W
R/W
R/W
Initial value
Read/Write
3
2
1
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
2
1
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
Undetermined
R/W
R/W
ETCRAH
Block size counter
Bit
7
6
5
4
Initial value
Read/Write
3
Undetermined
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
ETCRAL
Initial block size
ETCRB
Bit
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Initial value
Undetermined
Read/Write
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Block transfer counter
In block transfer mode, ETCRAH functions as an 8-bit block size counter. ETCRAL holds the
initial block size. ETCRAH is decremented by 1 each time one byte or word is transferred. When
the count reaches H'00, ETCRAH is reloaded from ETCRAL. Blocks consisting of an arbitrary
number of bytes or words can be transferred repeatedly by setting the same initial block size value
in ETCRAH and ETCRAL.
In block transfer mode ETCRB functions as a 16-bit block transfer counter. ETCRB is
decremented by 1 each time one block is transferred. The transfer ends when the count reaches
H'0000.
The ETCRs are not initialized by a reset or in standby mode.
194
8.3.4 Data Transfer Control Registers (DTCR)
The data transfer control registers (DTCRs) are 8-bit readable/writable registers that control the
operation of the DMAC channels. A channel operates in full address mode when bits DTS2A and
DTS1A are both set to 1 in DTCRA. DTCRA and DTCRB have different functions in full address
mode.
DTCRA
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
DTE
DTSZ
SAID
SAIDE
DTIE
DTS2A
DTS1A
DTS0A
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Data transfer enable
Enables or disables
data transfer
Data transfer size
Selects byte or
word size
Data transfer
interrupt enable
Enables or disables the
CPU interrupt at the end
of the transfer
Source address
increment/decrement
Source address increment/
decrement enable
These bits select whether
the source address register
(MARA) is incremented,
decremented, or held fixed
during the data transfer
DTCRA is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in standby mode.
195
Data transfer
select 0A
Selects block
transfer mode
Data transfer select
2A and 1A
These bits must both be
set to 1
Bit 7—Data Transfer Enable (DTE): Together with the DTME bit in DTCRB, this bit enables or
disables data transfer on the channel. When the DTME and DTE bits are both set to 1, the channel
is enabled. If auto-request is specified, data transfer begins immediately. Otherwise, the channel
waits for transfers to be requested. When the specified number of transfers have been completed,
the DTE bit is automatically cleared to 0. When DTE is 0, the channel is disabled and does not
accept transfer requests. DTE is set to 1 by reading the register when DTE is 0, then writing 1.
Bit 7
DTE
Description
0
Data transfer is disabled (DTE is cleared to 0 when the specified number
of transfers have been completed)
1
Data transfer is enabled
(Initial value)
If DTIE is set to 1, a CPU interrupt is requested when DTE is cleared to 0.
Bit 6—Data Transfer Size (DTSZ): Selects the data size of each transfer.
Bit 6
DTSZ
Description
0
Byte-size transfer
1
Word-size transfer
(Initial value)
Bit 5—Source Address Increment/Decrement (SAID) and Bit 4—Source Address
Increment/Decrement Enable (SAIDE): These bits select whether the source address register
(MARA) is incremented, decremented, or held fixed during the data transfer.
Bit 5
SAID
Bit 4
SAIDE
Description
0
0
MARA is held fixed
1
MARA is incremented after each data transfer
(Initial value)
• If DTSZ = 0, MARA is incremented by 1 after each transfer
• If DTSZ = 1, MARA is incremented by 2 after each transfer
1
0
MARA is held fixed
1
MARA is decremented after each data transfer
• If DTSZ = 0, MARA is decremented by 1 after each transfer
• If DTSZ = 1, MARA is decremented by 2 after each transfer
196
Bit 3—Data Transfer Interrupt Enable (DTIE): Enables or disables the CPU interrupt (DEND)
requested when the DTE bit is cleared to 0.
Bit 3
DTIE
Description
0
The DEND interrupt requested by DTE is disabled
1
The DEND interrupt requested by DTE is enabled
(Initial value)
Bits 2 and 1—Data Transfer Select 2A and 1A (DTS2A, DTS1A): A channel operates in full
address mode when DTS2A and DTS1A are both set to 1.
Bit 0—Data Transfer Select 0A (DTS0A): Selects normal mode or block transfer mode.
Bit 0
DTS0A
Description
0
Normal mode
1
Block transfer mode
(Initial value)
Operations in these modes are described in sections 8.4.5, Normal Mode, and 8.4.6, Block
Transfer Mode.
197
DTCRB
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
DTME
—
DAID
DAIDE
TMS
DTS2B
DTS1B
DTS0B
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Data transfer master enable
Enables or disables data
transfer, together with
the DTE bit, and is cleared
to 0 by an interrupt
Reserved bit
Transfer mode select
Selects whether the
block area is the source
or destination in block
transfer mode
Destination address
increment/decrement
Destination address
increment/decrement enable
These bits select whether
the destination address
register (MARB) is incremented,
decremented, or held fixed
during the data transfer
Data transfer select
2B to 0B
These bits select the data
transfer activation source
DTCRB is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in standby mode.
Bit 7—Data Transfer Master Enable (DTME): Together with the DTE bit in DTCRA, this bit
enables or disables data transfer. When the DTME and DTE bits are both set to 1, the channel is
enabled. When an NMI interrupt occurs DTME is cleared to 0, suspending the transfer so that the
CPU can use the bus. The suspended transfer resumes when DTME is set to 1 again. For further
information on operation in block transfer mode, see section 8.6.6, NMI Interrupts and Block
Transfer Mode.
DTME is set to 1 by reading the register while DTME = 0, then writing 1.
Bit 7
DTME
Description
0
Data transfer is disabled (DTME is cleared to 0 when an NMI interrupt
occurs)
1
Data transfer is enabled
198
(Initial value)
Bit 6—Reserved: Although reserved, this bit can be written and read.
Bit 5—Destination Address Increment/Decrement (DAID) and Bit 4—Destination Address
Increment/Decrement Enable (DAIDE): These bits select whether the destination address
register (MARB), is incremented, decremented, or held fixed during the data transfer.
Bit 5
DAID
Bit 4
DAIDE
Description
0
0
MARB is held fixed
1
MARB is incremented after each data transfer
(Initial value)
• If DTSZ = 0, MARB is incremented by 1 after each data transfer
• If DTSZ = 1, MARB is incremented by 2 after each data transfer
1
0
MARB is held fixed
1
MARB is decremented after each data transfer
• If DTSZ = 0, MARB is decremented by 1 after each data transfer
• If DTSZ = 1, MARB is decremented by 2 after each data transfer
Bit 3—Transfer Mode Select (TMS): Selects whether the source or destination is the block area
in block transfer mode.
Bit 3
TMS
Description
0
Destination is the block area in block transfer mode
1
Source is the block area in block transfer mode
199
(Initial value)
Bits 2 to 0—Data Transfer Select (DTS2B, DTS1B, DTS0B): These bits select the data transfer
activation source. The selectable activation sources differ between normal mode and block
transfer mode.
Normal mode
Bit 2
DTS2B
Bit 1
DTS1B
Bit 0
DTS0B
Description
0
0
0
Auto-request (burst mode)
1
Cannot be used
0
Auto-request (cycle-steal mode)
1
Cannot be used
0
Cannot be used
1
Cannot be used
0
Falling edge of DREQ
1
Low level input at DREQ
1
1
0
1
(Initial value)
Block transfer mode
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
DTS2B DTS1B DTS0B Description
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
Compare match/input capture A interrupt from ITU channel 0 (Initial value)
1
Compare match/input capture A interrupt from ITU channel 1
0
Compare match/input capture A interrupt from ITU channel 2
1
Compare match/input capture A interrupt from ITU channel 3
0
Cannot be used
1
Cannot be used
0
Falling edge of DREQ
1
Cannot be used
The same internal interrupt can be selected to activate two or more channels. The channels are
activated in a priority order, highest priority first. For the priority order, see section 8.4.9,
Multiple-Channel Operation.
200
8.4 Operation
8.4.1 Overview
Table 8-5 summarizes the DMAC modes.
Table 8-5 DMAC Modes
Transfer Mode
Activation
Notes
Short address
mode
I/O mode
Compare match/input
capture A interrupt from
ITU channels 0 to 3
SCI channel 0
transmit-data-empty
and receive-data-full
interrupts
Idle mode
Repeat mode
• Up to four channels
can operate
independently
• Only the B channels
support external
requests
External request
Full address
mode
Normal mode
Auto-request
External request
Block transfer mode
Compare match/input
capture A interrupt from
ITU channels 0 to 3
External request
• A and B channels are
paired; up to two
channels are
available
• Burst mode or cyclesteal mode can be
selected for autorequests
A summary of operations in these modes follows.
I/O Mode: One byte or word is transferred per request. A designated number of these transfers
are executed. A CPU interrupt can be requested at completion of the designated number of
transfers. One 24-bit address and one 8-bit address are specified. The transfer direction is
determined automatically from the activation source.
Idle Mode: One byte or word is transferred per request. A designated number of these transfers
are executed. A CPU interrupt can be requested at completion of the designated number of
transfers. One 24-bit address and one 8-bit address are specified. The addresses are held fixed.
The transfer direction is determined automatically from the activation source.
Repeat Mode: One byte or word is transferred per request. A designated number of these
transfers are executed. When the designated number of transfers are completed, the initial address
and counter value are restored and operation continues. No CPU interrupt is requested. One 24-bit
address and one 8-bit address are specified. The transfer direction is determined automatically
from the activation source.
201
Normal Mode :
•
Auto-request
The DMAC is activated by register setup alone, and continues executing transfers until the
designated number of transfers have been completed. A CPU interrupt can be requested at
completion of the transfers. Both addresses are 24-bit addresses.
— Cycle-steal mode
The bus is released to another bus master after each byte or word is transferred.
— Burst mode
Unless requested by a higher-priority bus master, the bus is not released until the
designated number of transfers have been completed.
•
External request
One byte or word is transferred per request. A designated number of these transfers are
executed. A CPU interrupt can be requested at completion of the designated number of
transfers. Both addresses are 24-bit addresses.
Block Transfer Mode: One block of a specified size is transferred per request. A designated
number of block transfers are executed. At the end of each block transfer, one address is restored
to its initial value. When the designated number of blocks have been transferred, a CPU interrupt
can be requested. Both addresses are 24-bit addresses.
202
8.4.2 I/O Mode
I/O mode can be selected independently for each channel.
One byte or word is transferred at each transfer request in I/O mode. A designated number of
these transfers are executed. One address is specified in the memory address register (MAR), the
other in the I/O address register (IOAR). The direction of transfer is determined automatically
from the activation source. The transfer is from the address specified in IOAR to the address
specified in MAR if activated by an SCI channel 0 receive-data-full interrupt, and from the
address specified in MAR to the address specified in IOAR otherwise.
Table 8-6 indicates the register functions in I/O mode.
Table 8-6 Register Functions in I/O Mode
Function
Activated by
SCI ReceiveData-Full
Interrupt
Other
Activation
0
Destination
address
register
0
Source
address
register
0
Transfer counter
Register
23
MAR
23
7
All 1s
IOAR
15
Initial Setting
Operation
Source
address
register
Destination or
source address
Incremented or
decremented
once per transfer
Destination
address
register
Source or
destination
address
Held fixed
Number of
transfers
Decremented
once per
transfer until
H'0000 is
reached and
transfer ends
ETCR
Legend
MAR: Memory address register
IOAR: I/O address register
ETCR: Execute transfer count register
MAR and IOAR specify the source and destination addresses. MAR specifies a 24-bit source or
destination address, which is incremented or decremented as each byte or word is transferred.
IOAR specifies the lower 8 bits of a fixed address. The upper 16 bits are all 1s. IOAR is not
incremented or decremented.
Figure 8-2 illustrates how I/O mode operates.
203
Transfer
Address T
IOAR
1 byte or word is
transferred per request
Address B
Legend
L = initial setting of MAR
N = initial setting of ETCR
Address T = L
Address B = L + (–1) DTID • (2 DTSZ • N – 1)
Figure 8-2 Operation in I/O Mode
The transfer count is specified as a 16-bit value in ETCR. The ETCR value is decremented by 1 at
each transfer. When the ETCR value reaches H'0000, the DTE bit is cleared and the transfer ends.
If the DTIE bit is set to 1, a CPU interrupt is requested at this time. The maximum transfer count
is 65,536, obtained by setting ETCR to H'0000.
Transfers can be requested (activated) by compare match/input capture A interrupts from ITU
channels 0 to 3, SCI channel 0 transmit-data-empty and receive-data-full interrupts, and external
request signals.
For the detailed settings see section 8.2.4, Data Transfer Control Registers (DTCR).
204
Figure 8-3 shows a sample setup procedure for I/O mode.
I/O mode setup
Set source and
destination addresses
1
Set transfer count
2
Read DTCR
3
Set DTCR
4
1. Set the source and destination addresses
in MAR and IOAR. The transfer direction is
determined automatically from the activation
source.
2. Set the transfer count in ETCR.
3. Read DTCR while the DTE bit is cleared to 0.
4. Set the DTCR bits as follows.
• Select the DMAC activation source with bits
DTS2 to DTS0.
• Set or clear the DTIE bit to enable or disable
the CPU interrupt at the end of the transfer.
• Clear the RPE bit to 0 to select I/O mode.
• Select MAR increment or decrement with the
DTID bit.
• Select byte size or word size with the DTSZ bit.
• Set the DTE bit to 1 to enable the transfer.
I/O mode
Figure 8-3 I/O Mode Setup Procedure (Example)
8.4.3 Idle Mode
Idle mode can be selected independently for each channel.
One byte or word is transferred at each transfer request in idle mode. A designated number of
these transfers are executed. One address is specified in the memory address register (MAR), the
other in the I/O address register (IOAR). The direction of transfer is determined automatically
from the activation source. The transfer is from the address specified in IOAR to the address
specified in MAR if activated by an SCI channel 0 receive-data-full interrupt, and from the
address specified in MAR to the address specified in IOAR otherwise.
Table 8-7 indicates the register functions in idle mode.
205
Table 8-7 Register Functions in Idle Mode
Function
Activated by
SCI ReceiveData-Full
Interrupt
Other
Activation
0
Destination
address
register
0
Source
address
register
0
Transfer counter
Register
23
MAR
23
7
All 1s
IOAR
15
Initial Setting
Operation
Source
address
register
Destination or
source address
Held fixed
Destination
address
register
Source or
destination
address
Held fixed
Number of
transfers
Decremented
once per
transfer until
H'0000 is
reached and
transfer ends
ETCR
Legend
MAR: Memory address register
IOAR: I/O address register
ETCR: Execute transfer count register
MAR and IOAR specify the source and destination addresses. MAR specifies a 24-bit source or
destination address. IOAR specifies the lower 8 bits of a fixed address. The upper 16 bits are all
1s. MAR and IOAR are not incremented or decremented.
Figure 8-4 illustrates how idle mode operates.
MAR
Transfer
1 byte or word is
transferred per request
Figure 8-4 Operation in Idle Mode
206
IOAR
The transfer count is specified as a 16-bit value in ETCR. The ETCR value is decremented by 1 at
each transfer. When the ETCR value reaches H'0000, the DTE bit is cleared, the transfer ends, and
a CPU interrupt is requested. The maximum transfer count is 65,536, obtained by setting ETCR to
H'0000.
Transfers can be requested (activated) by compare match/input capture A interrupts from ITU
channels 0 to 3, SCI transmit-data-empty and receive-data-full interrupts, and external request
signals.
For the detailed settings see section 8.2.4, Data Transfer Control Registers (DTCR).
Figure 8-5 shows a sample setup procedure for idle mode.
Idle mode setup
Set source and
destination addresses
1
Set transfer count
2
Read DTCR
3
Set DTCR
4
1. Set the source and destination addresses
in MAR and IOAR. The transfer direction is determined automatically from the activation source.
2. Set the transfer count in ETCR.
3. Read DTCR while the DTE bit is cleared to 0.
4. Set the DTCR bits as follows.
• Select the DMAC activation source with bits
DTS2 to DTS0.
• Set the DTIE and RPE bits to 1 to select idle mode.
• Select byte size or word size with the DTSZ bit.
• Set the DTE bit to 1 to enable the transfer.
Idle mode
Figure 8-5 Idle Mode Setup Procedure (Example)
207
8.4.4 Repeat Mode
Repeat mode is useful for cyclically transferring a bit pattern from a table to the programmable
timing pattern controller (TPC) in synchronization, for example, with ITU compare match. Repeat
mode can be selected for each channel independently.
One byte or word is transferred per request in repeat mode, as in I/O mode. A designated number
of these transfers are executed. One address is specified in the memory address register (MAR),
the other in the I/O address register (IOAR). At the end of the designated number of transfers,
MAR and ETCR are restored to their original values and operation continues. The direction of
transfer is determined automatically from the activation source. The transfer is from the address
specified in IOAR to the address specified in MAR if activated by an SCI receive-data-full
interrupt, and from the address specified in MAR to the address specified in IOAR otherwise.
Table 8-8 indicates the register functions in repeat mode.
Table 8-8 Register Functions in Repeat Mode
Function
Register
23
0
Activated by
SCI ReceiveData-Full
Interrupt
Other
Activation Initial Setting
Destination
address
register
Source
address
register
Source
address
register
Destination Source or
address
destination
register
address
MAR
7
23
All 1s
0
IOAR
7
Destination or
Incremented or
source address decremented at
each transfer until
ETCRH reaches
H'0000, then restored
to initial value
0
Held fixed
Transfer counter
Number of
transfers
Decremented once
per transfer unti
H'0000 is reached,
then reloaded from
ETCRL
Initial transfer count
Number of
transfers
Held fixed
0
ETCRH
7
Operation
ETCRL
Legend
MAR: Memory address register
IOAR: I/O address register
ETCR: Execute transfer count register
208
In repeat mode ETCRH is used as the transfer counter while ETCRL holds the initial transfer
count. ETCRH is decremented by 1 at each transfer until it reaches H'00, then is reloaded from
ETCRL. MAR is also restored to its initial value, which is calculated from the DTSZ and DTID
bits in DTCR. Specifically, MAR is restored as follows:
MAR ← MAR – (–1)DTID · 2DTSZ · ETCRL
ETCRH and ETCRL should be initially set to the same value.
In repeat mode transfers continue until the CPU clears the DTE bit to 0. After DTE is cleared to 0,
if the CPU sets DTE to 1 again, transfers resume from the state at which DTE was cleared. No
CPU interrupt is requested.
As in I/O mode, MAR and IOAR specify the source and destination addresses. MAR specifies a
24-bit source or destination address. IOAR specifies the lower 8 bits of a fixed address. The upper
16 bits are all 1s. IOAR is not incremented or decremented.
Figure 8-6 illustrates how repeat mode operates.
Address T
Transfer
1 byte or word is
transferred per request
Address B
Legend
L = initial setting of MAR
N = initial setting of ETCRH and ETCRL
Address T = L
Address B = L + (–1) DTID • (2 DTSZ • N – 1)
Figure 8-6 Operation in Repeat Mode
209
IOAR
The transfer count is specified as an 8-bit value in ETCRH and ETCRL. The maximum transfer
count is 255, obtained by setting both ETCRH and ETCRL to H'FF.
Transfers can be requested (activated) by compare match/input capture A interrupts from ITU
channels 0 to 3, SCI transmit-data-empty and receive-data-full interrupts, and external request
signals.
For the detailed settings see section 8.2.4, Data Transfer Control Registers (DTCR).
Figure 8-7 shows a sample setup procedure for repeat mode.
Repeat mode
Set source and
destination addresses
1
Set transfer count
2
Read DTCR
3
Set DTCR
4
1. Set the source and destination addresses in MAR
and IOAR. The transfer direction is determined
automatically from the activation source.
2. Set the transfer count in both ETCRH and ETCRL.
3. Read DTCR while the DTE bit is cleared to 0.
4. Set the DTCR bits as follows.
• Select the DMAC activation source with bits
DTS2 to DTS0.
• Clear the DTIE bit to 0 and set the RPE bit to 1
to select repeat mode.
• Select MAR increment or decrement with the DTID bit.
• Select byte size or word size with the DTSZ bit.
• Set the DTE bit to 1 to enable the transfer.
Repeat mode
Figure 8-7 Repeat Mode Setup Procedure (Example)
210
8.4.5 Normal Mode
In normal mode the A and B channels are combined. One byte or word is transferred per request.
A designated number of these transfers are executed. Addresses are specified in MARA and
MARB. Table 8-9 indicates the register functions in I/O mode.
Table 8-9 Register Functions in Normal Mode
Register
23
Function
Initial Setting
Operation
0
Source address
register
Source address
Incremented or
decremented once per
transfer, or held fixed
0
Destination
address register
Destination
address
Incremented or
decremented once per
transfer, or held fixed
0
Transfer counter
Number of
transfers
Decremented once per
transfer
MARA
23
MARB
15
ETCRA
Legend
MARA: Memory address register A
MARB: Memory address register B
ETCRA: Execute transfer count register A
The source and destination addresses are both 24-bit addresses. MARA specifies the source
address. MARB specifies the destination address. MARA and MARB can be independently
incremented, decremented, or held fixed as data is transferred.
The transfer count is specified as a 16-bit value in ETCRA. The ETCRA value is decremented by
1 at each transfer. When the ETCRA value reaches H'0000, the DTE bit is cleared and the transfer
ends. If the DTIE bit is set, a CPU interrupt is requested at this time. The maximum transfer count
is 65,536, obtained by setting ETCRA to H'0000.
Figure 8-8 illustrates how normal mode operates.
211
Transfer
Address TA
Address BA
Address T B
Address B B
Legend
L A = initial setting of MARA
L B = initial setting of MARB
N = initial setting of ETCRA
TA = LA
BA = L A + SAIDE • (–1) SAID • (2 DTSZ • N – 1)
TB = LB
BB = L B + DAIDE • (–1) DAID • (2 DTSZ • N – 1)
Figure 8-8 Operation in Normal Mode
Transfers can be requested (activated) by an external request or auto-request. An auto-requested
transfer is activated by the register settings alone. The designated number of transfers are executed
automatically. Either cycle-steal or burst mode can be selected. In cycle-steal mode the DMAC
releases the bus temporarily after each transfer. In burst mode the DMAC keeps the bus until the
transfers are completed, unless there is a bus request from a higher-priority bus master.
For the detailed settings see section 8.3.4, Data Transfer Control Registers (DTCR).
212
Figure 8-9 shows a sample setup procedure for normal mode.
Normal mode
Set initial source address
1
Set initial destination address
2
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Set transfer count
3
Set DTCRB (1)
4
Set DTCRA (1)
5
Read DTCRB
6
Set DTCRB (2)
7
Read DTCRA
8
Set DTCRA (2)
9
6.
7.
8.
9.
Set the initial source address in MARA.
Set the initial destination address in MARB.
Set the transfer count in ETCRA.
Set the DTCRB bits as follows.
• Clear the DTME bit to 0.
• Set the DAID and DAIDE bits to select whether
MARB is incremented, decremented, or held fixed.
• Select the DMAC activation source with bits
DTS2B to DTS0B.
Set the DTCRA bits as follows.
• Clear the DTE bit to 0.
• Select byte or word size with the DTSZ bit.
• Set the SAID and SAIDE bits to select whether
MARA is incremented, decremented, or held fixed.
• Set or clear the DTIE bit to enable or disable the
CPU interrupt at the end of the transfer.
• Clear the DTS0A bit to 0 and set the DTS2A
and DTS1A bits to 1 to select normal mode.
Read DTCRB with DTME cleared to 0.
Set the DTME bit to 1 in DTCRB.
Read DTCRA with DTE cleared to 0.
Set the DTE bit to 1 in DTCRA to enable the transfer.
Normal mode
Note: * Carry out settings 1 to 9 with the DEND interrupt masked in the CPU. If an NMI
interrupt occurs during the setup procedure, it may clear the DTME bit to 0,
in which case the transfer will not start.
Figure 8-9 Normal Mode Setup Procedure (Example)
213
8.4.6 Block Transfer Mode
In block transfer mode the A and B channels are combined. One block of a specified size is
transferred per request. A designated number of block transfers are executed. Addresses are
specified in MARA and MARB. The block area address can be either held fixed or cycled.
Table 8-10 indicates the register functions in block transfer mode.
Table 8-10 Register Functions in Block Transfer Mode
Register
23
Function
Initial Setting
Operation
0
Source address
register
Source address
Incremented or
decremented once per
transfer, or held fixed
0
Destination
address register
Destination
address
Incremented or
decremented once per
transfer, or held fixed
0
Block size counter Block size
Decremented once per
transfer until H'00 is
reached, then reloaded
from ETCRAL
Initial block size
Block size
Held fixed
Block transfer
counter
Number of block
transfers
Decremented once per
block transfer until H'0000
is reached and the
transfer ends
MARA
23
MARB
7
ETCRAH
7
0
ETCRAL
15
0
ETCRB
Legend
MARA:
MARB:
ETCRA:
ETCRB:
Memory address register A
Memory address register B
Execute transfer count register A
Execute transfer count register B
The source and destination addresses are both 24-bit addresses. MARA specifies the source
address. MARB specifies the destination address. MARA and MARB can be independently
incremented, decremented, or held fixed as data is transferred. One of these registers operates as a
block area register: even if it is incremented or decremented, it is restored to its initial value at the
end of each block transfer. The TMS bit in DTCRB selects whether the block area is the source or
destination.
214
If M (1 to 255) is the size of the block transferred at each request and N (1 to 65,536) is the
number of blocks to be transferred, then ETCRAH and ETCRAL should initially be set to M and
ETCRB should initially be set to N.
Figure 8-10 illustrates how block transfer mode operates. In this figure, bit TMS is cleared to 0,
meaning the block area is the destination.
TA
Address T B
Transfer
Block 1
Block area
BA
Address B B
Block 2
M bytes or words are
transferred per request
Block N
Legend
L A = initial setting of MARA
L B = initial setting of MARB
M = initial setting of ETCRAH and ETCRAL
N = initial setting of ETCRB
T A = LA
B A = L A + SAIDE • (–1) SAID • (2 DTSZ • M – 1)
T B = LB
B B = L B + DAIDE • (–1)DAID • (2 DTSZ • M – 1)
Figure 8-10 Operation in Block Transfer Mode
215
When activated by a transfer request, the DMAC executes a burst transfer. During the transfer
MARA and MARB are updated according to the DTCR settings, and ETCRAH is decremented.
When ETCRAH reaches H'00, it is reloaded from ETCRAL to restore the initial value. The
memory address register of the block area is also restored to its initial value, and ETCRB is
decremented. If ETCRB is not H'0000, the DMAC then waits for the next transfer request.
ETCRAH and ETCRAL should be initially set to the same value.
The above operation is repeated until ETCRB reaches H'0000, at which point the DTE bit is
cleared to 0 and the transfer ends. If the DTIE bit is set to 1, a CPU interrupt is requested at this
time.
Figure 8-11 shows examples of a block transfer with byte data size when the block area is the
destination. In (a) the block area address is cycled. In (b) the block area address is held fixed.
Transfers can be requested (activated) by compare match/input capture A interrupts from ITU
channels 0 to 3, and by external request signals.
For the detailed settings see section 8.3.4, Data Transfer Control Registers (DTCR).
216
Start
(DTE = DTME = 1)
Transfer requested?
Start
(DTE = DTME = 1)
No
Transfer requested?
Yes
No
Yes
Get bus
Get bus
Read from MARA address
Read from MARA address
MARA = MARA + 1
MARA = MARA + 1
Write to MARB address
Write to MARB address
MARB = MARB + 1
ETCRAH = ETCRAH – 1
ETCRAH = ETCRAH – 1
No
No
ETCRAH = H'00
ETCRAH = H'00
Yes
Yes
Release bus
Release bus
ETCRAH = ETCRAL
MARB = MARB – ETCRAL
ETCRAH = ETCRAL
ETCRB = ETCRB – 1
ETCRB = ETCRB – 1
ETCRB = H'0000
No
ETCRB = H'0000
Yes
Yes
Clear DTE to 0 and end transfer
Clear DTE to 0 and end transfer
a. DTSZ = TMS = 0
SAID = DAID = 0
SAIDE = DAIDE = 1
b. DTSZ = TMS = 0
SAID = 0
SAIDE = 1
DAIDE = 0
Figure 8-11 Block Transfer Mode Flowcharts (Examples)
217
No
Figure 8-12 shows a sample setup procedure for block transfer mode.
Block transfer mode
Set source address
1
Set destination address
2
Set block transfer count
3
Set block size
4
Set DTCRB (1)
5
Set DTCRA (1)
6
Read DTCRB
7
Set DTCRB (2)
8
Read DTCRA
9
Set DTCRA (2)
10
Set the source address in MARA.
Set the destination address in MARB.
Set the block transfer count in ETCRB.
Set the block size (number of bytes or words)
in both ETCRAH and ETCRAL.
5. Set the DTCRB bits as follows.
• Clear the DTME bit to 0.
• Set the DAID and DAIDE bits to select whether
MARB is incremented, decremented, or held fixed.
• Set or clear the TMS bit to make the block area
the source or destination.
• Select the DMAC activation source with bits
DTS2B to DTS0B.
6. Set the DTCRA bits as follows.
• Clear the DTE to 0.
• Select byte size or word size with the DTSZ bit.
• Set the SAID and SAIDE bits to select whether
MARA is incremented, decremented, or held fixed.
• Set or clear the DTIE bit to enable or disable the
CPU interrupt at the end of the transfer.
• Set bits DTS2A to DTS0A all to 1 to select
block transfer mode.
7. Read DTCRB with DTME cleared to 0.
8. Set the DTME bit to 1 in DTCRB.
9. Read DTCRA with DTE cleared to 0.
10. Set the DTE bit to 1 in DTCRA to enable
the transfer.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Block transfer mode
Note: * Carry out settings 1 to 10 with the DEND interrupt masked in the CPU.If an NMI
interrupt occurs during the setup procedure, it may clear the DTME bit to 0,
in which case the transfer will not start.
Figure 8-12 Block Transfer Mode Setup Procedure (Example)
218
8.4.7 DMAC Activation
The DMAC can be activated by an internal interrupt, external request, or auto-request. The
available activation sources differ depending on the transfer mode and channel as indicated in
table 8-11.
Table 8-11 DMAC Activation Sources
Short Address Mode
Channels
0B and 1B
Normal
Block
IMIA0
o
o
×
o
IMIA1
o
o
×
o
IMIA2
o
o
×
o
IMIA3
o
o
×
o
TXI0
o
o
×
×
RXI0
o
o
×
×
Falling edge
of DREQ
×
o
o
o
Low input at
DREQ
×
o
o
×
×
×
o
×
Activation Source
Internal
interrupts
External
requests
Auto-request
Full Address Mode
Channels
0A and 1A
Activation by Internal Interrupts: When an interrupt request is selected as a DMAC activation
source and the DTE bit is set to 1, that interrupt request is not sent to the CPU. It is not possible
for an interrupt request to activate the DMAC and simultaneously generate a CPU interrupt.
When the DMAC is activated by an interrupt request, the interrupt request flag is cleared
automatically. If the same interrupt is selected to activate two or more channels, the interrupt
request flag is cleared when the highest-priority channel is activated, but the transfer request is
held pending on the other channels in the DMAC, which are activated in their priority order.
219
Activation by External Request: If an external request (DREQ pin) is selected as an activation
source, the DREQ pin becomes an input pin and the corresponding TEND pin becomes an output
pin, regardless of the port data direction register (DDR) settings. The DREQ input can be levelsensitive or edge-sensitive.
In short address mode and normal mode, an external request operates as follows. If edge sensing is
selected, one byte or word is transferred each time a high-to-low transition of the DREQ input is
detected. If the next edge is input before the transfer is completed, the next transfer may not be
executed. If level sensing is selected, the transfer continues while DREQ is low, until the transfer
is completed. The bus is released temporarily after each byte or word has been transferred,
however. If the DREQ input goes high during a transfer, the transfer is suspended after the current
byte or word has been transferred. When DREQ goes low, the request is held internally until one
byte or word has been transferred. The TEND signal goes low during the last write cycle.
In block transfer mode, an external request operates as follows. Only edge-sensitive transfer
requests are possible in block transfer mode. Each time a high-to-low transition of the DREQ
input is detected, a block of the specified size is transferred. The TEND signal goes low during the
last write cycle in each block.
Activation by Auto-Request: The transfer starts as soon as enabled by register setup, and
continues until completed. Cycle-steal mode or burst mode can be selected.
In cycle-steal mode the DMAC releases the bus temporarily after transferring each byte or word.
Normally, DMAC cycles alternate with CPU cycles.
In burst mode the DMAC keeps the bus until the transfer is completed, unless there is a higherpriority bus request. If there is a higher-priority bus request, the bus is released after the current
byte or word has been transferred.
220
8.4.8 DMAC Bus Cycle
Figure 8-13 shows an example of the timing of the basic DMAC bus cycle. This example shows a
word-size transfer from a 16-bit two-state access area to an 8-bit three-state access area. When the
DMAC gets the bus from the CPU, after one dead cycle (Td), it reads from the source address and
writes to the destination address. During these read and write operations the bus is not released
even if there is another bus request. DMAC cycles comply with bus controller settings in the same
way as CPU cycles.
CPU cycle
T1
T2
T1
DMAC cycle (word transfer)
T2
Td
T1
T2
T1
T2
T3
T1
T2
CPU cycle
T3
ø
Source
address
Destination address
Address
bus
RD
HWR
LWR
Figure 8-13 DMA Transfer Bus Timing (Example)
221
T1
T2
T1
T2
Figure 8-14 shows the timing when the DMAC is activated by low input at a DREQ pin. This
example shows a word-size transfer from a 16-bit two-state access area to another 16-bit two-state
access area. The DMAC continues the transfer while the DREQ pin is held low.
CPU cycle
T1
T2
T3
DMAC cycle
Td
T1
T2
T1
DMAC cycle
(last transfer cycle)
CPU cycle
T2
T1
T2
Td
T1
T2
T1
T2
CPU cycle
T1
ø
DREQ
Source Destination
address address
Source Destination
address address
Address
bus
RD
HWR , LWR
TEND
Figure 8-14 Bus Timing of DMA Transfer Requested by Low DREQ Input
222
T2
Figure 8-15 shows an auto-requested burst-mode transfer. This example shows a transfer of three
words from a 16-bit two-state access area to another 16-bit two-state access area.
CPU cycle
T1
T2
DMAC cycle
Td
T1
T2
T1
T2
T1
T2
T1
CPU cycle
T2
T1
T2
T1
T2
T1
T2
ø
Source
address
Destination
address
Address
bus
RD
HWR ,
LWR
Figure 8-15 Burst DMA Bus Timing
When the DMAC is activated from a DREQ pin there is a minimum interval of four states from
when the transfer is requested until the DMAC starts operating. The DREQ pin is not sampled
during the time between the transfer request and the start of the transfer. In short address mode
and normal mode, the pin is next sampled at the end of the read cycle. In block transfer mode, the
pin is next sampled at the end of one block transfer.
223
Figure 8-16 shows the timing when the DMAC is activated by the falling edge of DREQ in
normal mode.
CPU cycle
T2
T1
T2
T1
CPU
cycle
DMAC cycle
T2
Td
T1
T2
T1
T2
T1
T2
DMAC cycle
Td
T1
T2
ø
DREQ
Address
bus
RD
HWR , LWR
Minimum 4 states
Next sampling point
Figure 8-16 Timing of DMAC Activation by Falling Edge of DREQ in Normal Mode
224
Figure 8-17 shows the timing when the DMAC is activated by level-sensitive low DREQ input in
normal mode.
CPU cycle
T2
T1
T2
T1
DMAC cycle
T2
Td
T1
T2
T1
CPU cycle
T2
T1
T2
T1
T2
T1
ø
DREQ
Address
bus
RD
HWR , LWR
Minimum 4 states
Next sampling point
Figure 8-17 Timing of DMAC Activation by Low DREQ Level in Normal Mode
225
Figure 8-18 shows the timing when the DMAC is activated by the falling edge of DREQ in block
transfer mode.
End of 1 block transfer
DMAC cycle
T1
T2
T1
T2
T1
CPU cycle
T2
T1
T2
T1
T2
T1
T2
DMAC cycle
Td
T1
T2
ø
DREQ
Address
bus
RD
HWR , LWR
TEND
Next sampling
Minimum 4 states
Figure 8-18 Timing of DMAC Activation
by Falling Edge of DREQ in Block Transfer
Mode
226
8.4.9 Multiple-Channel Operation
The DMAC channel priority order is: channel 0 > channel 1 and channel A > channel B.
Table 8-12 shows the complete priority order.
Table 8-12 Channel Priority Order
Short Address Mode
Full Address Mode
Priority
Channel 0A
Channel 0
High
Channel 0B
Channel 1A
Channel 1
Channel 1B
Low
Multiple-Channel Operation: If transfers are requested on two or more channels simultaneously,
or if a transfer on one channel is requested during a transfer on another channel, the DMAC
operates as follows.
•
When a transfer is requested, the DMAC requests the bus right. When it gets the bus right, it
starts a transfer on the highest-priority channel at that time.
•
Once a transfer starts on one channel, requests to other channels are held pending until that
channel releases the bus.
•
After each transfer in short address mode, and each externally-requested or cycle-steal
transfer in normal mode, the DMAC releases the bus and returns to step 1. After releasing the
bus, if there is a transfer request for another channel, the DMAC requests the bus again.
•
After completion of a burst-mode transfer, or after transfer of one block in block transfer
mode, the DMAC releases the bus and returns to step 1. If there is a transfer request for a
higher-priority channel or a bus request from a higher-priority bus master, however, the
DMAC releases the bus after completing the transfer of the current byte or word. After
releasing the bus, if there is a transfer request for another channel, the DMAC requests the
bus again.
227
Figure 8-19 shows the timing when channel 0A is set up for I/O mode and channel 1 for burst
mode, and a transfer request for channel 0A is received while channel 1 is active.
DMAC cycle
(channel 1)
T1
T2
CPU
cycle
T1
T2
DMAC cycle
(channel 0A)
Td
T1
T2
T1
CPU
cycle
T2
T1
T2
DMAC cycle
(channel 1)
Td
T1
T2
T1
ø
Address
bus
RD
HWR ,
LWR
Figure 8-19 Timing of Multiple-Channel Operations in the Same Group
228
T2
8.4.10 External Bus Requests, Refresh Controller, and DMAC
During a DMA transfer, if the bus right is requested by an external bus request signal (BREQ) or
by the refresh controller, the DMAC releases the bus after completing the transfer of the current
byte or word. If there is a transfer request at this point, the DMAC requests the bus right again.
Figure 8-20 shows an example of the timing of insertion of a refresh cycle during a burst transfer
on channel 0.
Refresh
cycle
DMAC cycle (channel 0)
T1
T2
T1
T2
T1
T2
T1
T2
T1
T2
DMAC cycle (channel 0)
Td
T1
T2
T1
ø
Address
bus
RD
HWR , LWR
Figure 8-20 Bus Timing of Refresh Controller and DMAC
229
T2
T1
T2
8.4.11 NMI Interrupts and DMAC
NMI interrupts do not affect DMAC operations in short address mode.
If an NMI interrupt occurs during a transfer in full address mode, the DMAC suspends operations.
In full address mode, a channel is enabled when its DTE and DTME bits are both set to 1. NMI
input clears the DTME bit to 0. After transferring the current byte or word, the DMAC releases
the bus to the CPU. In normal mode, the suspended transfer resumes when the CPU sets the
DTME bit to 1 again. Check that the DTE bit is set to 1 and the DTME bit is cleared to 0 before
setting the DTME bit to 1.
Figure 8-21 shows the procedure for resuming a DMA transfer in normal mode on channel 0 after
the transfer was halted by NMI input.
Resuming DMA transfer
in normal mode
DTE = 1
DTME = 0
1. Check that DTE = 1 and DTME = 0.
2. Read DTCRB while DTME = 0,
then write 1 in the DTME bit.
1
No
Yes
Set DTME to 1
DMA transfer continues
2
End
Figure 8-21 Procedure for Resuming a DMA Transfer Halted by NMI (Example)
For information about NMI interrupts in block transfer mode, see section 8.6.6, NMI Interrupts
and Block Transfer Mode.
230
8.4.12 Aborting a DMA Transfer
When the DTE bit in an active channel is cleared to 0, the DMAC halts after transferring the
current byte or word. The DMAC starts again when the DTE bit is set to 1. In full address mode,
the DTME bit can be used for the same purpose. Figure 8-22 shows the procedure for aborting a
DMA transfer by software.
DMA transfer abort
Set DTCR
1. Clear the DTE bit to 0 in DTCR.
To avoid generating an interrupt when
aborting a DMA transfer, clear the DTIE
bit to 0 simultaneously.
1
DMA transfer aborted
Figure 8-22 Procedure for Aborting a DMA Transfer
231
8.4.13 Exiting Full Address Mode
Figure 8-23 shows the procedure for exiting full address mode and initializing the pair of
channels. To set the channels up in another mode after exiting full address mode, follow the setup
procedure for the relevant mode.
Exiting full address mode
Halt the channel
1
Initialize DTCRB
2
Initialize DTCRA
3
1. Clear the DTE bit to 0 in DTCRA, or wait
for the transfer to end and the DTE bit
to be cleared to 0.
2. Clear all DTCRB bits to 0.
3. Clear all DTCRA bits to 0.
Initialized and halted
Figure 8-23 Procedure for Exiting Full Address Mode (Example)
232
8.4.14 DMAC States in Reset State, Standby Modes, and Sleep Mode
When the chip is reset or enters hardware or software standby mode, the DMAC is initialized.
DMAC operations continue in sleep mode. Figure 8-24 shows the timing of a cycle-steal transfer
in sleep mode.
Sleep mode
CPU cycle
T2
DMAC cycle
Td
T1
T2
T1
DMAC cycle
T2
Td
T1
T2
T1
T2
ø
Address
bus
RD
HWR , LWR
Figure 8-24 Timing of Cycle-Steal Transfer in Sleep Mode
233
Td
8.5 Interrupts
The DMAC generates only DMA-end interrupts. Table 8-13 lists the interrupts and their priority.
Table 8-13 DMAC Interrupts
Description
Interrupt
Short Address Mode
Full Address Mode
Interrupt Priority
DEND0A
End of transfer on channel 0A
End of transfer on
channel 0
High
DEND0B
End of transfer on channel 0B
—
DEND1A
End of transfer on channel 1A
End of transfer on
channel 1
DEND1B
End of transfer on channel 1B
—
Low
Each interrupt is enabled or disabled by the DTIE bit in the corresponding data transfer control
register (DTCR). Separate interrupt signals are sent to the interrupt controller.
The interrupt priority order among channels is channel 0 > channel 1 and channel A > channel B.
Figure 8-25 shows the DMA-end interrupt logic. An interrupt is requested whenever DTE = 0 and
DTIE = 1.
DTE
DMA-end interrupt
DTIE
Figure 8-25 DMA-End Interrupt Logic
The DMA-end interrupt for the B channels (DENDB) is unavailable in full address mode. The
DTME bit does not affect interrupt operations.
234
8.6 Usage Notes
8.6.1 Note on Word Data Transfer
Word data cannot be accessed starting at an odd address. When word-size transfer is selected, set
even values in the memory and I/O address registers (MAR and IOAR).
8.6.2 DMAC Self-Access
The DMAC itself cannot be accessed during a DMAC cycle. DMAC registers cannot be specified
as source or destination addresses.
8.6.3 Longword Access to Memory Address Registers
A memory address register can be accessed as longword data at the MARR address.
Example
MOV.L
MOV.L
#LBL, ER0
ER0, @MARR
Four byte accesses are performed. Note that the CPU may release the bus between the second byte
(MARE) and third byte (MARH).
Memory address registers should be written and read only when the DMAC is halted.
8.6.4 Note on Full Address Mode Setup
Full address mode is controlled by two registers: DTCRA and DTCRB. Care must be taken to
prevent the B channel from operating in short address mode during the register setup. The enable
bits (DTE and DTME) should not be set to 1 until the end of the setup procedure.
235
8.6.5 Note on Activating DMAC by Internal Interrupts
When using an internal interrupt to activate the DMAC, make sure that the interrupt selected as
the activating source does not occur during the interval after it has been selected but before the
DMAC has been enabled. The on-chip supporting module that will generate the interrupt should
not be activated until the DMAC has been enabled. If the DMAC must be enabled while the onchip supporting module is active, follow the procedure in figure 8-26.
Enabling of DMAC
Yes
Interrupt handling by CPU
1
Selected interrupt
requested?
No
Clear selected interrupt’s
enable bit to 0
2
Enable DMAC
3
Set selected interrupt’s
enable bit to 1
4
1. While the DTE bit is cleared to 0,
interrupt requests are sent to the
CPU.
2. Clear the interrupt enable bit to 0
in the interrupt-generating on-chip
supporting module.
3. Enable the DMAC.
4. Enable the DMAC-activating
interrupt.
DMAC operates
Figure 8-26 Procedure for Enabling DMAC while On-Chip Supporting
Module is Operating (Example)
If the DTE bit is set to 1 but the DTME bit is cleared to 0, the DMAC is halted and the selected
activating source cannot generate a CPU interrupt. If the DMAC is halted by an NMI interrupt, for
example, the selected activating source cannot generate CPU interrupts. To terminate DMAC
operations in this state, clear the DTE bit to 0 to allow CPU interrupts to be requested. To continue
DMAC operations, carry out steps 2 and 4 in figure 8-26 before and after setting the DTME bit
to 1.
236
When an ITU interrupt activates the DMAC, make sure the next interrupt does not occur before
the DMA transfer ends. If one ITU interrupt activates two or more channels, make sure the next
interrupt does not occur before the DMA transfers end on all the activated channels. If the next
interrupt occurs before a transfer ends, the channel or channels for which that interrupt was
selected may fail to accept further activation requests.
8.6.6 NMI Interrupts and Block Transfer Mode
If an NMI interrupt occurs in block transfer mode, the DMAC operates as follows.
•
When the NMI interrupt occurs, the DMAC finishes transferring the current byte or word,
then clears the DTME bit to 0 and halts. The halt may occur in the middle of a block.
It is possible to find whether a transfer was halted in the middle of a block by checking the
block size counter. If the block size counter does not have its initial value, the transfer was
halted in the middle of a block.
•
If the transfer is halted in the middle of a block, the activating interrupt flag is cleared to 0.
The activation request is not held pending.
•
While the DTE bit is set to 1 and the DTME bit is cleared to 0, the DMAC is halted and does
not accept activating interrupt requests. If an activating interrupt occurs in this state, the
DMAC does not operate and does not hold the transfer request pending internally. Neither is a
CPU interrupt requested.
For this reason, before setting the DTME bit to 1, first clear the enable bit of the activating
interrupt to 0. Then, after setting the DTME bit to 1, set the interrupt enable bit to 1 again.
See section 8.6.5, Note on Activating DMAC by Internal Interrupts.
•
When the DTME bit is set to 1, the DMAC waits for the next transfer request. If it was halted
in the middle of a block transfer, the rest of the block is transferred when the next transfer
request occurs. Otherwise, the next block is transferred when the next transfer request occurs.
237
8.6.7 Memory and I/O Address Register Values
Table 8-14 indicates the address ranges that can be specified in the memory and I/O address
registers (MAR and IOAR).
Table 8-14 Address Ranges Specifiable in MAR and IOAR
1-Mbyte Mode
16-Mbyte Mode
MAR
H'00000 to H'FFFFF
(0 to 1048575)
H'000000 to H'FFFFFF
(0 to 16777215)
IOAR
H'FFF00 to H'FFFFF
(1048320 to 1048575)
H'FFFF00 to H'FFFFFF
(16776960 to 16777215)
Note: MAR bits 23 to 20 are ignored in 1-Mbyte mode.
8.6.8 Bus Cycle when Transfer is Aborted
When a transfer is aborted by clearing the DTE bit or suspended by an NMI that clears the DTME
bit, if this halts a channel for which the DMAC has a transfer request pending internally, a dead
cycle may occur. This dead cycle does not update the halted channel’s address register or counter
value. Figure 8-27 shows an example in which an auto-requested transfer in cycle-steal mode on
channel 0 is aborted by clearing the DTE bit in channel 0.
CPU cycle
T1
T2
DMAC cycle
Td
T1
T2
T1
DMAC
cycle
CPU cycle
T2
T1
T2
T3
Td
Td
CPU cycle
T1
ø
Address bus
RD
HWR, LWR
DTE bit is
cleared
Figure 8-27 Bus Timing at Abort of DMA Transfer in Cycle-Steal Mode
238
T2
Section 9 I/O Ports
9.1 Overview
The H8/3002 has six input/output ports (ports 4, 6, 8, 9, A, and B) and one input port (port 7).
Table 9-1 summarizes the port functions. The pins in each port are multiplexed as shown in
table 9-1.
Each port has a data direction register (DDR) for selecting input or output, and a data register
(DR) for storing output data. In addition to these registers, port 4 has an input pull-up control
register (PCR) for switching input pull-up transistors on and off.
Ports 4, 6, and 8 can drive one TTL load and a 90-pF capacitive load. Ports 9, A, and B can drive
one TTL load and a 30-pF capacitive load. Ports 4, 6, and 8 to B can drive a darlington pair.
Port B can drive LEDs (with 10-mA current sink). Pins P82 to P80, PA7 to PA0, and PB3 to PB0
have Schmitt-trigger input circuits.
For block diagrams of the ports see appendix C, I/O Port Block Diagrams.
239
Table 9-1 Port Functions
Port
Description
Pins
Mode 1
Port 4
• 8-bit I/O port
• Input pull-up
P47 to P40/D7 to D0
Data input/output (D7 to D0) and 8-bit
generic input/output
8-bit bus mode: generic input/output
16-bit bus mode: data input/output
Port 6
• 3-bit I/O port
P62/BACK
P61/BREQ
P60/WAIT
Bus control signal input/output
(BACK, BREQ, WAIT) and 3-bit
generic input/output
Port 7
• 8-bit input port
P77 to P70/AN7 to AN0
Analog input (AN7 to AN0) to A/D
converter, and 8-bit generic input
Port 8
• 5-bit I/O port
• P82 to P80 have
Schmitt inputs
P84/CS0
DDR = 0: generic input
DDR = 1 (reset value): CS0 output
P83/CS1/IRQ3
P82/CS2/IRQ2
P81/CS3/IRQ1
IRQ3 to IRQ1 input, CS1 to CS3
output, and generic input
DDR = 0 (reset value): generic input
DDR = 1: CS1 to CS3 output
P80/RFSH/IRQ0
IRQ0 input, RFSH output, and
generic input/output
P95/SCK1/IRQ5
P94/SCK0/IRQ4
P93/RxD1
P92/RxD0
P91/TxD1
P90/TxD0
Input and output (SCK1, SCK0, RxD1,
RxD0, TxD1, TxD0) for serial
communication interfaces 0 and 1
(SCI0/1), IRQ5 and IRQ4 input, and
6-bit generic input/output
Port 9
• 6-bit I/O port
240
Mode 2
Mode 3
Mode 4
Table 9-1 Port Functions (cont)
Port
Description
Pins
Mode 1
Port A
• 8-bit I/O port
• Schmitt inputs
PA7/TP7/TIOCB2/A20
Output (TP7) from Address output
programmable
(A20)
timing pattern
controller (TPC),
input or output
(TIOCB2) for 16-bit
integrated timer
unit (ITU), and
generic input/output
PA6/TP6/TIOCA2/A21
PA5/TP5/TIOCB1/A22
PA4/TP4/TIOCA1/A23
TPC output
(TP6 to TP4), ITU
input and output
(TIOCA2, TIOCB1,
TIOCA1), and
generic input/
output
PA3/TP3/TIOCB0/TCLKD
PA2/TP2/TIOCA0/TCLKC
PA1/TP1/TEND1/TCLKB
PA0/TP0/TEND0/TCLKA
TPC output (TP3 to TP0), output
(TEND1, TEND0) from DMA
controller (DMAC), ITU input and output
(TCLKD, TCLKC, TCLKB, TCLKA,
TIOCB0, TIOCA0), and generic
input/output
PB7/TP15/DREQ1/ADTRG
PB6/TP14/DREQ0
PB5/TP13/TOCXB4
PB4/TP12/TOCXA4
PB3/TP11/TIOCB4
PB2/TP10/TIOCA4
PB1/TP9/TIOCB3
PB0/TP8/TIOCA3
TPC output (TP15 to TP8), DMAC input
(DREQ1, DREQ0), external trigger
input (ADTRG) to A/D converter, ITU
input and output (TOCXB4, TOCXA4,
TIOCB4, TIOCA4, TIOCB3, TIOCA3),
and 8-bit generic input/output
Port B
• 8-bit I/O port
• Can drive LEDs
• PB3 to PB0
have Schmitt
inputs
241
Mode 2
Mode 3
Mode 4
TPC output
(TP6 to TP4),
ITU input and
output (TIOCA2,
TIOCB1, TIOCA1),
address output
(A23 to A21), and
generic input/output
9.2 Port 4
9.2.1 Overview
Port 4 is an 8-bit input/output port with the pin configuration shown in figure 9-1. The pin
functions differ between the 8-bit and 16-bit bus modes.
When the bus width control register (ABWCR) designates areas 0 to 7 all as 8-bit-access areas,
the H8/3002 operates in 8-bit bus mode and port 4 is a generic input/output port. When at least
one of areas 0 to 7 is designated as a 16-bit-access area, the H8/3002 operates in 16-bit bus mode
and port 4 becomes the lower data bus.
Port 4 has software-programmable built-in pull-up transistors.
Pins in port 4 can drive one TTL load and a 90-pF capacitive load. They can also drive a
darlington transistor pair.
Port 4
Port 4 pins
8-bit bus mode *1
16-bit bus mode *2
P47 /D7
P47 (input/output)
D 7 (input/output)
P46 /D6
P46 (input/output)
D 6 (input/output)
P45 /D5
P45 (input/output)
D 5 (input/output)
P44 /D4
P44 (input/output)
D 4 (input/output)
P43 /D3
P43 (input/output)
D 3 (input/output)
P42 /D2
P42 (input/output)
D 2 (input/output)
P41 /D1
P41 (input/output)
D 1 (input/output)
P40 /D0
P40 (input/output)
D 0 (input/output)
Notes: 1. Initial state in modes 1 and 3.
2. Initial state in modes 2 and 4.
Figure 9-1 Port 4 Pin Configuration
242
9.2.2 Register Descriptions
Table 9-2 summarizes the registers of port 4.
Table 9-2 Port 4 Registers
Address*
Name
Abbreviation
R/W
Initial Value
H'FFC5
Port 4 data direction register
P4DDR
W
H'00
H'FFC7
Port 4 data register
P4DR
R/W
H'00
H'FFDA
Port 4 input pull-up control register
P4PCR
R/W
H'00
Note: * Lower 16 bits of the address.
Port 4 Data Direction Register (P4DDR): P4DDR is an 8-bit write-only register that can select
input or output for each pin in port 4.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P4 7 DDR P4 6 DDR P4 5 DDR P4 4 DDR P4 3 DDR P4 2 DDR P4 1 DDR P4 0 DDR
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
Port 4 data direction 7 to 0
These bits select input or output for port 4 pins
8-Bit Bus Mode: When all areas are designated as 8-bit-access areas, selecting 8-bit bus mode,
port 4 functions as a generic input/output port. A pin in port 4 becomes an output pin if the
corresponding P4DDR bit is set to 1, and an input pin if this bit is cleared to 0.
16-Bit Bus Mode: When at least one area is designated as a 16-bit-access area, selecting 16-bit
bus mode, port 4 functions as the lower data bus.
P4DDR is a write-only register. Its value cannot be read. All bits return 1 when read.
P4DDR is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. In software standby mode
it retains its previous setting.
ABWCR and P4DDR are not initialized in software standby mode. When port 4 functions as a
generic input/output port, if a P4DDR bit is set to 1, the corresponding pin maintains its output
state in software standby mode.
243
Port 4 Data Register (P4DR): P4DR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that stores data for
pins P47 to P40.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P4 7
P4 6
P4 5
P4 4
P4 3
P4 2
P4 1
P4 0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Port 4 data 7 to 0
These bits store data for port 4 pins
When a bit in P4DDR is set to 1, if port 4 is read the value of the corresponding P4DR bit is
returned directly, regardless of the actual state of the pin. When a bit in P4DDR is cleared to 0, if
port 4 is read the corresponding pin level is read. This applies in both 8-bit and 16-bit bus modes.
P4DR is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. In software standby mode it
retains its previous setting.
Port 4 Input Pull-Up Control Register (P4PCR): P4PCR is an 8-bit readable/writable register
that controls the MOS input pull-up transistors in port 4.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P4 7 PCR P4 6 PCR P4 5 PCR P4 4 PCR P4 3 PCR P4 2 PCR P4 1 PCR P4 0 PCR
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Port 4 input pull-up control 7 to 0
These bits control input pull-up transistors built into port 4
In 8-bit bus mode, when a P4DDR bit is cleared to 0 (selecting generic input), if the
corresponding P4PCR bit is set to 1, the input pull-up transistor is turned on.
P4PCR is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. In software standby mode
it retains its previous setting.
244
9.2.3 Pin Functions in Each Mode
The functions of port 4 differ depending on whether 8-bit or 16-bit bus mode is selected by
ABWCR settings. The pin functions in each mode are described below.
8-Bit Bus Mode: Input or output can be selected separately for each pin in port 4. A pin becomes
an output pin if the corresponding P4DDR bit is set to 1 and an input pin if this bit is cleared to 0.
Figure 9-2 shows the pin functions in 8-bit bus mode. This is the initial state in modes 1 and 3.
P47 (input/output)
P46 (input/output)
P45 (input/output)
Port 4
P44 (input/output)
P43 (input/output)
P42 (input/output)
P41 (input/output)
P40 (input/output)
Figure 9-2 Pin Functions in 8-Bit Bus Mode (Port 4)
16-Bit Bus Mode: The input/output settings in P4DDR are ignored. Port 4 automatically becomes
a bidirectional data bus. Figure 9-3 shows the pin functions in 16-bit bus mode. This is the initial
state in modes 2 and 4.
245
D 7 (input/output)
D 6 (input/output)
D 5 (input/output)
D 4 (input/output)
Port 4
D 3 (input/output)
D 2 (input/output)
D 1 (input/output)
D 0 (input/output)
Figure 9-3 Pin Functions in 16-Bit Bus Mode (Port 4)
9.2.4 Input Pull-Up Transistors
Port 4 has built-in MOS input pull-up transistors that can be controlled by software. These input
pull-up transistors can be used in 8-bit bus mode. They can be turned on and off individually.
In 8-bit bus mode, when a P4PCR bit is set to 1 and the corresponding P4DDR bit is cleared to 0,
the input pull-up transistor is turned on.
The input pull-up transistors are turned off by a reset and in hardware standby mode. In software
standby mode they retain their previous state.
Table 9-3 summarizes the states of the input pull-ups in the 8-bit and 16-bit bus modes.
Table 9-3 Input Pull-Up Transistor States (Port 4)
Mode
Reset
Hardware
Standby Mode
Software
Standby Mode
Other Modes
8-bit bus mode
Off
Off
On/off
On/off
Off
Off
16-bit bus mode
Legend
Off:
The input pull-up transistor is always off.
On/off: The input pull-up transistor is on if P4PCR = 1 and P4DDR = 0. Otherwise, it is off.
246
9.3 Port 6
9.3.1 Overview
Port 6 is a 3-bit input/output port that is also used for input and output of bus control signals
(BACK, BREQ, and WAIT). Port 6 has the same set of pin functions in all operating modes.
Figure 9-4 shows the pin configuration of port 6.
Pins in port 6 can drive one TTL load and a 90-pF capacitive load. They can also drive a
darlington transistor pair.
Port 6 pins
P62 (input/output)/BACK (output)
Port 6
P61 (input/output)/BREQ (input)
P60 (input/output)/WAIT (input)
Figure 9-4 Port 6 Pin Configuration
9.3.2 Register Descriptions
Table 9-4 summarizes the registers of port 6.
Table 9-4 Port 6 Registers
Address*
Name
Abbreviation
R/W
Initial Value
H'FFC9
Port 6 data direction register
P6DDR
W
H'80
H'FFCB
Port 6 data register
P6DR
R/W
H'80
Note: * Lower 16 bits of the address.
247
Port 6 Data Direction Register (P6DDR): P6DDR is an 8-bit write-only register that can select
input or output for each pin in port 6.
Bit
7
—
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P6 6 DDR P6 5 DDR P6 4 DDR P6 3 DDR P6 2 DDR P6 1 DDR P6 0 DDR
Initial value
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
Reserved bits
Port 6 data direction 2 to 0
These bits select input or
output for port 6 pins
A pin in port 6 becomes an output pin if the corresponding P6DDR bit is set to 1, and an input pin
if this bit is cleared to 0. Bits 7 to 3 are reserved.
P6DDR is a write-only register. Its value cannot be read. All bits return 1 when read.
P6DDR is initialized to H'80 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. In software standby mode
it retains its previous setting. If a P6DDR bit is set to 1, the corresponding pin maintains its output
state in software standby mode.
Port 6 Data Register (P6DR): P6DR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that stores data for
pins P62 to P60.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
P6 6
P6 5
P6 4
P6 3
P6 2
P6 1
P6 0
Initial value
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Reserved bits
Port 6 data 2 to 0
These bits store data
for port 6 pins
When a bit in P6DDR is set to 1, if port 6 is read the value of the corresponding P6DR bit is
returned directly. When a bit in P6DDR is cleared to 0, if port 6 is read the corresponding pin
level is read. In this case bit 7 reads 1 and bits 6 to 3 have undetermined values. Bits 7 to 3 are
reserved. Bits 6 to 3 can be written and read, but they cannot be used for port input or output.
Bit 7 cannot be modified and always reads 1.
P6DR is initialized to H'80 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. In software standby mode it
retains its previous setting.
248
9.3.3 Pin Functions
The port 6 pins are also used for BACK output and BREQ and WAIT input. Table 9-5 describes
the selection of pin functions.
Table 9-5 Port 6 Pin Functions
Pin
Pin Functions and Selection Method
P62/BACK
Bit BRLE in BRCR and bit P62DDR select the pin function as follows
BRLE
P62DDR
Pin function
P61/BREQ
0
0
1
—
P62 input
P62 output
BACK output
Bit BRLE in BRCR and bit P61DDR select the pin function as follows
BRLE
P61DDR
Pin function
P60/WAIT
1
0
1
0
1
—
P61 input
P61 output
BREQ input
Bits WCE7 to WCE0 in WCER, bit WMS1 in WCR, and bit P60DDR select the
pin function as follows
WCER
All 1s
WMS1
P60DDR
Pin function
Not all 1s
0
0
1
P60 input
P60 output
1
—
0*
0*
WAIT input
Note: * Do not set bit P60DDR to 1.
9.4 Port 7
9.4.1 Overview
Port 7 is an 8-bit input port that is also used for analog input to the A/D converter. Port 7 has the
same set of pin functions in all operating modes. Figure 9-5 shows the pin configuration of port 7.
249
Port 7 pins
P77 (input)/AN 7 (input)
P76 (input)/AN 6 (input)
P75 (input)/AN 5 (input)
P74 (input)/AN 4 (input)
Port 7
P73 (input)/AN 3 (input)
P72 (input)/AN 2 (input)
P71 (input)/AN 1 (input)
P70 (input)/AN 0 (input)
Figure 9-5 Port 7 Pin Configuration
9.4.2 Register Description
Table 9-6 summarizes the port 7 register. Port 7 is an input-only port, so it has no data direction
register.
Table 9-6 Port 7 Register
Address*
Name
Abbreviation
R/W
Initial Value
H'FFCE
Port 7 data register
P7DR
R
Undetermined
Note: * Lower 16 bits of the address.
Port 7 Data Register (P7DR)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P77
P76
P75
P74
P73
P72
P71
P70
Initial value
—*
—*
—*
—*
—*
—*
—*
—*
Read/Write
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Note: * Determined by pins P7 7 to P70 .
When port 7 is read, the pin levels are always read.
250
9.5 Port 8
9.5.1 Overview
Port 8 is a 5-bit input/output port that is also used for CS3 to CS0 output, RFSH output, and IRQ3
to IRQ0 input. Port 8 has the same set of pin functions in all operating modes. Figure 9-6 shows
the pin configuration of port 8.
Pins in port 8 can drive one TTL load and a 90-pF capacitive load. They can also drive a
darlington transistor pair. Pins P82 to P80 have Schmitt-trigger inputs.
Port 8 pins
P84 (input)/CS0 (output)
P83 (input)/CS1 (output)/IRQ 3 (input)
P82 (input)/CS2 (output)/IRQ 2 (input)
Port 8
P81 (input)/CS3 (output)/IRQ 1 (input)
P80 (input/output)/RFSH (output)/IRQ 0 (input)
Figure 9-6 Port 8 Pin Configuration
9.5.2 Register Descriptions
Table 9-7 summarizes the registers of port 8.
Table 9-7 Port 8 Registers
Address*
Name
Abbreviation
R/W
Initial Value
H'FFCD
Port 8 data direction register
P8DDR
W
H'F0
H'FFCF
Port 8 data register
P8DR
R/W
H'E0
Note: * Lower 16 bits of the address.
251
Port 8 Data Direction Register (P8DDR): P8DDR is an 8-bit write-only register that can select
input or output for each pin in port 8.
Bit
7
6
5
—
—
—
Initial value
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
—
—
W
W
W
W
W
4
3
2
1
0
P8 4 DDR P8 3 DDR P8 2 DDR P8 1 DDR P8 0 DDR
Reserved bits
Port 8 data direction 4 to 0
These bits select input or
output for port 8 pins
When bits in P8DDR bit are set to 1, P84 to P81 become CS0 to CS3 output pins and P80 becomes
a generic output pin. When bits in P8DDR are cleared to 0, the corresponding pins become input
pins.
P8DDR is a write-only register. Its value cannot be read. All bits return 1 when read.
P8DDR is initialized to H'F0 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. In software standby mode
it retains its previous setting. If a P8DDR bit is set to 1, the corresponding pin maintains its output
state in software standby mode.
Port 8 Data Register (P8DR): P8DR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that stores data for
pins P84 to P80.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
—
—
P8 4
P8 3
P8 2
P8 1
P8 0
Initial value
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
—
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Reserved bits
Port 8 data 4 to 0
These bits store data
for port 8 pins
When a bit in P8DDR is set to 1, if port 8 is read the value of the corresponding P8DR bit is
returned directly. When a bit in P8DDR is cleared to 0, if port 8 is read the corresponding pin
level is read.
Bits 7 to 5 are reserved. They cannot be modified and always read 1.
P8DR is initialized to H'E0 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. In software standby mode it
retains its previous setting.
252
9.5.3 Pin Functions
The port 8 pins are also used for CS3 to CS0 and RFSH output and IRQ3 to IRQ0 input.
Table 9-8 describes the selection of pin functions.
Table 9-8 Port 8 Pin Functions
Pin
Pin Functions and Selection Method
P84/CS0
Bit P84DDR selects the pin function as follows
P84DDR
Pin function
P83/CS1/IRQ3
0
1
P84 input
CS0 output
Bit P83DDR selects the pin function as follows
P83DDR
Pin function
0
1
P83 input
CS1 output
IRQ3 input
P82/CS2/IRQ2
Bit P82DDR selects the pin function as follows
P82DDR
Pin function
0
1
P82 input
CS2 output
IRQ2 input
P81/CS3/IRQ1
Bit P81DDR selects the pin function as follows
P81DDR
Pin function
0
1
P81 input
CS3 output
IRQ1 input
P80/RFSH/IRQ0
Bit RFSHE in RFSHCR and bit P80DDR select the pin function as follows
RFSHE
P80DDR
Pin function
0
1
0
1
—
P80 input
P80 output
RFSH output
IRQ0 input
253
9.6 Port 9
9.6.1 Overview
Port 9 is a 6-bit input/output port that is also used for input and output (TxD0, TxD1, RxD0, RxD1,
SCK0, SCK1) by serial communication interface channels 0 and 1 (SCI0 and SCI1), and for IRQ5
and IRQ4 input. Port 9 has the same set of pin functions in all operating modes. Figure 9-7 shows
the pin configuration of port 9.
Pins in port 9 can drive one TTL load and a 30-pF capacitive load. They can also drive a
darlington transistor pair.
Port 9 pins
P95 (input/output)/SCK 1 (input/output)/IRQ 5 (input)
P94 (input/output)/SCK 0 (input/output)/IRQ 4 (input)
Port 9
P93 (input/output)/RxD1 (input)
P92 (input/output)/RxD0 (input)
P91 (input/output)/TxD1 (output)
P90 (input/output)/TxD0 (output)
Figure 9-7 Port 9 Pin Configuration
9.6.2 Register Descriptions
Table 9-9 summarizes the registers of port 9.
Table 9-9 Port 9 Registers
Address*
Name
Abbreviation
R/W
Initial Value
H'FFD0
Port 9 data direction register
P9DDR
W
H'C0
H'FFD2
Port 9 data register
P9DR
R/W
H'C0
Note: * Lower 16 bits of the address.
254
Port 9 Data Direction Register (P9DDR): P9DDR is an 8-bit write-only register that can select
input or output for each pin in port 9.
Bit
7
6
5
3
4
2
1
0
—
—
Initial value
1
1
P9 5 DDR P9 4 DDR P9 3 DDR P9 2 DDR P9 1 DDR P9 0 DDR
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
—
W
W
W
W
W
W
Reserved bits
Port 9 data direction 5 to 0
These bits select input or
output for port 9 pins
A pin in port 9 becomes an output pin if the corresponding P9DDR bit is set to 1, and an input pin
if this bit is cleared to 0.
P9DDR is a write-only register. Its value cannot be read. All bits return 1 when read.
P9DDR is initialized to H'C0 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. In software standby mode
it retains its previous setting. If a P9DDR bit is set to 1, the corresponding pin maintains its output
state in software standby mode.
Port 9 Data Register (P9DR): P9DR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that stores data for
pins P95 to P90.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
—
P95
P9 4
P9 3
P8 2
P9 1
P9 0
Initial value
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Reserved bits
Port 9 data 5 to 0
These bits store data
for port 9 pins
When a bit in P9DDR is set to 1, if port 9 is read the value of the corresponding P9DR bit is
returned directly. When a bit in P9DDR is cleared to 0, if port 9 is read the corresponding pin
level is read.
Bits 7 and 6 are reserved. They cannot be modified and always read 1.
P9DR is initialized to H'C0 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. In software standby mode it
retains its previous setting.
255
9.6.3 Pin Functions
The port 9 pins are also used for SCI0 and SCI1 input and output (TxD0, RxD0, SCK0, TxD1,
RxD1, SCK1), and for IRQ5 and IRQ4 input. Table 9-10 describes the selection of pin functions.
Table 9-10 Port 9 Pin Functions
Pin
Pin Functions and Selection Method
P95/SCK1/IRQ5
Bit C/A in SMR of SCI1, bits CKE0 and CKE1 in SCR of SCI1, and bit P95DDR
select the pin function as follows
CKE1
0
C/A
0
CKE0
P95DDR
Pin function
1
0
0
1
1
—
1
—
—
—
—
—
SCK1 output
SCK1 input
P95 SCK1 output
P95
input output
IRQ5 input
P94/SCK0/IRQ4
Bit C/A in SMR of SCI0, bits CKE0 and CKE1 in SCR of SCI0, and bit P94DDR
select the pin function as follows
CKE1
0
C/A
0
CKE0
P94DDR
Pin function
1
0
0
1
1
—
1
—
—
—
—
—
SCK0 output
SCK0 input
P94 SCK0 output
P94
input output
IRQ4 input
256
Table 9-10 Port 9 Pin Functions (cont)
Pin
Pin Functions and Selection Method
P93/RxD1
Bit RE in SCR of SCI1 and bit P93DDR select the pin function as follows
RE
P93DDR
Pin function
P92/RxD0
0
0
1
—
P93 input
P93 output
RxD1 input
Bit RE in SCR of SCI0 and bit P92DDR select the pin function as follows
RE
P92DDR
Pin function
P91/TxD1
0
1
0
1
—
P92 input
P92 output
RxD0 input
Bit TE in SCR of SCI1 and bit P91DDR select the pin function as follows
TE
P91DDR
Pin function
P90/TxD0
1
0
1
0
1
—
P91 input
P91 output
TxD1 output
Bit TE in SCR of SCI0 and bit P90DDR select the pin function as follows
TE
P90DDR
Pin function
0
1
0
1
—
P90 input
P90 output
TxD0 output
257
9.7 Port A
9.7.1 Overview
Port A is an 8-bit input/output port that is also used for address output (A23 to A20), output
(TP7 to TP0) from the programmable timing pattern controller (TPC), input and output (TIOCB2,
TIOCA2, TIOCB1, TIOCA1, TIOCB0, TIOCA0, TCLKD, TCLKC, TCLKB, TCLKA) by the
16-bit integrated timer unit (ITU), and output (TEND1, TEND0) from the DMA controller
(DMAC). Figure 9-8 shows the pin configuration of port A.
Pins in port A can drive one TTL load and a 30-pF capacitive load. They can also drive a
darlington transistor pair. Port A has Schmitt-trigger inputs.
Port A pins
PA 7 /TP7 /TIOCB 2 /A 20
PA 6 /TP6 /TIOCA 2 /A 21
PA 5 /TP5 /TIOCB 1 /A 22
PA 4 /TP4 /TIOCA 1 /A 23
Port A
PA 3 /TP3 /TIOCB 0 /TCLKD
PA 2 /TP2 /TIOCA 0 /TCLKC
PA 1 /TP1 /TEND1 /TCLKB
PA 0 /TP0 /TEND0 /TCLKA
Modes 1 and 2
PA 7 (input/output)/TP7 (output)/TIOCB2 (input/output)
PA 6 (input/output)/TP6 (output)/TIOCA2 (input/output)
PA 5 (input/output)/TP5 (output)/TIOCB1 (input/output)
PA 4 (input/output)/TP4 (output)/TIOCA1 (input/output)
Port A
PA 3 (input/output)/TP3 (output)/TIOCB0 (input/output)/TCLKD (input)
PA 2 (input/output)/TP2 (output)/TIOCA0 (input/output)/TCLKC (input)
PA 1 (input/output)/TP1 (output)/TEND1 (output)/TCLKB (input)
PA 0 (input/output)/TP0 (output)/TEND0 (output)/TCLKA (input)
Figure 9-8 Port A Pin Configuration (1)
258
Modes 3 and 4
A 20 (output)
PA 6 (input/output)/TP6 (output)/TIOCA 2 (input/output)/A 21 (output)
PA 5 (input/output)/TP5 (output)/TIOCB 1 (input/output)/A 22 (output)
PA 4 (input/output)/TP4 (output)/TIOCA 1 (input/output)/A 23 (output)
Port A
PA 3 (input/output)/TP3 (output)/TIOCB 0 (input/output)/TCLKD (input)
PA 2 (input/output)/TP2 (output)/TIOCA 0 (input/output)/TCLKC (input)
PA 1 (input/output)/TP1 (output)/TEND1 (output)/TCLKB (input)
PA 0 (input/output)/TP0 (output)/TEND0 (output)/TCLKA (input)
Figure 9-8 Port A Pin Configuration (2)
9.7.2 Register Descriptions
Table 9-11 summarizes the registers of port A.
Table 9-11 Port A Registers
Address*
Name
Abbreviation
R/W
H'FFD1
Port A data direction register
PADDR
W
H'00
H'FFD3
Port A data register
PADR
R/W
H'00
Note: * Lower 16 bits of the address.
259
Initial Value
Port A Data Direction Register (PADDR): PADDR is an 8-bit write-only register that can select
input or output for each pin in port A.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PA 7
PA 6
PA 5
PA 4
PA 3
PA 2
PA 1
PA 0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Port A data direction 7 to 0
These bits select input or output for port A pins
A pin in port A becomes an output pin if the corresponding PADDR bit is set to 1, and an input
pin if this bit is cleared to 0. In modes 3and 4, PA7 functions as an address output pin regardless of
the PA7DDR setting.
PADDR is a write-only register. Its value cannot be read. All bits return 1 when read.
PADDR is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. In software standby mode
it retains its previous setting. If a PADDR bit is set to 1, the corresponding pin maintains its output
state in software standby mode.
Port A Data Register (PADR): PADR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that stores data for
pins PA7 to PA0.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PA 7
PA 6
PA 5
PA 4
PA 3
PA 2
PA 1
PA 0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Port A data 7 to 0
These bits store data for port A pins
When a bit in PADDR is set to 1, if port A is read the value of the corresponding PADR bit is
returned directly. When a bit in PADDR is cleared to 0, if port A is read the corresponding pin
level is read.
PADR is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. In software standby mode it
retains its previous setting.
260
9.7.3 Pin Functions
The port A pins are also used for TPC output (TP7 to TP0), ITU input/output
(TIOCB2 to TIOCB0, TIOCA2 to TIOCA0), ITU input (TCLKD, TCLKC, TCLKB, TCLKA),
DMAC output (TEND1, TEND0), and address output (A23 to A20). Table 9-12 describes the
selection of pin functions.
Table 9-12 Port A Pin Functions (cont)
Pin
Pin Functions and Selection Method
PA7/TP7/
TIOCB2/A20
The mode setting, ITU channel 2 settings (bit PWM2 in TMDR and bits
IOB2 to IOB0 in TIOR2), bit NDER7 in NDERA, and bit PA7DDR in PADDR
select the pin function as follows
Mode
ITU channel 2
settings
1, 2
(1) in table
below
3, 4
(2) in table below
—
PA7DDR
—
0
1
1
—
NDER7
—
—
0
1
—
TIOCB2
output
PA7
input
PA7
output
TP7
output
A20
output
Pin function
TIOCB2 input*
Note: * TIOCB2 input when IOB2 = 1 and PWM2 = 0.
ITU channel 2
settings
(2)
IOB2
(1)
(2)
0
1
IOB1
0
0
1
—
IOB0
0
1
—
—
261
Table 9-12 Port A Pin Functions (cont)
Pin
Pin Functions and Selection Method
PA6/TP6/
TIOCA2/A21
The mode setting, bit A21E in BRCR, ITU channel 2 settings (bit PWM2 in
TMDR and bits IOA2 to IOA0 in TIOR2), bit NDER6 in NDERA, and bit
PA6DDR in PADDR select the pin function as follows
Mode
1, 2
ITU channel 2
settings
(1) in table
below
(2) in table below
PA6DDR
—
0
1
1
NDER6
—
—
0
1
TIOCA2 output
PA6
input
PA6
output
TP6
output
Pin function
TIOCA2 input*
Mode
3, 4
A21E
0
ITU channel 2
settings
—
PA6DDR
—
—
0
1
1
NDER6
—
—
—
0
1
A21
output
TIOCA2
output
PA6
input
PA6
output
TP6
output
Pin function
1
(1) in table
below
(2) in table below
TIOCA2 input*
Note: * TIOCA2 input when IOA2 = 1.
ITU channel 2
settings
(2)
(1)
PWM2
(2)
0
IOA2
(1)
1
0
1
—
IOA1
0
0
1
—
—
IOA0
0
1
—
—
—
262
Table 9-12 Port A Pin Functions (cont)
Pin
Pin Functions and Selection Method
PA5/TP5
TIOCB1/A22
The mode setting, bit A22E in BRCR, ITU channel 1 settings (bit PWM1 in
TMDR and bits IOB2 to IOB0 in TIOR1), bit NDER5 in NDERA, and bit
PA5DDR in PADDR select the pin function as follows
Mode
1, 2
ITU channel 1
settings
(1) in table
below
(2) in table below
PA5DDR
—
0
1
1
NDER5
—
—
0
1
TIOCB1 output
PA5
input
PA5
output
TP5
output
Pin function
TIOCB1 input*
Mode
3, 4
A22E
0
ITU channel 1
settings
—
PA5DDR
—
—
0
1
1
NDER5
—
—
—
0
1
A22
output
TIOCB1
output
PA5
input
PA5
output
TP5
output
Pin function
1
(1) in table
below
(2) in table below
TIOCB1 input*
Note: * TIOCB1 input when IOB2 = 1 and PWM1 = 0.
ITU channel 1
settings
(2)
IOB2
(1)
(2)
0
1
IOB1
0
0
1
—
IOB0
0
1
—
—
263
Table 9-12 Port A Pin Functions (cont)
Pin
Pin Functions and Selection Method
PA4/TP4/
TIOCA1/A23
The mode setting, bit A23E in BRCR, ITU channel 1 settings (bit PWM1 in
TMDR and bits IOA2 to IOA0 in TIOR1), bit NDER4 in NDERA, and bit
PA4DDR in PADDR select the pin function as follows
Mode
1, 2
ITU channel 1
settings
(1) in table
below
(2) in table below
PA4DDR
—
0
1
1
NDER4
—
—
0
1
TIOCA1 output
PA4
input
PA4
output
TP4
output
Pin function
TIOCA1 input*
Mode
3, 4
A23E
0
ITU channel 1
settings
—
PA4DDR
—
—
0
1
1
NDER4
—
—
—
0
1
A23
output
TIOCA1
output
PA4
input
PA4
output
TP4
output
Pin function
1
(1) in table
below
(2) in table below
TIOCA1 input*
Note: * TIOCA1 input when IOA2 = 1.
ITU channel 1
settings
(2)
(1)
PWM1
(2)
0
IOA2
(1)
1
0
1
—
IOA1
0
0
1
—
—
IOA0
0
1
—
—
—
264
Table 9-12 Port A Pin Functions (cont)
Pin
Pin Functions and Selection Method
PA3/TP3/
TIOCB0/TCLKD
ITU channel 0 settings (bit PWM0 in TMDR and bits IOB2 to IOB0 in TIOR0),
bits TPSC2 to TPSC0 in timer control registers 4 to 0 (TCR4 to TCR0), bit
NDER3 in NDERA, and bit PA3DDR in PADDR select the pin function as
follows
ITU channel 0
settings
(1)in table
below
(2) in table below
PA3DDR
—
0
1
1
NDER3
—
—
0
1
TIOCB0 output
PA3
input
PA3
output
TP3
output
Pin function
TIOCB0 input*1
TCLKD input*2
Notes: 1. TIOCB0 input when IOB2 = 1 and PWM0 = 0.
2. TCLKD input when TPSC2 = TPSC1 = TPSC0 = 1 in any of TCR4
to TCR0.
ITU channel 0
settings
(2)
IOB2
(1)
(2)
0
1
IOB1
0
0
1
—
IOB0
0
1
—
—
265
Table 9-12 Port A Pin Functions (cont)
Pin
Pin Functions and Selection Method
PA2/TP2/
TIOCA0/TCLKC
ITU channel 0 settings (bit PWM0 in TMDR and bits IOA2 to IOA0 in TIOR0),
bits TPSC2 to TPSC0 in TCR4 to TCR0, bit NDER2 in NDERA, and bit
PA2DDR in PADDR select the pin function as follows
ITU channel 0
settings
(1) in table
below
(2) in table below
PA2DDR
—
0
1
1
NDER2
—
—
0
1
TIOCA0 output
PA2
input
PA2
output
TP2
output
Pin function
TIOCA0 input*1, TCLKC input*2
Notes: 1. TIOCA0 input when IOA2 = 1.
2. TCLKC input when TPSC2 = TPSC1 = 1 and TPSC0 = 0 in any of
TCR4 to TCR0.
ITU channel 0
settings
(2)
(1)
PWM0
(2)
0
IOA2
(1)
1
0
1
—
IOA1
0
0
1
—
—
IOA0
0
1
—
—
—
266
Table 9-12 Port A Pin Functions (cont)
Pin
Pin Functions and Selection Method
PA1/TP1
TCLKB/TEND1
DMAC channel 1 settings (bits DTS2/1/0A and DTS2/1/0B in DTCR1A and
DTCR1B), bit NDER1 in NDERA, and bit PA1DDR in PADDR select the pin
function as follows
DMAC channel 1
settings
(1) in table
below
(2)in table below
PA1DDR
—
0
1
1
NDER1
—
—
0
1
TEND1 output
PA1
input
PA1
output
TP1
output
Pin function
TCLKB input*
Note: * TCLKB input when MDF = 1 in TMDR, or when TPSC2 = 1,
TPSC1 = 0, and TPSC0 = 1 in any of TCR4 to TCR0.
DMAC channel 1
settings
(2)
DTS2A, DTS1A
Not both 1
DTS0A
(1)
(2)
(1)
(2)
(1)
Both 1
—
0
0
1
1
1
DTS2B
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
1
DTS1B
—
0
1
—
—
—
0
1
267
Table 9-12 Port A Pin Functions (cont)
Pin
Pin Functions and Selection Method
PA0/TP0
TCLKA/TEND0
DMAC channel 0 settings (bits DTS2/1/0A and DTS2/1/0B in DTCR0A and
DTCR0B), bit NDER0 in NDERA, and bit PA0DDR in PADDR select the pin
function as follows
DMAC channel 0
settings
(1) in table
below
(2)in table below
PA0DDR
—
0
1
1
NDER0
—
—
0
1
TEND0 output
PA0
input
PA0
output
TP0
output
Pin function
TCLKA input*
Note: * TCLKA input when MDF = 1 in TMDR, or when TPSC2 = 1,
TPSC1 = 0, and TPSC0 = 0 in any of TCR4 to TCR0.
DMAC channel 0
settings
(2)
DTS2A, DTS1A
(1)
(2)
(1)
Not both 1
DTS0A
(2)
(1)
Both 1
—
0
0
1
1
1
DTS2B
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
1
DTS1B
—
0
1
—
—
—
0
1
268
9.8 Port B
9.8.1 Overview
Port B is an 8-bit input/output port that is also used for TPC output (TP15 to TP8), ITU
input/output (TIOCB4, TIOCB3, TIOCA4, TIOCA3), ITU output (TOCXB4, TOCXA4), DMAC
input (DREQ1, DREQ0), and ADTRG input to the A/D converter. Port B has the same set of pin
functions in all operating modes. Figure 9-9 shows the pin configuration of port B.
Pins in port B can drive one TTL load and a 30-pF capacitive load. They can also drive a LED or
a darlington transistor pair. Pins PB3 to PB0 have Schmitt-trigger inputs.
Port B pins
PB 7 (input/output)/TP15 (output)/DREQ1 (input)/ADTRG (input)
PB 6 (input/output)/TP14 (output)/DREQ0 (input)
PB 5 (input/output)/TP13 (output)/TOCXB 4 (output)
PB 4 (input/output)/TP12 (output)/TOCXA 4 (output)
Port B
PB 3 (input/output)/TP11 (output)/TIOCB 4 (input/output)
PB 2 (input/output)/TP10 (output)/TIOCA 4 (input/output)
PB 1 (input/output)/TP9 (output)/TIOCB 3 (input/output)
PB 0 (input/output)/TP8 (output)/TIOCA 3 (input/output)
Figure 9-9 Port B Pin Configuration
9.8.2 Register Descriptions
Table 9-13 summarizes the registers of port B.
Table 9-13 Port B Registers
Address*
Name
Abbreviation
R/W
Initial Value
H'FFD4
Port B data direction register
PBDDR
W
H'00
H'FFD6
Port B data register
PBDR
R/W
H'00
Note: * Lower 16 bits of the address.
269
Port B Data Direction Register (PBDDR): PBDDR is an 8-bit write-only register that can select
input or output for each pin in port B.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PB7 DDR PB6 DDR PB5 DDR PB4 DDR PB3 DDR PB2 DDR PB1 DDR PB0 DDR
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
Port B data direction 7 to 0
These bits select input or output for port B pins
A pin in port B becomes an output pin if the corresponding PBDDR bit is set to 1, and an input
pin if this bit is cleared to 0.
PBDDR is a write-only register. Its value cannot be read. All bits return 1 when read.
PBDDR is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. In software standby mode
it retains its previous setting. If a PBDDR bit is set to 1, the corresponding pin maintains its output
state in software standby mode.
Port B Data Register (PBDR): PBDR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that stores data for
pins PB7 to PB0.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PB 7
PB 6
PB 5
PB 4
PB 3
PB 2
PB 1
PB 0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Port B data 7 to 0
These bits store data for port B pins
When a bit in PBDDR is set to 1, if port B is read the value of the corresponding PBDR bit is
returned directly. When a bit in PBDDR is cleared to 0, if port B is read the corresponding pin
level is read.
PBDR is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. In software standby mode it
retains its previous setting.
270
9.8.3 Pin Functions
The port B pins are also used for TPC output (TP15 to TP8), ITU input/output (TIOCB4, TIOCB3,
TIOCA4, TIOCA3) and output (TOCXB4, TOCXA4), DMAC input (DREQ1, DREQ0), and
ADTRG input. Table 9-14 describes the selection of pin functions.
Table 9-14 Port B Pin Functions
Pin
Pin Functions and Selection Method
PB7/TP15/DREQ1/ DMAC channel 1 settings (bits DTS2/1/0A and DTS2/1/0B in DTCR1A and
ADTRG
DTCR1B), bit TRGE in ADCR, bit NDER15 in NDERB, and bit PB7DDR in
PBDDR select the pin function as follows
PB7DDR
0
1
1
NDER15
—
0
1
PB7 input
PB7 output
Pin function
DREQ1
TP15 output
input*1
ADTRG input*2
Notes: 1. DREQ1 input under DMAC channel 1 settings (1) in the table below.
2. ADTRG input when TRGE = 1.
DMAC channel
1 settings
(2)
DTS2A, DTS1A
Not both 1
DTS0A
(1)
(2)
(1)
(2)
(1)
Both 1
—
0
0
1
1
1
DTS2B
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
1
DTS1B
—
0
1
—
—
—
0
1
271
Table 9-14 Port B Pin Functions (cont)
Pin
Pin Functions and Selection Method
PB6/TP14/DREQ0
DMAC channel 0 settings (bits DTS2/1/0A and DTS2/1/0B in DTCR0A and
DTCR0B), bit NDER14 in NDERB, and bit PB6DDR in PBDDR select the pin
function as follows
PB6DDR
0
1
1
NDER14
—
0
1
PB6 input
PB6 output
TP14 output
Pin function
DREQ0 input*
Note: * DREQ0 input under DMAC channel 0 settings (1) in the table below.
DMAC channel
0 settings
(2)
DTS2A, DTS1A
Not both 1
DTS0A
(1)
(2)
(1)
(2)
(1)
Both 1
—
0
0
1
1
1
DTS2B
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
1
DTS1B
—
0
1
—
—
—
0
1
PB5/TP13/TOCXB4 ITU channel 4 settings (bit CMD1 in TFCR and bit EXB4 in TOER), bit
NDER13 in NDERB, and bit PB5DDR in PBDDR select the pin function as
follows
EXB4, CMD1
Not both 1
Both 1
PB5DDR
0
1
1
—
NDER13
—
0
1
—
PB5
input
PB5
output
TP13
output
TOCXB4 output
Pin function
PB4/TP12/TOCXA4 ITU channel 4 settings (bit CMD1 in TFCR and bit EXA4 in TOER), bit
NDER12 in NDERB, and bit PB4DDR in PBDDR select the pin function as
follows
EXA4, CMD1
Not both 1
Both 1
PB4DDR
0
1
1
—
NDER12
—
0
1
—
PB4
input
PB4
output
TP12
output
TOCXA4 output
Pin function
272
Table 9-14 Port B Pin Functions (cont)
Pin
Pin Functions and Selection Method
PB3/TP11/TIOCB4 ITU channel 4 settings (bit PWM4 in TMDR, bit CMD1 in TFCR, bit EB4 in
TOER, and bits IOB2 to IOB0 in TIOR4), bit NDER11 in NDERB, and bit
PB3DDR in PBDDR select the pin function as follows
ITU channel 4
settings
(1) in table below
(2) in table below
PB3DDR
—
0
1
1
NDER11
—
—
0
1
TIOCB4 output
PB3
input
PB3
output
TP11
output
Pin function
TIOCB4 input*
Note: * TIOCB4 input when CMD1 = PWM4 = 0 and IOB2 = 1.
ITU channel 4
settings
(2)
(2)
(1)
(2)
(1)
EB4
0
1
CMD1
—
IOB2
—
0
0
0
1
—
IOB1
—
0
0
1
—
—
IOB0
—
0
1
—
—
—
0
273
1
Table 9-14 Port B Pin Functions (cont)
Pin
Pin Functions and Selection Method
PB2/TP10/TIOCA4 ITU channel 4 settings (bit CMD1 in TFCR, bit EA4 in TOER, bit PWM4 in
TMDR, and bits IOA2 to IOA0 in TIOR4), bit NDER10 in NDERB, and bit
PB2DDR in PBDDR select the pin function as follows
ITU channel 4
settings
(1) in table below
(2) in table below
PB2DDR
—
0
1
1
NDER10
—
—
0
1
TIOCA4 output
PB2
input
PB2
output
TP10
output
Pin function
TIOCA4 input*
Note: * TIOCA4 input when CMD1 = PWM4 = 0 and IOA2 = 1.
ITU channel 4
settings
(2)
(2)
(1)
(2)
EA4
0
CMD1
—
PWM4
—
IOA2
—
0
0
0
IOA1
—
0
0
IOA0
—
0
1
(1)
1
0
1
0
274
1
—
1
—
—
1
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Table 9-14 Port B Pin Functions (cont)
Pin
Pin Functions and Selection Method
PB1/TP9/TIOCB3
ITU channel 3 settings (bit PWM3 in TMDR, bit CMD1 in TFCR, bit EB3 in
TOER, and bits IOB2 to IOB0 in TIOR3), bit NDER9 in NDERB, and bit
PB1DDR in PBDDR select the pin function as follows
ITU channel 3
settings
(1) in table below
(2) in table below
PB1DDR
—
0
1
1
NDER9
—
—
0
1
TIOCB3 output
PB1
input
PB1
output
TP9
output
Pin function
TIOCB3 input*
Note: * TIOCB3 input when CMD1 = PWM3 = 0 and IOB2 = 1.
ITU channel 3
settings
(2)
(2)
(1)
(2)
(1)
EB3
0
1
CMD1
—
IOB2
—
0
0
0
1
—
IOB1
—
0
0
1
—
—
IOB0
—
0
1
—
—
—
0
275
1
Table 9-14 Port B Pin Functions (cont)
Pin
Pin Functions and Selection Method
PB0/TP8/TIOCA3
ITU channel 3 settings (bit CMD1 in TFCR, bit EA3 in TOER, bit PWM3 in
TMDR, and bits IOA2 to IOA0 in TIOR3), bit NDER8 in NDERB, and bit
PB0DDR in PBDDR select the pin function as follows
ITU channel 3
settings
(1) in table below
(2) in table below
PB0DDR
—
0
1
1
NDER8
—
—
0
1
TIOCA3 output
PB0
input
PB0
output
TP8
output
Pin function
TIOCA3 input*
Note: * TIOCA3 input when CMD1 = PWM3 = 0 and IOA2 = 1.
ITU channel 3
settings
(2)
(2)
(1)
(2)
EA3
0
CMD1
—
PWM3
—
IOA2
—
0
0
0
IOA1
—
0
0
IOA0
—
0
1
(1)
1
0
1
0
276
1
—
1
—
—
1
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Section 10 16-Bit Integrated Timer Unit (ITU)
10.1 Overview
The H8/3002 has a built-in 16-bit integrated timer unit (ITU) with five 16-bit timer channels.
10.1.1 Features
ITU features are listed below.
•
Capability to process up to 12 pulse outputs or 10 pulse inputs
•
Ten general registers (GRs, two per channel) with independently-assignable output compare
or input capture functions
•
Selection of eight counter clock sources for each channel:
Internal clocks: ø, ø/2, ø/4, ø/8
External clocks: TCLKA, TCLKB, TCLKC, TCLKD
•
Five operating modes selectable in all channels:
— Waveform output by compare match
Selection of 0 output, 1 output, or toggle output (only 0 or 1 output in channel 2)
— Input capture function
Rising edge, falling edge, or both edges (selectable)
— Counter clearing function
Counters can be cleared by compare match or input capture
— Synchronization
Two or more timer counters (TCNTs) can be preset simultaneously, or cleared
simultaneously by compare match or input capture. Counter synchronization enables
synchronous register input and output.
277
— PWM mode
PWM output can be provided with an arbitrary duty cycle. With synchronization, up to
five-phase PWM output is possible
•
Phase counting mode selectable in channel 2
Two-phase encoder output can be counted automatically.
•
Three additional modes selectable in channels 3 and 4
— Reset-synchronized PWM mode
If channels 3 and 4 are combined, three-phase PWM output is possible with three pairs of
complementary waveforms.
— Complementary PWM mode
If channels 3 and 4 are combined, three-phase PWM output is possible with three pairs of
non-overlapping complementary waveforms.
— Buffering
Input capture registers can be double-buffered. Output compare registers can be updated
automatically.
•
High-speed access via internal 16-bit bus
The 16-bit timer counters, general registers, and buffer registers can be accessed at high speed
via a 16-bit bus.
•
Fifteen interrupt sources
Each channel has two compare match/input capture interrupts and an overflow interrupt. All
interrupts can be requested independently.
•
Activation of DMA controller (DMAC)
Four of the compare match/input capture interrupts from channels 0 to 3 can start the DMAC.
•
Output triggering of programmable pattern controller (TPC)
Compare match/input capture signals from channels 0 to 3 can be used as TPC output
triggers.
278
Table 10-1 summarizes the ITU functions.
Table 10-1 ITU Functions
Item
Channel 0
Clock sources
Internal clocks: ø, ø/2, ø/4, ø/8
External clocks: TCLKA, TCLKB, TCLKC, TCLKD, selectable independently
General registers
(output compare/input
capture registers)
GRA0, GRB0
GRA1, GRB1
GRA2, GRB2
GRA3, GRB3
Buffer registers
—
—
—
BRA3, BRB3
BRA4, BRB4
Input/output pins
TIOCA0,
TIOCB0
TIOCA1,
TIOCB1
TIOCA2,
TIOCB2
TIOCA3,
TIOCB3
TIOCA4,
TIOCB4
Output pins
—
—
—
—
TOCXA4,
TOCXB4
Counter clearing function
GRA0/GRB0
compare
match or
input capture
GRA1/GRB1
compare
match or
input capture
GRA2/GRB2
compare
match or
input capture
GRA3/GRB3
compare
match or
input capture
GRA4/GRB4
compare
match or
input capture
0
o
o
o
o
o
1
o
o
o
o
o
Toggle
o
o
—
o
o
Input capture function
o
o
o
o
o
Synchronization
o
o
o
o
o
PWM mode
o
o
o
o
o
Reset-synchronized
PWM mode
—
—
—
o
o
Complementary PWM
mode
—
—
—
o
o
Phase counting mode
—
—
o
—
—
Buffering
—
—
—
o
o
DMAC activation
GRA0 compare GRA1 compare GRA2 compare GRA3 compare —
match or
match or
match or
match or
input capture
input capture
input capture
input capture
Compare
match output
Interrupt sources
Channel 1
Channel 2
Channel 3
Channel 4
GRA4, GRB4
Three sources
Three sources
Three sources
Three sources
Three sources
• Compare
match/input
capture A0
• Compare
match/input
capture A1
• Compare
match/input
capture A2
• Compare
match/input
capture A3
• Compare
match/input
capture A4
• Compare
match/input
capture B0
• Compare
match/input
capture B1
• Compare
match/input
capture B2
• Compare
match/input
capture B3
• Compare
match/input
capture B4
• Overflow
• Overflow
• Overflow
• Overflow
• Overflow
Legend
o: Available
—: Not available
279
10.1.2 Block Diagrams
ITU Block Diagram (Overall): Figure 10-1 is a block diagram of the ITU.
TCLKA to TCLKD
IMIA0 to IMIA4
IMIB0 to IMIB4
OVI0 to OVI4
Clock selector
ø, ø/2, ø/4, ø/8
TOCXA4, TOCXB4
Control logic
TIOCA0 to TIOCA4
TIOCB0 to TIOCB4
TSTR
TSNC
TMDR
TFCR
Module data bus
Legend
TOER:
TOCR:
TSTR:
TSNC:
TMDR:
TFCR:
Timer output master enable register (8 bits)
Timer output control register (8 bits)
Timer start register (8 bits)
Timer synchro register (8 bits)
Timer mode register (8 bits)
Timer function control register (8 bits)
Figure 10-1 ITU Block Diagram (Overall)
280
On-chip data bus
TOCR
Bus interface
16-bit timer channel 0
16-bit timer channel 1
16-bit timer channel 2
16-bit timer channel 3
16-bit timer channel 4
TOER
Block Diagram of Channels 0 and 1: ITU channels 0 and 1 are functionally identical. Both have
the structure shown in figure 10-2.
TCLKA to TCLKD
TIOCA0
TIOCB0
Clock selector
ø, ø/2, ø/4, ø/8
Control logic
IMIA0
IMIB0
OVI0
TSR
TIER
TIOR
TCR
GRB
GRA
TCNT
Comparator
Module data bus
Legend
TCNT:
GRA, GRB:
TCR:
TIOR:
TIER:
TSR:
Timer counter (16 bits)
General registers A and B (input capture/output compare registers) (16 bits × 2)
Timer control register (8 bits)
Timer I/O control register (8 bits)
Timer interrupt enable register (8 bits)
Timer status register (8 bits)
Figure 10-2 Block Diagram of Channels 0 and 1 (for Channel 0)
281
Block Diagram of Channel 2: Figure 10-3 is a block diagram of channel 2. This is the channel
that provides only 0 output and 1 output.
TCLKA to TCLKD
TIOCA2
TIOCB2
Clock selector
ø, ø/2, ø/4, ø/8
Control logic
IMIA2
IMIB2
OVI2
TSR2
TIER2
TIOR2
TCR2
GRB2
GRA2
TCNT2
Comparator
Module data bus
Legend
Timer counter 2 (16 bits)
TCNT2:
GRA2, GRB2: General registers A2 and B2 (input capture/output compare registers)
(16 bits × 2)
Timer control register 2 (8 bits)
TCR2:
Timer I/O control register 2 (8 bits)
TIOR2:
Timer interrupt enable register 2 (8 bits)
TIER2:
Timer status register 2 (8 bits)
TSR2:
Figure 10-3 Block Diagram of Channel 2
282
Block Diagrams of Channels 3 and 4: Figure 10-4 is a block diagram of channel 3. Figure 10-5
is a block diagram of channel 4.
TCLKA to
TCLKD
ø, ø/2,
ø/4, ø/8
TIOCA3
TIOCB3
Clock selector
Control logic
IMIA3
IMIB3
OVI3
TSR3
TIER3
TIOR3
TCR3
GRB3
BRB3
GRA3
BRA3
TCNT3
Comparator
Module data bus
Legend
Timer counter 3 (16 bits)
TCNT3:
GRA3, GRB3: General registers A3 and B3 (input capture/output compare registers)
(16 bits × 2)
BRA3, BRB3: Buffer registers A3 and B3 (input capture/output compare buffer registers)
(16 bits × 2)
Timer control register 3 (8 bits)
TCR3:
Timer I/O control register 3 (8 bits)
TIOR3:
Timer interrupt enable register 3 (8 bits)
TIER3:
Timer status register 3 (8 bits)
TSR3:
Figure 10-4 Block Diagram of Channel 3
283
TCLKA to
TCLKD
ø, ø/2,
ø/4, ø/8
TOCXA4
TOCXB4
TIOCA4
TIOCB4
IMIA4
IMIB4
OVI4
Clock selector
Control logic
TSR4
TIER4
TIOR4
TCR4
GRB4
BRB4
GRA4
BRA4
TCNT4
Comparator
Module data bus
Legend
Timer counter 4 (16 bits)
TCNT4:
GRA4, GRB4: General registers A4 and B4 (input capture/output compare registers)
(16 bits × 2)
BRA4, BRB4: Buffer registers A4 and B4 (input capture/output compare buffer registers)
(16 bits × 2)
Timer control register 4 (8 bits)
TCR4:
Timer I/O control register 4 (8 bits)
TIOR4:
Timer interrupt enable register 4 (8 bits)
TIER4:
Timer status register 4 (8 bits)
TSR4:
Figure 10-5 Block Diagram of Channel 4
284
10.1.3 Input/Output Pins
Table 10-2 summarizes the ITU pins.
Table 10-2 ITU Pins
Abbreviation
Input/
Output
Common Clock input A
TCLKA
Input
External clock A input pin
(phase-A input pin in phase counting mode)
Clock input B
TCLKB
Input
External clock B input pin
(phase-B input pin in phase counting mode)
Clock input C
TCLKC
Input
External clock C input pin
Clock input D
TCLKD
Input
External clock D input pin
Input capture/output
compare A0
TIOCA0
Input/
output
GRA0 output compare or input capture pin
PWM output pin in PWM mode
Input capture/output
compare B0
TIOCB0
Input/
output
GRB0 output compare or input capture pin
Input capture/output
compare A1
TIOCA1
Input/
output
GRA1 output compare or input capture pin
PWM output pin in PWM mode
Input capture/output
compare B1
TIOCB1
Input/
output
GRB1 output compare or input capture pin
Input capture/output
compare A2
TIOCA2
Input/
output
GRA2 output compare or input capture pin
PWM output pin in PWM mode
Input capture/output
compare B2
TIOCB2
Input/
output
GRB2 output compare or input capture pin
Input capture/output
compare A3
TIOCA3
Input/
output
GRA3 output compare or input capture pin
PWM output pin in PWM mode, complementary PWM mode, or reset-synchronized
PWM mode
Input capture/output
compare B3
TIOCB3
Input/
output
GRB3 output compare or input capture pin
PWM output pin in complementary PWM
mode or reset-synchronized PWM mode
Input capture/output
compare A4
TIOCA4
Input/
output
GRA4 output compare or input capture pin
PWM output pin in PWM mode, complementary PWM mode, or reset-synchronized
PWM mode
Input capture/output
compare B4
TIOCB4
Input/
output
GRB4 output compare or input capture pin
PWM output pin in complementary PWM
mode or reset-synchronized PWM mode
Output compare XA4 TOCXA4
Output
PWM output pin in complementary PWM
mode or reset-synchronized PWM mode
Output compare XB4 TOCXB4
Output
PWM output pin in complementary PWM
mode or reset-synchronized PWM mode
Channel
0
1
2
3
4
Name
285
Function
10.1.4 Register Configuration
Table 10-3 summarizes the ITU registers.
Table 10-3 ITU Registers
Channel
Address*1
Name
Abbreviation
R/W
Initial
Value
Common
H'FF60
Timer start register
TSTR
R/W
H'E0
H'FF61
Timer synchro register
TSNC
R/W
H'E0
H'FF62
Timer mode register
TMDR
R/W
H'80
H'FF63
Timer function control register
TFCR
R/W
H'C0
H'FF90
Timer output master enable register
TOER
R/W
H'FF
H'FF91
Timer output control register
TOCR
R/W
H'FF
H'FF64
Timer control register 0
TCR0
R/W
H'80
H'FF65
Timer I/O control register 0
TIOR0
R/W
H'88
H'FF66
Timer interrupt enable register 0
TIER0
R/W
H'F8
H'F8
0
1
H'FF67
Timer status register 0
TSR0
R/(W)*2
H'FF68
Timer counter 0 (high)
TCNT0H
R/W
H'00
H'FF69
Timer counter 0 (low)
TCNT0L
R/W
H'00
H'FF6A
General register A0 (high)
GRA0H
R/W
H'FF
H'FF6B
General register A0 (low)
GRA0L
R/W
H'FF
H'FF6C
General register B0 (high)
GRB0H
R/W
H'FF
H'FF6D
General register B0 (low)
GRB0L
R/W
H'FF
H'FF6E
Timer control register 1
TCR1
R/W
H'80
H'FF6F
Timer I/O control register 1
TIOR1
R/W
H'88
H'FF70
Timer interrupt enable register 1
TIER1
R/W
H'F8
H'F8
H'FF71
Timer status register 1
TSR1
R/(W)*2
H'FF72
Timer counter 1 (high)
TCNT1H
R/W
H'00
H'FF73
Timer counter 1 (low)
TCNT1L
R/W
H'00
H'FF74
General register A1 (high)
GRA1H
R/W
H'FF
H'FF75
General register A1 (low)
GRA1L
R/W
H'FF
H'FF76
General register B1 (high)
GRB1H
R/W
H'FF
H'FF77
General register B1 (low)
GRB1L
R/W
H'FF
Notes: 1. The lower 16 bits of the address are indicated.
2. Only 0 can be written, to clear flags.
286
Table 10-3 ITU Registers (cont)
Channel
Address*1
Name
Abbreviation
R/W
Initial
Value
2
H'FF78
Timer control register 2
TCR2
R/W
H'80
H'FF79
Timer I/O control register 2
TIOR2
R/W
H'88
H'FF7A
Timer interrupt enable register 2
TIER2
R/W
H'F8
H'F8
3
H'FF7B
Timer status register 2
TSR2
R/(W)*2
H'FF7C
Timer counter 2 (high)
TCNT2H
R/W
H'00
H'FF7D
Timer counter 2 (low)
TCNT2L
R/W
H'00
H'FF7E
General register A2 (high)
GRA2H
R/W
H'FF
H'FF7F
General register A2 (low)
GRA2L
R/W
H'FF
H'FF80
General register B2 (high)
GRB2H
R/W
H'FF
H'FF81
General register B2 (low)
GRB2L
R/W
H'FF
H'FF82
Timer control register 3
TCR3
R/W
H'80
H'FF83
Timer I/O control register 3
TIOR3
R/W
H'88
H'FF84
Timer interrupt enable register 3
TIER3
R/W
H'F8
H'F8
H'FF85
Timer status register 3
TSR3
R/(W)*2
H'FF86
Timer counter 3 (high)
TCNT3H
R/W
H'00
H'FF87
Timer counter 3 (low)
TCNT3L
R/W
H'00
H'FF88
General register A3 (high)
GRA3H
R/W
H'FF
H'FF89
General register A3 (low)
GRA3L
R/W
H'FF
H'FF8A
General register B3 (high)
GRB3H
R/W
H'FF
H'FF8B
General register B3 (low)
GRB3L
R/W
H'FF
H'FF8C
Buffer register A3 (high)
BRA3H
R/W
H'FF
H'FF8D
Buffer register A3 (low)
BRA3L
R/W
H'FF
H'FF8E
Buffer register B3 (high)
BRB3H
R/W
H'FF
H'FF8F
Buffer register B3 (low)
BRB3L
R/W
H'FF
Notes: 1. The lower 16 bits of the address are indicated.
2. Only 0 can be written, to clear flags.
287
Table 10-3 ITU Registers (cont)
Channel
Address*1
Name
Abbreviation
R/W
Initial
Value
4
H'FF92
Timer control register 4
TCR4
R/W
H'80
H'FF93
Timer I/O control register 4
TIOR4
R/W
H'88
H'FF94
Timer interrupt enable register 4
TIER4
R/W
H'F8
H'F8
H'FF95
Timer status register 4
TSR4
R/(W)*2
H'FF96
Timer counter 4 (high)
TCNT4H
R/W
H'00
H'FF97
Timer counter 4 (low)
TCNT4L
R/W
H'00
H'FF98
General register A4 (high)
GRA4H
R/W
H'FF
H'FF99
General register A4 (low)
GRA4L
R/W
H'FF
H'FF9A
General register B4 (high)
GRB4H
R/W
H'FF
H'FF9B
General register B4 (low)
GRB4L
R/W
H'FF
H'FF9C
Buffer register A4 (high)
BRA4H
R/W
H'FF
H'FF9D
Buffer register A4 (low)
BRA4L
R/W
H'FF
H'FF9E
Buffer register B4 (high)
BRB4H
R/W
H'FF
H'FF9F
Buffer register B4 (low)
BRB4L
R/W
H'FF
Notes: 1. The lower 16 bits of the address are indicated.
2. Only 0 can be written, to clear flags.
288
10.2 Register Descriptions
10.2.1 Timer Start Register (TSTR)
TSTR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that starts and stops the timer counter (TCNT) in
channels 0 to 4.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
—
—
STR4
STR3
STR2
STR1
STR0
Initial value
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
—
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Reserved bits
Counter start 4 to 0
These bits start and
stop TCNT4 to TCNT0
TSTR is initialized to H'E0 by a reset and in standby mode.
Bits 7 to 5—Reserved: These bits cannot be modified and are always read as 1.
Bit 4—Counter Start 4 (STR4): Starts and stops timer counter 4 (TCNT4).
Bit 4
STR4
Description
0
TCNT4 is halted
1
TCNT4 is counting
(Initial value)
Bit 3—Counter Start 3 (STR3): Starts and stops timer counter 3 (TCNT3).
Bit 3
STR3
Description
0
TCNT3 is halted
1
TCNT3 is counting
(Initial value)
Bit 2—Counter Start 2 (STR2): Starts and stops timer counter 2 (TCNT2).
Bit 2
STR2
Description
0
TCNT2 is halted
1
TCNT2 is counting
(Initial value)
289
Bit 1—Counter Start 1 (STR1): Starts and stops timer counter 1 (TCNT1).
Bit 1
STR1
Description
0
TCNT1 is halted
1
TCNT1 is counting
(Initial value)
Bit 0—Counter Start 0 (STR0): Starts and stops timer counter 0 (TCNT0).
Bit 0
STR0
Description
0
TCNT0 is halted
1
TCNT0 is counting
(Initial value)
10.2.2 Timer Synchro Register (TSNC)
TSNC is an 8-bit readable/writable register that selects whether channels 0 to 4 operate
independently or synchronously. Channels are synchronized by setting the corresponding bits to 1.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
—
—
SYNC4
SYNC3
SYNC2
SYNC1
SYNC0
Initial value
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
—
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Reserved bits
Timer sync 4 to 0
These bits synchronize
channels 4 to 0
TSNC is initialized to H'E0 by a reset and in standby mode.
Bits 7 to 5—Reserved:These bits cannot be modified and are always read as 1.
Bit 4—Timer Sync 4 (SYNC4): Selects whether channel 4 operates independently or
synchronously.
Bit 4
SYNC4
Description
0
Channel 4’s timer counter (TCNT4) operates independently
TCNT4 is preset and cleared independently of other channels
1
Channel 4 operates synchronously
TCNT4 can be synchronously preset and cleared
290
(Initial value)
Bit 3—Timer Sync 3 (SYNC3): Selects whether channel 3 operates independently or
synchronously.
Bit 3
SYNC3
Description
0
Channel 3’s timer counter (TCNT3) operates independently
TCNT3 is preset and cleared independently of other channels
1
Channel 3 operates synchronously
TCNT3 can be synchronously preset and cleared
(Initial value)
Bit 2—Timer Sync 2 (SYNC2): Selects whether channel 2 operates independently or
synchronously.
Bit 2
SYNC2
Description
0
Channel 2’s timer counter (TCNT2) operates independently
TCNT2 is preset and cleared independently of other channels
1
Channel 2 operates synchronously
TCNT2 can be synchronously preset and cleared
(Initial value)
Bit 1—Timer Sync 1 (SYNC1): Selects whether channel 1 operates independently or
synchronously.
Bit 1
SYNC1
Description
0
Channel 1’s timer counter (TCNT1) operates independently
TCNT1 is preset and cleared independently of other channels
1
Channel 1 operates synchronously
TCNT1 can be synchronously preset and cleared
(Initial value)
Bit 0—Timer Sync 0 (SYNC0): Selects whether channel 0 operates independently or
synchronously.
Bit 0
SYNC0
Description
0
Channel 0’s timer counter (TCNT0) operates independently
TCNT0 is preset and cleared independently of other channels
1
Channel 0 operates synchronously
TCNT0 can be synchronously preset and cleared
291
(Initial value)
10.2.3 Timer Mode Register (TMDR)
TMDR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that selects PWM mode for channels 0 to 4. It also
selects phase counting mode and the overflow flag (OVF) setting conditions for channel 2.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
MDF
FDIR
PWM4
PWM3
PWM2
PWM1
PWM0
Initial value
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
PWM mode 4 to 0
These bits select PWM
mode for channels 4 to 0
Flag direction
Selects the setting condition for the overflow
flag (OVF) in timer status register 2 (TSR2)
Phase counting mode flag
Selects phase counting mode for channel 2
Reserved bit
TMDR is initialized to H'80 by a reset and in standby mode.
Bit 7—Reserved:This bit cannot be modified and is, always read as 1.
Bit 6—Phase Counting Mode Flag (MDF): Selects whether channel 2 operates normally or in
phase counting mode.
Bit 6
MDF
Description
0
Channel 2 operates normally
1
Channel 2 operates in phase counting mode
(Initial value)
292
When MDF is set to 1 to select phase counting mode, TCNT2 operates as an up/down-counter and
pins TCLKA and TCLKB become counter clock input pins. TCNT2 counts both rising and falling
edges of TCLKA and TCLKB, and counts up or down as follows.
Counting Direction
Down-Counting
TCLKA pin
TCLKB pin
Up-Counting
High
Low
Low
High
Low
High
High
Low
In phase counting mode channel 2 operates as above regardless of the external clock edges
selected by bits CKEG1 and CKEG0 and the clock source selected by bits TPSC2 to TPSC0 in
TCR2. Phase counting mode takes precedence over these settings.
The counter clearing condition selected by the CCLR1 and CCLR0 bits in TCR2 and the compare
match/input capture settings and interrupt functions of TIOR2, TIER2, and TSR2 remain effective
in phase counting mode.
Bit 5—Flag Direction (FDIR): Designates the setting condition for the OVF flag in TSR2. The
FDIR designation is valid in all modes in channel 2.
Bit 5
FDIR
Description
0
OVF is set to 1 in TSR2 when TCNT2 overflows or underflows
1
OVF is set to 1 in TSR2 when TCNT2 overflows
(Initial value)
Bit 4—PWM Mode 4 (PWM4): Selects whether channel 4 operates normally or in PWM mode.
Bit 4
PWM4
Description
0
Channel 4 operates normally
1
Channel 4 operates in PWM mode
(Initial value)
When bit PWM4 is set to 1 to select PWM mode, pin TIOCA4 becomes a PWM output pin. The
output goes to 1 at compare match with GRA4, and to 0 at compare match with GRB4.
If complementary PWM mode or reset-synchronized PWM mode is selected by bits CMD1 and
CMD0 in TFCR, the CMD1 and CMD0 setting takes precedence and the PWM4 setting is
ignored.
293
Bit 3—PWM Mode 3 (PWM3): Selects whether channel 3 operates normally or in PWM mode.
Bit 3
PWM3
Description
0
Channel 3 operates normally
1
Channel 3 operates in PWM mode
(Initial value)
When bit PWM3 is set to 1 to select PWM mode, pin TIOCA3 becomes a PWM output pin. The
output goes to 1 at compare match with GRA3, and to 0 at compare match with general register
B3 (GRB3).
If complementary PWM mode or reset-synchronized PWM mode is selected by bits CMD1 and
CMD0 in TFCR, the CMD1 and CMD0 setting takes precedence and the PWM3 setting is
ignored.
Bit 2—PWM Mode 2 (PWM2): Selects whether channel 2 operates normally or in PWM mode.
Bit 2
PWM2
Description
0
Channel 2 operates normally
1
Channel 2 operates in PWM mode
(Initial value)
When bit PWM2 is set to 1 to select PWM mode, pin TIOCA2 becomes a PWM output pin. The
output goes to 1 at compare match with GRA2, and to 0 at compare match with GRB2.
Bit 1—PWM Mode 1 (PWM1): Selects whether channel 1 operates normally or in PWM mode.
Bit 1
PWM1
Description
0
Channel 1 operates normally
1
Channel 1 operates in PWM mode
(Initial value)
When bit PWM1 is set to 1 to select PWM mode, pin TIOCA1 becomes a PWM output pin. The
output goes to 1 at compare match with GRA1, and to 0 at compare match with GRB1.
294
Bit 0—PWM Mode 0 (PWM0): Selects whether channel 0 operates normally or in PWM mode.
Bit 0
PWM0
Description
0
Channel 0 operates normally
1
Channel 0 operates in PWM mode
(Initial value)
When bit PWM0 is set to 1 to select PWM mode, pin TIOCA0 becomes a PWM output pin. The
output goes to 1 at compare match with GRA0, and to 0 at compare match with GRB0.
10.2.4 Timer Function Control Register (TFCR)
TFCR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that selects complementary PWM mode, resetsynchronized PWM mode, and buffering for channels 3 and 4.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
—
CMD1
CMD0
BFB4
BFA4
BFB3
BFA3
Initial value
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Reserved bits
Combination mode 1/0
These bits select complementary
PWM mode or reset-synchronized
PWM mode for channels 3 and 4
Buffer mode B4 and A4
These bits select buffering of
general registers (GRB4 and
GRA4) by buffer registers
(BRB4 and BRA4) in channel 4
Buffer mode B3 and A3
These bits select buffering
of general registers (GRB3
and GRA3) by buffer
registers (BRB3 and BRA3)
in channel 3
TFCR is initialized to H'C0 by a reset and in standby mode.
Bits 7 and 6—Reserved: These bits cannot be modified and are always read as 1.
295
Bits 5 and 4—Combination Mode 1 and 0 (CMD1, CMD0): These bits select whether channels
3 and 4 operate in normal mode, complementary PWM mode, or reset-synchronized PWM mode.
Bit 5
CMD1
Bit 4
CMD0
Description
0
0
Channels 3 and 4 operate normally
(Initial value)
1
1
0
Channels 3 and 4 operate together in complementary PWM mode
1
Channels 3 and 4 operate together in reset-synchronized PWM mode
Before selecting reset-synchronized PWM mode or complementary PWM mode, halt the timer
counter or counters that will be used in these modes.
When these bits select complementary PWM mode or reset-synchronized PWM mode, they take
precedence over the setting of the PWM mode bits (PWM4 and PWM3) in TMDR. Settings of
timer sync bits SYNC4 and SYNC3 in TSNC are valid in complementary PWM mode and resetsynchronized PWM mode, however. When complementary PWM mode is selected, channels 3
and 4 must not be synchronized (do not set bits SYNC3 and SYNC4 both to 1 in TSNC).
Bit 3—Buffer Mode B4 (BFB4): Selects whether GRB4 operates normally in channel 4, or
whether GRB4 is buffered by BRB4.
Bit 3
BFB4
Description
0
GRB4 operates normally
1
GRB4 is buffered by BRB4
(Initial value)
Bit 2—Buffer Mode A4 (BFA4): Selects whether GRA4 operates normally in channel 4, or
whether GRA4 is buffered by BRA4.
Bit 2
BFA4
Description
0
GRA4 operates normally
1
GRA4 is buffered by BRA4
(Initial value)
296
Bit 1—Buffer Mode B3 (BFB3): Selects whether GRB3 operates normally in channel 3, or
whether GRB3 is buffered by BRB3.
Bit 1
BFB3
Description
0
GRB3 operates normally
1
GRB3 is buffered by BRB3
(Initial value)
Bit 0—Buffer Mode A3 (BFA3): Selects whether GRA3 operates normally in channel 3, or
whether GRA3 is buffered by BRA3.
Bit 0
BFA3
Description
0
GRA3 operates normally
1
GRA3 is buffered by BRA3
(Initial value)
10.2.5 Timer Output Master Enable Register (TOER)
TOER is an 8-bit readable/writable register that enables or disables output settings for channels 3
and 4.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
—
EXB4
EXA4
EB3
EB4
EA4
EA3
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read/Write
—
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Reserved bits
Master enable TOCXA4, TOCXB4
These bits enable or disable output
settings for pins TOCXA4and TOCXB4
Master enable TIOCA3, TIOCB3 , TIOCA4, TIOCB4
These bits enable or disable output settings for pins
TIOCA3, TIOCB3 , TIOCA4, and TIOCB4
TOER is initialized to H'FF by a reset and in standby mode.
Bits 7 and 6—Reserved: These bits cannot be modified and are always read as 1.
297
Bit 5—Master Enable TOCXB4 (EXB4): Enables or disables ITU output at pin TOCXB4.
Bit 5
EXB4
Description
0
TOCXB4 output is disabled regardless of TFCR settings (TOCXB4operates as a generic
input/output pin).
If XTGD = 0, EXB4 is cleared to 0 when input capture A occurs in channel 1.
1
TOCXB4 is enabled for output according to TFCR settings
(Initial value)
Bit 4—Master Enable TOCXA4 (EXA4): Enables or disables ITU output at pin TOCXA4.
Bit 4
EXA4
Description
0
TOCXA4 output is disabled regardless of TFCR settings (TOCXA4 operates as a generic
input/output pin).
If XTGD = 0, EXA4 is cleared to 0 when input capture A occurs in channel 1.
1
TOCXA4 is enabled for output according to TFCR settings
(Initial value)
Bit 3—Master Enable TIOCB3 (EB3): Enables or disables ITU output at pin TIOCB3.
Bit 3
EB3
Description
0
TIOCB3 output is disabled regardless of TIOR3 and TFCR settings (TIOCB3 operates as
a generic input/output pin).
If XTGD = 0, EB3 is cleared to 0 when input capture A occurs in channel 1.
1
TIOCB3 is enabled for output according to TIOR3 and TFCR settings
298
(Initial value)
Bit 2—Master Enable TIOCB4 (EB4): Enables or disables ITU output at pin TIOCB4.
Bit 2
EB4
Description
0
TIOCB4 output is disabled regardless of TIOR4 and TFCR settings (TIOCB4 operates as
a generic input/output pin).
If XTGD = 0, EB4 is cleared to 0 when input capture A occurs in channel 1.
1
TIOCB4 is enabled for output according to TIOR4 and TFCR settings
(Initial value)
Bit 1—Master Enable TIOCA4 (EA4): Enables or disables ITU output at pin TIOCA4.
Bit 1
EA4
Description
0
TIOCA4 output is disabled regardless of TIOR4, TMDR, and TFCR settings (TIOCA4
operates as a generic input/output pin).
If XTGD = 0, EA4 is cleared to 0 when input capture A occurs in channel 1.
1
TIOCA4 is enabled for output according to TIOR4, TMDR, and
TFCR settings
(Initial value)
Bit 0—Master Enable TIOCA3 (EA3): Enables or disables ITU output at pin TIOCA3.
Bit 0
EA3
Description
0
TIOCA3 output is disabled regardless of TIOR3, TMDR, and TFCR settings (TIOCA3
operates as a generic input/output pin).
If XTGD = 0, EA3 is cleared to 0 when input capture A occurs in channel 1.
1
TIOCA3 is enabled for output according to TIOR3, TMDR, and
TFCR settings
299
(Initial value)
10.2.6 Timer Output Control Register (TOCR)
TOCR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that selects externally triggered disabling of output in
complementary PWM mode and reset-synchronized PWM mode, and inverts the output levels.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
—
—
XTGD
—
—
OLS4
OLS3
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read/Write
—
—
—
R/W
—
—
R/W
R/W
Reserved bits
Output level select 3, 4
These bits select output
levels in complementary
PWM mode and resetsynchronized PWM mode
Reserved bits
External trigger disable
Selects externally triggered disabling of output in
complementary PWM mode and reset-synchronized
PWM mode
The settings of the XTGD, OLS4, and OLS3 bits are valid only in complementary PWM mode
and reset-synchronized PWM mode. These settings do not affect other modes.
TOCR is initialized to H'FF by a reset and in standby mode.
Bits 7 to 5—Reserved: These bits cannot be modified and are always read as 1.
Bit 4—External Trigger Disable (XTGD): Selects externally triggered disabling of ITU output
in complementary PWM mode and reset-synchronized PWM mode.
Bit 4
XTGD
Description
0
Input capture A in channel 1 is used as an external trigger signal in complementary PWM
mode and reset-synchronized PWM mode.
When an external trigger occurs, bits 5 to 0 in TOER are cleared to 0, disabling ITU
output.
1
External triggering is disabled
(Initial value)
300
Bits 3 and 2—Reserved: These bits cannot be modified and are always read as 1.
Bit 1—Output Level Select 4 (OLS4): Selects output levels in complementary PWM mode and
reset-synchronized PWM mode.
Bit 1
OLS4
Description
0
TIOCA3, TIOCA4, and TIOCB4 outputs are inverted
1
TIOCA3, TIOCA4, and TIOCB4 outputs are not inverted
(Initial value)
Bit 0—Output Level Select 3 (OLS3): Selects output levels in complementary PWM mode and
reset-synchronized PWM mode.
Bit 0
OLS3
Description
0
TIOCB3, TOCXA4, and TOCXB4 outputs are inverted
1
TIOCB3, TOCXA4, and TOCXB4 outputs are not inverted
(Initial value)
10.2.7 Timer Counters (TCNT)
TCNT is a 16-bit counter. The ITU has five TCNTs, one for each channel.
Channel
Abbreviation
Function
0
TCNT0
Up-counter
1
TCNT1
2
TCNT2
Phase counting mode: up/down-counter
Other modes: up-counter
3
TCNT3
4
TCNT4
Complementary PWM mode: up/down-counter
Other modes: up-counter
Bit
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Each TCNT is a 16-bit readable/writable register that counts pulse inputs from a clock source. The
clock source is selected by bits TPSC2 to TPSC0 in TCR.
301
TCNT0 and TCNT1 are up-counters. TCNT2 is an up/down-counter in phase counting mode and
an up-counter in other modes. TCNT3 and TCNT4 are up/down-counters in complementary PWM
mode and up-counters in other modes.
TCNT can be cleared to H'0000 by compare match with GRA or GRB or by input capture to GRA
or GRB (counter clearing function) in the same channel.
When TCNT overflows (changes from H'FFFF to H'0000), the OVF flag is set to 1 in the timer
status register (TSR) of the corresponding channel.
When TCNT underflows (changes from H'0000 to H'FFFF), the OVF flag is set to 1 in TSR of the
corresponding channel.
The TCNTs are linked to the CPU by an internal 16-bit bus and can be written or read by either
word access or byte access.
Each TCNT is initialized to H'0000 by a reset and in standby mode.
10.2.8 General Registers (GRA, GRB)
The general registers are 16-bit registers. The ITU has 10 general registers, two in each channel.
Channel
Abbreviation
Function
0
GRA0, GRB0
Output compare/input capture register
1
GRA1, GRB1
2
GRA2, GRB2
3
GRA3, GRB3
4
GRA4, GRB4
Output compare/input capture register; can be buffered by buffer
registers BRA and BRB
Bit
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read/Write
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
A general register is a 16-bit readable/writable register that can function as either an output
compare register or an input capture register. The function is selected by settings in TIOR.
When a general register is used as an output compare register, its value is constantly compared
with the TCNT value. When the two values match (compare match), the IMFA or IMFB flag is set
to 1 in TSR. Compare match output can be selected in TIOR.
302
When a general register is used as an input capture register, rising edges, falling edges, or both
edges of an external input capture signal are detected and the current TCNT value is stored in the
general register. The corresponding IMFA or IMFB flag in TSR is set to 1 at the same time. The
valid edge or edges of the input capture signal are selected in TIOR.
TIOR settings are ignored in PWM mode, complementary PWM mode, and reset-synchronized
PWM mode.
General registers are linked to the CPU by an internal 16-bit bus and can be written or read by
either word access or byte access.
General registers are initialized to the output compare function (with no output signal) by a reset
and in standby mode. The initial value is H'FFFF.
10.2.9 Buffer Registers (BRA, BRB)
The buffer registers are 16-bit registers. The ITU has four buffer registers, two each in channels 3
and 4.
Channel
Abbreviation
Function
3
BRA3, BRB3
Used for buffering
4
BRA4, BRB4
• When the corresponding GRA or GRB functions as an output
compare register, BRA or BRB can function as an output compare
buffer register: the BRA or BRB value is automatically transferred
to GRA or GRB at compare match
• When the corresponding GRA or GRB functions as an input
capture register, BRA or BRB can function as an input capture
buffer register: the GRA or GRB value is automatically transferred
to BRA or BRB at input capture
Bit
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read/Write
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
A buffer register is a 16-bit readable/writable register that is used when buffering is selected.
Buffering can be selected independently by bits BFB4, BFA4, BFB3, and BFA3 in TFCR.
The buffer register and general register operate as a pair. When the general register functions as an
output compare register, the buffer register functions as an output compare buffer register. When
the general register functions as an input capture register, the buffer register functions as an input
capture buffer register.
303
The buffer registers are linked to the CPU by an internal 16-bit bus and can be written or read by
either word or byte access.
Buffer registers are initialized to H'FFFF by a reset and in standby mode.
10.2.10 Timer Control Registers (TCR)
TCR is an 8-bit register. The ITU has five TCRs, one in each channel.
Channel
Abbreviation
Function
0
TCR0
1
TCR1
2
TCR2
TCR controls the timer counter. The TCRs in all channels are
functionally identical. When phase counting mode is selected in
channel 2, the settings of bits CKEG1 and CKEG0 and TPSC2 to
TPSC0 in TCR2 are ignored.
3
TCR3
4
TCR4
Bit
7
6
5
—
CCLR1
CCLR0
Initial value
1
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
4
3
2
1
0
TPSC2
TPSC1
TPSC0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CKEG1 CKEG0
Timer prescaler 2 to 0
These bits select the
counter clock
Clock edge 1/0
These bits select external clock edges
Counter clear 1/0
These bits select the counter clear source
Reserved bit
Each TCR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that selects the timer counter clock source, selects
the edge or edges of external clock sources, and selects how the counter is cleared.
TCR is initialized to H'80 by a reset and in standby mode.
Bit 7—Reserved: This bit cannot be modified and is always read as 1.
304
Bits 6 and 5—Counter Clear 1/0 (CCLR1, CCLR0): These bits select how TCNT is cleared.
Bit 6
CCLR1
Bit 5
CCLR0
Description
0
0
TCNT is not cleared
1
(Initial value)
capture*1
1
TCNT is cleared by GRA compare match or input
0
TCNT is cleared by GRB compare match or input capture*1
1
Synchronous clear: TCNT is cleared in synchronization with other
synchronized timers*2
Notes: 1. TCNT is cleared by compare match when the general register functions as an output
compare register, and by input capture when the general register functions as an input
capture register.
2. Selected in TSNC.
Bits 4 and 3—Clock Edge 1/0 (CKEG1, CKEG0): These bits select external clock input edges
when an external clock source is used.
Bit 4
CKEG1
Bit 3
CKEG0
Description
0
0
Count rising edges
1
Count falling edges
—
Count both edges
1
(Initial value)
When channel 2 is set to phase counting mode, bits CKEG1 and CKEG0 in TCR2 are ignored.
Phase counting takes precedence.
305
Bits 2 to 0—Timer Prescaler 2 to 0 (TPSC2 to TPSC0): These bits select the counter clock
source.
Bit 2
TPSC2
Bit 1
TPSC1
Bit 0
TPSC0
Function
0
0
0
Internal clock: ø
1
Internal clock: ø/2
0
Internal clock: ø/4
1
Internal clock: ø/8
0
External clock A: TCLKA input
1
External clock B: TCLKB input
0
External clock C: TCLKC input
1
External clock D: TCLKD input
1
1
0
1
(Initial value)
When bit TPSC2 is cleared to 0 an internal clock source is selected, and the timer counts only
falling edges. When bit TPSC2 is set to 1 an external clock source is selected, and the timer
counts the edge or edges selected by bits CKEG1 and CKEG0.
When channel 2 is set to phase counting mode (MDF = 1 in TMDR), the settings of bits TPSC2 to
TPSC0 in TCR2 are ignored. Phase counting takes precedence.
10.2.11 Timer I/O Control Register (TIOR)
TIOR is an 8-bit register. The ITU has five TIORs, one in each channel.
Channel
Abbreviation
Function
0
TIOR0
1
TIOR1
2
TIOR2
TIOR controls the general registers. Some functions differ in PWM
mode. TIOR3 and TIOR4 settings are ignored when complementary
PWM mode or reset-synchronized PWM mode is selected in
channels 3 and 4.
3
TIOR3
4
TIOR4
306
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
IOB2
IOB1
IOB0
—
IOA2
IOA1
IOA0
Initial value
1
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
I/O control A2 to A0
These bits select GRA
functions
Reserved bit
I/O control B2 to B0
These bits select GRB functions
Reserved bit
Each TIOR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that selects the output compare or input capture
function for GRA and GRB, and specifies the functions of the TIOCA and TIOCB pins. If the
output compare function is selected, TIOR also selects the type of output. If input capture is
selected, TIOR also selects the edge or edges of the input capture signal.
TIOR is initialized to H'88 by a reset and in standby mode.
Bit 7—Reserved: This bit cannot be modified and is always read as 1.
Bits 6 to 4—I/O Control B2 to B0 (IOB2 to IOB0): These bits select the GRB function.
Bit 6
IOB2
Bit 5
IOB1
Bit 4
IOB0
0
0
0
1
1
1
0
GRB is an output
compare register
No output at compare match
0 output at GRB compare
(Initial value)
match*1
0
1 output at GRB compare match*1
1
Output toggles at GRB compare match
(1 output in channel 2)*1, *2
0
1
1
Function
0
GRB is an input
capture register
GRB captures rising edge of input
GRB captures falling edge of input
GRB captures both edges of input
1
Notes: 1. After a reset, the output is 0 until the first compare match.
2. Channel 2 output cannot be toggled by compare match. This setting selects 1 output
instead.
307
Bit 3—Reserved: This bit cannot be modified and is always read as 1.
Bits 2 to 0—I/O Control A2 to A0 (IOA2 to IOA0): These bits select the GRA function.
Bit 2
IOA2
Bit 1
IOA1
Bit 0
IOA0
0
0
0
1
1
1
0
GRA is an output
compare register
No output at compare match
0 output at GRA compare
(Initial value)
match*1
0
1 output at GRA compare match*1
1
Output toggles at GRA compare match
(1 output in channel 2)*1, *2
0
1
1
Function
GRA is an input
capture register
GRA captures rising edge of input
GRA captures falling edge of input
0
GRA captures both edges of input
1
Notes: 1. After a reset, the output is 0 until the first compare match.
2. Channel 2 output cannot be toggled by compare match. This setting selects 1 output
instead.
10.2.12 Timer Status Register (TSR)
TSR is an 8-bit register. The ITU has five TSRs, one in each channel.
Channel
Abbreviation
Function
0
TSR0
Indicates input capture, compare match, and overflow status
1
TSR1
2
TSR2
3
TSR3
4
TSR4
308
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
—
—
—
—
OVF
IMFB
IMFA
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
—
—
—
—
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
Bit
Reserved bits
Overflow flag
Status flag indicating
overflow or underflow
Input capture/compare match flag B
Status flag indicating GRB compare
match or input capture
Input capture/compare match flag A
Status flag indicating GRA compare
match or input capture
Note: * Only 0 can be written, to clear the flag.
Each TSR is an 8-bit readable/writable register containing flags that indicate TCNT overflow or
underflow and GRA or GRB compare match or input capture. These flags are interrupt sources
and generate CPU interrupts if enabled by corresponding bits in TIER.
TSR is initialized to H'F8 by a reset and in standby mode.
Bits 7 to 3—Reserved: These bits cannot be modified and are always read as 1.
Bit 2—Overflow Flag (OVF): This status flag indicates TCNT overflow or underflow.
Bit 2
OVF
Description
0
[Clearing condition]
Read OVF when OVF = 1, then write 0 in OVF
(Initial value)
1
[Setting condition]
TCNT overflowed from H'FFFF to H'0000, or underflowed from H'0000 to H'FFFF*
Notes: * TCNT underflow occurs when TCNT operates as an up/down-counter. Underflow occurs
only under the following conditions:
1. Channel 2 operates in phase counting mode (MDF = 1 in TMDR)
2. Channels 3 and 4 operate in complementary PWM mode (CMD1 = 1 and CMD0 = 0 in
TFCR)
309
Bit 1—Input Capture/Compare Match Flag B (IMFB): This status flag indicates GRB
compare match or input capture events.
Bit 1
IMFB
Description
0
[Clearing condition]
Read IMFB when IMFB = 1, then write 0 in IMFB
(Initial value)
1
[Setting conditions]
TCNT = GRB when GRB functions as an output compare register.
TCNT value is transferred to GRB by an input capture signal, when GRB functions as
an input capture register.
Bit 0—Input Capture/Compare Match Flag A (IMFA): This status flag indicates GRA
compare match or input capture events.
Bit 0
IMFA
Description
0
[Clearing condition]
Read IMFA when IMFA = 1, then write 0 in IMFA.
DMAC activated by IMIA interrupt (channels 0 to 3 only).
1
[Setting conditions]
TCNT = GRA when GRA functions as an output compare register.
TCNT value is transferred to GRA by an input capture signal, when GRA functions
as an input capture register.
310
(Initial value)
10.2.13 Timer Interrupt Enable Register (TIER)
TIER is an 8-bit register. The ITU has five TIERs, one in each channel.
Channel
Abbreviation
Function
0
TIER0
Enables or disables interrupt requests.
1
TIER1
2
TIER2
3
TIER3
4
TIER4
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
—
—
—
—
OVIE
IMIEB
IMIEA
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
—
—
—
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
Reserved bits
Overflow interrupt enable
Enables or disables OVF
interrupts
Input capture/compare match
interrupt enable B
Enables or disables IMFB interrupts
Input capture/compare match
interrupt enable A
Enables or disables IMFA
interrupts
Each TIER is an 8-bit readable/writable register that enables and disables overflow interrupt
requests and general register compare match and input capture interrupt requests.
TIER is initialized to H'F8 by a reset and in standby mode.
Bits 7 to 3—Reserved: These bits cannot be modified and are always read as 1.
311
Bit 2—Overflow Interrupt Enable (OVIE): Enables or disables the interrupt requested by the
OVF flag in TSR when OVF is set to 1.
Bit 2
OVIE
Description
0
OVI interrupt requested by OVF is disabled
1
OVI interrupt requested by OVF is enabled
(Initial value)
Bit 1—Input Capture/Compare Match Interrupt Enable B (IMIEB): Enables or disables the
interrupt requested by the IMFB flag in TSR when IMFB is set to 1.
Bit 1
IMIEB
Description
0
IMIB interrupt requested by IMFB is disabled
1
IMIB interrupt requested by IMFB is enabled
(Initial value)
Bit 0—Input Capture/Compare Match Interrupt Enable A (IMIEA): Enables or disables the
interrupt requested by the IMFA flag in TSR when IMFA is set to 1.
Bit 0
IMIEA
Description
0
IMIA interrupt requested by IMFA is disabled
1
IMIA interrupt requested by IMFA is enabled
312
(Initial value)
10.3 CPU Interface
10.3.1 16-Bit Accessible Registers
The timer counters (TCNTs), general registers A and B (GRAs and GRBs), and buffer registers A
and B (BRAs and BRBs) are 16-bit registers, and are linked to the CPU by an internal 16-bit data
bus. These registers can be written or read a word at a time, or a byte at a time.
Figures 10-6 and 10-7 show examples of word access to a timer counter (TCNT). Figures 10-8,
10-9, 10-10, and 10-11 show examples of byte access to TCNTH and TCNTL.
On-chip data bus
H
CPU
H
L
Bus interface
L
TCNTH
Module
data bus
TCNTL
Figure 10-6 Access to Timer Counter (CPU Writes to TCNT, Word)
On-chip data bus
H
CPU
L
H
Bus interface
L
TCNTH
TCNTL
Figure 10-7 Access to Timer Counter (CPU Reads TCNT, Word)
313
Module
data bus
On-chip data bus
H
CPU
L
H
Bus interface
L
TCNTH
Module
data bus
TCNTL
Figure 10-8 Access to Timer Counter (CPU Writes to TCNT, Upper Byte)
On-chip data bus
H
CPU
L
H
Bus interface
L
TCNTH
Module
data bus
TCNTL
Figure 10-9 Access to Timer Counter (CPU Writes to TCNT, Lower Byte)
On-chip data bus
H
CPU
L
H
Bus interface
L
TCNTH
TCNTL
Figure 10-10 Access to Timer Counter (CPU Reads TCNT, Upper Byte)
314
Module
data bus
On-chip data bus
H
CPU
H
L
Bus interface
L
TCNTH
Module
data bus
TCNTL
Figure 10-11 Access to Timer Counter (CPU Reads TCNT, Lower Byte)
10.3.2 8-Bit Accessible Registers
The registers other than the timer counters, general registers, and buffer registers are 8-bit
registers. These registers are linked to the CPU by an internal 8-bit data bus.
Figures 10-12 and 10-13 show examples of byte read and write access to a TCR.
If a word-size data transfer instruction is executed, two byte transfers are performed.
On-chip data bus
H
CPU
L
H
Bus interface
L
TCR
Figure 10-12 TCR Access (CPU Writes to TCR)
315
Module
data bus
On-chip data bus
H
CPU
L
H
Bus interface
L
TCR
Figure 10-13 TCR Access (CPU Reads TCR)
316
Module
data bus
10.4 Operation
10.4.1 Overview
A summary of operations in the various modes is given below.
Normal Operation: Each channel has a timer counter and general registers. The timer counter
counts up, and can operate as a free-running counter, periodic counter, or external event counter.
General registers A and B can be used for input capture or output compare.
Synchronous Operation: The timer counters in designated channels are preset synchronously.
Data written to the timer counter in any one of these channels is simultaneously written to the
timer counters in the other channels as well. The timer counters can also be cleared synchronously
if so designated by the CCLR1 and CCLR0 bits in the TCRs.
PWM Mode: A PWM waveform is output from the TIOCA pin. The output goes to 1 at compare
match A and to 0 at compare match B. The duty cycle can be varied from 0% to 100% depending
on the settings of GRA and GRB. When a channel is set to PWM mode, its GRA and GRB
automatically become output compare registers.
Reset-Synchronized PWM Mode: Channels 3 and 4 are paired for three-phase PWM output with
complementary waveforms. (The three phases are related by having a common transition point.)
When reset-synchronized PWM mode is selected GRA3, GRB3, GRA4, and GRB4 automatically
function as output compare registers, TIOCA3, TIOCB3, TIOCA4, TOCXA4, TIOCB4, and
TOCXB4 function as PWM output pins, and TCNT3 operates as an up-counter. TCNT4 operates
independently, and is not compared with GRA4 or GRB4.
Complementary PWM Mode: Channels 3 and 4 are paired for three-phase PWM output with
non-overlapping complementary waveforms. When complementary PWM mode is selected
GRA3, GRB3, GRA4, and GRB4 automatically function as output compare registers, and
TIOCA3, TIOCB3, TIOCA4, TOCXA4, TIOCB4, and TOCXB4 function as PWM output pins.
TCNT3 and TCNT4 operate as up/down-counters.
Phase Counting Mode: The phase relationship between two clock signals input at TCLKA and
TCLKB is detected and TCNT2 counts up or down accordingly. When phase counting mode is
selected TCLKA and TCLKB become clock input pins and TCNT2 operates as an up/downcounter.
317
Buffering :
•
If the general register is an output compare register
When compare match occurs the buffer register value is transferred to the general register.
•
If the general register is an input capture register
When input capture occurs the TCNT value is transferred to the general register, and the
previous general register value is transferred to the buffer register.
•
Complementary PWM mode
The buffer register value is transferred to the general register when TCNT3 and TCNT4
change counting direction.
•
Reset-synchronized PWM mode
The buffer register value is transferred to the general register at GRA3 compare match.
10.4.2 Basic Functions
Counter Operation: When one of bits STR0 to STR4 is set to 1 in the timer start register
(TSTR), the timer counter (TCNT) in the corresponding channel starts counting. The counting can
be free-running or periodic.
•
Sample setup procedure for counter
Figure 10-14 shows a sample procedure for setting up a counter.
318
Counter setup
Select counter clock
Type of counting?
1
No
Yes
Free-running counting
Periodic counting
Select counter clear source
2
Select output compare
register function
3
Set period
4
Start counter
5
Start counter
Periodic counter
5
Free-running counter
Figure 10-14 Counter Setup Procedure (Example)
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Set bits TPSC2 to TPSC0 in TCR to select the counter clock source. If an external clock
source is selected, set bits CKEG1 and CKEG0 in TCR to select the desired edge(s) of the
external clock signal.
For periodic counting, set CCLR1 and CCLR0 in TCR to have TCNT cleared at GRA
compare match or GRB compare match.
Set TIOR to select the output compare function of GRA or GRB, whichever was selected in
step 2.
Write the count period in GRA or GRB, whichever was selected in step 2.
Set the STR bit to 1 in TSTR to start the timer counter.
319
•
Free-running and periodic counter operation
A reset leaves the counters (TCNTs) in ITU channels 0 to 4 all set as free-running counters. A
free-running counter starts counting up when the corresponding bit in TSTR is set to 1. When
the count overflows from H'FFFF to H'0000, the OVF flag is set to 1 in TSR. If the
corresponding OVIE bit is set to 1 in TIER, a CPU interrupt is requested. After the overflow,
the counter continues counting up from H'0000. Figure 10-15 illustrates free-running
counting.
TCNT value
H'FFFF
H'0000
Time
STR0 to
STR4 bit
OVF
Figure 10-15 Free-Running Counter Operation
When a channel is set to have its counter cleared by compare match, in that channel TCNT
operates as a periodic counter. Select the output compare function of GRA or GRB, set bit
CCLR1 or CCLR0 in TCR to have the counter cleared by compare match, and set the count
period in GRA or GRB. After these settings, the counter starts counting up as a periodic
counter when the corresponding bit is set to 1 in TSTR. When the count matches GRA or
GRB, the IMFA or IMFB flag is set to 1 in TSR and the counter is cleared to H'0000. If the
corresponding IMIEA or IMIEB bit is set to 1 in TIER, a CPU interrupt is requested at this
time. After the compare match, TCNT continues counting up from H'0000. Figure 10-16
illustrates periodic counting.
320
TCNT value
Counter cleared by general
register compare match
GR
Time
H'0000
STR bit
IMF
Figure 10-16 Periodic Counter Operation
•
TCNT count timing
— Internal clock source
Bits TPSC2 to TPSC0 in TCR select the system clock (ø) or one of three internal clock
sources obtained by prescaling the system clock (ø/2, ø/4, ø/8).
Figure 10-17 shows the timing.
ø
Internal
clock
TCNT input
TCNT
N–1
N
Figure 10-17 Count Timing for Internal Clock Sources
321
N+1
— External clock source
Bits TPSC2 to TPSC0 in TCR select an external clock input pin (TCLKA to TCLKD),
and its valid edge or edges are selected by bits CKEG1 and CKEG0. The rising edge,
falling edge, or both edges can be selected.
The pulse width of the external clock signal must be at least 1.5 system clocks when a
single edge is selected, and at least 2.5 system clocks when both edges are selected.
Shorter pulses will not be counted correctly.
Figure 10-18 shows the timing when both edges are detected.
ø
External
clock input
TCNT input
TCNT
N–1
N
N+1
Figure 10-18 Count Timing for External Clock Sources (when Both Edges are Detected)
322
Waveform Output by Compare Match: In ITU channels 0, 1, 3, and 4, compare match A or B
can cause the output at the TIOCA or TIOCB pin to go to 0, go to 1, or toggle. In channel 2 the
output can only go to 0 or go to 1.
•
Sample setup procedure for waveform output by compare match
Figure 10-19 shows a sample procedure for setting up waveform output by compare match.
Output setup
1. Select the compare match output mode (0, 1, or
toggle) in TIOR. When a waveform output mode
is selected, the pin switches from its generic input/
output function to the output compare function
(TIOCA or TIOCB). An output compare pin outputs
0 until the first compare match occurs.
Select waveform
output mode
1
Set output timing
2
2. Set a value in GRA or GRB to designate the
compare match timing.
Start counter
3
3. Set the STR bit to 1 in TSTR to start the timer
counter.
Waveform output
Figure 10-19 Setup Procedure for Waveform Output by Compare Match (Example)
•
Examples of waveform output
Figure 10-20 shows examples of 0 and 1 output. TCNT operates as a free-running counter, 0
output is selected for compare match A, and 1 output is selected for compare match B. When
the pin is already at the selected output level, the pin level does not change.
323
TCNT value
H'FFFF
GRB
GRA
Time
H'0000
TIOCB
TIOCA
No change
No change
No change
No change
1 output
0 output
Figure 10-20 0 and 1 Output (Examples)
Figure 10-21 shows examples of toggle output. TCNT operates as a periodic counter, cleared
by compare match B. Toggle output is selected for both compare match A and B.
TCNT value
Counter cleared by compare match with GRB
GRB
GRA
H'0000
Time
TIOCB
Toggle
output
TIOCA
Toggle
output
Figure 10-21 Toggle Output (Example)
324
•
Output compare timing
The compare match signal is generated in the last state in which TCNT and the general
register match (when TCNT changes from the matching value to the next value). When the
compare match signal is generated, the output value selected in TIOR is output at the output
compare pin (TIOCA or TIOCB). When TCNT matches a general register, the compare
match signal is not generated until the next counter clock pulse.
Figure 10-22 shows the output compare timing.
ø
TCNT input
clock
TCNT
N
GR
N
N+1
Compare
match signal
TIOCA,
TIOCB
Figure 10-22 Output Compare Timing
Input Capture Function: The TCNT value can be captured into a general register when a
transition occurs at an input capture/output compare pin (TIOCA or TIOCB). Capture can take
place on the rising edge, falling edge, or both edges. The input capture function can be used to
measure pulse width or period.
•
Sample setup procedure for input capture
Figure 10-23 shows a sample procedure for setting up input capture.
325
Input selection
Select input-capture input
1
Start counter
2
1. Set TIOR to select the input capture function of a
general register and the rising edge, falling edge,
or both edges of the input capture signal. Clear the
port data direction bit to 0 before making these
TIOR settings.
2. Set the STR bit to 1 in TSTR to start the timer
counter.
Input capture
Figure 10-23 Setup Procedure for Input Capture (Example)
•
Examples of input capture
Figure 10-24 illustrates input capture when the falling edge of TIOCB and both edges of
TIOCA are selected as capture edges. TCNT is cleared by input capture into GRB.
TCNT value
Counter cleared by TIOCB
input (falling edge)
H'0180
H'0160
H'0005
H'0000
Time
TIOCB
TIOCA
GRA
H'0005
H'0160
GRB
H'0180
Figure 10-24 Input Capture (Example)
326
•
Input capture signal timing
Input capture on the rising edge, falling edge, or both edges can be selected by settings in
TIOR. Figure 10-25 shows the timing when the rising edge is selected. The pulse width of the
input capture signal must be at least 1.5 system clocks for single-edge capture, and 2.5 system
clocks for capture of both edges.
ø
Input-capture input
Internal input
capture signal
N
TCNT
N
GRA, GRB
Figure 10-25 Input Capture Signal Timing
327
10.4.3 Synchronization
The synchronization function enables two or more timer counters to be synchronized by writing
the same data to them simultaneously (synchronous preset). With appropriate TCR settings, two or
more timer counters can also be cleared simultaneously (synchronous clear). Synchronization
enables additional general registers to be associated with a single time base. Synchronization can
be selected for all channels (0 to 4).
Sample Setup Procedure for Synchronization: Figure 10-26 shows a sample procedure for
setting up synchronization.
Setup for synchronization
Select synchronization
1
Synchronous preset
Write to TCNT
Synchronous clear
2
Clearing
synchronized to this
channel?
No
Yes
Synchronous preset
Select counter clear source
3
Select counter clear source
4
Start counter
5
Start counter
5
Counter clear
Synchronous clear
1. Set the SYNC bits to 1 in TSNC for the channels to be synchronized.
2. When a value is written in TCNT in one of the synchronized channels, the same value is
simultaneously written in TCNT in the other channels (synchronized preset).
3. Set the CCLR1 or CCLR0 bit in TCR to have the counter cleared by compare match or input capture.
4. Set the CCLR1 and CCLR0 bits in TCR to have the counter cleared synchronously.
5. Set the STR bits in TSTR to 1 to start the synchronized counters.
Figure 10-26 Setup Procedure for Synchronization (Example)
328
Example of Synchronization: Figure 10-27 shows an example of synchronization. Channels 0, 1,
and 2 are synchronized, and are set to operate in PWM mode. Channel 0 is set for counter clearing
by compare match with GRB0. Channels 1 and 2 are set for synchronous counter clearing. The
timer counters in channels 0, 1, and 2 are synchronously preset, and are synchronously cleared by
compare match with GRB0. A three-phase PWM waveform is output from pins TIOCA0,
TIOCA1, and TIOCA2. For further information on PWM mode, see section 10.4.4, PWM Mode.
Value of TCNT0 to TCNT2
Cleared by compare match with GRB0
GRB0
GRB1
GRA0
GRB2
GRA1
GRA2
Time
H'0000
TIOCA0
TIOCA1
TIOCA2
Figure 10-27 Synchronization (Example)
329
10.4.4 PWM Mode
In PWM mode GRA and GRB are paired and a PWM waveform is output from the TIOCA pin.
GRA specifies the time at which the PWM output changes to 1. GRB specifies the time at which
the PWM output changes to 0. If either GRA or GRB is selected as the counter clear source, a
PWM waveform with a duty cycle from 0% to 100% is output at the TIOCA pin. PWM mode can
be selected in all channels (0 to 4).
Table 10-4 summarizes the PWM output pins and corresponding registers. If the same value is set
in GRA and GRB, the output does not change when compare match occurs.
Table 10-4 PWM Output Pins and Registers
Channel
Output Pin
1 Output
0 Output
0
TIOCA0
GRA0
GRB0
1
TIOCA1
GRA1
GRB1
2
TIOCA2
GRA2
GRB2
3
TIOCA3
GRA3
GRB3
4
TIOCA4
GRA4
GRB4
330
Sample Setup Procedure for PWM Mode: Figure 10-28 shows a sample procedure for setting
up PWM mode.
PWM mode
Select counter clock
1
Select counter clear source
2
Set GRA
3
Set GRB
4
Select PWM mode
5
Start counter
6
1. Set bits TPSC2 to TPSC0 in TCR to
select the counter clock source. If an
external clock source is selected, set
bits CKEG1 and CKEG0 in TCR to
select the desired edge(s) of the
external clock signal.
2. Set bits CCLR1 and CCLR0 in TCR
to select the counter clear source.
3. Set the time at which the PWM
waveform should go to 1 in GRA.
4. Set the time at which the PWM
waveform should go to 0 in GRB.
5. Set the PWM bit in TMDR to select
PWM mode. When PWM mode is
selected, regardless of the TIOR
contents, GRA and GRB become
output compare registers specifying
the times at which the PWM output
goes to 1 and 0. The TIOCA pin
automatically becomes the PWM
output pin. The TIOCB pin conforms
to the settings of bits IOB1 and IOB0
in TIOR. If TIOCB output is not
desired, clear both IOB1 and IOB0 to 0.
6. Set the STR bit to 1 in TSTR to start
the timer counter.
PWM mode
Figure 10-28 Setup Procedure for PWM Mode (Example)
331
Examples of PWM Mode: Figure 10-29 shows examples of operation in PWM mode. In PWM
mode TIOCA becomes an output pin. The output goes to 1 at compare match with GRA, and to 0
at compare match with GRB.
In the examples shown, TCNT is cleared by compare match with GRA or GRB. Synchronized
operation and free-running counting are also possible.
TCNT value
Counter cleared by compare match with GRA
GRA
GRB
Time
H'0000
TIOCA
a. Counter cleared by GRA
TCNT value
Counter cleared by compare match with GRB
GRB
GRA
Time
H'0000
TIOCA
b. Counter cleared by GRB
Figure 10-29 PWM Mode (Example 1)
332
Figure 10-30 shows examples of the output of PWM waveforms with duty cycles of 0% and
100%. If the counter is cleared by compare match with GRB, and GRA is set to a higher value
than GRB, the duty cycle is 0%. If the counter is cleared by compare match with GRA, and GRB
is set to a higher value than GRA, the duty cycle is 100%.
TCNT value
Counter cleared by compare match with GRB
GRB
GRA
H'0000
Time
TIOCA
Write to GRA
Write to GRA
a. 0% duty cycle
TCNT value
Counter cleared by compare match with GRA
GRA
GRB
H'0000
Time
TIOCA
Write to GRB
Write to GRB
b. 100% duty cycle
Figure 10-30 PWM Mode (Example 2)
333
10.4.5 Reset-Synchronized PWM Mode
In reset-synchronized PWM mode channels 3 and 4 are combined to produce three pairs of
complementary PWM waveforms, all having one waveform transition point in common.
When reset-synchronized PWM mode is selected TIOCA3, TIOCB3, TIOCA4, TOCXA4, TIOCB4,
and TOCXB4 automatically become PWM output pins, and TCNT3 functions as an up-counter.
Table 10-5 lists the PWM output pins. Table 10-6 summarizes the register settings.
Table 10-5 Output Pins in Reset-Synchronized PWM Mode
Channel
Output Pin
Description
3
TIOCA3
PWM output 1
TIOCB3
PWM output 1´ (complementary waveform to PWM output 1)
TIOCA4
PWM output 2
TOCXA4
PWM output 2´ (complementary waveform to PWM output 2)
TIOCB4
PWM output 3
TOCXB4
PWM output 3´ (complementary waveform to PWM output 3)
4
Table 10-6 Register Settings in Reset-Synchronized PWM Mode
Register
Setting
TCNT3
Initially set to H'0000
TCNT4
Not used (operates independently)
GRA3
Specifies the count period of TCNT3
GRB3
Specifies a transition point of PWM waveforms output from TIOCA3 and TIOCB3
GRA4
Specifies a transition point of PWM waveforms output from TIOCA4 and TOCXA4
GRB4
Specifies a transition point of PWM waveforms output from TIOCB4 and TOCXB4
334
Sample Setup Procedure for Reset-Synchronized PWM Mode: Figure 10-31 shows a sample
procedure for setting up reset-synchronized PWM mode.
Reset-synchronized PWM mode
Stop counter
1
Select counter clock
2
Select counter clear source
3
Select reset-synchronized
PWM mode
4
Set TCNT
5
Set general registers
6
Start counter
7
Reset-synchronized PWM mode
1. Clear the STR3 bit in TSTR to 0 to
halt TCNT3. Reset-synchronized
PWM mode must be set up while
TCNT3 is halted.
2. Set bits TPSC2 to TPSC0 in TCR to
select the counter clock source for
channel 3. If an external clock source
is selected, select the external clock
edge(s) with bits CKEG1 and CKEG0
in TCR.
3. Set bits CCLR1 and CCLR0 in TCR3
to select GRA3 compare match as
the counter clear source.
4. Set bits CMD1 and CMD0 in TFCR to
select reset-synchronized PWM mode.
TIOCA3, TIOCB3, TIOCA4, TIOCB4,
TOCXA4, and TOCXB4 automatically
become PWM output pins.
5. Preset TCNT3 to H'0000. TCNT4
need not be preset.
6. GRA3 is the waveform period register.
Set the waveform period value in
GRA3. Set transition times of the
PWM output waveforms in GRB3,
GRA4, and GRB4. Set times within
the compare match range of TCNT3.
X ≤ GRA3 (X: setting value)
7. Set the STR3 bit in TSTR to 1 to start
TCNT3.
Figure 10-31 Setup Procedure for Reset-Synchronized PWM Mode (Example)
335
Example of Reset-Synchronized PWM Mode: Figure 10-32 shows an example of operation in
reset-synchronized PWM mode. TCNT3 operates as an up-counter in this mode. TCNT4 operates
independently, detached from GRA4 and GRB4. When TCNT3 matches GRA3, TCNT3 is
cleared and resumes counting from H'0000. The PWM outputs toggle at compare match of
TCNT3 with GRB3, GRA4, and GRB4, respectively, and all toggle when the counter is cleared.
TCNT3 value
Counter cleared at compare match with GRA3
GRA3
GRB3
GRA4
GRB4
H'0000
Time
TIOCA3
TIOCB3
TIOCA4
TOCXA4
TIOCB4
TOCXB4
Figure 10-32 Operation in Reset-Synchronized PWM Mode (Example, OLS3 = OLS4 = 1)
For the settings and operation when reset-synchronized PWM mode and buffer mode are both
selected, see section 10.4.8, Buffering.
336
10.4.6 Complementary PWM Mode
In complementary PWM mode channels 3 and 4 are combined to output three pairs of
complementary, non-overlapping PWM waveforms.
When complementary PWM mode is selected TIOCA3, TIOCB3, TIOCA4, TOCXA4, TIOCB4,
and TOCXB4 automatically become PWM output pins, and TCNT3 and TCNT4 function as
up/down-counters.
Table 10-7 lists the PWM output pins. Table 10-8 summarizes the register settings.
Table 10-7 Output Pins in Complementary PWM Mode
Channel
Output Pin
Description
3
TIOCA3
PWM output 1
TIOCB3
PWM output 1´ (non-overlapping complementary waveform to PWM
output 1)
TIOCA4
PWM output 2
TOCXA4
PWM output 2´ (non-overlapping complementary waveform to PWM
output 2)
TIOCB4
PWM output 3
TOCXB4
PWM output 3´ (non-overlapping complementary waveform to PWM
output 3)
4
Table 10-8 Register Settings in Complementary PWM Mode
Register
Setting
TCNT3
Initially specifies the non-overlap margin (difference to TCNT4)
TCNT4
Initially set to H'0000
GRA3
Specifies the upper limit value of TCNT3 minus 1
GRB3
Specifies a transition point of PWM waveforms output from TIOCA3 and TIOCB3
GRA4
Specifies a transition point of PWM waveforms output from TIOCA4 and TOCXA4
GRB4
Specifies a transition point of PWM waveforms output from TIOCB4 and TOCXB4
337
Setup Procedure for Complementary PWM Mode: Figure 10-33 shows a sample procedure for
setting up complementary PWM mode.
Complementary PWM mode
Stop counting
1
Select counter clock
2
Select complementary
PWM mode
3
Set TCNTs
4
Set general registers
5
Start counters
6
Complementary PWM mode
1. Clear bits STR3 and STR4 to 0 in
TSTR to halt the timer counters.
Complementary PWM mode must be
set up while TCNT3 and TCNT4 are
halted.
2. Set bits TPSC2 to TPSC0 in TCR to
select the same counter clock source
for channels 3 and 4. If an external
clock source is selected, select the
external clock edge(s) with bits
CKEG1 and CKEG0 in TCR. Do not
select any counter clear source
with bits CCLR1 and CCLR0 in TCR.
3. Set bits CMD1 and CMD0 in TFCR
to select complementary PWM mode.
TIOCA3, TIOCB3, TIOCA4, TIOCB4,
TOCXA4, and TOCXB4 automatically
become PWM output pins.
4. Clear TCNT4 to H'0000. Set the
non-overlap margin in TCNT3. Do not
set TCNT3 and TCNT4 to the same
value.
5. GRA3 is the waveform period
register. Set the upper limit value of
TCNT3 minus 1 in GRA3. Set
transition times of the PWM output
waveforms in GRB3, GRA4, and
GRB4. Set times within the compare
match range of TCNT3 and TCNT4.
T ≤ X (X: initial setting of GRB3,
GRA4, or GRB4. T: initial setting of
TCNT3)
6. Set bits STR3 and STR4 in TSTR to
1 to start TCNT3 and TCNT4.
Note: After exiting complementary PWM mode, to resume operating in complementary
PWM mode, follow the entire setup procedure from step 1 again.
Figure 10-33 Setup Procedure for Complementary PWM Mode (Example)
338
Clearing Procedure for Complementary PWM Mode: Figure 10-34 shows the steps to clear
complementary PWM mode.
Complementary PWM mode
Clear complementary
PWM mode
1
Stop counter operation
2
Normal operating mode
1. Clear bit CMD1 bit of TFCR to 0 to set
channels 3 and 4 to normal operating mode.
2. After setting channels 3 and 4 to normal
operating mode, wait at least one counter
clock period, then clear bits STR3 and
STR4 of TSTR to 0 to stop counter operation
of TCNT3 andTCNT4.
Figure 10-34 Clearing Procedure for Complementary PWM Mode
339
Examples of Complementary PWM Mode: Figure 10-35 shows an example of operation in
complementary PWM mode. TCNT3 and TCNT4 operate as up/down-counters, counting down
from compare match between TCNT3 and GRA3 and counting up from the point at which
TCNT4 underflows. During each up-and-down counting cycle, PWM waveforms are generated by
compare match with general registers GRB3, GRA4, and GRB4. Since TCNT3 is initially set to a
higher value than TCNT4, compare match events occur in the sequence TCNT3, TCNT4, TCNT4,
TCNT3.
TCNT3 and
TCNT4 values
Down-counting starts at compare
match between TCNT3 and GRA3
GRA3
TCNT3
GRB3
GRA4
GRB4
TCNT4
Time
H'0000
TIOCA3
Up-counting starts when
TCNT4 underflows
TIOCB3
TIOCA4
TOCXA4
TIOCB4
TOCXB4
Figure 10-35 Operation in Complementary PWM Mode (Example 1, OLS3 = OLS4 = 1)
340
Figure 10-36 shows examples of waveforms with 0% and 100% duty cycles (in one phase) in
complementary PWM mode. In this example the outputs change at compare match with GRB3, so
waveforms with duty cycles of 0% or 100% can be output by setting GRB3 to a value larger than
GRA3. The duty cycle can be changed easily during operation by use of the buffer registers. For
further information see section 10.4.8, Buffering.
TCNT3 and
TCNT4 values
GRA3
GRB3
Time
H'0000
TIOCA3
TIOCB3
0% duty cycle
a. 0% duty cycle
TCNT3 and
TCNT4 values
GRA3
GRB3
H'0000
Time
TIOCA3
TIOCB3
100% duty cycle
b. 100% duty cycle
Figure 10-36 Operation in Complementary PWM Mode (Example 2, OLS3 = OLS4 = 1)
341
In complementary PWM mode, TCNT3 and TCNT4 overshoot and undershoot at the transitions
between up-counting and down-counting. The setting conditions for the IMFA bit in channel 3
and the OVF bit in channel 4 differ from the usual conditions. In buffered operation the buffer
transfer conditions also differ. Timing diagrams are shown in figures 10-37 and 10-38.
TCNT3
N–1
N
N+1
GRA3
N
N–1
N
Flag not set
IMFA
Set to 1
Buffer transfer
signal (BR to GR)
GR
Buffer transfer
No buffer transfer
Figure 10-37 Overshoot Timing
342
Underflow
TCNT4
H'0001
H'0000
Overflow
H'FFFF
H'0000
Flag not set
OVF
Set to 1
Buffer transfer
signal (BR to GR)
GR
Buffer transfer
No buffer transfer
Figure 10-38 Undershoot Timing
In channel 3, IMFA is set to 1 only during up-counting. In channel 4, OVF is set to 1 only when
an underflow occurs. When buffering is selected, buffer register contents are transferred to the
general register at compare match A3 during up-counting, and when TCNT4 underflows.
General Register Settings in Complementary PWM Mode: When setting up general registers
for complementary PWM mode or changing their settings during operation, note the following
points.
•
Initial settings
Do not set values from H'0000 to T – 1 (where T is the initial value of TCNT3). After the
counters start and the first compare match A3 event has occurred, however, settings in this
range also become possible.
•
Changing settings
Use the buffer registers. Correct waveform output may not be obtained if a general register is
written to directly.
•
Cautions on changes of general register settings
Figure 10-39 shows six correct examples and one incorrect example.
343
GRA3
GR
H'0000
Not allowed
BR
GR
Figure 10-39 Changing a General Register Setting by Buffer Transfer (Example 1)
— Buffer transfer at transition from up-counting to down-counting
If the general register value is in the range from GRA3 – T + 1 to GRA3, do not transfer a
buffer register value outside this range. Conversely, if the general register value is outside
this range, do not transfer a value within this range. See figure 10-40.
GRA3 + 1
GRA3
Illegal changes
GRA3 – T + 1
GRA3 – T
TCNT3
TCNT4
Figure 10-40 Changing a General Register Setting by Buffer Transfer (Caution 1)
344
— Buffer transfer at transition from down-counting to up-counting
If the general register value is in the range from H'0000 to T – 1, do not transfer a buffer
register value outside this range. Conversely, when a general register value is outside this
range, do not transfer a value within this range. See figure 10-41.
TCNT3
TCNT4
T
T–1
Illegal changes
H'0000
H'FFFF
Figure 10-41 Changing a General Register Setting by Buffer Transfer (Caution 2)
345
— General register settings outside the counting range (H'0000 to GRA3)
Waveforms with a duty cycle of 0% or 100% can be output by setting a general register to
a value outside the counting range. When a buffer register is set to a value outside the
counting range, then later restored to a value within the counting range, the counting
direction (up or down) must be the same both times. See figure 10-42.
GRA3
GR
H'0000
0% duty cycle
100% duty cycle
Output pin
Output pin
BR
GR
Write during down-counting
Write during up-counting
Figure 10-42 Changing a General Register Setting by Buffer Transfer (Example 2)
Settings can be made in this way by detecting GRA3 compare match or TCNT4
underflow before writing to the buffer register. They can also be made by using GRA3
compare match to activate the DMAC.
346
10.4.7 Phase Counting Mode
In phase counting mode the phase difference between two external clock inputs (at the TCLKA
and TCLKB pins) is detected, and TCNT2 counts up or down accordingly.
In phase counting mode, the TCLKA and TCLKB pins automatically function as external clock
input pins and TCNT2 becomes an up/down-counter, regardless of the settings of bits TPSC2 to
TPSC0, CKEG1, and CKEG0 in TCR2. Settings of bits CCLR1, CCLR0 in TCR2, and settings in
TIOR2, TIER2, TSR2, GRA2, and GRB2 are valid. The input capture and output compare
functions can be used, and interrupts can be generated.
Phase counting is available only in channel 2.
Sample Setup Procedure for Phase Counting Mode: Figure 10-43 shows a sample procedure
for setting up phase counting mode.
Phase counting mode
Select phase counting mode
1
Select flag setting condition
2
Start counter
3
1. Set the MDF bit in TMDR to 1 to select
phase counting mode.
2. Select the flag setting condition with
the FDIR bit in TMDR.
3. Set the STR2 bit to 1 in TSTR to start
the timer counter.
Phase counting mode
Figure 10-43 Setup Procedure for Phase Counting Mode (Example)
347
Example of Phase Counting Mode: Figure 10-44 shows an example of operations in phase
counting mode. Table 10-9 lists the up-counting and down-counting conditions for TCNT2.
In phase counting mode both the rising and falling edges of TCLKA and TCLKB are counted.
The phase difference between TCLKA and TCLKB must be at least 1.5 states, the phase overlap
must also be at least 1.5 states, and the pulse width must be at least 2.5 states. See figure 10-45.
TCNT2 value
Counting up
Counting down
Time
TCLKB
TCLKA
Figure 10-44 Operation in Phase Counting Mode (Example)
Table 10-9 Up/Down Counting Conditions
Counting Direction
Up-Counting
TCLKB
Down-Counting
High
TCLKA
Low
Phase
difference
Low
High
Phase
difference
High
Low
Low
Pulse width
High
Pulse width
TCLKA
TCLKB
Overlap
Overlap
Phase difference and overlap: at least 1.5 states
Pulse width:
at least 2.5 states
Figure 10-45 Phase Difference, Overlap, and Pulse Width in Phase Counting Mode
348
10.4.8 Buffering
Buffering operates differently depending on whether a general register is an output compare
register or an input capture register, with further differences in reset-synchronized PWM mode
and complementary PWM mode. Buffering is available only in channels 3 and 4. Buffering
operations under the conditions mentioned above are described next.
•
General register used for output compare
The buffer register value is transferred to the general register at compare match. See
figure 10-46.
Compare match signal
BR
GR
Comparator
TCNT
Figure 10-46 Compare Match Buffering
•
General register used for input capture
The TCNT value is transferred to the general register at input capture. The previous general
register value is transferred to the buffer register.
See figure 10-47.
Input capture signal
BR
GR
Figure 10-47 Input Capture Buffering
349
TCNT
•
Complementary PWM mode
The buffer register value is transferred to the general register when TCNT3 and TCNT4
change counting direction. This occurs at the following two times:
— When TCNT3 matches GRA3
— When TCNT4 underflows
•
Reset-synchronized PWM mode
The buffer register value is transferred to the general register at compare match A3.
Sample Buffering Setup Procedure: Figure 10-48 shows a sample buffering setup procedure.
Buffering
Select general register functions
1
Set buffer bits
2
Start counters
3
1. Set TIOR to select the output compare or input
capture function of the general registers.
2. Set bits BFA3, BFA4, BFB3, and BFB4 in TFCR
to select buffering of the required general registers.
3. Set the STR bits to 1 in TSTR to start the timer
counters.
Buffered operation
Figure 10-48 Buffering Setup Procedure (Example)
350
Examples of Buffering: Figure 10-49 shows an example in which GRA is set to function as an
output compare register buffered by BRA, TCNT is set to operate as a periodic counter cleared by
GRB compare match, and TIOCA and TIOCB are set to toggle at compare match A and B.
Because of the buffer setting, when TIOCA toggles at compare match A, the BRA value is
simultaneously transferred to GRA. This operation is repeated each time compare match A occurs.
Figure 10-50 shows the transfer timing.
TCNT value
Counter cleared by compare match B
GRB
H'0250
H'0200
H'0100
H'0000
Time
BRA
H'0200
GRA
H'0250
H'0200
H'0100
H'0200
H'0100
H'0200
TIOCB
Toggle
output
TIOCA
Toggle
output
Compare match A
Figure 10-49 Register Buffering (Example 1: Buffering of Output Compare Register)
351
ø
n
TCNT
n+1
Compare
match signal
Buffer transfer
signal
N
BR
GR
n
N
Figure 10-50 Compare Match and Buffer Transfer Timing (Example)
352
Figure 10-51 shows an example in which GRA is set to function as an input capture register
buffered by BRA, and TCNT is cleared by input capture B. The falling edge is selected as the
input capture edge at TIOCB. Both edges are selected as input capture edges at TIOCA. Because
of the buffer setting, when the TCNT value is captured into GRA at input capture A, the previous
GRA value is simultaneously transferred to BRA. Figure 10-52 shows the transfer timing.
TCNT value
Counter cleared by
input capture B
H'0180
H'0160
H'0005
H'0000
Time
TIOCB
TOICA
GRA
H'0005
H'0160
H'0160
H'0005
BRA
GRB
H'0180
Input capture A
Figure 10-51 Register Buffering (Example 2: Buffering of Input Capture Register)
353
ø
TIOC pin
Input capture
signal
TCNT
n
n+1
N
N+1
GR
M
n
n
N
BR
m
M
M
n
Figure 10-52 Input Capture and Buffer Transfer Timing (Example)
354
Figure 10-53 shows an example in which GRB3 is buffered by BRB3 in complementary PWM
mode. Buffering is used to set GRB3 to a higher value than GRA3, generating a PWM waveform
with 0% duty cycle. The BRB3 value is transferred to GRB3 when TCNT3 matches GRA3, and
when TCNT4 underflows.
TCNT3 and
TCNT4 values
TCNT3
H'1FFF
GRA3
GRB3
TCNT4
H'0999
H'0000
BRB3
GRB3
Time
H'1FFF
H'0999
H'0999
H'0999
H'0999
H'1FFF
H'1FFF
H'0999
TIOCA3
TIOCB3
Figure 10-53 Register Buffering (Example 4: Buffering in Complementary PWM Mode)
355
10.4.9 ITU Output Timing
The ITU outputs from channels 3 and 4 can be disabled by bit settings in TOER or by an external
trigger, or inverted by bit settings in TOCR.
Timing of Enabling and Disabling of ITU Output by TOER: In this example an ITU output is
disabled by clearing a master enable bit to 0 in TOER. An arbitrary value can be output by
appropriate settings of the data register (DR) and data direction register (DDR) of the
corresponding input/output port. Figure 10-54 illustrates the timing of the enabling and disabling
of ITU output by TOER.
T1
T2
T3
ø
Address
TOER address
TOER
ITU output pin
Timer output
ITU output
I/O port
Generic input/output
Figure 10-54 Timing of Disabling of ITU Output by Writing to TOER (Example)
356
Timing of Disabling of ITU Output by External Trigger: If the XTGD bit is cleared to 0 in
TOCR in reset-synchronized PWM mode or complementary PWM mode, when an input capture
A signal occurs in channel 1, the master enable bits are cleared to 0 in TOER, disabling ITU
output. Figure 10-55 shows the timing.
ø
TIOCA1 pin
Input capture
signal
N
TOER
ITU output
pins
H'C0
N
ITU output
I/O port
Generic
input/output
ITU output
ITU output
ITU output
H'C0
I/O port
Generic
input/output
N: Arbitrary setting (H'C1 to H'FF)
Figure 10-55 Timing of Disabling of ITU Output by External Trigger (Example)
Timing of Output Inversion by TOCR: The output levels in reset-synchronized PWM mode and
complementary PWM mode can be inverted by inverting the output level select bits (OLS4 and
OLS3) in TOCR. Figure 10-56 shows the timing.
T1
T2
T3
ø
Address
TOCR address
TOCR
ITU output pin
Inverted
Figure 10-56 Timing of Inverting of ITU Output Level by Writing to TOCR (Example)
357
10.5 Interrupts
The ITU has two types of interrupts: input capture/compare match interrupts, and overflow
interrupts.
10.5.1 Setting of Status Flags
Timing of Setting of IMFA and IMFB at Compare Match: IMFA and IMFB are set to 1 by a
compare match signal generated when TCNT matches a general register (GR). The compare
match signal is generated in the last state in which the values match (when TCNT is updated from
the matching count to the next count). Therefore, when TCNT matches a general register, the
compare match signal is not generated until the next timer clock input. Figure 10-57 shows the
timing of the setting of IMFA and IMFB.
ø
TCNT input
clock
TCNT
N
N+1
GR
N
Compare
match signal
IMF
IMI
Figure 10-57 Timing of Setting of IMFA and IMFB by Compare Match
358
Timing of Setting of IMFA and IMFB by Input Capture: IMFA and IMFB are set to 1 by an
input capture signal. The TCNT contents are simultaneously transferred to the corresponding
general register. Figure 10-58 shows the timing.
ø
Input capture
signal
IMF
N
TCNT
GR
N
IMI
Figure 10-58 Timing of Setting of IMFA and IMFB by Input Capture
Timing of Setting of Overflow Flag (OVF): OVF is set to 1 when TCNT overflows from
H'FFFF to H'0000 or underflows from H'0000 to H'FFFF. Figure 10-59 shows the timing.
359
ø
TCNT
H'FFFF
H'0000
Overflow
signal
OVF
OVI
Figure 10-59 Timing of Setting of OVF
10.5.2 Clearing of Status Flags
If the CPU reads a status flag while it is set to 1, then writes 0 in the status flag, the status flag is
cleared. Figure 10-60 shows the timing.
TSR write cycle
T1
T2
T3
ø
Address
TSR address
IMF, OVF
Figure 10-60 Timing of Clearing of Status Flags
360
10.5.3 Interrupt Sources and DMA Controller Activation
Each ITU channel can generate a compare match/input capture A interrupt, a compare match/input
capture B interrupt, and an overflow interrupt. In total there are 15 interrupt sources, all
independently vectored. An interrupt is requested when the interrupt request flag and interrupt
enable bit are both set to 1.
The priority order of the channels can be modified in interrupt priority registers A and B (IPRA
and IPRB). For details see section 5, Interrupt Controller.
Compare match/input capture A interrupts in channels 0 to 3 can activate the DMA controller
(DMAC). When the DMAC is activated a CPU interrupt is not requested.
Table 10-10 lists the interrupt sources.
Table 10-10 ITU Interrupt Sources
Channel
Interrupt
Source
Description
DMAC
Activatable
Priority*
0
IMIA0
Compare match/input capture A0
Yes
High
IMIB0
Compare match/input capture B0
No
OVI0
Overflow 0
No
IMIA1
Compare match/input capture A1
Yes
IMIB1
Compare match/input capture B1
No
OVI1
Overflow 1
No
IMIA2
Compare match/input capture A2
Yes
IMIB2
Compare match/input capture B2
No
OVI2
Overflow 2
No
IMIA3
Compare match/input capture A3
Yes
IMIB3
Compare match/input capture B3
No
OVI3
Overflow 3
No
IMIA4
Compare match/input capture A4
No
IMIB4
Compare match/input capture B4
No
OVI4
Overflow 4
No
1
2
3
4
Low
Note: * The priority immediately after a reset is indicated. Inter-channel priorities can be changed
by settings in IPRA and IPRB.
361
10.6 Usage Notes
This section describes contention and other matters requiring special attention during ITU
operations.
Contention between TCNT Write and Clear: If a counter clear signal occurs in the T3 state of a
TCNT write cycle, clearing of the counter takes priority and the write is not performed. See
figure 10-61.
TCNT write cycle
T2
T1
T3
ø
Address
TCNT address
Internal write signal
Counter clear signal
TCNT
N
H'0000
Figure 10-61 Contention between TCNT Write and Clear
362
Contention between TCNT Word Write and Increment: If an increment pulse occurs in the T3
state of a TCNT word write cycle, writing takes priority and TCNT is not incremented. See
figure 10-62.
TCNT word write cycle
T1
T2
T3
ø
Address
TCNT address
Internal write signal
TCNT input clock
TCNT
N
M
TCNT write data
Figure 10-62 Contention between TCNT Word Write and Increment
363
Contention between TCNT Byte Write and Increment: If an increment pulse occurs in the T2
or T3 state of a TCNT byte write cycle, writing takes priority and TCNT is not incremented. The
TCNT byte that was not written retains its previous value. See figure 10-63, which shows an
increment pulse occurring in the T2 state of a byte write to TCNTH.
TCNTH byte write cycle
T2
T1
T3
ø
TCNTH address
Address
Internal write signal
TCNT input clock
TCNTH
N
M
TCNT write data
TCNTL
X
X+1
X
Figure 10-63 Contention between TCNT Byte Write and Increment
364
Contention between General Register Write and Compare Match: If a compare match occurs
in the T3 state of a general register write cycle, writing takes priority and the compare match
signal is inhibited. See figure 10-64.
General register write cycle
T2
T1
T3
ø
GR address
Address
Internal write signal
TCNT
N
GR
N
N+1
M
General register write data
Compare match signal
Inhibited
Figure 10-64 Contention between General Register Write and Compare Match
365
Contention between TCNT Write and Overflow or Underflow: If an overflow occurs in the T3
state of a TCNT write cycle, writing takes priority and the counter is not incremented. OVF is
set to 1.The same holds for underflow. See figure 10-65.
TCNT write cycle
T1
T2
T3
ø
Address
TCNT address
Internal write signal
TCNT input clock
Overflow signal
TCNT
H'FFFF
M
TCNT write data
OVF
Figure 10-65 Contention between TCNT Write and Overflow
366
Contention between General Register Read and Input Capture: If an input capture signal
occurs during the T3 state of a general register read cycle, the value before input capture is read.
See figure 10-66.
General register read cycle
T1
T2
T3
ø
GR address
Address
Internal read signal
Input capture signal
GR
X
Internal data bus
M
X
Figure 10-66 Contention between General Register Read and Input Capture
367
Contention between Counter Clearing by Input Capture and Counter Increment: If an input
capture signal and counter increment signal occur simultaneously, the counter is cleared according
to the input capture signal. The counter is not incremented by the increment signal. The value
before the counter is cleared is transferred to the general register. See figure 10-67.
ø
Input capture signal
Counter clear signal
TCNT input clock
N
TCNT
GR
H'0000
N
Figure 10-67 Contention between Counter Clearing by Input Capture and
Counter Increment
368
Contention between General Register Write and Input Capture: If an input capture signal
occurs in the T3 state of a general register write cycle, input capture takes priority and the write to
the general register is not performed. See figure 10-68.
General register write cycle
T1
T2
T3
ø
Address
GR address
Internal write signal
Input capture signal
M
TCNT
GR
M
Figure 10-68 Contention between General Register Write and Input Capture
Note on Waveform Period Setting: When a counter is cleared by compare match, the counter is
cleared in the last state at which the TCNT value matches the general register value, at the time
when this value would normally be updated to the next count. The actual counter frequency is
therefore given by the following formula:
f=
ø
(N + 1)
(f: counter frequency. ø: system clock frequency. N: value set in general register.)
369
Contention between Buffer Register Write and Input Capture: If a buffer register is used for
input capture buffering and an input capture signal occurs in the T3 state of a write cycle, input
capture takes priority and the write to the buffer register is not performed.
See figure 10-69.
Buffer register write cycle
T1
T2
T3
ø
Address
BR address
Internal write signal
Input capture signal
GR
N
X
TCNT value
BR
M
N
Figure 10-69 Contention between Buffer Register Write and Input Capture
370
Note on Synchronous Preset: When channels are synchronized, if a TCNT value is modified by
byte write access, all 16 bits of all synchronized counters assume the same value as the counter
that was addressed.
(Example) When channels 2 and 3 are synchronized
• Byte write to channel 2 or byte write to channel 3
TCNT2
W
X
TCNT3
Y
Z
Upper byte Lower byte
Write A to upper byte
of channel 2
TCNT2
A
X
TCNT3
A
X
Upper byte Lower byte
Write A to lower byte
of channel 3
TCNT2
Y
A
TCNT3
Y
A
Upper byte Lower byte
• Word write to channel 2 or word write to channel 3
TCNT2
W
X
TCNT3
Y
Z
Write AB word to
channel 2 or 3
Upper byte Lower byte
TCNT2
A
B
TCNT3
A
B
Upper byte Lower byte
Note on Setup of Reset-Synchronized PWM Mode and Complementary PWM Mode: When
setting bits CMD1 and CMD0 in TFCR, take the following precautions:
•
Write to bits CMD1 and CMD0 only when TCNT3 and TCNT4 are stopped.
•
Do not switch directly between reset-synchronized PWM mode and complementary PWM
mode. First switch to normal mode (by clearing bit CMD1 to 0), then select resetsynchronized PWM mode or complementary PWM mode.
371
372
—
—
—
o
o
o
SYNC0 = 1 —
Input capture B
Counter By compare
clearing match/input
capture A
By compare
match/input
capture B
Synchronous
clear
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
o
—
o
o
PWM0 = 0 —
PWM0 = 0 —
o
PWM0 = 0 —
PWM0 = 1 —
o
TFCR
TOCR
Register Settings
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Master
Enable
TOER
o*
o
IOB
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
Clear
Select
o
o
o
TCR0
o
o
o
o
o
o
Clock
Select
CCLR1 = 1 o
CCLR0 = 1
CCLR1 = 1 o
CCLR0 = 0
CCLR1 = 0 o
CCLR0 = 1
IOB2 = 1
o
Other bits
unrestricted
o
IOB2 = 0
o
Other bits
unrestricted
IOA2 = 1
o
Other bits
unrestricted
o
IOA2 = 0
o
Other bits
unrestricted
—
o
IOA
TIOR0
Note: * The input capture function cannot be used in PWM mode. If compare match A and compare match B occur simultaneously, the compare match signal is inhibited.
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
ResetComple- SynchroOutput
mentary nized
BufferLevel
PWM
PWM
ing
XTGD Select
Legend: o Setting available (valid). — Setting does not affect this mode.
—
—
o
Output compare B
o
—
o
Output compare A
Input capture A
—
—
—
—
SYNC0 = 1 —
o
Synchronous preset
PWM mode
FDIR PWM
Synchronization
Operating Mode
MDF
TMDR
TSNC
Table 10-11 (a) ITU Operating Modes (Channel 0)
ITU Operating Modes
373
—
o
SYNC1 = 1 —
By compare
match/input
capture B
Synchronous
clear
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
o
—
o
o
PWM1 = 0 —
PWM1 = 0 —
o
PWM1 = 0 —
PWM1 = 1 —
o
TOCR
Register Settings
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
o*2
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
ResetComple- SynchroOutput
mentary nized
BufferLevel
PWM
PWM
ing
XTGD Select
TFCR
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Master
Enable
TOER
o*1
o
IOB
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
Clear
Select
o
o
o
TCR1
o
o
o
o
o
o
Clock
Select
CCLR1 = 1 o
CCLR0 = 1
CCLR1 = 1 o
CCLR0 = 0
CCLR1 = 0 o
CCLR0 = 1
IOB2 = 1
o
Other bits
unrestricted
o
IOB2 = 0
o
Other bits
unrestricted
IOA2 = 1
o
Other bits
unrestricted
o
IOA2 = 0
o
Other bits
unrestricted
—
o
IOA
TIOR1
Legend: o Setting available (valid). — Setting does not affect this mode.
Notes: 1. The input capture function cannot be used in PWM mode. If compare match A and compare match B occur simultaneously, the compare match signal is inhibited.
2. Valid only when channels 3 and 4 are operating in complementary PWM mode or reset-synchronized PWM mode.
—
o
Counter By compare
clearing match/input
capture A
—
o
Input capture A
—
—
o
Output compare B
o
—
o
Output compare A
Input capture B
—
—
—
—
SYNC1 = 1 —
o
Synchronous preset
PWM mode
FDIR PWM
Synchronization
Operating Mode
MDF
TMDR
TSNC
Table 10-11 (b) ITU Operating Modes (Channel 1)
374
—
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
Output compare A
Output compare B
Input capture A
SYNC2 = 1 o
Synchronous
clear
MDF = 1 o
—
—
o
o
o
o
—
—
—
—
PWM2 = 0 —
PWM2 = 0 —
o
PWM2 = 0 —
PWM2 = 1 —
o
TOCR
Register Settings
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
ResetComple- SynchroOutput
mentary nized
BufferLevel
PWM
PWM
ing
XTGD Select
TFCR
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Master
Enable
TOER
o*
o
IOB
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
Clear
Select
o
o
o
o
TCR2
o
o
o
o
o
o
Clock
Select
o
—
CCLR1 = 1 o
CCLR0 = 1
CCLR1 = 1 o
CCLR0 = 0
CCLR1 = 0 o
CCLR0 = 1
IOB2 = 1
o
Other bits
unrestricted
o
IOB2 = 0
o
Other bits
unrestricted
IOA2 = 1
o
Other bits
unrestricted
o
IOA2 = 0
o
Other bits
unrestricted
—
o
IOA
TIOR2
Legend: o Setting available (valid). — Setting does not affect this mode.
Note: * The input capture function cannot be used in PWM mode. If compare match A and compare match B occur simultaneously, the compare match signal is inhibited.
o
—
o
o
By compare
match/input
capture B
Phase counting
mode
—
o
o
Counter By compare
clearing match/input
capture A
—
o
o
Input capture B
—
—
—
—
—
SYNC2 = 1 o
o
Synchronous preset
PWM mode
FDIR PWM
Synchronization
Operating Mode
MDF
TMDR
TSNC
Table 10-11 (c) ITU Operating Modes (Channel 2)
375
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
o
o
o
o
SYNC3 = 1 —
—
o
o*3
o
o
o
Output compare B
Input capture A
Input capture B
Counter
clearing
—
—
—
—
—
o*3
PWM
o
CMD1 = 0
o
o
—
—
o
o
o
CMD1 = 0
CMD1 = 0
CMD1 = 0
o
o
Illegal setting:
CMD1 = 1
CMD0 = 0
CMD1 = 1
CMD0 = 0
CMD1 = 1
CMD0 = 1
o
o
CMD1 = 1
CMD0 = 0
CMD1 = 1
CMD0 = 1
o
Illegal setting: o*4
CMD1 = 1
CMD0 = 0
CMD1 = 0
CMD1 = 0
PWM3 = 0 CMD1 = 0
PWM3 = 0 CMD1 = 0
o
PWM3 = 1 CMD1 = 0
PWM3 = 0 CMD1 = 0
Complementary
PWM
o*6
o*6
—
—
—
—
—
—
BFA3 = 1 —
Other bits
unrestricted
BFB3 = 1 —
Other bits
unrestricted
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
—
—
o
o
—
—
—
—
—
—
Register Settings
TFCR
TOCR
ResetOutput
SynchroLevel
nized PWM Buffering XTGD Select
o
o
—
—
CMD1 = 0 o
—
—
CMD1 = 0 o
—
—
o*1
o*1
o
o
o*1
o*1
o*1
EA3 ignored
Other bits
unrestricted
EA3 ignored
Other bits
unrestricted
o
o
o
—
—
o
o
o
—
o*2
IOA2 = 0
o
Other bits
unrestricted
o
IOB2 = 0
Other bits
unrestricted
IOA2 = 1
o
Other bits
unrestricted
o
IOA2 = 1
Other bits
unrestricted
o
o
o
o*1
o
o
—
—
o
o
o
o
IOA
IOB
TIOR3
Master
Enable
TOER
o
o
o
o
o
o
Clock
Select
o
o
o
o
CCLR1 = 0 o*5
CCLR0 = 0
CCLR1 = 0 o
CCLR0 = 1
CCLR1 = 1 o
CCLR0 = 1
CCLR1 = 1 o
CCLR0 = 0
CCLR1 = 0 o
CCLR0 = 1
o
o
o
o
o
o
Clear
Select
TCR3
Legend: o Setting available (valid). — Setting does not affect this mode.
Notes: 1. Master enable bit settings are valid only during waveform output.
2. The input capture function cannot be used in PWM mode. If compare match A and compare match B occur simultaneously, the compare match signal is inhibited.
3. Do not set both channels 3 and 4 for synchronous operation when complementary PWM mode is selected.
4. The counter cannot be cleared by input capture A when reset-synchronized PWM mode is selected.
5. In complementary PWM mode, select the same clock source for channels 3 and 4.
6. Use the input capture A function in channel 1.
Buffering
(BRB)
By compare
match/input
capture A
By compare
match/input
capture B
Synchronous
clear
Complementary
PWM mode
Reset-synchronized
PWM mode
Buffering
(BRA)
FDIR
—
—
—
Synchronization
MDF
SYNC3 = 1 —
o
—
o
—
Operating Mode
Synchronous preset
PWM mode
Output compare A
—
TMDR
TSNC
Table 10-11 (d) ITU Operating Modes (Channel 3)
376
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
o
o
o
o
SYNC4 = 1 —
—
o
o*3
o
o
o
Output compare B
Input capture A
Input capture B
Counter
clearing
—
—
—
—
—
o*3
PWM
o
CMD1 = 0
o
o
—
—
o
o
o
o
o
Illegal setting:
CMD1 = 1
CMD0 = 0
Illegal setting:
CMD1 = 1
CMD0 = 0
Illegal setting:
CMD1 = 1
CMD0 = 0
CMD1 = 1
CMD0 = 0
CMD1 = 1
CMD0 = 1
PWM4 = 0 CMD1 = 0
PWM4 = 0 CMD1 = 0
o
PWM4 = 1 CMD1 = 0
PWM4 = 0 CMD1 = 0
Complementary
PWM
o
o
CMD1 = 1
CMD0 = 0
CMD1 = 1
CMD0 = 1
o*4
o*4
o*4
CMD1 = 0
CMD1 = 0
CMD1 = 0
o
o
—
—
—
—
—
—
BFA4 = 1 —
Other bits
unrestricted
BFB4 = 1 —
Other bits
unrestricted
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
—
—
o
o
—
—
—
—
—
—
Register Settings
TFCR
TOCR
ResetOutput
SynchroLevel
nized PWM Buffering XTGD Select
o
o
—
—
CMD1 = 0 o
—
—
CMD1 = 0 o
—
—
o*1
o*1
o
o
o*1
o*1
o*1
EA4 ignored
Other bits
unrestricted
EB4 ignored
Other bits
unrestricted
o
o
o
—
—
o
o
o
—
o*2
IOA2 = 0
o
Other bits
unrestricted
o
IOB2 = 0
Other bits
unrestricted
IOA2 = 1
o
Other bits
unrestricted
o
IOB2 = 1
Other bits
unrestricted
o
o
o
o*1
o
o
—
—
o
o
o
o
IOA
IOB
TIOR4
Master
Enable
TOER
o
o
o
o
o
o
Clock
Select
o
o
o*6
o
o
o*6
CCLR1 = 0 o*5
CCLR0 = 0
CCLR1 = 1 o
CCLR0 = 1
CCLR1 = 1 o
CCLR0 = 0
CCLR1 = 0 o
CCLR0 = 1
o
o
o
o
o
o
Clear
Select
TCR4
Legend: o Setting available (valid). — Setting does not affect this mode.
Notes: 1. Master enable bit settings are valid only during waveform output.
2. The input capture function cannot be used in PWM mode. If compare match A and compare match B occur simultaneously, the compare match signal is inhibited.
3. Do not set both channels 3 and 4 for synchronous operation when complementary PWM mode is selected.
4. When reset-synchronized PWM mode is selected, TCNT4 operates independently and the counter clearing function is available. Waveform output is not affected.
5. In complementary PWM mode, select the same clock source for channels 3 and 4.
6. TCR4 settings are valid in reset-synchronized PWM mode, but TCNT4 operates independently, without affecting waveform output.
Buffering
(BRB)
By compare
match/input
capture A
By compare
match/input
capture B
Synchronous
clear
Complementary
PWM mode
Reset-synchronized
PWM mode
Buffering
(BRA)
FDIR
—
—
—
Synchronization
MDF
SYNC4 = 1 —
o
—
o
—
Operating Mode
Synchronous preset
PWM mode
Output compare A
—
TMDR
TSNC
Table 10-11 (e) ITU Operating Modes (Channel 4)
Section 11 Programmable Timing Pattern Controller
11.1 Overview
The H8/3002 has a built-in programmable timing pattern controller (TPC) that provides pulse
outputs by using the 16-bit integrated timer unit (ITU) as a time base. The TPC pulse outputs are
divided into 4-bit groups (group 3 to group 0) that can operate simultaneously and independently.
11.1.1 Features
TPC features are listed below.
•
16-bit output data
Maximum 16-bit data can be output. TPC output can be enabled on a bit-by-bit basis.
•
Four output groups
Output trigger signals can be selected in 4-bit groups to provide up to four different 4-bit
outputs.
•
Selectable output trigger signals
Output trigger signals can be selected for each group from the compare-match signals of four
ITU channels.
•
Non-overlap mode
A non-overlap margin can be provided between pulse outputs.
•
Can operate together with the DMA controller (DMAC)
The compare-match signals selected as trigger signals can activate the DMAC for sequential
output of data without CPU intervention.
377
11.1.2 Block Diagram
Figure 11-1 shows a block diagram of the TPC.
ITU compare match signals
Control logic
TP15
TP14
TP13
TP12
TP11
TP10
TP 9
TP 8
TP 7
TP 6
TP 5
TP 4
TP 3
TP 2
TP 1
TP 0
Legend
TPMR:
TPCR:
NDERB:
NDERA:
PBDDR:
PADDR:
NDRB:
NDRA:
PBDR:
PADR:
PADDR
PBDDR
NDERA
NDERB
TPMR
TPCR
Internal
data bus
Pulse output
pins, group 3
PBDR
NDRB
PADR
NDRA
Pulse output
pins, group 2
Pulse output
pins, group 1
Pulse output
pins, group 0
TPC output mode register
TPC output control register
Next data enable register B
Next data enable register A
Port B data direction register
Port A data direction register
Next data register B
Next data register A
Port B data register
Port A data register
Figure 11-1 TPC Block Diagram
378
11.1.3 TPC Pins
Table 11-1 summarizes the TPC output pins.
Table 11-1 TPC Pins
Name
Symbol
I/O
Function
TPC output 0
TP0
Output
Group 0 pulse output
TPC output 1
TP1
Output
TPC output 2
TP2
Output
TPC output 3
TP3
Output
TPC output 4
TP4
Output
TPC output 5
TP5
Output
TPC output 6
TP6
Output
TPC output 7
TP7
Output
TPC output 8
TP8
Output
TPC output 9
TP9
Output
TPC output 10
TP10
Output
TPC output 11
TP11
Output
TPC output 12
TP12
Output
TPC output 13
TP13
Output
TPC output 14
TP14
Output
TPC output 15
TP15
Output
Group 1 pulse output
Group 2 pulse output
Group 3 pulse output
379
11.1.4 Registers
Table 11-2 summarizes the TPC registers.
Table 11-2 TPC Registers
Address*1
Name
Abbreviation
R/W
Initial Value
H'FFD1
Port A data direction register
PADDR
W
H'00
H'00
H'FFD3
Port A data register
PADR
R/(W)*2
H'FFD4
Port B data direction register
PBDDR
W
H'00
H'00
H'FFD6
Port B data register
PBDR
R/(W)*2
H'FFA0
TPC output mode register
TPMR
R/W
H'F0
H'FFA1
TPC output control register
TPCR
R/W
H'FF
H'FFA2
Next data enable register B
NDERB
R/W
H'00
H'FFA3
Next data enable register A
NDERA
R/W
H'00
H'FFA5/
H'FFA7*3
Next data register A
NDRA
R/W
H'00
H'FFA4
H'FFA6*3
Next data register B
NDRB
R/W
H'00
Notes: 1. Lower 16 bits of the address.
2. Bits used for TPC output cannot be written.
3. The NDRA address is H'FFA5 when the same output trigger is selected for TPC output
groups 0 and 1 by settings in TPCR. When the output triggers are different, the NDRA
address is H'FFA7 for group 0 and H'FFA5 for group 1. Similarly, the address of NDRB
is H'FFA4 when the same output trigger is selected for TPC output groups 2 and 3 by
settings in TPCR. When the output triggers are different, the NDRB address is H'FFA6
for group 2 and H'FFA4 for group 3.
380
11.2 Register Descriptions
11.2.1 Port A Data Direction Register (PADDR)
PADDR is an 8-bit write-only register that selects input or output for each pin in port A.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PA7 DDR PA6 DDR PA5 DDR PA4 DDR PA3 DDR PA2 DDR PA1 DDR PA0 DDR
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
Port A data direction 7 to 0
These bits select input or
output for port A pins
Port A is multiplexed with pins TP7 to TP0. Bits corresponding to pins used for TPC output must
be set to 1. For further information about PADDR, see section 9.7, Port A.
11.2.2 Port A Data Register (PADR)
PADR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that stores TPC output data for groups 0 and 1, when
these TPC output groups are used.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PA 7
PA 6
PA 5
PA 4
PA 3
PA 2
PA 1
PA 0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
Port A data 7 to 0
These bits store output data
for TPC output groups 0 and 1
Note: * Bits selected for TPC output by NDERA settings become read-only bits.
For further information about PADR, see section 9.7, Port A.
381
11.2.3 Port B Data Direction Register (PBDDR)
PBDDR is an 8-bit write-only register that selects input or output for each pin in port B.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PB7 DDR PB6 DDR PB5 DDR PB4 DDR PB3 DDR PB2 DDR PB1 DDR PB0 DDR
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
Port B data direction 7 to 0
These bits select input or
output for port B pins
Port B is multiplexed with pins TP15 to TP8. Bits corresponding to pins used for TPC output must
be set to 1. For further information about PBDDR, see section 9.8, Port B.
11.2.4 Port B Data Register (PBDR)
PBDR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that stores TPC output data for groups 2 and 3, when
these TPC output groups are used.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PB 7
PB 6
PB 5
PB 4
PB 3
PB 2
PB 1
PB 0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
Port B data 7 to 0
These bits store output data
for TPC output groups 2 and 3
Note: * Bits selected for TPC output by NDERB settings become read-only bits.
For further information about PBDR, see section 9.8, Port B.
382
11.2.5 Next Data Register A (NDRA)
NDRA is an 8-bit readable/writable register that stores the next output data for TPC output groups
1 and 0 (pins TP7 to TP0). During TPC output, when an ITU compare match event specified in
TPCR occurs, NDRA contents are transferred to the corresponding bits in PADR. The address of
NDRA differs depending on whether TPC output groups 0 and 1 have the same output trigger or
different output triggers.
NDRA is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. It is not initialized in
software standby mode.
Same Trigger for TPC Output Groups 0 and 1: If TPC output groups 0 and 1 are triggered by
the same compare match event, the NDRA address is H'FFA5. The upper 4 bits belong to group 1
and the lower 4 bits to group 0. Address H'FFA7 consists entirely of reserved bits that cannot be
modified and always read 1.
Address H'FFA5
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
NDR7
NDR6
NDR5
NDR4
NDR3
NDR2
NDR1
NDR0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Next data 7 to 4
These bits store the next output
data for TPC output group 1
Next data 3 to 0
These bits store the next output
data for TPC output group 0
Address H'FFA7
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read/Write
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Reserved bits
383
Different Triggers for TPC Output Groups 0 and 1: If TPC output groups 0 and 1 are triggered
by different compare match events, the address of the upper 4 bits of NDRA (group 1) is H'FFA5
and the address of the lower 4 bits (group 0) is H'FFA7. Bits 3 to 0 of address H'FFA5 and bits 7
to 4 of address H'FFA7 are reserved bits that cannot be modified and always read 1.
Address H'FFA5
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
NDR7
NDR6
NDR5
NDR4
—
—
—
—
Initial value
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
—
—
—
—
Next data 7 to 4
These bits store the next output
data for TPC output group 1
Reserved bits
Address H'FFA7
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
—
—
—
NDR3
NDR2
NDR1
NDR0
Initial value
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
—
—
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Reserved bits
Next data 3 to 0
These bits store the next output
data for TPC output group 0
384
11.2.6 Next Data Register B (NDRB)
NDRB is an 8-bit readable/writable register that stores the next output data for TPC output groups
3 and 2 (pins TP15 to TP8). During TPC output, when an ITU compare match event specified in
TPCR occurs, NDRB contents are transferred to the corresponding bits in PBDR. The address of
NDRB differs depending on whether TPC output groups 2 and 3 have the same output trigger or
different output triggers.
NDRB is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. It is not initialized in
software standby mode.
Same Trigger for TPC Output Groups 2 and 3: If TPC output groups 2 and 3 are triggered by
the same compare match event, the NDRB address is H'FFA4. The upper 4 bits belong to group 3
and the lower 4 bits to group 2. Address H'FFA6 consists entirely of reserved bits that cannot be
modified and always read 1.
Address H'FFA4
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
NDR15
NDR14
NDR13
NDR12
NDR11
NDR10
NDR9
NDR8
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Next data 15 to 12
These bits store the next output
data for TPC output group 3
Next data 11 to 8
These bits store the next output
data for TPC output group 2
Address H'FFA6
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read/Write
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Reserved bits
385
Different Triggers for TPC Output Groups 2 and 3: If TPC output groups 2 and 3 are triggered
by different compare match events, the address of the upper 4 bits of NDRB (group 3) is H'FFA4
and the address of the lower 4 bits (group 2) is H'FFA6. Bits 3 to 0 of address H'FFA4 and bits 7
to 4 of address H'FFA6 are reserved bits that cannot be modified and always read 1.
Address H'FFA4
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
NDR15
NDR14
NDR13
NDR12
—
—
—
—
Initial value
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
—
—
—
—
Next data 15 to 12
These bits store the next output
data for TPC output group 3
Reserved bits
Address H'FFA6
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
—
—
—
NDR11
NDR10
NDR9
NDR8
Initial value
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
—
—
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Reserved bits
Next data 11 to 8
These bits store the next output
data for TPC output group 2
386
11.2.7 Next Data Enable Register A (NDERA)
NDERA is an 8-bit readable/writable register that enables or disables TPC output groups 1 and 0
(TP7 to TP0) on a bit-by-bit basis.
Bit
6
7
NDER7
5
NDER6 NDER5
4
3
NDER4 NDER3
2
NDER2
1
0
NDER1 NDER0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Next data enable 7 to 0
These bits enable or disable
TPC output groups 1 and 0
If a bit is enabled for TPC output by NDERA, then when the ITU compare match event selected
in the TPC output control register (TPCR) occurs, the NDRA value is automatically transferred to
the corresponding PADR bit, updating the output value. If TPC output is disabled, the bit value is
not transferred from NDRA to PADR and the output value does not change.
NDERA is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. It is not initialized in
software standby mode.
Bits 7 to 0—Next Data Enable 7 to 0 (NDER7 to NDER0): These bits enable or disable TPC
output groups 1 and 0 (TP7 to TP0) on a bit-by-bit basis.
Bits 7 to 0
NDER7 to NDER0
Description
0
TPC outputs TP7 to TP0 are disabled
(NDR7 to NDR0 are not transferred to PA7 to PA0)
1
TPC outputs TP7 to TP0 are enabled
(NDR7 to NDR0 are transferred to PA7 to PA0)
387
(Initial value)
11.2.8 Next Data Enable Register B (NDERB)
NDERB is an 8-bit readable/writable register that enables or disables TPC output groups 3 and 2
(TP15 to TP8) on a bit-by-bit basis.
Bit
7
6
4
5
3
2
1
0
NDER15 NDER14 NDER13 NDER12 NDER11 NDER10 NDER9 NDER8
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Next data enable 15 to 8
These bits enable or disable
TPC output groups 3 and 2
If a bit is enabled for TPC output by NDERB, then when the ITU compare match event selected in
the TPC output control register (TPCR) occurs, the NDRB value is automatically transferred to
the corresponding PBDR bit, updating the output value. If TPC output is disabled, the bit value is
not transferred from NDRB to PBDR and the output value does not change.
NDERB is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. It is not initialized in
software standby mode.
Bits 7 to 0—Next Data Enable 15 to 8 (NDER15 to NDER8): These bits enable or disable TPC
output groups 3 and 2 (TP15 to TP8) on a bit-by-bit basis.
Bits 7 to 0
NDER15 to NDER8
Description
0
TPC outputs TP15 to TP8 are disabled
(NDR15 to NDR8 are not transferred to PB7 to PB0)
1
TPC outputs TP15 to TP8 are enabled
(NDR15 to NDR8 are transferred to PB7 to PB0)
388
(Initial value)
11.2.9 TPC Output Control Register (TPCR)
TPCR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that selects output trigger signals for TPC outputs on a
group-by-group basis.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
0
1
G3CMS1 G3CMS0 G2CMS1 G2CMS0 G1CMS1 G1CMS0 G0CMS1 G0CMS0
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Group 3 compare
match select 1 and 0
These bits select
the compare match
Group 2 compare
event that triggers
TPC output group 3 match select 1 and 0
These bits select
(TP15 to TP12 )
the compare match
event that triggers Group 1 compare
TPC output group 2 match select 1 and 0
These bits select
(TP11 to TP8 )
the compare match
event that triggers Group 0 compare
TPC output group 1 match select 1 and 0
These bits select
(TP7 to TP4 )
the compare match
event that triggers
TPC output group 0
(TP3 to TP0 )
TPCR is initialized to H'FF by a reset and in hardware standby mode. It is not initialized in
software standby mode.
389
Bits 7 and 6—Group 3 Compare Match Select 1 and 0 (G3CMS1, G3CMS0): These bits
select the compare match event that triggers TPC output group 3 (TP15 to TP12).
Bit 7
G3CMS1
Bit 6
G3CMS0
0
0
TPC output group 3 (TP15 to TP12) is triggered by compare match in ITU
channel 0
1
TPC output group 3 (TP15 to TP12) is triggered by compare match in ITU
channel 1
0
TPC output group 3 (TP15 to TP12) is triggered by compare match in ITU
channel 2
1
TPC output group 3 (TP15 to TP12) is triggered by
compare match in ITU channel 3
1
Description
(Initial value)
Bits 5 and 4—Group 2 Compare Match Select 1 and 0 (G2CMS1, G2CMS0): These bits
select the compare match event that triggers TPC output group 2 (TP11 to TP8).
Bit 5
G2CMS1
Bit 4
G2CMS0
0
0
TPC output group 2 (TP11 to TP8) is triggered by compare match in ITU
channel 0
1
TPC output group 2 (TP11 to TP8) is triggered by compare match in ITU
channel 1
0
TPC output group 2 (TP11 to TP8) is triggered by compare match in ITU
channel 2
1
TPC output group 2 (TP11 to TP8) is triggered by
compare match in ITU channel 3
1
Description
390
(Initial value)
Bits 3 and 2—Group 1 Compare Match Select 1 and 0 (G1CMS1, G1CMS0): These bits
select the compare match event that triggers TPC output group 1 (TP7 to TP4).
Bit 3
G1CMS1
Bit 2
G1CMS0
0
0
TPC output group 1 (TP7 to TP4) is triggered by compare match in ITU
channel 0
1
TPC output group 1 (TP7 to TP4) is triggered by compare match in ITU
channel 1
0
TPC output group 1 (TP7 to TP4) is triggered by compare match in ITU
channel 2
1
TPC output group 1 (TP7 to TP4) is triggered by
compare match in ITU channel 3
1
Description
(Initial value)
Bits 1 and 0—Group 0 Compare Match Select 1 and 0 (G0CMS1, G0CMS0): These bits
select the compare match event that triggers TPC output group 0 (TP3 to TP0).
Bit 1
G0CMS1
Bit 0
G0CMS0
0
0
TPC output group 0 (TP3 to TP0) is triggered by compare match in ITU
channel 0
1
TPC output group 0 (TP3 to TP0) is triggered by compare match in ITU
channel 1
0
TPC output group 0 (TP3 to TP0) is triggered by compare match in ITU
channel 2
1
TPC output group 0 (TP3 to TP0) is triggered by
compare match in ITU channel 3
1
Description
391
(Initial value)
11.2.10 TPC Output Mode Register (TPMR)
TPMR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that selects normal or non-overlapping TPC output for
each group.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
—
—
—
Initial value
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
—
—
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
G3NOV G2NOV
G1NOV G0NOV
Reserved bits
Group 3 non-overlap
Selects non-overlapping TPC
output for group 3 (TP15 to TP12 )
Group 2 non-overlap
Selects non-overlapping TPC
output for group 2 (TP11 to TP8 )
Group 1 non-overlap
Selects non-overlapping TPC
output for group 1 (TP7 to TP4 )
Group 0 non-overlap
Selects non-overlapping TPC
output for group 0 (TP3 to TP0 )
The output trigger period of a non-overlapping TPC output waveform is set in general register B
(GRB) in the ITU channel selected for output triggering. The non-overlap margin is set in general
register A (GRA). The output values change at compare match A and B. For details see
section 11.3.4, Non-Overlapping TPC Output.
TPMR is initialized to H'F0 by a reset and in hardware standby mode. It is not initialized in
software standby mode.
Bits 7 to 4—Reserved: These bits cannot be modified and are always read as 1.
392
Bit 3—Group 3 Non-Overlap (G3NOV): Selects normal or non-overlapping TPC output for
group 3 (TP15 to TP12).
Bit 3
G3NOV
Description
0
Normal TPC output in group 3 (output values change at
compare match A in the selected ITU channel)
1
Non-overlapping TPC output in group 3 (independent 1 and 0 output at
compare match A and B in the selected ITU channel)
(Initial value)
Bit 2—Group 2 Non-Overlap (G2NOV): Selects normal or non-overlapping TPC output for
group 2 (TP11 to TP8).
Bit 2
G2NOV
Description
0
Normal TPC output in group 2 (output values change at
compare match A in the selected ITU channel)
1
Non-overlapping TPC output in group 2 (independent 1 and 0 output at
compare match A and B in the selected ITU channel)
(Initial value)
Bit 1—Group 1 Non-Overlap (G1NOV): Selects normal or non-overlapping TPC output for
group 1 (TP7 to TP4).
Bit 1
G1NOV
Description
0
Normal TPC output in group 1 (output values change at
compare match A in the selected ITU channel)
1
Non-overlapping TPC output in group 1 (independent 1 and 0 output at
compare match A and B in the selected ITU channel)
(Initial value)
Bit 0—Group 0 Non-Overlap (G0NOV): Selects normal or non-overlapping TPC output for
group 0 (TP3 to TP0).
Bit 0
G0NOV
Description
0
Normal TPC output in group 0 (output values change at
compare match A in the selected ITU channel)
1
Non-overlapping TPC output in group 0 (independent 1 and 0 output at
compare match A and B in the selected ITU channel)
393
(Initial value)
11.3 Operation
11.3.1 Overview
When corresponding bits in PADDR or PBDDR and NDERA or NDERB are set to 1, TPC output
is enabled. The TPC output initially consists of the corresponding PADR or PBDR contents.
When a compare-match event selected in TPCR occurs, the corresponding NDRA or NDRB bit
contents are transferred to PADR or PBDR to update the output values.
Figure 11-2 illustrates the TPC output operation. Table 11-3 summarizes the TPC operating
conditions.
DDR
NDER
Q
Q
Output trigger signal
C
Q
DR
D
Q NDR
D
Internal
data bus
TPC output pin
Figure 11-2 TPC Output Operation
Table 11-3 TPC Operating Conditions
NDER
DDR
Pin Function
0
0
Generic input port
1
Generic output port
0
Generic input port (but software cannot write to the DR bit, and when compare
match occurs, the NDR bit value is transferred to the DR bit)
1
TPC pulse output
1
Sequential output of up to 16-bit patterns is possible by writing new output data to NDRA and
NDRB before the next compare match. For information on non-overlapping operation, see
section 11.3.4, Non-Overlapping TPC Output.
394
11.3.2 Output Timing
If TPC output is enabled, NDRA/NDRB contents are transferred to PADR/PBDR and output when
the selected compare match event occurs. Figure 11-3 shows the timing of these operations for the
case of normal output in groups 2 and 3, triggered by compare match A.
ø
TCNT
N
N+1
GRA
N
Compare
match A signal
NDRB
n
PBDR
m
n
TP8 to TP15
m
n
Figure 11-3 Timing of Transfer of Next Data Register Contents and Output (Example)
395
11.3.3 Normal TPC Output
Sample Setup Procedure for Normal TPC Output: Figure 11-4 shows a sample procedure for
setting up normal TPC output.
Normal TPC output
Select GR functions
1
Set GRA value
2
Select counting operation
3
Select interrupt request
4
Set initial output data
5
Select port output
6
Enable TPC output
7
Select TPC output trigger
8
Set next TPC output data
9
Start counter
10
ITU setup
Port and
TPC setup
ITU setup
Compare match?
1.
Set TIOR to make GRA an output compare
register (with output inhibited).
2. Set the TPC output trigger period.
3. Select the counter clock source with bits
TPSC2 to TPSC0 in TCR. Select the counter
clear source with bits CCLR1 and CCLR0.
4. Enable the IMFA interrupt in TIER.
The DMAC can also be set up to transfer
data to the next data register.
5. Set the initial output values in the DR bits
of the input/output port pins to be used for
TPC output.
6. Set the DDR bits of the input/output port
pins to be used for TPC output to 1.
7. Set the NDER bits of the pins to be used for
TPC output to 1.
8. Select the ITU compare match event to be
used as the TPC output trigger in TPCR.
9. Set the next TPC output values in the NDR bits.
10. Set the STR bit to 1 in TSTR to start the
timer counter.
11. At each IMFA interrupt, set the next output
values in the NDR bits.
No
Yes
Set next TPC output data
11
Figure 11-4 Setup Procedure for Normal TPC Output (Example)
396
Example of Normal TPC Output (Example of Five-Phase Pulse Output): Figure 11-5 shows
an example in which the TPC is used for cyclic five-phase pulse output.
TCNT value
Compare match
TCNT
GRA
H'0000
Time
NDRB
80
PBDR
00
C0
80
40
C0
60
40
20
60
30
20
10
30
18
10
08
18
88
08
80
88
C0
80
40
C0
TP15
TP14
TP13
TP12
TP11
•
•
•
•
The ITU channel to be used as the output trigger channel is set up so that GRA is an output compare
register and the counter will be cleared by compare match A. The trigger period is set in GRA.
The IMIEA bit is set to 1 in TIER to enable the compare match A interrupt.
H'F8 is written in PBDDR and NDERB, and bits G3CMS1, G3CMS0, G2CMS1, and G2CMS0 are set in
TPCR to select compare match in the ITU channel set up in step 1 as the output trigger.
Output data H'80 is written in NDRB.
The timer counter in this ITU channel is started. When compare match A occurs, the NDRB contents
are transferred to PBDR and output. The compare match/input capture A (IMFA) interrupt service routine
writes the next output data (H'C0) in NDRB.
Five-phase overlapping pulse output (one or two phases active at a time) can be obtained by writing
H'40, H'60, H'20, H'30, H'10, H'18, H'08, H'88… at successive IMFA interrupts. If the DMAC is set for
activation by this interrupt, pulse output can be obtained without loading the CPU.
Figure 11-5 Normal TPC Output Example (Five-Phase Pulse Output)
397
11.3.4 Non-Overlapping TPC Output
Sample Setup Procedure for Non-Overlapping TPC Output: Figure 11-6 shows a sample
procedure for setting up non-overlapping TPC output.
Non-overlapping
TPC output
Select GR functions
1
Set GR values
2
Select counting operation
3
Select interrupt requests
4
Set initial output data
5
Set up TPC output
6
Enable TPC transfer
7
Select TPC transfer trigger
8
Select non-overlapping groups
9
Set next TPC output data
10
Start counter
11
ITU setup
Port and
TPC setup
ITU setup
Compare match A?
1. Set TIOR to make GRA and GRB output
compare registers (with output inhibited).
2. Set the TPC output trigger period in GRB
and the non-overlap margin in GRA.
3. Select the counter clock source with bits
TPSC2 to TPSC0 in TCR. Select the counter
clear source with bits CCLR1 and CCLR0.
4. Enable the IMFA interrupt in TIER.
The DMAC can also be set up to transfer
data to the next data register.
5. Set the initial output values in the DR bits
of the input/output port pins to be used for
TPC output.
6. Set the DDR bits of the input/output port pins
to be used for TPC output to 1.
7. Set the NDER bits of the pins to be used for
TPC output to 1.
8. In TPCR, select the ITU compare match
event to be used as the TPC output trigger.
9. In TPMR, select the groups that will operate
in non-overlap mode.
10. Set the next TPC output values in the NDR
bits.
11. Set the STR bit to 1 in TSTR to start the timer
counter.
12. At each IMFA interrupt, write the next output
value in the NDR bits.
No
Yes
Set next TPC output data
12
Figure 11-6 Setup Procedure for Non-Overlapping TPC Output (Example)
398
Example of Non-Overlapping TPC Output (Example of Four-Phase Complementary NonOverlapping Output): Figure 11-7 shows an example of the use of TPC output for four-phase
complementary non-overlapping pulse output.
TCNT value
GRB
TCNT
GRA
Time
H'0000
NDRB
95
PBDR
00
65
95
59
05
65
56
41
59
95
50
56
65
14
95
05
65
Non-overlap margin
TP15
TP14
TP13
TP12
TP11
TP10
TP9
TP8
• The ITU channel to be used as the output trigger channel is set up so that GRA and GRB are output
compare registers and the counter will be cleared by compare match B. The TPC output trigger
period is set in GRB. The non-overlap margin is set in GRA. The IMIEA bit is set to 1 in TIER to enable
IMFA interrupts.
• H'FF is written in PBDDR and NDERB, and bits G3CMS1, G3CMS0, G2CMS1, and G2CMS0 are set in
TPCR to select compare match in the ITU channel set up in step 1 as the output trigger. Bits G3NOV
and G2NOV are set to 1 in TPMR to select non-overlapping output. Output data H'95 is written in NDRB.
• The timer counter in this ITU channel is started. When compare match B occurs, outputs change from
1 to 0. When compare match A occurs, outputs change from 0 to 1 (the change from 0 to 1 is delayed
by the value of GRA). The IMFA interrupt service routine writes the next output data (H'65) in NDRB.
• Four-phase complementary non-overlapping pulse output can be obtained by writing H'59, H'56, H'95…
at successive IMFA interrupts. If the DMAC is set for activation by this interrupt, pulse output can be
obtained without loading the CPU.
Figure 11-7 Non-Overlapping TPC Output Example (Four-Phase Complementary
Non-Overlapping Pulse Output)
399
11.3.5 TPC Output Triggering by Input Capture
TPC output can be triggered by ITU input capture as well as by compare match. If GRA functions
as an input capture register in the ITU channel selected in TPCR, TPC output will be triggered by
the input capture signal. Figure 11-8 shows the timing.
ø
TIOC pin
Input capture
signal
N
NDR
DR
M
N
Figure 11-8 TPC Output Triggering by Input Capture (Example)
400
11.4 Usage Notes
11.4.1 Operation of TPC Output Pins
TP0 to TP15 are multiplexed with ITU, DMAC, address bus, and other pin functions. When ITU,
DMAC, or address output is enabled, the corresponding pins cannot be used for TPC output. The
data transfer from NDR bits to DR bits takes place, however, regardless of the usage of the pin.
Pin functions should be changed only under conditions in which the output trigger event will not
occur.
11.4.2 Note on Non-Overlapping Output
During non-overlapping operation, the transfer of NDR bit values to DR bits takes place as
follows.
1.
NDR bits are always transferred to DR bits at compare match A.
2.
At compare match B, NDR bits are transferred only if their value is 0. Bits are not transferred
if their value is 1.
Figure 11-9 illustrates the non-overlapping TPC output operation.
DDR
NDER
Q
Q
Compare match A
Compare match B
C
Q
DR
D
Q NDR
TPC output pin
Figure 11-9 Non-Overlapping TPC Output
401
D
Internal
data bus
Therefore, 0 data can be transferred ahead of 1 data by making compare match B occur before
compare match A. NDR contents should not be altered during the interval from compare match B
to compare match A (the non-overlap margin).
This can be accomplished by having the IMFA interrupt service routine write the next data in
NDR, or by having the IMFA interrupt activate the DMAC. The next data must be written before
the next compare match B occurs.
Figure 11-10 shows the timing relationships.
Compare
match A
Compare
match B
NDR write
NDR write
NDR
DR
0 output
0/1 output
0 output
0/1 output
Write to NDR
in this interval
Do not write
to NDR in this
interval
Write to NDR
in this interval
Do not write
to NDR in this
interval
Figure 11-10 Non-Overlapping Operation and NDR Write Timing
402
Section 12 Watchdog Timer
12.1 Overview
The H8/3002 has an on-chip watchdog timer (WDT). The WDT has two selectable functions: it
can operate as a watchdog timer to supervise system operation, or it can operate as an interval
timer. As a watchdog timer, it generates a reset signal for the H8/3002 chip if a system crash
allows the timer counter (TCNT) to overflow before being rewritten. In interval timer operation,
an interval timer interrupt is requested at each TCNT overflow.
12.1.1 Features
WDT features are listed below.
•
Selection of eight counter clock sources
ø/2, ø/32, ø/64, ø/128, ø/256, ø/512, ø/2048, or ø/4096
•
Interval timer option
•
Timer counter overflow generates a reset signal or interrupt.
The reset signal is generated in watchdog timer operation. An interval timer interrupt is
generated in interval timer operation.
•
Watchdog timer reset signal resets the entire H8/3002 internally, and can also be output
externally.
The reset signal generated by timer counter overflow during watchdog timer operation resets
the entire H8/3002 internally. An external reset signal can be output from the RESO pin to
reset other system devices simultaneously.
403
12.1.2 Block Diagram
Figure 12-1 shows a block diagram of the WDT.
Overflow
TCNT
Interrupt
(interval timer) control
Interrupt signal
TCSR
Read/
write
control
Internal
data bus
Internal clock sources
ø/2
RSTCSR
ø/32
Reset
(internal, external)
Reset control
ø/64
Clock
Clock
selector
ø/128
ø/256
ø/512
Legend
TCNT:
Timer counter
TCSR:
Timer control/status register
RSTCSR: Reset control/status register
ø/2048
ø/4096
Figure 12-1 WDT Block Diagram
12.1.3 Pin Configuration
Table 12-1 describes the WDT output pin.
Table 12-1 WDT Pin
Name
Abbreviation
I/O
Function
Reset output
RESO
Output*
External output of the watchdog timer reset signal
Note: * Open-drain output.
404
12.1.4 Register Configuration
Table 12-2 summarizes the WDT registers.
Table 12-2 WDT Registers
Address*1
Write*2
H'FFA8
H'FFAA
Read
Name
Abbreviation
R/W
Initial Value
H'18
H'FFA8
Timer control/status register
TCSR
R/(W)*3
H'FFA9
Timer counter
TCNT
R/W
H'00
RSTCSR
R/(W)*3
H'3F
H'FFAB
Reset control/status register
Notes: 1. Lower 16 bits of the address.
2. Write word data starting at this address.
3. Only 0 can be written in bit 7, to clear the flag.
405
12.2 Register Descriptions
12.2.1 Timer Counter (TCNT)
TCNT is an 8-bit readable and writable* up-counter.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
When the TME bit is set to 1 in TCSR, TCNT starts counting pulses generated from an internal
clock source selected by bits CKS2 to CKS0 in TCSR. When the count overflows (changes from
H'FF to H'00), the OVF bit is set to 1 in TCSR. TCNT is initialized to H'00 by a reset and when
the TME bit is cleared to 0.
Note: * TCNT is write-protected by a password. For details see section 12.2.4, Notes on Register
Access.
406
12.2.2 Timer Control/Status Register (TCSR)
TCSR is an 8-bit readable and writable*1 register. Its functions include selecting the timer mode
and clock source.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
OVF
WT/IT
TME
—
—
CKS2
CKS1
CKS0
Initial value
0
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/(W)*2
R/W
R/W
—
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
Clock select
These bits select the
TCNT clock source
Reserved bits
Timer enable
Selects whether TCNT runs or halts
Timer mode select
Selects the mode
Overflow flag
Status flag indicating overflow
Bits 7 to 5 are initialized to 0 by a reset and in standby mode. Bits 2 to 0 are initialized to 0 by a
reset. In software standby mode bits 2 to 0 are not initialized, but retain their previous values.
Notes: 1. TCSR is write-protected by a password. For details see section 12.2.4, Notes on
Register Access.
2. Only 0 can be written, to clear the flag.
407
Bit 7—Overflow Flag (OVF): This status flag indicates that the timer counter has overflowed
from H'FF to H'00.
Bit 7
OVF
0
1
Description
[Clearing condition]
Cleared by reading OVF when OVF = 1, then writing 0 in OVF
(Initial value)
[Setting condition]
Set when TCNT changes from H'FF to H'00
Bit 6—Timer Mode Select (WT/IT): Selects whether to use the WDT as a watchdog timer or
interval timer. If used as an interval timer, the WDT generates an interval timer interrupt request
when TCNT overflows. If used as a watchdog timer, the WDT generates a reset signal when
TCNT overflows.
Bit 6
WT/IT
Description
0
Interval timer: requests interval timer interrupts
1
Watchdog timer: generates a reset signal
(Initial value)
Bit 5—Timer Enable (TME): Selects whether TCNT runs or is halted.
Bit 5
TME
Description
0
TCNT is initialized to H'00 and halted
1
TCNT is counting
(Initial value)
Bits 4 and 3—Reserved: These bits cannot be modified and are always read as 1.
408
Bits 2 to 0—Clock Select 2 to 0 (CKS2/1/0): These bits select one of eight internal clock
sources, obtained by prescaling the system clock (ø), for input to TCNT.
Bit 2
CKS2
Bit 1
CKS1
Bit 0
CKS0
Description
0
0
0
ø/2
1
ø/32
0
ø/64
1
ø/128
0
ø/256
1
ø/512
0
ø/2048
1
ø/4096
1
1
0
1
(Initial value)
12.2.3 Reset Control/Status Register (RSTCSR)
RSTCSR is an 8-bit readable and writable*1 register that indicates when a reset signal has been
generated by watchdog timer overflow, and controls external output of the reset signal.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
WRST
RSTOE
—
—
—
—
—
—
Initial value
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read/Write
R/(W)*2
R/W
—
—
—
—
—
—
Reserved bits
Reset output enable
Enables or disables external output of the reset signal
Watchdog timer reset
Indicates that a reset signal has been generated
Bits 7 and 6 are initialized by input of a reset signal at the RES pin. They are not initialized by
reset signals generated by watchdog timer overflow.
Notes: 1. RSTCSR is write-protected by a password. For details see section 12.2.4, Notes on
Register Access.
2. Only 0 can be written in bit 7, to clear the flag.
409
Bit 7—Watchdog Timer Reset (WRST): During watchdog timer operation, this bit indicates that
TCNT has overflowed and generated a reset signal. This reset signal resets the entire H8/3002
chip internally. If bit RSTOE is set to 1, this reset signal is also output (low) at the RESO pin to
initialize external system devices.
Bit 7
WRST
0
1
Description
[Clearing condition]
(1)Cleared to 0 by reset signal input at RES pin
(2)Cleared by reading WRST when WRST=1, then writing 0 in WRST
(Initial value)
[Setting condition]
Set when TCNT overflow generates a reset signal during watchdog timer operation
Bit 6—Reset Output Enable (RSTOE): Enables or disables external output at the RESO pin of
the reset signal generated if TCNT overflows during watchdog timer operation.
Bit 6
RSTOE
Description
0
Reset signal is not output externally
1
Reset signal is output externally
(Initial value)
Bits 5 to 0—Reserved: These bits cannot be modified and are always read as 1.
410
12.2.4 Notes on Register Access
The watchdog timer’s TCNT, TCSR, and RSTCSR registers differ from other registers in being
more difficult to write. The procedures for writing and reading these registers are given below.
Writing to TCNT and TCSR: These registers must be written by a word transfer instruction.
They cannot be written by byte instructions. Figure 12-2 shows the format of data written to
TCNT and TCSR. TCNT and TCSR both have the same write address. The write data must be
contained in the lower byte of the written word. The upper byte must contain H'5A (password for
TCNT) or H'A5 (password for TCSR). This transfers the write data from the lower byte to TCNT
or TCSR.
15
TCNT write
Address
H'FFA8*
8 7
H'5A
15
TCSR write
Address
H'FFA8*
0
Write data
8 7
H'A5
0
Write data
Note: * Lower 16 bits of the address.
Figure 12-2 Format of Data Written to TCNT and TCSR
411
Writing to RSTCSR: RSTCSR must be written by a word transfer instruction. It cannot be
written by byte transfer instructions. Figure 12-3 shows the format of data written to RSTCSR. To
write 0 in the WRST bit, the write data must have H'A5 in the upper byte and H'00 in the lower
byte. The H'00 in the lower byte clears the WRST bit in RSTCSR to 0. To write to the RSTOE bit,
the upper byte must contain H'5A and the lower byte must contain the write data. Writing this
word transfers a write data value into the RSTOE bit.
Writing 0 in WRST bit
Address
H'FFAA*
Writing to RSTOE bit
Address
15
8 7
H'A5
15
H'FFAA*
0
H'00
8 7
H'5A
0
Write data
Note: * Lower 16 bits of the address.
Figure 12-3 Format of Data Written to RSTCSR
Reading TCNT, TCSR, and RSTCSR: These registers are read like other registers. Byte access
instructions can be used. The read addresses are H'FFA8 for TCSR, H'FFA9 for TCNT, and
H'FFAB for RSTCSR, as listed in table 12-3.
Table 12-3 Read Addresses of TCNT, TCSR, and RSTCSR
Address*
Register
H'FFA8
TCSR
H'FFA9
TCNT
H'FFAB
RSTCSR
Note: * Lower 16 bits of the address.
412
12.3 Operation
Operations when the WDT is used as a watchdog timer and as an interval timer are described
below.
12.3.1 Watchdog Timer Operation
Figure 12-4 illustrates watchdog timer operation. To use the WDT as a watchdog timer, set the
WT/IT and TME bits to 1 in TCSR. Software must prevent TCNT overflow by rewriting the
TCNT value (normally by writing H'00) before overflow occurs. If TCNT fails to be rewritten and
overflows due to a system crash etc., the H8/3002 is internally reset for a duration of 518 states.
The watchdog reset signal can be externally output from the RESO pin to reset external system
devices. The reset signal is output externally for 132 states. External output can be enabled or
disabled by the RSTOE bit in RSTCSR.
A watchdog reset has the same vector as a reset generated by input at the RES pin. Software can
distinguish a RES reset from a watchdog reset by checking the WRST bit in RSTCSR.
If a RES reset and a watchdog reset occur simultaneously, the RES reset takes priority.
WDT overflow
H'FF
TME set to 1
TCNT count
value
H'00
OVF = 1
Start
Internal
reset signal
H'00 written
in TCNT
Reset
518 states
RESO
132 states
Figure 12-4 Watchdog Timer Operation
413
H'00 written
in TCNT
12.3.2 Interval Timer Operation
Figure 12-5 illustrates interval timer operation. To use the WDT as an interval timer, clear bit
WT/IT to 0 and set bit TME to 1 in TCSR. An interval timer interrupt request is generated at each
TCNT overflow. This function can be used to generate interval timer interrupts at regular
intervals.
H'FF
TCNT
count value
Time t
H'00
WT/ IT = 0
TME = 1
Interval
timer
interrupt
Interval
timer
interrupt
Interval
timer
interrupt
Interval
timer
interrupt
Figure 12-5 Interval Timer Operation
414
12.3.3 Timing of Setting of Overflow Flag (OVF)
Figure 12-6 shows the timing of setting of the OVF flag in TCSR. The OVF flag is set to 1 when
TCNT overflows. At the same time, a reset signal is generated in watchdog timer operation, or an
interval timer interrupt is generated in interval timer operation.
ø
TCNT
H'FF
H'00
Overflow signal
OVF
Figure 12-6 Timing of Setting of OVF
415
12.3.4 Timing of Setting of Watchdog Timer Reset Bit (WRST)
The WRST bit in RSTCSR is valid when bits WT/IT and TME are both set to 1 in TCSR.
Figure 12-7 shows the timing of setting of WRST and the internal reset timing. The WRST bit is
set to 1 when TCNT overflows and OVF is set to 1. At the same time an internal reset signal is
generated for the entire H8/3002 chip. This internal reset signal clears OVF to 0, but the WRST
bit remains set to 1. The reset routine must therefore clear the WRST bit.
ø
H'FF
TCNT
H'00
Overflow signal
OVF
WDT internal
reset
WRST
Figure 12-7 Timing of Setting of WRST Bit and Internal Reset
416
12.4 Interrupts
During interval timer operation, an overflow generates an interval timer interrupt (WOVI). The
interval timer interrupt is requested whenever the OVF bit is set to 1 in TCSR.
12.5 Usage Notes
Contention between TCNT Write and Increment: If a timer counter clock pulse is generated
during the T3 state of a write cycle to TCNT, the write takes priority and the timer count is not
incremented. See figure 12-8.
Write cycle: CPU writes to TCNT
T1
T2
T3
ø
TCNT
Internal write
signal
TCNT input
clock
TCNT
N
M
Counter write data
Figure 12-8 Contention between TCNT Write and Increment
Changing CKS2 to CKS0 Values: Halt TCNT by clearing the TME bit to 0 in TCSR before
changing the values of bits CKS2 to CKS0.
417
418
Section 13 Serial Communication Interface
13.1 Overview
The H8/3002 has a serial communication interface (SCI) with two independent channels. Both
channels are functionally identical. The SCI can communicate in asynchronous mode or
synchronous mode, and has a multiprocessor communication function for serial communication
among two or more processors.
13.1.1 Features
SCI features are listed below.
•
Selection of asynchronous or synchronous mode for serial communication
a.
Asynchronous mode
Serial data communication is synchronized one character at a time. The SCI can communicate
with a universal asynchronous receiver/transmitter (UART), asynchronous communication
interface adapter (ACIA), or other chip that employs standard asynchronous serial
communication. It can also communicate with two or more other processors using the
multiprocessor communication function. There are twelve selectable serial data
communication formats.
—
—
—
—
—
—
b.
Data length:
Stop bit length:
Parity bit:
Multiprocessor bit:
Receive error detection:
Break detection:
7 or 8 bits
1 or 2 bits
even, odd, or none
1 or 0
parity, overrun, and framing errors
by reading the RxD level directly when a framing error occurs
Synchronous mode
Serial data communication is synchronized with a clock signal. The SCI can communicate
with other chips having a synchronous communication function. There is one serial data
communication format.
— Data length:
8 bits
— Receive error detection: overrun errors
419
•
Full duplex communication
The transmitting and receiving sections are independent, so the SCI can transmit and receive
simultaneously. The transmitting and receiving sections are both double-buffered, so serial
data can be transmitted and received continuously.
•
Built-in baud rate generator with selectable bit rates
•
Selectable transmit/receive clock sources: internal clock from baud rate generator, or external
clock from the SCK pin.
•
Four types of interrupts
Transmit-data-empty, transmit-end, receive-data-full, and receive-error interrupts are
requested independently. The transmit-data-empty and receive-data-full interrupts can
activate the DMA controller (DMAC) to transfer data.
420
13.1.2 Block Diagram
Bus interface
Figure 13-1 shows a block diagram of the SCI.
Module data bus
RxD
RDR
TDR
RSR
TSR
BRR
SSR
SCR
SMR
Baud rate
generator
Transmit/
receive control
TxD
Parity generate
Parity check
SCK
ø
ø/4
ø/16
ø/64
Clock
External clock
TEI
TXI
RXI
ERI
Legend
RSR: Receive shift register
RDR: Receive data register
TSR: Transmit shift register
TDR: Transmit data register
SMR: Serial mode register
SCR: Serial control register
SSR: Serial status register
BRR: Bit rate register
Figure 13-1 SCI Block Diagram
421
Internal
data bus
13.1.3 Input/Output Pins
The SCI has serial pins for each channel as listed in table 13-1.
Table 13-1 SCI Pins
Channel
Name
Abbreviation
I/O
Function
0
Serial clock pin
SCK0
Input/output
SCI0 clock input/output
Receive data pin
RxD0
Input
SCI0 receive data input
Transmit data pin
TxD0
Output
SCI0 transmit data output
Serial clock pin
SCK1
Input/output
SCI1 clock input/output
Receive data pin
RxD1
Input
SCI1 receive data input
Transmit data pin
TxD1
Output
SCI1 transmit data output
1
13.1.4 Register Configuration
The SCI has internal registers as listed in table 13-2. These registers select asynchronous or
synchronous mode, specify the data format and bit rate, and control the transmitter and receiver
sections.
Table 13-2 Registers
Channel
Address*1
Name
Abbreviation
R/W
Initial Value
0
H'FFB0
Serial mode register
SMR
R/W
H'00
H'FFB1
Bit rate register
BRR
R/W
H'FF
H'FFB2
Serial control register
SCR
R/W
H'00
H'FFB3
Transmit data register
TDR
R/W
H'FF
H'FFB4
Serial status register
SSR
R/(W)*2
H'84
H'FFB5
Receive data register
RDR
R
H'00
H'FFB8
Serial mode register
SMR
R/W
H'00
H'FFB9
Bit rate register
BRR
R/W
H'FF
H'FFBA
Serial control register
SCR
R/W
H'00
H'FFBB
Transmit data register
TDR
R/W
H'FF
H'FFBC
Serial status register
SSR
R/(W)*2
H'84
H'FFBD
Receive data register
RDR
R
H'00
1
Notes: 1. Lower 16 bits of the address.
2. Only 0 can be written, to clear flags.
422
13.2 Register Descriptions
13.2.1 Receive Shift Register (RSR)
RSR is the register that receives serial data.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Initial value
Read/Write
The SCI loads serial data input at the RxD pin into RSR in the order received, LSB (bit 0) first,
thereby converting the data to parallel data. When 1 byte has been received, it is automatically
transferred to RDR. The CPU cannot read or write RSR directly.
13.2.2 Receive Data Register (RDR)
RDR is the register that stores received serial data.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
When the SCI finishes receiving 1 byte of serial data, it transfers the received data from RSR into
RDR for storage. RSR is then ready to receive the next data. This double buffering allows data to
be received continuously.
RDR is a read-only register. Its contents cannot be modified by the CPU. RDR is initialized to
H'00 by a reset and in standby mode.
423
13.2.3 Transmit Shift Register (TSR)
TSR is the register that transmits serial data.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Initial value
Read/Write
The SCI loads transmit data from TDR into TSR, then transmits the data serially from the TxD
pin, LSB (bit 0) first. After transmitting one data byte, the SCI automatically loads the next
transmit data from TDR into TSR and starts transmitting it. If the TDRE flag is set to 1 in SSR,
however, the SCI does not load the TDR contents into TSR. The CPU cannot read or write TSR
directly.
13.2.4 Transmit Data Register (TDR)
TDR is an 8-bit register that stores data for serial transmission.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
When the SCI detects that TSR is empty, it moves transmit data written in TDR from TDR into
TSR and starts serial transmission. Continuous serial transmission is possible by writing the next
transmit data in TDR during serial transmission from TSR.
The CPU can always read and write TDR. TDR is initialized to H'FF by a reset and in standby
mode.
424
13.2.5 Serial Mode Register (SMR)
SMR is an 8-bit register that specifies the SCI serial communication format and selects the clock
source for the baud rate generator.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
C/A
CHR
PE
O/E
STOP
MP
CKS1
CKS0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Clock select 1/0
These bits select the
baud rate generator’s
clock source
Multiprocessor mode
Selects the multiprocessor
function
Stop bit length
Selects the stop bit length
Parity mode
Selects even or odd parity
Parity enable
Selects whether a parity bit is added
Character length
Selects character length in asynchronous mode
Communication mode
Selects asynchronous or synchronous mode
The CPU can always read and write SMR. SMR is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in standby
mode.
425
Bit 7—Communication Mode (C/A): Selects whether the SCI operates in asynchronous or
synchronous mode.
Bit 7
C/A
Description
0
Asynchronous mode
1
Synchronous mode
(Initial value)
Bit 6—Character Length (CHR): Selects 7-bit or 8-bit data length in asynchronous mode. In
synchronous mode the data length is 8 bits regardless of the CHR setting.
Bit 6
CHR
Description
0
8-bit data
1
7-bit data*
(Initial value)
Note: * When 7-bit data is selected, the MSB (bit 7) in TDR is not transmitted.
Bit 5—Parity Enable (PE): In asynchronous mode, this bit enables or disables the addition of a
parity bit to transmit data, and the checking of the parity bit in receive data. In synchronous mode
the parity bit is neither added nor checked, regardless of the PE setting.
Bit 5
PE
Description
0
Parity bit not added or checked
1
Parity bit added and checked*
(Initial value)
Note: * When PE is set to 1, an even or odd parity bit is added to transmit data according to the
even or odd parity mode selected by the O/E bit, and the parity bit in receive data is
checked to see that it matches the even or odd mode selected by the O/E bit.
426
Bit 4—Parity Mode (O/E): Selects even or odd parity. The O/E bit setting is valid in
asynchronous mode when the PE bit is set to 1 to enable the adding and checking of a parity bit.
The O/E setting is ignored in synchronous mode, or when parity adding and checking is disabled
in asynchronous mode.
Bit 4
O/E
Description
0
Even parity*1
1
Odd
(Initial value)
parity*2
Notes: 1. When even parity is selected, the parity bit added to transmit data makes an even
number of 1s in the transmitted character and parity bit combined. Receive data must
have an even number of 1s in the received character and parity bit combined.
2. When odd parity is selected, the parity bit added to transmit data makes an odd number
of 1s in the transmitted character and parity bit combined. Receive data must have an
odd number of 1s in the received character and parity bit combined.
Bit 3—Stop Bit Length (STOP): Selects one or two stop bits in asynchronous mode. This setting
is used only in asynchronous mode. In synchronous mode no stop bit is added, so the STOP bit
setting is ignored.
Bit 3
STOP
Description
0
One stop bit*1
1
Two stop
(Initial value)
bits*2
Notes: 1. One stop bit (with value 1) is added at the end of each transmitted character.
2. Two stop bits (with value 1) are added at the end of each transmitted character.
In receiving, only the first stop bit is checked, regardless of the STOP bit setting. If the second
stop bit is 1 it is treated as a stop bit. If the second stop bit is 0 it is treated as the start bit of the
next incoming character.
427
Bit 2—Multiprocessor Mode (MP): Selects a multiprocessor format. When a multiprocessor
format is selected, parity settings made by the PE and O/E bits are ignored. The MP bit setting is
valid only in asynchronous mode. It is ignored in synchronous mode.
For further information on the multiprocessor communication function, see section 13.3.3,
Multiprocessor Communication Function.
Bit 2
MP
Description
0
Multiprocessor function disabled
1
Multiprocessor format selected
(Initial value)
Bits 1 and 0—Clock Select 1 and 0 (CKS1/0): These bits select the clock source of the on-chip
baud rate generator. Four clock sources are available: ø, ø/4, ø/16, and ø/64.
For the relationship between the clock source, bit rate register setting, and baud rate, see
section 13.2.8, Bit Rate Register.
Bit 1
CKS1
Bit 0
CKS0
Description
0
0
ø
0
1
ø/4
1
0
ø/16
1
1
ø/64
(Initial value)
428
13.2.6 Serial Control Register (SCR)
SCR enables the SCI transmitter and receiver, enables or disables serial clock output in
asynchronous mode, enables or disables interrupts, and selects the transmit/receive clock source.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TIE
RIE
TE
RE
MPIE
TEIE
CKE1
CKE0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Clock enable 1/0
These bits select the
SCI clock source
Transmit end interrupt enable
Enables or disables transmitend interrupts (TEI)
Multiprocessor interrupt enable
Enables or disables multiprocessor
interrupts
Receive enable
Enables or disables the receiver
Transmit enable
Enables or disables the transmitter
Receive interrupt enable
Enables or disables receive-data-full interrupts (RXI) and
receive-error interrupts (ERI)
Transmit interrupt enable
Enables or disables transmit-data-empty interrupts (TXI)
The CPU can always read and write SCR. SCR is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in standby
mode.
429
Bit 7—Transmit Interrupt Enable (TIE): Enables or disables the transmit-data-empty interrupt
(TXI) requested when the TDRE flag in SSR is set to 1 due to transfer of serial transmit data from
TDR to TSR.
Bit 7
TIE
Description
0
Transmit-data-empty interrupt request (TXI) is disabled*
1
Transmit-data-empty interrupt request (TXI) is enabled
(Initial value)
Note: * TXI interrupt requests can be cleared by reading the value 1 from the TDRE flag, then
clearing it to 0; or by clearing the TIE bit to 0.
Bit 6—Receive Interrupt Enable (RIE): Enables or disables the receive-data-full interrupt
(RXI) requested when the RDRF flag is set to 1 in SSR due to transfer of serial receive data from
RSR to RDR; also enables or disables the receive-error interrupt (ERI).
Bit 6
RIE
Description
0
Receive-end (RXI) and receive-error (ERI) interrupt requests are disabled (Initial value)
1
Receive-end (RXI) and receive-error (ERI) interrupt requests are enabled
Note: * RXI and ERI interrupt requests can be cleared by reading the value 1 from the RDRF, FER,
PER, or ORER flag, then clearing it to 0; or by clearing the RIE bit to 0.
Bit 5—Transmit Enable (TE): Enables or disables the start of SCI serial transmitting operations.
Bit 5
TE
Description
0
Transmitting disabled*1
1
Transmitting enabled*2
(Initial value)
Notes: 1. The TDRE bit is locked at 1 in SSR.
2. In the enabled state, serial transmitting starts when the TDRE bit in SSR is cleared to 0
after writing of transmit data into TDR. Select the transmit format in SMR before setting
the TE bit to 1.
430
Bit 4—Receive Enable (RE): Enables or disables the start of SCI serial receiving operations.
Bit 4
RE
Description
0
Receiving disabled*1
1
enabled*2
Receiving
(Initial value)
Notes: 1. Clearing the RE bit to 0 does not affect the RDRF, FER, PER, and ORER flags. These
flags retain their previous values.
2. In the enabled state, serial receiving starts when a start bit is detected in asynchronous
mode, or serial clock input is detected in synchronous mode. Select the receive format
in SMR before setting the RE bit to 1.
Bit 3—Multiprocessor Interrupt Enable (MPIE): Enables or disables multiprocessor interrupts.
The MPIE setting is valid only in asynchronous mode, and only if the MP bit is set to 1 in SMR.
The MPIE setting is ignored in synchronous mode or when the MP bit is cleared to 0.
Bit 3
MPIE
Description
0
Multiprocessor interrupts are disabled (normal receive operation)
[Clearing conditions]
The MPIE bit is cleared to 0.
MPB = 1 in received data.
(Initial value)
1
Multiprocessor interrupts are enabled*
Receive-data-full interrupts (RXI), receive-error interrupts (ERI), and setting of the RDRF,
FER, and ORER status flags in SSR are disabled until data with the multiprocessor bit
set to 1 is received.
Note: * The SCI does not transfer receive data from RSR to RDR, does not detect receive errors,
and does not set the RDRF, FER, and ORER flags in SSR. When it receives data in which
MPB = 1, the SCI sets the MPB bit to 1 in SSR, automatically clears the MPIE bit to 0,
enables RXI and ERI interrupts (if the RIE bit is set to 1 in SCR), and allows the FER and
ORER flags to be set.
431
Bit 2—Transmit-End Interrupt Enable (TEIE): Enables or disables the transmit-end interrupt
(TEI) requested if TDR does not contain new transmit data when the MSB is transmitted.
Bit 2
TEIE
Description
0
Transmit-end interrupt requests (TEI) are disabled*
1
Transmit-end interrupt requests (TEI) are enabled*
(Initial value)
Note: * TEI interrupt requests can be cleared by reading the value 1 from the TDRE flag in SSR,
then clearing the TDRE flag to 0, thereby also clearing the TEND flag to 0; or by clearing
the TEIE bit to 0.
Bits 1 and 0—Clock Enable 1 and 0 (CKE1/0): These bits select the SCI clock source and
enable or disable clock output from the SCK pin. Depending on the settings of CKE1 and CKE0,
the SCK pin can be used for generic input/output, serial clock output, or serial clock input.
The CKE0 setting is valid only in asynchronous mode, and only when the SCI is internally
clocked (CKE1 = 0). The CKE0 setting is ignored in synchronous mode, or when an external
clock source is selected (CKE1 = 1). Select the SCI operating mode in SMR before setting the
CKE1 and CKE0 bits. For further details on selection of the SCI clock source, see table 13-9 in
section 13.3, Operation.
Bit 1
CKE1
Bit 0
CKE0
Description
0
0
Asynchronous mode
Internal clock, SCK pin available for generic
input/output *1
Synchronous mode
Internal clock, SCK pin used for serial clock output *1
Asynchronous mode
Internal clock, SCK pin used for clock output *2
Synchronous mode
Internal clock, SCK pin used for serial clock output
Asynchronous mode
External clock, SCK pin used for clock input *3
Synchronous mode
External clock, SCK pin used for serial clock input
Asynchronous mode
External clock, SCK pin used for clock input *3
Synchronous mode
External clock, SCK pin used for serial clock input
0
1
1
1
0
1
Notes: 1. Initial value
2. The output clock frequency is the same as the bit rate.
3. The input clock frequency is 16 times the bit rate.
432
13.2.7 Serial Status Register (SSR)
SSR is an 8-bit register containing multiprocessor bit values, and status flags that indicate SCI
operating status.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TDRE
RDRF
ORER
FER
PER
TEND
MPB
MPBT
Initial value
1
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
Read/Write
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R
R
R/W
Multiprocessor
bit transfer
Value of multiprocessor bit to
be transmitted
Multiprocessor bit
Stores the received
multiprocessor bit value
Transmit end
Status flag indicating end of
transmission
Parity error
Status flag indicating detection of
a receive parity error
Framing error
Status flag indicating detection of a receive
framing error
Overrun error
Status flag indicating detection of a receive overrun error
Receive data register full
Status flag indicating that data has been received and stored in RDR
Transmit data register empty
Status flag indicating that transmit data has been transferred from TDR into
TSR and new data can be written in TDR
Note: * Only 0 can be written, to clear the flag.
433
The CPU can always read and write SSR, but cannot write 1 in the TDRE, RDRF, ORER, PER,
and FER flags. These flags can be cleared to 0 only if they have first been read while set to 1. The
TEND and MPB flags are read-only bits that cannot be written.
SSR is initialized to H'84 by a reset and in standby mode.
Bit 7—Transmit Data Register Empty (TDRE): Indicates that the SCI has loaded transmit data
from TDR into TSR and the next serial transmit data can be written in TDR.
Bit 7
TDRE
Description
0
TDR contains valid transmit data
[Clearing conditions]
Software reads TDRE while it is set to 1, then writes 0.
The DMAC writes data in TDR.
1
TDR does not contain valid transmit data
[Setting conditions]
The chip is reset or enters standby mode.
The TE bit in SCR is cleared to 0.
TDR contents are loaded into TSR, so new data can be written in TDR.
(Initial value)
Bit 6—Receive Data Register Full (RDRF): Indicates that RDR contains new receive data.
Bit 6
RDRF
Description
0
RDR does not contain new receive data
[Clearing conditions]
The chip is reset or enters standby mode.
Software reads RDRF while it is set to 1, then writes 0.
The DMAC reads data from RDR.
1
RDR contains new receive data
[Setting condition]
When serial data is received normally and transferred from RSR to RDR.
(Initial value)
Note: The RDR contents and RDRF flag are not affected by detection of receive errors or by
clearing of the RE bit to 0 in SCR. They retain their previous values. If the RDRF flag is still
set to 1 when reception of the next data ends, an overrun error occurs and receive data is
lost.
434
Bit 5—Overrun Error (ORER): Indicates that data reception ended abnormally due to an
overrun error.
Bit 5
ORER
Description
0
Receiving is in progress or has ended normally
[Clearing conditions]
The chip is reset or enters standby mode.
Software reads ORER while it is set to 1, then writes 0.
1
A receive overrun error occurred*2
[Setting condition]
Reception of the next serial data ends when RDRF = 1.
(Initial value)*1
Notes: 1. Clearing the RE bit to 0 in SCR does not affect the ORER flag, which retains its
previous value.
2. RDR continues to hold the receive data before the overrun error, so subsequent receive
data is lost. Serial receiving cannot continue while the ORER flag is set to 1. In
synchronous mode, serial transmitting is also disabled.
Bit 4—Framing Error (FER): Indicates that data reception ended abnormally due to a framing
error in asynchronous mode.
Bit 4
FER
Description
0
Receiving is in progress or has ended normally
[Clearing conditions]
The chip is reset or enters standby mode.
Software reads FER while it is set to 1, then writes 0.
1
A receive framing error occurred*2
[Setting condition]
The stop bit at the end of receive data is checked and found to be 0.
(Initial value)*1
Notes: 1. Clearing the RE bit to 0 in SCR does not affect the FER flag, which retains its previous
value.
2. When the stop bit length is 2 bits, only the first bit is checked. The second stop bit is not
checked. When a framing error occurs the SCI transfers the receive data into RDR but
does not set the RDRF flag. Serial receiving cannot continue while the FER flag is set
to 1. In synchronous mode, serial transmitting is also disabled.
435
Bit 3—Parity Error (PER): Indicates that data reception ended abnormally due to a parity error
in asynchronous mode.
Bit 3
PER
Description
0
Receiving is in progress or has ended normally*1
[Clearing conditions]
The chip is reset or enters standby mode.
Software reads PER while it is set to 1, then writes 0.
1
A receive parity error occurred*2
[Setting condition]
The number of 1s in receive data, including the parity bit, does not match the even or
odd parity setting of O/E in SMR.
(Initial value)
Notes: 1. Clearing the RE bit to 0 in SCR does not affect the PER flag, which retains its previous
value.
2. When a parity error occurs the SCI transfers the receive data into RDR but does not set
the RDRF flag. Serial receiving cannot continue while the PER flag is set to 1. In
synchronous mode, serial transmitting is also disabled.
Bit 2—Transmit End (TEND): Indicates that when the last bit of a serial character was
transmitted TDR did not contain new transmit data, so transmission has ended. The TEND flag is
a read-only bit and cannot be written.
Bit 2
TEND
Description
0
Transmission is in progress
[Clearing conditions]
Software reads TDRE while it is set to 1, then writes 0 in the TDRE flag.
The DMAC writes data in TDR.
1
End of transmission
[Setting conditions]
The chip is reset or enters standby mode.
The TE bit is cleared to 0 in SCR.
TDRE is 1 when the last bit of a serial character is transmitted.
436
(Initial value)
Bit 1—Multiprocessor Bit (MPB): Stores the value of the multiprocessor bit in receive data
when a multiprocessor format is used in asynchronous mode. MPB is a read-only bit and cannot
be written.
Bit 1
MPB
Description
0
Multiprocessor bit value in receive data is 0*
1
Multiprocessor bit value in receive data is 1
(Initial value)
Note: * If the RE bit is cleared to 0 when a multiprocessor format is selected, MPB retains its
previous value.
Bit 0—Multiprocessor Bit Transfer (MPBT): Stores the value of the multiprocessor bit added to
transmit data when a multiprocessor format is selected for transmitting in asynchronous mode.
The MPBT setting is ignored in synchronous mode, when a multiprocessor format is not selected,
or when the SCI is not transmitting.
Bit 0
MPBT
Description
0
Multiprocessor bit value in transmit data is 0
1
Multiprocessor bit value in transmit data is 1
(Initial value)
13.2.8 Bit Rate Register (BRR)
BRR is an 8-bit register that, together with the CKS1 and CKS0 bits in SMR that select the baud
rate generator clock source, determines the serial communication bit rate.
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
The CPU can always read and write BRR. BRR is initialized to H'FF by a reset and in standby
mode. The two SCI channels have independent baud rate generator control, so different values can
be set in the two channels.
Table 13-3 shows examples of BRR settings in asynchronous mode. Table 13-4 shows examples
of BRR settings in synchronous mode.
437
Table 13-3 Examples of Bit Rates and BRR Settings in Asynchronous Mode
ø (MHz)
2
2.097152
2.4576
3
Bit Rate
(bits/s)
n
N
Error
(%)
n
N
Error
(%)
n
N
Error
(%)
n
N
Error
(%)
110
1
141
0.03
1
148
–0.04
1
174
–0.26
1
212
0.03
150
1
103
0.16
1
108
0.21
1
127
0.00
1
155
0.16
300
0
207
0.16
0
217
0.21
0
255
0.00
1
77
0.16
600
0
103
0.16
0
108
0.21
0
127
0.00
0
155
0.16
1200
0
51
0.16
0
54
–0.70
0
63
0.00
0
77
0.16
2400
0
25
0.16
0
26
1.14
0
31
0.00
0
38
0.16
4800
0
12
0.16
0
13
–2.48
0
15
0.00
0
19
–2.34
9600
0
6
–6.99
0
6
–2.48
0
7
0.00
0
9
–2.34
19200
0
2
8.51
0
2
13.78
0
3
0.00
0
4
–2.34
31250
0
1
0.00
0
1
4.86
0
1
22.88
0
2
0.00
38400
0
1
–18.62
0
1
–14.67
0
1
0.00
—
—
—
ø (MHz)
3.6864
4
4.9152
5
Bit Rate
(bits/s)
n
N
Error
(%)
n
N
Error
(%)
n
N
Error
(%)
n
N
Error
(%)
110
2
64
0.70
2
70
0.03
2
86
0.31
2
88
–0.25
150
1
191
0.00
1
207
0.16
1
255
0.00
2
64
0.16
300
1
95
0.00
1
103
0.16
1
127
0.00
1
129
0.16
600
0
191
0.00
0
207
0.16
0
255
0.00
1
64
0.16
1200
0
95
0.00
0
103
0.16
0
127
0.00
0
129
0.16
2400
0
47
0.00
0
51
0.16
0
63
0.00
0
64
0.16
4800
0
23
0.00
0
25
0.16
0
31
0.00
0
32
–1.36
9600
0
11
0.00
0
12
0.16
0
15
0.00
0
15
1.73
19200
0
5
0.00
0
6
–6.99
0
7
0.00
0
7
1.73
31250
—
—
—
0
3
0.00
0
4
–1.70
0
4
0.00
38400
0
2
0.00
0
2
8.51
0
3
0.00
0
3
1.73
438
Table 13-3 Examples of Bit Rates and BRR Settings in Asynchronous Mode (cont)
ø (MHz)
6
6.144
7.3728
8
Bit Rate
(bits/s)
n
N
Error
(%)
n
N
Error
(%)
n
N
Error
(%)
n
N
Error
(%)
110
2
106
–0.44
2
108
0.08
2
130
–0.07
2
141
0.03
150
2
77
0.16
2
79
0.00
2
95
0.00
2
103
0.16
300
1
155
0.16
1
159
0.00
1
191
0.00
1
207
0.16
600
1
77
0.16
1
79
0.00
1
95
0.00
1
103
0.16
1200
0
155
0.16
0
159
0.00
0
191
0.00
0
207
0.16
2400
0
77
0.16
0
79
0.00
0
95
0.00
0
103
0.16
4800
0
38
0.16
0
39
0.00
0
47
0.00
0
51
0.16
9600
0
19
–2.34
0
19
0.00
0
23
0.00
0
25
0.16
19200
0
9
–2.34
0
9
0.00
0
11
0.00
0
12
0.16
31250
0
5
0.00
0
5
2.40
0
6
5.33
0
7
0.00
38400
0
4
–2.34
0
4
0.00
0
5
0.00
0
6
–6.99
ø (MHz)
9.8304
10
12
12.288
Bit Rate
(bits/s)
n
N
Error
(%)
n
N
Error
(%)
n
N
Error
(%)
n
N
Error
(%)
110
2
174
–0.26
2
177
–0.25
2
212
0.03
2
217
0.08
150
2
127
0.00
2
129
0.16
2
155
0.16
2
159
0.00
300
1
255
0.00
2
64
0.16
2
77
0.16
2
79
0.00
600
1
127
0.00
1
129
0.16
1
155
0.16
1
159
0.00
1200
0
255
0.00
1
64
0.16
1
77
0.16
1
79
0.00
2400
0
127
0.00
0
129
0.16
0
155
0.16
0
159
0.00
4800
0
63
0.00
0
64
0.16
0
77
0.16
0
79
0.00
9600
0
31
0.00
0
32
–1.36
0
38
0.16
0
39
0.00
19200
0
15
0.00
0
15
1.73
0
19
–2.34
0
19
0.00
31250
0
9
–1.70
0
9
0.00
0
11
0.00
0
11
2.40
38400
0
7
0.00
0
7
1.73
0
9
–2.34
0
9
0.00
439
Table 13-3 Examples of Bit Rates and BRR Settings in Asynchronous Mode (cont)
ø (MHz)
14
14.7456
16
Bit Rate
(bits/s)
n
N
Error
(%)
n
N
Error
(%)
n
N
Error
(%)
110
2
248
–0.17
3
64
0.70
3
70
0.03
150
2
181
0.16
2
191
0.00
2
207
0.16
300
2
90
0.16
2
95
0.00
2
103
0.16
600
1
181
0.16
1
191
0.00
1
207
0.16
1200
1
90
0.16
1
95
0.00
1
103
0.16
2400
0
181
0.16
0
191
0.00
0
207
0.16
4800
0
90
0.16
0
95
0.00
0
103
0.16
9600
0
45
–0.93
0
47
0.00
0
51
0.16
19200
0
22
–0.93
0
23
0.00
0
25
0.16
31250
0
13
0.00
0
14
–1.70
0
15
0.00
38400
0
10
3.57
0
11
0.00
0
12
0.16
440
Table 13-4 Examples of Bit Rates and BRR Settings in Synchronous Mode
ø (MHz)
2
4
8
10
16
Bit Rate
(bits/s)
n
N
n
N
n
N
n
N
n
N
110
3
70
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
250
2
124
2
249
3
124
—
—
3
249
500
1
249
2
124
2
249
—
—
3
124
1k
1
124
1
249
2
124
—
—
2
249
2.5 k
0
199
1
99
1
199
1
249
2
99
5k
0
99
0
199
1
99
1
124
1
199
10 k
0
49
0
99
0
199
0
249
1
99
25 k
0
19
0
39
0
79
0
99
0
159
50 k
0
9
0
19
0
39
0
49
0
79
100 k
0
4
0
9
0
19
0
24
0
39
250 k
0
1
0
3
0
7
0
9
0
15
500 k
0
0*
0
1
0
3
0
4
0
7
0
0*
0
1
—
—
0
3
2M
0
0*
—
—
0
1
2.5 M
—
—
0
0*
—
—
0
0*
1M
4M
Note: Settings with an error of 1% or less are recommended.
Legend
Blank: No setting available
—:
Setting possible, but error occurs
*:
Continuous transmit/receive not possible
The BRR setting is calculated as follows:
Asynchronous mode:
N=
ø
64 ×
22n–1
×B
× 106 – 1
Synchronous mode:
N=
B:
N:
ø:
n:
ø
8 × 22n–1 × B
× 106 – 1
Bit rate (bits/s)
BRR setting for baud rate generator (0 ≤ N ≤ 255)
System clock frequency (MHz)
Baud rate generator clock source (n = 0, 1, 2, 3)
(For the clock sources and values of n, see the following table.)
441
SMR Settings
n
Clock Source
CKS1
CKS0
0
ø
0
0
1
ø/4
0
1
2
ø/16
1
0
3
ø/64
1
1
The bit rate error in asynchronous mode is calculated as follows.
ø × 106
Error (%) =
(N + 1) × B × 64 × 22n–1
–1 × 100
442
Table 13-5 indicates the maximum bit rates in asynchronous mode for various system clock
frequencies. Tables 13-6 and 13-7 indicate the maximum bit rates with external clock input.
Table 13-5 Maximum Bit Rates for Various Frequencies (Asynchronous Mode)
Settings
ø (MHz)
Maximum Bit Rate (bits/s)
n
N
2
62500
0
0
2.097152
65536
0
0
2.4576
76800
0
0
3
93750
0
0
3.6864
115200
0
0
4
125000
0
0
4.9152
153600
0
0
5
156250
0
0
6
187500
0
0
6.144
192000
0
0
7.3728
230400
0
0
8
250000
0
0
9.8304
307200
0
0
10
312500
0
0
12
375000
0
0
12.288
384000
0
0
14
437500
0
0
14.7456
460800
0
0
16
500000
0
0
443
Table 13-6 Maximum Bit Rates with External Clock Input (Asynchronous Mode)
ø (MHz)
External Input Clock (MHz)
Maximum Bit Rate (bits/s)
2
0.5000
31250
2.097152
0.5243
32768
2.4576
0.6144
38400
3
0.7500
46875
3.6864
0.9216
57600
4
1.0000
62500
4.9152
1.2288
76800
5
1.2500
78125
6
1.5000
93750
6.144
1.5360
96000
7.3728
1.8432
115200
8
2.0000
125000
9.8304
2.4576
153600
10
2.5000
156250
12
3.0000
187500
12.288
3.0720
192000
14
3.5000
218750
14.7456
3.6864
230400
16
4.0000
250000
444
Table 13-7 Maximum Bit Rates with External Clock Input (Synchronous Mode)
ø (MHz)
External Input Clock (MHz)
Maximum Bit Rate (bits/s)
2
0.3333
333333.3
4
0.6667
666666.7
6
1.0000
1000000.0
8
1.3333
1333333.3
10
1.6667
1666666.7
12
2.0000
2000000.0
14
2.3333
2333333.3
16
2.6667
2666666.7
445
13.3 Operation
13.3.1 Overview
The SCI has an asynchronous mode in which characters are synchronized individually, and a
synchronous mode in which communication is synchronized with clock pulses. Serial
communication is possible in either mode. Asynchronous or synchronous mode and the
communication format are selected in SMR, as shown in table 13-8. The SCI clock source is
selected by the C/A bit in SMR and the CKE1 and CKE0 bits in SCR, as shown in table 13-9.
Asynchronous Mode
•
Data length is selectable: 7 or 8 bits.
•
Parity and multiprocessor bits are selectable. So is the stop bit length (1 or 2 bits). These
selections determine the communication format and character length.
•
In receiving, it is possible to detect framing errors, parity errors, overrun errors, and the break
state.
•
An internal or external clock can be selected as the SCI clock source.
— When an internal clock is selected, the SCI operates using the on-chip baud rate generator,
and can output a serial clock signal with a frequency matching the bit rate.
— When an external clock is selected, the external clock input must have a frequency
16 times the bit rate. (The on-chip baud rate generator is not used.)
Synchronous Mode
•
The communication format has a fixed 8-bit data length.
•
In receiving, it is possible to detect overrun errors.
•
An internal or external clock can be selected as the SCI clock source.
— When an internal clock is selected, the SCI operates using the on-chip baud rate generator,
and outputs a serial clock signal to external devices.
— When an external clock is selected, the SCI operates on the input serial clock. The on-chip
baud rate generator is not used.
446
Table 13-8 SMR Settings and Serial Communication Formats
SCI Communication Format
SMR Settings
Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 2 Bit 5 Bit 3
C/A CHR MP
PE
STOP Mode
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
0
1
0
1
1
0
0
1
—
0
0
0
1
—
1
0
1
1
—
0
0
1
1
—
1
1
—
—
—
—
Asynchronous
mode
Data
Length
Multiprocessor
Bit
Parity
Bit
Stop
Bit
Length
8-bit data
Absent
Absent
1 bit
2 bits
Present
1 bit
2 bits
7-bit data
Absent
1 bit
2 bits
Present
1 bit
2 bits
Asynchronous
mode (multiprocessor
format)
8-bit data
Present
Absent
1 bit
2 bits
7-bit data
1 bit
2 bits
Synchronous
mode
8-bit data
Absent
None
Table 13-9 SMR and SCR Settings and SCI Clock Source Selection
SMR
SCR Settings
SCI Transmit/Receive Clock
Bit 7 Bit 1 Bit 0
C/A CKE1 CKE0
Mode
Clock Source
SCK Pin Function
0
0
0
Asynchronous mode
Internal
SCI does not use the SCK pin
0
0
1
0
1
0
0
1
1
1
0
0
1
0
1
1
1
0
1
1
1
Outputs a clock with frequency
matching the bit rate
Synchronous mode
External
Inputs a clock with frequency
16 times the bit rate
Internal
Outputs the serial clock
External
Inputs the serial clock
447
13.3.2 Operation in Asynchronous Mode
In asynchronous mode each transmitted or received character begins with a start bit and ends with
a stop bit. Serial communication is synchronized one character at a time.
The transmitting and receiving sections of the SCI are independent, so full duplex communication
is possible. The transmitter and receiver are both double buffered, so data can be written and read
while transmitting and receiving are in progress, enabling continuous transmitting and receiving.
Figure 13-2 shows the general format of asynchronous serial communication. In asynchronous
serial communication the communication line is normally held in the mark (high) state. The SCI
monitors the line and starts serial communication when the line goes to the space (low) state,
indicating a start bit. One serial character consists of a start bit (low), data (LSB first), parity bit
(high or low), and stop bit (high), in that order.
When receiving in asynchronous mode, the SCI synchronizes at the falling edge of the start bit.
The SCI samples each data bit on the eighth pulse of a clock with a frequency 16 times the bit
rate. Receive data is latched at the center of each bit.
1
Serial data
(LSB)
0
D0
Idle (mark) state
1
(MSB)
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
Start
bit
Transmit or receive data
1 bit
7 bits or 8 bits
D6
D7
0/1
Parity
bit
1
1
Stop
bit
1 bit or 1 bit or
no bit 2 bits
One unit of data (character or frame)
Figure 13-2 Data Format in Asynchronous Communication (Example: 8-Bit Data with
Parity and 2 Stop Bits)
448
Communication Formats: Table 13-10 shows the 12 communication formats that can be selected
in asynchronous mode. The format is selected by settings in SMR.
Table 13-10 Serial Communication Formats (Asynchronous Mode)
SMR Settings
Serial Communication Format and Frame Length
CHR
PE
MP
STOP
1
2
3
0
0
0
0
S
8-bit data
STOP
0
0
0
1
S
8-bit data
STOP STOP
0
1
0
0
S
8-bit data
P
STOP
0
1
0
1
S
8-bit data
P
STOP STOP
1
0
0
0
S
7-bit data
STOP
1
0
0
1
S
7-bit data
STOP STOP
1
1
0
0
S
7-bit data
P
STOP
1
1
0
1
S
7-bit data
P
STOP STOP
0
—
1
0
S
8 bit data
MPB STOP
0
—
1
1
S
8 bit data
MPB STOP STOP
1
—
1
0
S
7-bit data
MPB STOP
1
—
1
1
S
7-bit data
MPB STOP STOP
Legend
S:
Start bit
STOP: Stop bit
P:
Parity bit
MPB: Multiprocessor bit
449
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
Clock: An internal clock generated by the on-chip baud rate generator or an external clock input
from the SCK pin can be selected as the SCI transmit/receive clock. The clock source is selected
by the C/A bit in SMR and bits CKE1 and CKE0 in SCR. See table 13-9.
When an external clock is input at the SCK pin, it must have a frequency equal to 16 times the
desired bit rate.
When the SCI operates on an internal clock, it can output a clock signal at the SCK pin. The
frequency of this output clock is equal to the bit rate. The phase is aligned as in figure 13-3 so that
the rising edge of the clock occurs at the center of each transmit data bit.
0
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
0/1
1
1
1 frame
Figure 13-3 Phase Relationship between Output Clock and Serial Data
(Asynchronous Mode)
Transmitting and Receiving Data
SCI Initialization (Asynchronous Mode): Before transmitting or receiving, clear the TE and RE
bits to 0 in SCR, then initialize the SCI as follows.
When changing the communication mode or format, always clear the TE and RE bits to 0 before
following the procedure given below. Clearing TE to 0 sets the TDRE flag to 1 and initializes
TSR. Clearing RE to 0, however, does not initialize the RDRF, PER, FER, and ORER flags and
RDR, which retain their previous contents.
When an external clock is used, the clock should not be stopped during initialization or
subsequent operation. SCI operation becomes unreliable if the clock is stopped.
Figure 13-4 is a sample flowchart for initializing the SCI.
450
Start of initialization
Clear TE and RE bits
to 0 in SCR
Set CKE1 and CKE0 bits
in SCR (leaving TE and
RE bits cleared to 0)
1
Select communication
format in SMR
2
Set value in BRR
3
1. Select the clock source in SCR. Clear the RIE, TIE, TEIE,
MPIE, TE, and RE bits to 0. If clock output is selected in
asynchronous mode, clock output starts immediately after
the setting is made in SCR.
2. Select the communication format in SMR.
3. Write the value corresponding to the bit rate in BRR.
This step is not necessary when an external clock is used.
4. Wait for at least the interval required to transmit or receive
1 bit, then set the TE or RE bit to 1 in SCR. Set the RIE,
TIE, TEIE, and MPIE bits as necessary. Setting the TE
or RE bit enables the SCI to use the TxD or RxD pin.
Note: In simultaneous transmit/receive operations,
the TE and RE bits should be set to 1 or cleared to
0 simultaneously.
Wait
1 bit interval
elapsed?
No
Yes
Set TE or RE bit to 1 in SCR
Set RIE, TIE, TEIE, and
MPIE bits as necessary
4
Transmitting or receiving
Figure 13-4 Sample Flowchart for SCI Initialization
451
Transmitting Serial Data (Asynchronous Mode): Figure 13-5 shows a sample flowchart for
transmitting serial data and indicates the procedure to follow.
1
Initialize
Start transmitting
2
Read TDRE flag in SSR
No
TDRE = 1?
Yes
Write transmit data
in TDR and clear TDRE
flag to 0 in SSR
All data
transmitted?
No
1. SCI initialization: the transmit data output function
of the TxD pin is selected automatically.
2. SCI status check and transmit data write: read SSR,
check that the TDRE flag is 1, then write transmit data
in TDR and clear the TDRE flag to 0.
3. To continue transmitting serial data: after checking
that the TDRE flag is 1, indicating that data can be
written, write data in TDR, then clear the TDRE
flag to 0. When the DMAC is activated by a transmit-data-empty interrupt request (TXI) to write data in TDR,
the TDRE flag is checked and cleared automatically.
4. To output a break signal at the end of serial transmission:
set the DDR bit to 1 and clear the DR bit to 0
(DDR and DR are I/O port registers), then clear the
TE bit to 0 in SCR.
3
Yes
Read TEND flag in SSR
TEND = 1?
No
Yes
Output break
signal?
No
4
Yes
Clear DR bit to 0,
set DDR bit to 1
Clear TE bit to 0 in SCR
End
Figure 13-5 Sample Flowchart for Transmitting Serial Data
452
In transmitting serial data, the SCI operates as follows.
•
The SCI monitors the TDRE flag in SSR. When the TDRE flag is cleared to 0 the SCI
recognizes that TDR contains new data, and loads this data from TDR into TSR.
•
After loading the data from TDR into TSR, the SCI sets the TDRE flag to 1 and starts
transmitting. If the TIE bit is set to 1 in SCR, the SCI requests a transmit-data-empty interrupt
(TXI) at this time.
Serial transmit data is transmitted in the following order from the TxD pin:
— Start bit:
One 0 bit is output.
— Transmit data:
7 or 8 bits are output, LSB first.
— Parity bit or multiprocessor bit: One parity bit (even or odd parity) or one multiprocessor
bit is output. Formats in which neither a parity bit nor a
multiprocessor bit is output can also be selected.
— Stop bit:
One or two 1 bits (stop bits) are output.
— Mark state:
Output of 1 bits continues until the start bit of the next
transmit data.
•
The SCI checks the TDRE flag when it outputs the stop bit. If the TDRE flag is 0, the SCI
loads new data from TDR into TSR, outputs the stop bit, then begins serial transmission of
the next frame. If the TDRE flag is 1, the SCI sets the TEND flag to 1 in SSR, outputs the
stop bit, then continues output of 1 bits in the mark state. If the TEIE bit is set to 1 in SCR, a
transmit-end interrupt (TEI) is requested at this time.
Figure 13-6 shows an example of SCI transmit operation in asynchronous mode.
1
Start
bit
0
Parity Stop Start
bit
bit
bit
Data
D0
D1
D7
0/1
1
0
Parity Stop
bit
bit
Data
D0
D1
D7
0/1
1
1
Idle (mark)
state
TDRE
TEND
TXI
interrupt
request
TXI interrupt handler
writes data in TDR and
clears TDRE flag to 0
TXI
interrupt
request
TEI interrupt request
1 frame
Figure 13-6 Example of SCI Transmit Operation in Asynchronous Mode
(8-Bit Data with Parity and 1 Stop Bit)
453
Receiving Serial Data (Asynchronous Mode): Figure 13-7 shows a sample flowchart for
receiving serial data and indicates the procedure to follow.
Initialize
1
Start receiving
Read ORER, PER,
and FER flags in SSR
PER ∨ FER ∨
ORER = 1?
2
Yes
3
No
Error handling
(continued on next page)
Read RDRF flag in SSR
4
No
RDRF = 1?
Yes
1. SCI initialization: the receive data function of
the RxD pin is selected automatically.
2, 3. Receive error handling and break
detection: if a receive error occurs, read the
ORER, PER, and FER flags in SSR to identify
the error. After executing the necessary error
handling, clear the ORER, PER, and FER
flags all to 0. Receiving cannot resume if any
of the ORER, PER, and FER flags remains
set to 1. When a framing error occurs, the
RxD pin can be read to detect the break state.
4. SCI status check and receive data read: read
SSR, check that RDRF is set to 1, then read
receive data from RDR and clear the RDRF
flag to 0. Notification that the RDRF flag has
changed from 0 to 1 can also be given by the
RXI interrupt.
5. To continue receiving serial data: check the
RDRF flag, read RDR, and clear the RDRF
flag to 0 before the stop bit of the current
frame is received. If the DMAC is activated
by an RXI interrupt to read the RDR value,
the RDRF flag is cleared automatically.
Read receive data
from RDR, and clear
RDRF flag to 0 in SSR
No
Finished
receiving?
5
Yes
Clear RE bit to 0 in SCR
End
Figure 13-7 Sample Flowchart for Receiving Serial Data (1)
454
3
Error handling
No
ORER = 1?
Yes
Overrun error handling
No
FER = 1?
Yes
Yes
Break?
No
Framing error handling
Clear RE bit to 0 in SCR
No
PER = 1?
Yes
Parity error handling
Clear ORER, PER, and
FER flags to 0 in SSR
End
Figure 13-7 Sample Flowchart for Receiving Serial Data (2)
455
In receiving, the SCI operates as follows.
•
The SCI monitors the receive data line. When it detects a start bit, the SCI synchronizes
internally and starts receiving.
•
Receive data is stored in RSR in order from LSB to MSB.
•
The parity bit and stop bit are received.
After receiving, the SCI makes the following checks:
— Parity check:
The number of 1s in the receive data must match the even or odd parity
setting of the O/E bit in SMR.
— Stop bit check: The stop bit value must be 1. If there are two stop bits, only the first stop
bit is checked.
— Status check: The RDRF flag must be 0 so that receive data can be transferred from
RSR into RDR.
If these checks all pass, the RDRF flag is set to 1 and the received data is stored in RDR. If one of
the checks fails (receive error), the SCI operates as indicated in table 13-11.
Note: When a receive error occurs, further receiving is disabled. In receiving, the RDRF flag is
not set to 1. Be sure to clear the error flags to 0.
•
When the RDRF flag is set to 1, if the RIE bit is set to 1 in SCR, a receive-data-full interrupt
(RXI) is requested. If the ORER, PER, or FER flag is set to 1 and the RIE bit in SCR is also
set to 1, a receive-error interrupt (ERI) is requested.
Table 13-11 Receive Error Conditions
Receive Error
Abbreviation
Condition
Data Transfer
Overrun error
ORER
Receiving of next data ends
while RDRF flag is still set to
1 in SSR
Receive data not transferred
from RSR to RDR
Framing error
FER
Stop bit is 0
Receive data transferred
from RSR to RDR
Parity error
PER
Parity of receive data differs
from even/odd parity setting
in SMR
Receive data transferred
from RSR to RDR
456
Figure 13-8 shows an example of SCI receive operation in asynchronous mode.
1
Start
bit
0
Parity Stop Start
bit
bit
bit
Data
D0
D1
D7
0/1
1
0
Parity Stop
bit
bit
Data
D0
D1
D7
0/1
1
1
Idle (mark)
state
RDRF
FER
RXI
request
1 frame
RXI interrupt handler
reads data in RDR and
clears RDRF flag to 0
Framing error,
ERI request
Figure 13-8 Example of SCI Receive Operation (8-Bit Data with Parity and One Stop Bit)
13.3.3 Multiprocessor Communication
The multiprocessor communication function enables several processors to share a single serial
communication line. The processors communicate in asynchronous mode using a format with an
additional multiprocessor bit (multiprocessor format).
In multiprocessor communication, each receiving processor is addressed by an ID. A serial
communication cycle consists of an ID-sending cycle that identifies the receiving processor, and a
data-sending cycle. The multiprocessor bit distinguishes ID-sending cycles from data-sending
cycles.
The transmitting processor starts by sending the ID of the receiving processor with which it wants
to communicate as data with the multiprocessor bit set to 1. Next the transmitting processor sends
transmit data with the multiprocessor bit cleared to 0.
Receiving processors skip incoming data until they receive data with the multiprocessor bit set
to 1. When they receive data with the multiprocessor bit set to 1, receiving processors compare the
data with their IDs. The receiving processor with a matching ID continues to receive further
incoming data. Processors with IDs not matching the received data skip further incoming data
until they again receive data with the multiprocessor bit set to 1. Multiple processors can send and
receive data in this way.
Figure 13-9 shows an example of communication among different processors using a
multiprocessor format.
457
Communication Formats: Four formats are available. Parity-bit settings are ignored when a
multiprocessor format is selected. For details see table 13-10.
Clock: See the description of asynchronous mode.
Transmitting
processor
Serial communication line
Receiving
processor A
Receiving
processor B
Receiving
processor C
Receiving
processor D
(ID = 01)
(ID = 02)
(ID = 03)
(ID = 04)
Serial data
H'01
H'AA
(MPB = 1)
(MPB = 0)
ID-sending cycle: receiving
processor address
Data-sending cycle:
data sent to receiving
processor specified by ID
Legend
MPB: Multiprocessor bit
Figure 13-9 Example of Communication among Processors using Multiprocessor Format
(Sending Data H'AA to Receiving Processor A)
458
Transmitting and Receiving Data
Transmitting Multiprocessor Serial Data: Figure 13-10 shows a sample flowchart for
transmitting multiprocessor serial data and indicates the procedure to follow.
1
Initialize
Start transmitting
2
Read TDRE flag in SSR
TDRE = 1?
No
Yes
Write transmit data in
TDR and set MPBT bit in SSR
Clear TDRE flag to 0
All data transmitted?
No
3
Yes
1. SCI initialization: the transmit data
output function of the TxD pin is
selected automatically.
2. SCI status check and transmit data
write: read SSR, check that the TDRE
flag is 1, then write transmit
data in TDR. Also set the MPBT flag to
0 or 1 in SSR. Finally, clear the TDRE
flag to 0.
3. To continue transmitting serial data:
after checking that the TDRE flag is 1,
indicating that data can be
written, write data in TDR, then clear
the TDRE flag to 0. When the DMAC
is activated by a transmit-data-empty
interrupt request (TXI) to write data in
TDR, the TDRE flag is checked and
cleared automatically.
4. To output a break signal at the end of
serial transmission: set the DDR bit to
1 and clear the DR bit to 0 (DDR and
DR are I/O port registers), then clear
the TE bit to 0 in SCR.
Read TEND flag in SSR
TEND = 1?
No
Yes
Output break signal?
No
4
Yes
Clear DR bit to 0, set DDR bit to 1
Clear TE bit to 0 in SCR
End
Figure 13-10 Sample Flowchart for Transmitting Multiprocessor Serial Data
459
In transmitting serial data, the SCI operates as follows.
•
The SCI monitors the TDRE flag in SSR. When the TDRE flag is cleared to 0 the SCI
recognizes that TDR contains new data, and loads this data from TDR into TSR.
•
After loading the data from TDR into TSR, the SCI sets the TDRE flag to 1 and starts
transmitting. If the TIE bit in SCR is set to 1, the SCI requests a transmit-data-empty interrupt
(TXI) at this time.
Serial transmit data is transmitted in the following order from the TxD pin:
—
—
—
—
—
•
Start bit:
Transmit data:
Multiprocessor bit:
Stop bit:
Mark state:
One 0 bit is output.
7 or 8 bits are output, LSB first.
One multiprocessor bit (MPBT value) is output.
One or two 1 bits (stop bits) are output.
Output of 1 bits continues until the start bit of the next transmit data.
The SCI checks the TDRE flag when it outputs the stop bit. If the TDRE flag is 0, the SCI
loads data from TDR into TSR, outputs the stop bit, then begins serial transmission of the
next frame. If the TDRE flag is 1, the SCI sets the TEND flag in SSR to 1, outputs the stop
bit, then continues output of 1 bits in the mark state. If the TEIE bit is set to 1 in SCR, a
transmit-end interrupt (TEI) is requested at this time.
Figure 13-11 shows an example of SCI transmit operation using a multiprocessor format.
Multiprocessor
bit
1
Serial
data
Start
bit
0
Stop Start
bit
bit
Data
D0
D1
Multiprocessor
bit
D7
0/1
0
1
Stop
bit
Data
D0
D1
D7
0/1
1
1
Idle (mark)
state
TDRE
TEND
TXI
request
TXI interrupt handler
writes data in TDR and
clears TDRE flag to 0
TXI
request
TEI request
1 frame
Figure 13-11 Example of SCI Transmit Operation (8-Bit Data with Multiprocessor Bit and
One Stop Bit)
460
Receiving Multiprocessor Serial Data: Figure 13-12 shows a sample flowchart for receiving
multiprocessor serial data and indicates the procedure to follow.
Initialize
1
1. SCI initialization: the receive data function
of the RxD pin is selected automatically.
2. ID receive cycle: set the MPIE bit to 1 in SCR.
3. SCI status check and ID check: read SSR,
check that the RDRF flag is set to 1, then read
data from RDR and compare with the
processor’s own ID. If the ID does not match,
set the MPIE bit to 1 again and clear the
RDRF flag to 0. If the ID matches, clear the
RDRF flag to 0.
4. SCI status check and data receiving: read
SSR, check that the RDRF flag is set to 1,
then read data from RDR.
5. Receive error handling and break detection:
if a receive error occurs, read the
ORER and FER flags in SSR to identify the error.
After executing the necessary error handling,
clear the ORER and FER flags both to 0.
Receiving cannot resume while either the ORER
or FER flag remains set to 1. When a framing
error occurs, the RxD pin can be read to detect
the break state.
Start receiving
Set MPIE bit to 1 in SCR
2
Read ORER and FER flags in SSR
FER ∨ ORER = 1
Yes
No
Read RDRF flag in SSR
3
No
RDRF = 1?
Yes
Read receive data from RDR
No
Own ID?
Yes
Read ORER and FER flags in SSR
FER ∨ ORER = 1
Yes
No
Read RDRF flag in SSR
4
No
RDRF = 1?
Yes
Read receive data from RDR
No
Finished receiving?
Yes
5
Error handling
(continued on next page)
Clear RE bit to 0 in SCR
End
Figure 13-12 Sample Flowchart for Receiving Multiprocessor Serial Data (1)
461
5
Error handling
No
ORER = 1?
Yes
Overrun error handling
No
FER = 1?
Yes
Yes
Break?
No
Framing error handling
Clear RE bit to 0 in SCR
Clear ORER, PER, and FER
flags to 0 in SSR
End
Figure 13-12 Sample Flowchart for Receiving Multiprocessor Serial Data (2)
462
Figure 13-13 shows an example of SCI receive operation using a multiprocessor format.
1
Start
bit
0
MPB
Data (ID1)
D0
D1
D7
1
Stop Start
Data (data1)
bit
bit
1
0
D0
D1
MPB
D7
0
Stop
bit
1
1
Idle (mark)
state
MPIE
RDRF
RDR value
ID1
MPB detection
MPIE = 0
RXI request
(multiprocessor
interrupt)
RXI handler reads
RDR data and clears
RDRF flag to 0
Not own ID, so
MPIE bit is set
to 1 again
No RXI request,
RDR not updated
a. Own ID does not match data
1
Start
bit
0
MPB
Data (ID2)
D0
D1
D7
1
Stop Start
Data (data2)
bit
bit
1
0
D0
D1
MPB
D7
0
Stop
bit
1
1
Idle (mark)
state
MPIE
RDRF
RDR value
ID2
MPB detection
MPIE = 0
RXI request
(multiprocessor
interrupt)
Data 2
RXI interrupt handler Own ID, so receiving MPIE bit is set
reads RDR data and continues, with data to 1 again
clears RDRF flag to 0 received by RXI
interrupt handler
b. Own ID matches data
Figure 13-13 Example of SCI Receive Operation (8-Bit Data with Multiprocessor Bit and
One Stop Bit)
463
13.3.4 Synchronous Operation
In synchronous mode, the SCI transmits and receives data in synchronization with clock pulses.
This mode is suitable for high-speed serial communication.
The SCI transmitter and receiver share the same clock but are otherwise independent, so full
duplex communication is possible. The transmitter and receiver are also double buffered, so
continuous transmitting or receiving is possible by reading or writing data while transmitting or
receiving is in progress.
Figure 13-14 shows the general format in synchronous serial communication.
Transfer direction
One unit (character or frame) of serial data
*
*
Serial clock
LSB
Serial data
Bit 0
MSB
Bit 1
Bit 2
Bit 3
Bit 4
Bit 5
Bit 6
Bit 7
Don’t care
Don’t care
Note: * High except in continuous transmitting or receiving
Figure 13-14 Data Format in Synchronous Communication
In synchronous serial communication, each data bit is placed on the communication line from one
falling edge of the serial clock to the next. Data is guaranteed valid at the rise of the serial clock.
In each character, the serial data bits are transmitted in order from LSB (first) to MSB (last). After
output of the MSB, the communication line remains in the state of the MSB. In synchronous mode
the SCI receives data by synchronizing with the rise of the serial clock.
Communication Format: The data length is fixed at 8 bits. No parity bit or multiprocessor bit
can be added.
Clock: An internal clock generated by the on-chip baud rate generator or an external clock input
from the SCK pin can be selected by clearing or setting the CKE1 bit in SCR. See table 13-9.
When the SCI operates on an internal clock, it outputs the clock signal at the SCK pin. Eight clock
pulses are output per transmitted or received character. When the SCI is not transmitting or
receiving, the clock signal remains in the high state.
464
Transmitting and Receiving Data
SCI Initialization (Synchronous Mode): Before transmitting or receiving, clear the TE and RE
bits to 0 in SCR, then initialize the SCI as follows.
When changing the communication mode or format, always clear the TE and RE bits to 0 before
following the procedure given below. Clearing the TE bit to 0 sets the TDRE flag to 1 and
initializes TSR. Clearing the RE bit to 0, however, does not initialize the RDRF, PER, FER, and
ORE flags and RDR, which retain their previous contents.
Figure 13-15 is a sample flowchart for initializing the SCI.
Start of initialization
Clear TE and RE
bits to 0 in SCR
Set RIE, TIE, TEIE, MPIE,
CKE1, and CKE0 bits in SCR
(leaving TE and RE bits
cleared to 0)
1
2
Select communication
format in SMR
1. Select the clock source in SCR. Clear the RIE, TIE, TEIE,
MPIE, TE, and RE bits to 0.
2. Select the communication format in SMR.
3. Write the value corresponding to the bit rate in BRR.
This step is not necessary when an external clock is used.
4. Wait for at least the interval required to transmit or receive
one bit, then set the TE or RE bit to 1 in SCR. Also set
the RIE, TIE, TEIE, and MPIE bits as necessary.
Setting the TE or RE bit enables the SCI to use the
TxD or RxD pin.
Note: In simultaneous transmit/receive operations,
the TE and RE bits should be set to 1 or cleared to
0 simultaneously.
3
Set value in BRR
Wait
1 bit interval
elapsed?
No
Yes
Set TE or RE to 1 in SCR
Set RIE, TIE, TEIE, and
MPIE bits as necessary
4
Start transmitting or receiving
Figure 13-15 Sample Flowchart for SCI Initialization
465
Transmitting Serial Data (Synchronous Mode): Figure 13-16 shows a sample flowchart for
transmitting serial data and indicates the procedure to follow.
Initialize
1
Start transmitting
Read TDRE flag in SSR
2
No
TDRE = 1?
1. SCI initialization: the transmit data output function
of the TxD pin is selected automatically.
2. SCI status check and transmit data write: read SSR,
check that the TDRE flag is 1, then write transmit
data in TDR and clear the TDRE flag to 0.
3. To continue transmitting serial data: after checking
that the TDRE flag is 1, indicating that data can be
written, write data in TDR, then clear the TDRE flag
to 0. When the DMAC is activated by a transmitdata-empty interrupt request (TXI) to write data in
TDR, the TDRE flag is checked and cleared
automatically.
Yes
Write transmit data in
TDR and clear TDRE flag
to 0 in SSR
All data
transmitted?
No
3
Yes
Read TEND flag in SSR
TEND = 1?
No
Yes
Clear TE bit to 0 in SCR
End
Figure 13-16 Sample Flowchart for Serial Transmitting
466
In transmitting serial data, the SCI operates as follows.
•
The SCI monitors the TDRE flag in SSR. When the TDRE flag is cleared to 0 the SCI
recognizes that TDR contains new data, and loads this data from TDR into TSR.
•
After loading the data from TDR into TSR, the SCI sets the TDRE flag to 1 and starts
transmitting. If the TIE bit is set to 1 in SCR, the SCI requests a transmit-data-empty interrupt
(TXI) at this time.
If clock output is selected, the SCI outputs eight serial clock pulses. If an external clock
source is selected, the SCI outputs data in synchronization with the input clock. Data is output
from the TxD pin in order from LSB (bit 0) to MSB (bit 7).
•
The SCI checks the TDRE flag when it outputs the MSB (bit 7). If the TDRE flag is 0, the
SCI loads data from TDR into TSR and begins serial transmission of the next frame. If the
TDRE flag is 1, the SCI sets the TEND flag to 1 in SSR, and after transmitting the MSB,
holds the TxD pin in the MSB state. If the TEIE bit in SCR is set to 1, a transmit-end
interrupt (TEI) is requested at this time.
•
After the end of serial transmission, the SCK pin is held in a constant state.
467
Figure 13-17 shows an example of SCI transmit operation.
Transmit
direction
Serial clock
Serial data
Bit 0
Bit 1
Bit 7
Bit 0
Bit 1
Bit 6
Bit 7
TDRE
TEND
TXI
request
TXI interrupt handler
writes data in TDR
and clears TDRE
flag to 0
TXI
request
1 frame
Figure 13-17 Example of SCI Transmit Operation
468
TEI
request
Receiving Serial Data: Figure 13-18 shows a sample flowchart for receiving serial data and
indicates the procedure to follow. When switching from asynchronous mode to synchronous
mode, make sure that the ORER, PER, and FER flags are cleared to 0. If the FER or PER flag is
set to 1 the RDRF flag will not be set and both transmitting and receiving will be disabled.
Initialize
1
1.
Start receiving
Read ORER flag in SSR
ORER = 1?
2
Yes
3
No
Read RDRF flag in SSR
Error handling
4
No
RDRF = 1?
SCI initialization: the receive data function of
the RxD pin is selected automatically.
2, 3. Receive error handling: if a receive error
occurs, read the ORER flag in SSR, then after
executing the necessary error handling, clear
the ORER flag to 0. Neither transmitting nor
receiving can resume while the ORER flag
remains set to 1.
4. SCI status check and receive data read: read
SSR, check that the RDRF flag is set to 1,
then read receive data from RDR and clear
the RDRF flag to 0. Notification that the RDRF
flag has changed from 0 to 1 can also be
given by the RXI interrupt.
5. To continue receiving serial data: check the
RDRF flag, read RDR, and clear the RDRF
flag to 0 before the MSB (bit 7) of the current
frame is received. If the DMAC is activated
by a receive-data-full interrupt request (RXI)
to read RDR, the RDRF flag is cleared
automatically.
Yes
Read receive data
from RDR, and clear
RDRF flag to 0 in SSR
No
Finished
receiving?
5
Yes
Clear RE bit to 0 in SCR
End
Figure 13-18 Sample Flowchart for Serial Receiving (1)
469
3
Error handling
Overrun error handling
Clear ORER flag to 0 in SSR
End
Figure 13-18 Sample Flowchart for Serial Receiving (2)
In receiving, the SCI operates as follows.
•
The SCI synchronizes with serial clock input or output and initializes internally.
•
Receive data is stored in RSR in order from LSB to MSB.
After receiving the data, the SCI checks that the RDRF flag is 0 so that receive data can be
transferred from RSR to RDR. If this check passes, the RDRF flag is set to 1 and the received
data is stored in RDR. If the check does not pass (receive error), the SCI operates as indicated
in table 13-11.
•
After setting the RDRF flag to 1, if the RIE bit is set to 1 in SCR, the SCI requests a receivedata-full interrupt (RXI). If the ORER flag is set to 1 and the RIE bit in SCR is also set to 1,
the SCI requests a receive-error interrupt (ERI).
470
Figure 13-19 shows an example of SCI receive operation.
Receive direction
Serial clock
Serial data
Bit 7
Bit 0
Bit 7
Bit 0
Bit 1
Bit 6
Bit 7
RDRF
ORER
RXI
request
RXI interrupt handler
reads data in RDR and
clears RDRF flag to 0
RXI
request
Overrun error,
ERI request
1 frame
Figure 13-19 Example of SCI Receive Operation
Transmitting and Receiving Serial Data Simultaneously (Synchronous Mode): Figure 13-20
shows a sample flowchart for transmitting and receiving serial data simultaneously and indicates
the procedure to follow.
471
Initialize
1
Start transmitting and receiving
Read TDRE flag in SSR
2
No
TDRE = 1?
Yes
Write transmit data in TDR and
clear TDRE flag to 0 in SSR
Read ORER flag in SSR
Yes
ORER = 1?
3
No
Read RDRF flag in SSR
Error handling
4
No
RDRF = 1?
Yes
Read receive data from RDR
and clear RDRF flag to 0 in SSR
No
End of transmitting and
receiving?
5
Yes
Clear TE and RE bits to 0 in SCR
1. SCI initialization: the transmit data
output function of the TxD pin and
receive data input function of the
RxD pin are selected, enabling
simultaneous transmitting and
receiving.
2. SCI status check and transmit
data write: read SSR, check that
the TDRE flag is 1, then write
transmit data in TDR and clear
the TDRE flag to 0.
Notification that the TDRE flag has
changed from 0 to 1 can also be
given by the TXI interrupt.
3. Receive error handling: if a receive
error occurs, read the ORER flag in
SSR, then after executing the necessary error handling, clear the ORER
flag to 0.
Neither transmitting nor receiving
can resume while the ORER flag
remains set to 1.
4. SCI status check and receive
data read: read SSR, check that
the RDRF flag is 1, then read
receive data from RDR and clear
the RDRF flag to 0. Notification
that the RDRF flag has changed
from 0 to 1 can also be given
by the RXI interrupt.
5. To continue transmitting and
receiving serial data: check the
RDRF flag, read RDR, and clear
the RDRF flag to 0 before the
MSB (bit 7) of the current frame
is received. Also check that
the TDRE flag is set to 1, indicating that data can be written, write
data in TDR, then clear the TDRE
flag to 0 before the MSB (bit 7) of
the current frame is transmitted.
When the DMAC is activated by
a transmit-data-empty interrupt
request (TXI) to write data in TDR,
the TDRE flag is checked and
cleared automatically. When the
DMAC is activated by a receivedata-full interrupt request (RXI) to
read RDR, the RDRF flag is
cleared automatically.
End
Note: * When switching from transmitting or receiving to simultaneous
transmitting and receiving, clear the TE and RE bits both to 0,
then set the TE and RE bits both to 1 simultaneously.
Figure 13-20 Sample Flowchart of Simultaneous Serial Transmit and Receive Operations
472
13.4 SCI Interrupts
The SCI has four interrupt request sources: TEI (transmit-end interrupt), ERI (receive-error
interrupt), RXI (receive-data-full interrupt), and TXI (transmit-data-empty interrupt). Table 13-12
lists the interrupt sources and indicates their priority. These interrupts can be enabled and disabled
by the TIE, TEIE, and RIE bits in SCR. Each interrupt request is sent separately to the interrupt
controller.
The TXI interrupt is requested when the TDRE flag is set to 1 in SSR. The TEI interrupt is
requested when the TEND flag is set to 1 in SSR. The TXI interrupt request can activate the
DMAC to transfer data. Data transfer by the DMAC automatically clears the TDRE flag to 0. The
TEI interrupt request cannot activate the DMAC.
The RXI interrupt is requested when the RDRF flag is set to 1 in SSR. The ERI interrupt is
requested when the ORER, PER, or FER flag is set to 1 in SSR. The RXI interrupt request can
activate the DMAC to transfer data. Data transfer by the DMAC automatically clears the RDRF
flag to 0. The ERI interrupt request cannot activate the DMAC.
The DMAC can be activated by interrupts from SCI channel 0.
Table 13-12 SCI Interrupt Sources
Interrupt
Description
Priority
ERI
Receive error (ORER, FER, or PER)
High
RXI
Receive data register full (RDRF)
TXI
Transmit data register empty (TDRE)
TEI
Transmit end (TEND)
Low
473
13.5 Usage Notes
Note the following points when using the SCI.
TDR Write and TDRE Flag: The TDRE flag in SSR is a status flag indicating the loading of
transmit data from TDR into TSR. The SCI sets the TDRE flag to 1 when it transfers data from
TDR to TSR.
Data can be written into TDR regardless of the state of the TDRE flag. If new data is written in
TDR when the TDRE flag is 0, the old data stored in TDR will be lost because this data has not
yet been transferred to TSR. Before writing transmit data in TDR, be sure to check that the TDRE
flag is set to 1.
Simultaneous Multiple Receive Errors: Table 13-13 indicates the state of SSR status flags when
multiple receive errors occur simultaneously. When an overrun error occurs the RSR contents are
not transferred to RDR, so receive data is lost.
Table 13-13 SSR Status Flags and Transfer of Receive Data
RDRF
ORER
FER
PER
Receive Data
Transfer
RSR → RDR
1
1
0
0
×
Overrun error
0
0
1
0
o
Framing error
0
0
0
1
o
Parity error
1
1
1
0
×
Overrun error + framing error
1
1
0
1
×
Overrun error + parity error
0
0
1
1
o
Framing error + parity error
1
1
1
1
×
Overrun error + framing error + parity error
SSR Status Flags
Notes:
o:
Receive Errors
Receive data is transferred from RSR to RDR.
× Receive data is not transferred from RSR to RDR.
474
Break Detection and Processing: Break signals can be detected by reading the RxD pin directly
when a framing error (FER) is detected. In the break state the input from the RxD pin consists of
all 0s, so the FER flag is set and the parity error flag (PER) may also be set. In the break state the
SCI receiver continues to operate, so if the FER flag is cleared to 0 it will be set to 1 again.
Sending a Break Signal: When the TE bit is cleared to 0 the TxD pin becomes an I/O port, the
level and direction (input or output) of which are determined by DR and DDR bits. This feature
can be used to send a break signal.
After the serial transmitter is initialized, the DR value substitutes for the mark state until the TE
bit is set to 1 (the TxD pin function is not selected until the TE bit is set to 1). The DDR and DR
bits should therefore both be set to 1 beforehand.
To send a break signal during serial transmission, clear the DR bit to 0, then clear the TE bit to 0.
When the TE bit is cleared to 0 the transmitter is initialized, regardless of its current state, so the
TxD pin becomes an output port outputting the value 0.
Receive Error Flags and Transmitter Operation (Synchronous Mode Only): When a receive
error flag (ORER, PER, or FER) is set to 1 the SCI will not start transmitting, even if the TDRE
flag is cleared to 0. Be sure to clear the receive error flags to 0 when starting to transmit. Note that
clearing the RE bit to 0 does not clear the receive error flags to 0.
Receive Data Sampling Timing in Asynchronous Mode and Receive Margin: In asynchronous
mode the SCI operates on a base clock with 16 times the bit rate frequency. In receiving, the SCI
synchronizes internally with the fall of the start bit, which it samples on the base clock. Receive
data is latched at the rising edge of the eighth base clock pulse. See figure 13-21.
475
16 clocks
8 clocks
0
15 0
7
7
15 0
Internal
base clock
Receive data
(RxD)
Start bit
D0
D1
Synchronization
sampling timing
Data sampling
timing
Figure 13-21 Receive Data Sampling Timing in Asynchronous Mode
The receive margin in asynchronous mode can therefore be expressed as in equation (1).
1
| D – 0.5 |
) – (L – 0.5) F –
(1 + F) | × 100% ...................(1)
2N
N
Receive margin (%)
Ratio of clock frequency to bit rate (N = 16)
Clock duty cycle (D = 0 to 1.0)
Frame length (L = 9 to 12)
Absolute deviation of clock frequency
M = | (0.5 –
M:
N:
D:
L:
F:
From equation (1), if F = 0 and D = 0.5 the receive margin is 46.875%, as given by equation (2).
D = 0.5, F = 0
M = [0.5 – 1/(2 × 16)] × 100%
= 46.875%.................................................................................................(2)
This is a theoretical value. A reasonable margin to allow in system designs is 20% to 30%.
476
Restrictions on Usage of DMAC
To have the DMAC read RDR, be sure to select the SCI receive-data-full interrupt (RXI) as the
activation source with bits DTS2 to DTS0 in DTCR.
Restrictions in Synchronous Mode: When data transmission is performed using an external
clock source as the serial clock, an interval of at least 5 states is necessary between clearing the
TDRE bit in SSR and the start (falling edge) of the first transmit clock pulse corresponding to
each frame (figure 13-22). This interval is also necessary when performing continuous
transmission. If this condition is not satisfied, an operation error may occur.
SCK
t*
t*
TDRE
TXD
X0
X1
X2
X3
X4
X5
X6
X7
Y0
Y1
Y2
Y3
Continuous transmission
Note: * Make sure that t is at least 5 states.
Figure 13-22 Transmission in Synchronous Mode (Example)
477
478
Section 14 A/D Converter
14.1 Overview
The H8/3002 includes a 10-bit successive-approximations A/D converter with a selection of up to
eight analog input channels.
14.1.1 Features
A/D converter features are listed below.
•
10-bit resolution
•
Eight input channels
•
Selectable analog conversion voltage range
The analog voltage conversion range can be programmed by input of an analog reference
voltage at the VREF pin.
•
High-speed conversion
Conversion time: maximum 7.9 µs per channel (with 17 MHz system clock)
•
Two conversion modes
Single mode: A/D conversion of one channel
Scan mode: continuous conversion on one to four channels
•
Four 16-bit data registers
A/D conversion results are transferred for storage into data registers corresponding to the
channels.
•
Sample-and-hold function
•
A/D conversion can be externally triggered
•
A/D interrupt requested at end of conversion
At the end of A/D conversion, an A/D end interrupt (ADI) can be requested.
479
14.1.2 Block Diagram
Figure 14-1 shows a block diagram of the A/D converter.
On-chip
data bus
AV SS
AN 0
AN 5
ADCR
ADCSR
ADDRD
–
AN 2
AN 4
ADDRC
+
AN 1
AN 3
ADDRB
10-bit D/A
ADDRA
V REF
Successiveapproximations register
AVCC
Bus interface
Module data bus
Analog
multiplexer
ø/8
Comparator
Control circuit
Sample-andhold circuit
ø/16
AN 6
AN 7
ADI
interrupt
signal
ADTRG
Legend
ADCR:
ADCSR:
ADDRA:
ADDRB:
ADDRC:
ADDRD:
A/D control register
A/D control/status register
A/D data register A
A/D data register B
A/D data register C
A/D data register D
Figure 14-1 A/D Converter Block Diagram
480
14.1.3 Input Pins
Table 14-1 summarizes the A/D converter’s input pins. The eight analog input pins are divided
into two groups: group 0 (AN0 to AN3), and group 1 (AN4 to AN7). AVCC and AVSS are the
power supply for the analog circuits in the A/D converter. VREF is the A/D conversion reference
voltage.
Table 14-1 A/D Converter Pins
Pin Name
Abbreviation
I/O
Function
Analog power supply pin
AVCC
Input
Analog power supply
Analog ground pin
AVSS
Input
Analog ground and reference voltage
Reference voltage pin
VREF
Input
Analog reference voltage
Analog input pin 0
AN0
Input
Group 0 analog inputs
Analog input pin 1
AN1
Input
Analog input pin 2
AN2
Input
Analog input pin 3
AN3
Input
Analog input pin 4
AN4
Input
Analog input pin 5
AN5
Input
Analog input pin 6
AN6
Input
Analog input pin 7
AN7
Input
A/D external trigger input pin
ADTRG
Input
Group 1 analog inputs
External trigger input for starting A/D conversion
481
14.1.4 Register Configuration
Table 14-2 summarizes the A/D converter’s registers.
Table 14-2 A/D Converter Registers
Address*1
Name
Abbreviation
R/W
Initial Value
H'FFE0
A/D data register A (high)
ADDRAH
R
H'00
H'FFE1
A/D data register A (low)
ADDRAL
R
H'00
H'FFE2
A/D data register B (high)
ADDRBH
R
H'00
H'FFE3
A/D data register B (low)
ADDRBL
R
H'00
H'FFE4
A/D data register C (high)
ADDRCH
R
H'00
H'FFE5
A/D data register C (low)
ADDRCL
R
H'00
H'FFE6
A/D data register D (high)
ADDRDH
R
H'00
H'FFE7
A/D data register D (low)
ADDRDL
R
H'00
H'00
H'7E
H'FFE8
A/D control/status register
ADCSR
R/(W)*2
H'FFE9
A/D control register
ADCR
R/W
Notes: 1. Lower 16 bits of the address
2. Only 0 can be written in bit 7, to clear the flag.
482
14.2 Register Descriptions
14.2.1 A/D Data Registers A to D (ADDRA to ADDRD)
Bit
14
12
10
8
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
AD9 AD8 AD7 AD6 AD5 AD4 AD3 AD2 AD1 AD0 —
15
13
11
9
7
—
—
—
—
—
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
(n = A to D)
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
ADDRn
A/D conversion data
10-bit data giving an
A/D conversion result
Reserved bits
The four A/D data registers (ADDRA to ADDRD) are 16-bit read-only registers that store the
results of A/D conversion.
An A/D conversion produces 10-bit data, which is transferred for storage into the A/D data
register corresponding to the selected channel. The upper 8 bits of the result are stored in the
upper byte of the A/D data register. The lower 2 bits are stored in the lower byte. Bits 5 to 0 of an
A/D data register are reserved bits that always read 0. Table 14-3 indicates the pairings of analog
input channels and A/D data registers.
The CPU can always read and write the A/D data registers. The upper byte can be read directly,
but the lower byte is read through a temporary register (TEMP). For details see section 14.3, CPU
Interface.
The A/D data registers are initialized to H'0000 by a reset and in standby mode.
Table 14-3 Analog Input Channels and A/D Data Registers
Analog Input Channel
Group 0
Group 1
A/D Data Register
AN0
AN4
ADDRA
AN1
AN5
ADDRB
AN2
AN6
ADDRC
AN3
AN7
ADDRD
483
14.2.2 A/D Control/Status Register (ADCSR)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
ADF
ADIE
ADST
SCAN
CKS
CH2
CH1
CH0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/(W)*
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Channel select 2 to 0
These bits select analog
input channels
Clock select
Selects the A/D conversion time
Scan mode
Selects single mode or scan mode
A/D start
Starts or stops A/D conversion
A/D interrupt enable
Enables and disables A/D end interrupts
A/D end flag
Indicates end of A/D conversion
Note: * Only 0 can be written, to clear the flag.
ADCSR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that selects the mode and controls the A/D converter.
ADCSR is initialized to H'00 by a reset and in standby mode.
484
Bit 7—A/D End Flag (ADF): Indicates the end of A/D conversion.
Bit 7
ADF
Description
0
[Clearing condition]
Cleared by reading ADF while ADF = 1, then writing 0 in ADF
1
[Setting conditions]
Single mode: A/D conversion ends
Scan mode: A/D conversion ends in all selected channels
(Initial value)
Bit 6—A/D Interrupt Enable (ADIE): Enables or disables the interrupt (ADI) requested at the
end of A/D conversion.
Bit 6
ADIE
Description
0
A/D end interrupt request (ADI) is disabled
1
A/D end interrupt request (ADI) is enabled
(Initial value)
Bit 5—A/D Start (ADST): Starts or stops A/D conversion. The ADST bit remains set to 1 during
A/D conversion. It can also be set to 1 by external trigger input at the ADTRG pin.
Bit 5
ADST
Description
0
A/D conversion is stopped
1
Single mode: A/D conversion starts; ADST is automatically cleared to 0 when conversion
ends.
Scan mode: A/D conversion starts and continues, cycling among the selected channels,
until ADST is cleared to 0 by software, by a reset, or by a transition to standby mode.
(Initial value)
485
Bit 4—Scan Mode (SCAN): Selects single mode or scan mode. For further information on
operation in these modes, see section 14.4, Operation. Clear the ADST bit to 0 before switching
the conversion mode.
Bit 4
SCAN
Description
0
Single mode
1
Scan mode
(Initial value)
Bit 3—Clock Select (CKS): Selects the A/D conversion time. Clear the ADST bit to 0 before
switching the conversion time.
Bit 3
CKS
Description
0
Conversion time = 266 states (maximum)
1
Conversion time = 134 states (maximum)
(Initial value)
Bits 2 to 0—Channel Select 2 to 0 (CH2 to CH0): These bits and the SCAN bit select the analog
input channels. Clear the ADST bit to 0 before changing the channel selection.
Group
Selection
Channel Selection
Description
CH2
CH1
CH0
Single Mode
Scan Mode
0
0
0
AN0 (Initial value)
AN0
1
AN1
AN0, AN1
0
AN2
AN0 to AN2
1
AN3
AN0 to AN3
0
AN4
AN4
1
AN5
AN4, AN5
0
AN6
AN4 to AN6
1
AN7
AN4 to AN7
1
1
0
1
486
14.2.3 A/D Control Register (ADCR)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TRGE
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Initial value
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read/Write
R/W
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Reserved bits
Trigger enable
Enables or disables external triggering of A/D conversion
ADCR is an 8-bit readable/writable register that enables or disables external triggering of A/D
conversion. ADCR is initialized to H'7F by a reset and in standby mode.
Bit 7—Trigger Enable (TRGE): Enables or disables external triggering of A/D conversion.
Bit 7
TRGE
Description
0
A/D conversion cannot be externally triggered
1
A/D conversion starts at the falling edge of the external trigger signal (ADTRG)
Bits 6 to 0—Reserved: These bits cannot be modified and are always read as 1.
487
(Initial value)
14.3 CPU Interface
ADDRA to ADDRD are 16-bit registers, but they are connected to the CPU by an 8-bit data bus.
Therefore, although the upper byte can be be accessed directly by the CPU, the lower byte is read
through an 8-bit temporary register (TEMP).
An A/D data register is read as follows. When the upper byte is read, the upper-byte value is
transferred directly to the CPU and the lower-byte value is transferred into TEMP. Next, when the
lower byte is read, the TEMP contents are transferred to the CPU.
When reading an A/D data register, always read the upper byte before the lower byte. It is possible
to read only the upper byte, but if only the lower byte is read, incorrect data may be obtained.
Figure 14-2 shows the data flow for access to an A/D data register.
Upper-byte read
CPU
(H'AA)
Module data bus
Bus interface
TEMP
(H'40)
ADDRnH
(H'AA)
ADDRnL
(H'40)
(n = A to D)
Lower-byte read
CPU
(H'40)
Module data bus
Bus interface
TEMP
(H'40)
ADDRnH
(H'AA)
ADDRnL
(H'40)
(n = A to D)
Figure 14-2 A/D Data Register Access Operation (Reading H'AA40)
488
14.4 Operation
The A/D converter operates by successive approximations with 10-bit resolution. It has two
operating modes: single mode and scan mode.
14.4.1 Single Mode (SCAN = 0)
Single mode should be selected when only one A/D conversion on one channel is required. A/D
conversion starts when the ADST bit is set to 1 by software, or by external trigger input. The
ADST bit remains set to 1 during A/D conversion and is automatically cleared to 0 when
conversion ends.
When conversion ends the ADF bit is set to 1. If the ADIE bit is also set to 1, an ADI interrupt is
requested at this time. To clear the ADF flag to 0, first read ADCSR, then write 0 in ADF.
When the mode or analog input channel must be switched during analog conversion, to prevent
incorrect operation, first clear the ADST bit to 0 in ADCSR to halt A/D conversion. After making
the necessary changes, set the ADST bit to 1 to start A/D conversion again. The ADST bit can be
set at the same time as the mode or channel is changed.
Typical operations when channel 1 (AN1) is selected in single mode are described next.
Figure 14-3 shows a timing diagram for this example.
1.
Single mode is selected (SCAN = 0), input channel AN1 is selected (CH2 = CH1 = 0,
CH0 = 1), the A/D interrupt is enabled (ADIE = 1), and A/D conversion is started
(ADST = 1).
2.
When A/D conversion is completed, the result is transferred into ADDRB. At the same time
the ADF flag is set to 1, the ADST bit is cleared to 0, and the A/D converter becomes idle.
3.
Since ADF = 1 and ADIE = 1, an ADI interrupt is requested.
4.
The A/D interrupt handling routine starts.
5.
The routine reads ADCSR, then writes 0 in the ADF flag.
6.
The routine reads and processes the conversion result (ADDRB).
7.
Execution of the A/D interrupt handling routine ends. After that, if the ADST bit is set to 1,
A/D conversion starts again and steps 2 to 7 are repeated.
489
Figure 14-3 Example of A/D Converter Operation (Single Mode, Channel 1 Selected)
490
Note: * Vertical arrows ( ) indicate instructions executed by software.
ADDRD
ADDRC
ADDRB
ADDRA
State of channel 3
(AN 3)
State of channel 2
(AN 2)
Read conversion result
A/D conversion result (2)
Idle
Clear *
A/D conversion result (1)
A/D conversion (2)
Set *
Read conversion result
Idle
Idle
Idle
Clear *
State of channel 1
(AN 1)
A/D conversion (1)
Set *
Idle
Idle
A/D conversion
starts
State of channel 0
(AN 0)
ADF
ADST
ADIE
Set *
14.4.2 Scan Mode (SCAN = 1)
Scan mode is useful for monitoring analog inputs in a group of one or more channels. When the
ADST bit is set to 1 by software or external trigger input, A/D conversion starts on the first
channel in the group (AN0 when CH2 = 0, AN4 when CH2 = 1). When two or more channels are
selected, after conversion of the first channel ends, conversion of the second channel (AN1 or
AN5) starts immediately. A/D conversion continues cyclically on the selected channels until the
ADST bit is cleared to 0. The conversion results are transferred for storage into the A/D data
registers corresponding to the channels.
When the mode or analog input channel selection must be changed during analog conversion, to
prevent incorrect operation, first clear the ADST bit to 0 in ADCSR to halt A/D conversion. After
making the necessary changes, set the ADST bit to 1. A/D conversion will start again from the
first channel in the group. The ADST bit can be set at the same time as the mode or channel
selection is changed.
Typical operations when three channels in group 0 (AN0 to AN2) are selected in scan mode are
described next. Figure 14-4 shows a timing diagram for this example.
1.
Scan mode is selected (SCAN = 1), scan group 0 is selected (CH2 = 0), analog input channels
AN0 to AN2 are selected (CH1 = 1, CH0 = 0), and A/D conversion is started (ADST = 1).
2.
When A/D conversion of the first channel (AN0) is completed, the result is transferred into
ADDRA. Next, conversion of the second channel (AN1) starts automatically.
3.
Conversion proceeds in the same way through the third channel (AN2).
4.
When conversion of all selected channels (AN0 to AN2) is completed, the ADF flag is set to 1
and conversion of the first channel (AN0) starts again. If the ADIE bit is set to 1, an ADI
interrupt is requested at this time.
5.
Steps 2 to 4 are repeated as long as the ADST bit remains set to 1. When the ADST bit is
cleared to 0, A/D conversion stops. After that, if the ADST bit is set to 1, A/D conversion
starts again from the first channel (AN0).
491
Figure 14-4 Example of A/D Converter Operation (Scan Mode,
Channels AN0 to AN2 Selected)
492
Idle
Idle
Idle
A/D conversion (1)
Transfer
A/D conversion result (1)
Idle
Idle
Clear*1
Idle
A/D conversion result (3)
A/D conversion result (2)
A/D conversion result (4)
Idle
A/D conversion(5)*2
A/D conversion time
A/D conversion (4)
Idle
A/D conversion(3)
Idle
A/D conversion (2)
Notes: 1. Vertical arrows ( ) indicate instructions executed by software.
2. Data currently being converted is ignored.
ADDRD
ADDRC
ADDRB
ADDRA
State of channel 3
(AN 3)
State of channel 2
(AN 2)
State of channel 1
(AN 1)
State of channel 0
(AN 0)
ADF
ADST
Set *1
Continuous A/D conversion
Clear* 1
14.4.3 Input Sampling and A/D Conversion Time
The A/D converter has a built-in sample-and-hold circuit. The A/D converter samples the analog
input at a time tD after the ADST bit is set to 1, then starts conversion. Figure 14-5 shows the A/D
conversion timing. Table 14-4 indicates the A/D conversion time.
As indicated in figure 14-5, the A/D conversion time includes tD and the input sampling time. The
length of tD varies depending on the timing of the write access to ADCSR. The total conversion
time therefore varies within the ranges indicated in table 14-4.
In scan mode, the values given in table 14-4 apply to the first conversion. In the second and
subsequent conversions the conversion time is fixed at 256 states when CKS = 0 or 128 states
when CKS = 1.
(1)
ø
Address bus
(2)
Write signal
Input sampling
timing
ADF
tD
t SPL
t CONV
Legend
(1):
ADCSR write cycle
(2):
ADCSR address
tD :
Synchronization delay
t SPL : Input sampling time
t CONV: A/D conversion time
Figure 14-5 A/D Conversion Timing
493
Table 14-4 A/D Conversion Time (Single Mode)
CKS = 0
CKS = 1
Symbol
Min
Typ
Max
Min
Typ
Max
Synchronization delay
tD
10
—
17
6
—
9
Input sampling time
tSPL
—
80
—
—
40
—
A/D conversion time
tCONV
259
—
266
131
—
134
Note: Values in the table are numbers of states.
14.4.4 External Trigger Input Timing
A/D conversion can be externally triggered. When the TRGE bit is set to 1 in ADCR, external
trigger input is enabled at the ADTRG pin. A high-to-low transition at the ADTRG pin sets the
ADST bit to 1 in ADCSR, starting A/D conversion. Other operations, in both single and scan
modes, are the same as if the ADST bit had been set to 1 by software. Figure 14-6 shows the
timing.
ø
ADTRG
Internal trigger
signal
ADST
A/D conversion
Figure 14-6 External Trigger Input Timing
494
14.5 Interrupts
The A/D converter generates an interrupt (ADI) at the end of A/D conversion. The ADI interrupt
request can be enabled or disabled by the ADIE bit in ADCSR.
14.6 Usage Notes
When using the A/D converter, note the following points:
1.
Analog Input Voltage Range: During A/D conversion, the voltages input to the analog input
pins should be in the range AVSS ≤ ANn ≤ VREF.
2.
Relationships of AVCC and AVSS to VCC and VSS: AVCC, AVSS, VCC, and VSS should be
related as follows: AVSS = VSS. AVCC and AVSS must not be left open, even if the A/D
converter is not used.
3.
VREF Programming Range: The reference voltage input at the VREF pin should be in the
range VREF ≤ AVCC.
Failure to observe points 1, 2, and 3 above may degrade chip reliability.
4.
Note on Board Design: In board layout, separate the digital circuits from the analog circuits
as much as possible. Particularly avoid layouts in which the signal lines of digital circuits
cross or closely approach the signal lines of analog circuits. Induction and other effects may
cause the analog circuits to operate incorrectly, or may adversely affect the accuracy of A/D
conversion.
The analog input signals (AN0 to AN7), analog reference voltage (VREF), and analog supply
voltage (AVCC) must be separated from digital circuits by the analog ground (AVSS). The
analog ground (AVSS) should be connected to a stable digital ground (VSS) at one point on
the board.
5.
Note on Noise: To prevent damage from surges and other abnormal voltages at the analog
input pins (AN0 to AN7) and analog reference voltage pin (VREF), connect a protection circuit
like the one in figure 14-7 between AVCC and AVSS. The bypass capacitors connected to
AVCC and VREF and the filter capacitors connected to AN0 to AN7 must be connected to
AVSS. If filter capacitors like the ones in figure 14-7 are connected, the voltage values input
to the analog input pins (AN0 to AN7) will be smoothed, which may give rise to error. Error
can also occur if A/D conversion is frequently performed in scan mode so that the current that
charges and discharges the capacitor in the sample-and-hold circuit of the A/D converter
becomes greater than that input to the analog input pins via input impedance Rin. The circuit
constants should therefore be selected carefully.
495
AVCC
VREF
Rin*2
*1
100 Ω
AN0 to AN7
*1
0.1 µF
AVSS
Notes: 1.
10 µF
0.01 µF
2. Rin: input impedance
Figure 14-7 Example of Analog Input Protection Circuit
10 kΩ
AN0 to AN7
To A/D converter
20 pF
Figure 14-8 Analog Input Pin Equivalent Circuit
Table 14-5 Analog Input Pin Ratings
Item
min
max
Unit
Analog input capacitance
—
20
pF
Allowable signal-source impedance
—
10*
kΩ
Note: * When VCC = 4.0 V to 5.5 V and ø ≤ 12 MHz.
Note: Numeric values are approximate, except in table 14-5.
496
6.
A/D Conversion Accuracy Definitions: A/D conversion accuracy in the H8/3002 is defined as
follows:
•
Resolution:..................Digital output code length of A/D converter
•
Offset error: ................Deviation from ideal A/D conversion characteristic of analog input
voltage required to raise digital output from minimum voltage value
0000000000 to 0000000001 (figure 14-10)
•
Full-scale error:...........Deviation from ideal A/D conversion characteristic of analog input
voltage required to raise digital output from 1111111110 to 1111111111
(figure 14-10)
•
Quantization error:......Intrinsic error of the A/D converter; 1/2 LSB (figure 14-9)
•
Nonlinearity error: ......Deviation from ideal A/D conversion characteristic in range from zero
volts to full scale, exclusive of offset error, full-scale error, and
quantization error.
•
Absolute accuracy:......Deviation of digital value from analog input value, including offset
error, full-scale error, quantization error, and nonlinearity error.
Digital
output
111
Ideal A/D conversion
characteristic
110
101
100
011
010
Quantization error
001
000
1/8 2/8 3/8 4/8 5/8 6/8 7/8 FS
Analog input
voltage
Figure 14-9 A/D Converter Accuracy Definitions (1)
497
Full-scale
error
Digital
output
Ideal A/D
conversion
characteristic
Nonlinearity
error
Actual A/D conversion
characteristic
FS
Offset error
Analog input
voltage
Figure 14-10 A/D Converter Accuracy Definitions (2)
7.
Allowable Signal-Source Impedance: The analog inputs of the H8/3002 are designed to
assure accurate conversion of input signals with a signal-source impedance not exceeding 10
kΩ. The reason for this rating is that it enables the input capacitor in the sample-and-hold
circuit in the A/D converter to charge within the sampling time. If the sensor output
impedance exceeds 10 kΩ, charging may be inadequate and the accuracy of A/D conversion
cannot be guaranteed.
If a large external capacitor is provided in single mode, then the internal 10-kΩ input
resistance becomes the only significant load on the input. In this case the impedance of the
signal source is not a problem.
A large external capacitor, however, acts as a low-pass filter. This may make it impossible to
track analog signals with high dv/dt (e.g. a variation of 5 mV/µs) (figure 14-11). To convert
high-speed analog signals or to use scan mode, insert a low-impedance buffer.
8.
Effect on Absolute Accuracy: Attaching an external capacitor creates a coupling with ground,
so if there is noise on the ground line, it may degrade absolute accuracy. The capacitor must
be connected to an electrically stable ground, such as AVSS.
If a filter circuit is used, be careful of interference with digital signals on the same board, and
make sure the circuit does not act as an antenna.
498
H8/3002
Sensor output impedance
Sensor
input
10 kΩ
Up to 10 kΩ
Low-pass
filter
C to 0.1 µF
Equivalent circuit of
A/D converter
Cin =
15 pF
Figure 14-11 Analog Input Circuit (Example)
499
20 pF
Section 15 RAM
15.1 Overview
The H8/3002 has 512 bytes of on-chip static RAM. The RAM is connected to the CPU by a 16-bit
data bus. The CPU accesses both byte data and word data in two states, enabling rapid data
transfer.
The on-chip RAM is assigned to addresses H'FFD10 to H'FFF0F in modes 1 and 2, and addresses
H'FFFD10 to H'FFFF0F in modes 3 and 4. The RAM enable bit (RAME) in the system control
register (SYSCR) can enable or disable the on-chip RAM.
15.1.1 Block Diagram
Figure 15-1 shows a block diagram of the on-chip RAM.
On-chip data bus (upper 8 bits)
On-chip data bus (lower 8 bits)
Bus interface
H'FD10*
H'FD11*
H'FD12*
H'FD13*
On-chip RAM
H'FF0E*
H'FF0F*
Even addresses
Odd addresses
Note: * Lower 16 bits of the address
Figure 15-1 RAM Block Diagram
501
15.1.2 Register Configuration
The on-chip RAM is controlled by SYSCR. Table 15-1 gives the address and initial value of
SYSCR.
Table 15-1 RAM Control Register
Address*
Name
Abbreviation
R/W
Initial Value
H'FFF2
System control register
SYSCR
R/W
H'0B
Note: * Lower 16 bits of the address
15.2 System Control Register (SYSCR)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
SSBY
STS2
STS1
STS0
UE
NMIEG
—
RAME
Initial value
0
0
0
0
1
0
1
1
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
—
R/W
RAM enable bit
Enables or
disables
on-chip RAM
Reserved bit
NMI edge select
User bit enable
Standby timer select 2 to 0
Software standby
502
One function of SYSCR is to enable or disable access to the on-chip RAM. The on-chip RAM is
enabled or disabled by the RAME bit in SYSCR. For details about the other bits, see section 3.3,
System Control Register.
Bit 0—RAM Enable (RAME): Enables or disables the on-chip RAM. The RAME bit is
initialized at the rising edge of the input at the RES pin. It is not initialized in software standby
mode.
Bit 0
RAME
Description
0
On-chip RAM is disabled
1
On-chip RAM is enabled
(Initial value)
15.3 Operation
When the RAME bit is set to 1, accesses to addresses H'FFD10 to H'FFF0F in modes 1 and 2, and
to addresses H'FFFD10 to H'FFFF0F in modes 3 and 4, are directed to the on-chip RAM. When
the RAME bit is cleared to 0, the off-chip address space is accessed.
Since the on-chip RAM is connected to the CPU by an internal 16-bit data bus, it can be written
and read by word access. It can also be written and read by byte access. Byte data is accessed in
two states using the upper 8 bits of the data bus. Word data starting at an even address is accessed
in two states using all 16 bits of the data bus.
503
504
Section 16 Clock Pulse Generator
16.1 Overview
The H8/3002 has a built-in clock pulse generator (CPG) that generates the system clock (ø) and
other internal clock signals (ø/2 to ø/4096). The clock pulse generator consists of an oscillator
circuit, a duty adjustment circuit, and prescalers.
16.1.1 Block Diagram
Figure 16-1 shows a block diagram of the clock pulse generator.
CPG
XTAL
Oscillator
EXTAL
Duty
adjustment
circuit
Prescalers
ø
ø/2 to ø/4096
Figure 16-1 Block Diagram of Clock Pulse Generator
505
16.2 Oscillator Circuit
Clock pulses can be supplied by connecting a crystal resonator, or by input of an external clock
signal.
16.2.1 Connecting a Crystal Resonator
Circuit Configuration: A crystal resonator can be connected as in the example in figure 16-2.
The damping resistance Rd should be selected according to table 16-1. An AT-cut parallelresonance crystal should be used.
C L1
EXTAL
XTAL
Rd
C L1 = C L2 = 10 pF to 22 pF
C L2
Figure 16-2 Connection of Crystal Resonator (Example)
Table 16-1 Damping Resistance Value
Frequency (MHz)
2
4
8
10
12
16
17
Rd (Ω)
1k
500
200
0
0
0
0
Crystal Resonator: Figure 16-3 shows an equivalent circuit of the crystal resonator. The crystal
resonator should have the characteristics listed in table 16-2.
CL
L
Rs
XTAL
EXTAL
CO
AT-cut parallel-resonance type
Figure 16-3 Crystal Resonator Equivalent Circuit
506
Table 16-2 Crystal Resonator Parameters
Frequency (MHz)
2
4
8
10
12
16
17
Rs max (Ω)
500
120
80
70
60
50
40
Co (pF)
7 pF max
Use a crystal resonator with a frequency equal to the system clock frequency (ø).
Notes on Board Design: When a crystal resonator is connected, the following points should be
noted:
Other signal lines should be routed away from the oscillator circuit to prevent induction from
interfering with correct oscillation. See figure 16-4.
When the board is designed, the crystal resonator and its load capacitors should be placed as close
as possible to the XTAL and EXTAL pins.
Avoid
Signal A
Signal B
C L2
H8/3002
XTAL
EXTAL
C L1
Figure 16-4 Example of Incorrect Board Design
507
16.2.2 External Clock Input
Circuit Configuration: An external clock signal can be input as shown in the examples in
figure 16-5. In example b, the clock should be held high in standby mode.
If the XTAL pin is left open, the stray capacitance should not exceed 10 pF.
EXTAL
External clock input
XTAL
Open
a. XTAL pin left open
EXTAL
XTAL
External clock input
74HC04
b. Complementary clock input at XTAL pin
Figure 16-5 External Clock Input (Examples)
508
External Clock:The external clock frequency should be equal to the system clock frequency (ø).
Table 16-3 and figure 16-6 indicate the clock timing.
Table 16-3 Clock Timing
VCC = 2.7 to 5.5 V VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%
Item
Symbol
Min
Max
Min
Max
Unit Test Conditions
External clock rise
time
tEXr
—
10
—
5
ns
External clock fall
time
tEXf
—
10
—
5
ns
External clock
input duty (a/tcyc)
—
30
40
70
60
30
40
70
60
%
%
ø clock duty
(b/tcyc)
—
40
60
40
60
%
Figure 16-6
ø ≥ 5 MHz Figure
ø < 5 MHz 16-6
tcyc
a
EXTAL
VCC × 0.5
tEXr
tEXf
tcyc
b
ø
VCC × 0.5
Figure 16-6 External Clock Input Timing
509
Table 16–4 shows the external clock output stabilization delay time, and figure 16–7 shows the
timing for the external clock output stabilization delay time. The oscillator and duty correction
circuit have the function of regulating the waveform of the external clock input to the EXTAL pin.
When the specified clock signal is input to the EXTAL pin, internal clock signal output is
confirmed after the elapse of the external clock output stabilization delay time (tDEXT). As clock
signal output is not confirmed during the tDEXT period, the reset signal should be driven low and
the reset state maintained during this time.
Table 16–4 External Clock Output Stabilization Delay Time
Conditions: VCC = 2.7 to 5.5 V, AVCC = 2.7 to 5.5 V, VSS = AVSS = 0 V
Item
Symbol
Min
Max
Unit
Notes
External clock output stabilization
delay time
tDEXT*
500
—
µs
Figure 16-7
Note: * tDEXT includes a 10 tcyc RES pulse width (tRESW).
VCC
STBY
2.7 V
VIH
EXTAL
ø
RES
tDEXT*
Note: * tDEXT includes a 10 tcyc RES pulse width (tRESW).
Figure 16-7 External Clock Output Stabilization Delay Time
510
16.3 Duty Adjustment Circuit
When the oscillator frequency is 5 MHz or higher, the duty adjustment circuit adjusts the duty
cycle of the clock signal from the oscillator to generate the system clock (ø).
16.4 Prescalers
The prescalers divide the system clock (ø) to generate internal clocks (ø/2 to ø/4096).
511
Section 17 Power-Down State
17.1 Overview
The H8/3002 has a power-down state that greatly reduces power consumption by halting CPU
functions. The power-down state includes the following three modes:
•
•
•
Sleep mode
Software standby mode
Hardware standby mode
Table 17-1 indicates the methods of entering and exiting these power-down modes and the status
of the CPU and on-chip supporting modules in each mode.
Table 17-1 Power-Down State
State
Mode
Entering
Conditions
Clock
CPU
CPU
Refresh
Supporting
Registers DMAC Controller Functions RAM
Sleep
mode
SLEEP instruc- Active
tion executed
while SSBY = 0
in SYSCR
Software
standby
mode
SLEEP instruc- Halted Halted Held
tion executed
while SSBY = 1
in SYSCR
Hardware Low input at
standby STBY pin
mode
Halted Held
Halted Halted Undetermined
Active
I/O
Ports
Exiting
Conditions
Active
Active
Held
Held
• Interrupt
• RES
• STBY
Halted Halted
and
and
reset
held*1
Halted
and
reset
Held
Held
•
•
•
•
Halted Halted
and
and
reset
reset
Halted
and
reset
Held*2 High
• STBY
impedance • RES
NMI
IRQ0 to IRQ2
RES
STBY
Notes: 1. RTCNT and bits 7 and 6 of RTMCSR are initialized. Other bits and registers hold their previous states.
2. The RAME bit must be cleared to 0 in SYSCR before the transition from the program execution state to hardware
standby mode.
Legend
SYSCR: System control register
SSBY: Software standby bit
513
17.2 Register Configuration
The H8/3002’s system control register (SYSCR) controls the power-down state. Table 17-2
summarizes this register.
Table 17-2 Control Register
Address*
Name
Abbreviation
R/W
Initial Value
H'FFF2
System control register
SYSCR
R/W
H'0B
Note: * Lower 16 bits of the address.
17.2.1 System Control Register (SYSCR)
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
SSBY
STS2
STS1
STS0
UE
NMIEG
—
RAME
Initial value
0
0
0
0
1
0
1
1
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
—
R/W
RAM enable
Reserved bit
NMI edge select
User bit enable
Standby timer select 2 to 0
These bits select the
waiting time at exit from
software standby mode
Software standby
Enables transition to
software standby mode
SYSCR is an 8-bit readable/writable register. Bit 7 (SSBY) and bits 6 to 4 (STS2 to STS0) control
the power-down state. For information on the other SYSCR bits, see section 3.3, System Control
Register.
514
Bit 7—Software Standby (SSBY): Enables transition to software standby mode. When software
standby mode is exited by an external interrupt, this bit remains set to 1 after the return to normal
operation. To clear this bit, write 0.
Bit 7
SSBY
Description
0
SLEEP instruction causes transition to sleep mode
1
SLEEP instruction causes transition to software standby mode
(Initial value)
Bits 6 to 4—Standby Timer Select (STS2 to STS0): These bits select the length of time the CPU
and on-chip supporting modules wait for the clock to settle when software standby mode is exited
by an external interrupt. If the clock is generated by a crystal resonator, set these bits according to
the clock frequency so that the waiting time will be at least 8 ms. See table 17-3. If an external
clock is used, any setting is permitted.
Bit 6
STS2
Bit 5
STS1
Bit 4
STS0
Description
0
0
0
Waiting time = 8192 states
1
Waiting time = 16384 states
0
Waiting time = 32768 states
1
Waiting time = 65536 states
0
—
Waiting time = 131072 states
1
—
Illegal setting
1
1
515
(Initial value)
17.3 Sleep Mode
17.3.1 Transition to Sleep Mode
When the SSBY bit is cleared to 0 in SYSCR, execution of the SLEEP instruction causes a
transition from the program execution state to sleep mode. Immediately after executing the
SLEEP instruction the CPU halts, but the contents of its internal registers are retained. The DMA
controller (DMAC), refresh controller, and on-chip supporting modules do not halt in sleep mode.
17.3.2 Exit from Sleep Mode
Sleep mode is exited by an interrupt, or by input at the RES or STBY pin.
Exit by Interrupt: An interrupt terminates sleep mode and causes a transition to the interrupt
exception handling state. Sleep mode is not exited by an interrupt source in an on-chip supporting
module if the interrupt is disabled in the on-chip supporting module. Sleep mode is not exited by
an interrupt other than NMI if the interrupt is masked in the CPU.
Exit by RES Input: Low input at the RES pin exits from sleep mode to the reset state.
Exit by STBY Input: Low input at the STBY pin exits from sleep mode to hardware standby
mode.
516
17.4 Software Standby Mode
17.4.1 Transition to Software Standby Mode
To enter software standby mode, execute the SLEEP instruction while the SSBY bit is set to 1 in
SYSCR.
In software standby mode, current dissipation is reduced to an extremely low level because the
CPU, clock, and on-chip supporting modules all halt. The DMAC and on-chip supporting
modules are reset. As long as the specified voltage is supplied, however, CPU register contents
and on-chip RAM data are retained. The settings of the I/O ports and refresh controller* are also
held.
Note: * RTCNT and bits 7 and 6 of RTMCSR are initialized. Other bits and registers hold their
previous states.
17.4.2 Exit from Software Standby Mode
Software standby mode can be exited by input of an external interrupt at the NMI, IRQ0, IRQ1, or
IRQ2 pin, or by input at the RES or STBY pin.
Exit by Interrupt: When an NMI, IRQ0, IRQ1, or IRQ2 interrupt request signal is received, the
clock oscillator begins operating. After the oscillator settling time selected by bits STS2 to STS0
in SYSCR, stable clock signals are supplied to the entire H8/3002 chip, software standby mode
ends, and interrupt exception handling begins. Software standby mode is not exited if the interrupt
enable bits of interrupts IRQ0, IRQ1, and IRQ2 are cleared to 0, or if these interrupts are masked
in the CPU.
Exit by RES Input: When the RES input goes low, the clock oscillator starts and clock pulses are
supplied immediately to the entire H8/3002 chip. The RES signal must be held low long enough
for the clock oscillator to stabilize. When RES goes high, the CPU starts reset exception handling.
Exit by STBY Input: Low input at the STBY pin causes a transition to hardware standby mode.
517
17.4.3 Selection of Waiting Time for Exit from Software Standby Mode
Bits STS2 to STS0 in SYSCR should be set as follows.
Crystal Resonator: Set STS2 to STS0 so that the waiting time (for the clock to stabilize) is at
least 8 ms. Table 17-3 indicates the waiting times that are selected by STS2 to STS0 settings at
various system clock frequencies.
External Clock: Any value may be set.
Table 17-3 Clock Frequency and Waiting Time for Clock to Settle
Waiting
STS2 STS1 STS0 Time
16 MHZ 12 MHz 10 MHz 8 MHz
6 MHz
4 MHz
2 MHz
Unit
0
0
0
8192
states
0.51
0.65
0.8
1.0
1.3
2.0
4.1
ms
0
0
1
16384
states
1.0
1.3
1.6
2.0
2.7
4.1
8.2
0
1
0
32768
states
2.0
2.7
3.3
4.1
5.5
8.2
16.4
0
1
1
65536
states
4.1
5.5
6.6
8.2
10.9
16.4
32.8
1
0
—
131072
states
8.2
10.9
13.1
16.4
21.8
32.8
65.5
1
1
—
Illegal setting
: Recommended setting
518
17.4.4 Sample Application of Software Standby Mode
Figure 17-1 shows an example in which software standby mode is entered at the fall of NMI and
exited at the rise of NMI.
With the NMI edge select bit (NMIEG) cleared to 0 in SYSCR (selecting the falling edge), an
NMI interrupt occurs. Next the NMIEG bit is set to 1 (selecting the rising edge) and the SSBY bit
is set to 1; then the SLEEP instruction is executed to enter software standby mode.
Software standby mode is exited at the next rising edge of the NMI signal.
Clock
oscillator
ø
NMI
NMIEG
SSBY
NMI interrupt
handler
NMIEG = 1
SSBY = 1
Software standby
mode (powerdown state)
Oscillator
settling time
(tosc2)
NMI exception
handling
SLEEP
instruction
Figure 17-1 NMI Timing for Software Standby Mode (Example)
17.4.5 Note
The I/O ports retain their existing states in software standby mode. If a port is in the high output
state, its output current is not reduced.
519
17.5 Hardware Standby Mode
17.5.1 Transition to Hardware Standby Mode
Regardless of its current state, the chip enters hardware standby mode whenever the STBY pin
goes low. Hardware standby mode reduces power consumption drastically by halting all functions
of the CPU, DMAC, refresh controller, and on-chip supporting modules. All modules are reset
except the on-chip RAM. As long as the specified voltage is supplied, on-chip RAM data is
retained. I/O ports are placed in the high-impedance state.
Clear the RAME bit to 0 in SYSCR before STBY goes low to retain on-chip RAM data.
The inputs at the mode pins (MD2 to MD0) should not be changed during hardware standby
mode.
17.5.2 Exit from Hardware Standby Mode
Hardware standby mode is exited by inputs at the STBY and RES pins. While RES is low, when
STBY goes high, the clock oscillator starts running. RES should be held low long enough for the
clock oscillator to settle. When RES goes high, reset exception handling begins, followed by a
transition to the program execution state.
17.5.3 Timing for Hardware Standby Mode
Figure 17-2 shows the timing relationships for hardware standby mode. To enter hardware standby
mode, first drive RES low, then drive STBY low. To exit hardware standby mode, first drive
STBY high, wait for the clock to settle, then bring RES from low to high.
Clock
oscillator
RES
STBY
Oscillator
settling time
Reset
exception
handling
Figure 17-2 Hardware Standby Mode Timing
520
Section 18 Electrical Characteristics
18.1 Absolute Maximum Ratings
Table 18-1 lists the absolute maximum ratings.
Table 18-1 Absolute Maximum Ratings
Item
Symbol
Value
Unit
Power supply voltage
VCC
–0.3 to +7.0
V
Input voltage (except port 7)
Vin
–0.3 to VCC +0.3
V
Input voltage (port 7)
Vin
–0.3 to AVCC +0.3
V
Reference voltage
VREF
–0.3 to AVCC +0.3
V
Analog power supply voltage
AVCC
–0.3 to +7.0
V
Analog input voltage
VAN
–0.3 to AVCC +0.3
V
Operating temperature
Topr
Regular specifications: –20 to +75
°C
Wide-range specifications: –40 to +85
°C
–55 to +125
°C
Storage temperature
Tstg
Caution: Permanent damage to the chip may result if absolute maximum ratings are exceeded.
521
18.2 Electrical Characteristics
18.2.1 DC Characteristics
Table 18-2 lists the DC characteristics. Table 18-3 lists the permissible output currents.
Table 18-2 DC Characteristics
Conditions: VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, VREF = 4.5 V to AVCC,
VSS = AVSS = 0 V*, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications),
Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications)
Item
Schmitt
trigger input
voltages
Symbol
Port A,
P80 to P82,
PB0 to PB3
VT
–
VT
+
+
VT – VT
RES, STBY,
NMI, MD2 to
MD0
–
Min
Typ
Max
Unit Test Conditions
1.0
—
—
V
—
—
VCC × 0.7 V
0.4
—
—
V
VCC – 0.7 —
VCC + 0.3 V
EXTAL
VCC × 0.7 —
VCC + 0.3 V
Port 7
2.0
—
AVCC + 0.3 V
Ports 4, 6, 9,
P83, P84,
PB4 to PB7,
D15 to D8
2.0
—
VCC + 0.3 V
–0.3
—
0.5
V
NMI, EXTAL,
ports 4, 6, 7,
9, P83, P84,
PB4 to PB7,
D15 to D8
–0.3
—
0.8
V
Output high
voltage
All output pins VOH
VCC – 0.5 —
—
V
IOH = –200 µA
(except RESO)
3.5
—
—
V
IOH = –1mz
Output low
voltage
All output pins VOL
(except RESO)
—
—
0.4
V
IOL = 1.6 mA
Port B,
A19 to A0
—
—
1.0
V
IOL = 10 mA
RESO
—
—
0.4
V
IOL = 2.6 mA
Input high
voltage
Input low
voltage
Note: *
RES, STBY,
MD2 to MD0
VIH
VIL
If the A/D converter is not used, do not leave the AVCC, AVSS, and VREF pins open.
Connect AVCC and VREF to VCC, and connect AVSS to VSS.
522
Table 18-2 DC Characteristics (cont)
Conditions: VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, VREF = 4.5 V to AVCC ,
VSS = AVSS = 0 V*1, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications),
Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications)
Item
Symbol
Min
Typ
Max
Unit
Test Conditions
Input leakage STBY, NMI,
current
RES,
MD2 to MD0
|Iin|
—
—
1.0
µA
Vin = 0.5 to
VCC – 0.5 V
—
—
1.0
µA
Vin = 0.5 to
AVCC – 0.5 V
—
—
1.0
µA
Vin = 0.5 to
VCC – 0.5 V
—
—
10.0
µA
Vin = 0.5 to
VCC – 0.5 V
Port 7
Three-state
leakage
current
(off state)
Ports 4, 6,
8 to B, A19 to
A0, D15 to D8
|ITS1|
RESO
Input pull-up Port 4
current
–IP
50
—
300
µA
Vin = 0 V
Input
NMI
capacitance All input pins
except NMI
Cin
—
—
50
pF
—
—
15
Vin = 0 V
f = 1 MHz
Ta = 25°C
Current
Normal
dissipation*2 operation
ICC*4
—
45
70
mA
f = 16 MHz
—
53
85
—
30
50
—
38
63
—
0.01
5.0
µA
AICC
—
—
—
1.2
20.0
2.0
mA
AICC
—
—
0.01
0.3
5.0
0.6
µA
mA
VRAM
—
2.0
0.01
—
5.0
—
µA
V
Sleep mode
Standby
mode*3
Analog power During A/D
supply current conversion
Idle
During A/D
conversion
Idle
RAM standby voltage
Reference
current
f = 17 MHz
mA
f = 16 MHz
f = 17 MHz
Ta ≤ 50°C
50°C < Ta
VREF = 5.0 V
Notes: 1. If the A/D converter is not used, do not leave the AVCC, AVSS, and VREF pins open.
Connect AVCC and VREF to VCC, and connect AVSS to VSS.
2. Current dissipation values are for VIHmin = VCC – 0.5 V and VILmax = 0.5 V with all output
pins unloaded and the on-chip pull-up transistors in the off state.
3. The values are for VRAM ≤ VCC < 4.5 V, VIHmin = VCC × 0.9, and VILmax = 0.3 V.
4. When 16 MHz, ICC depends on f as follows:
ICC max = 5.0 (mA) + 4.06 (mA/MHz) × f [normal mode]
ICC max = 5.0 (mA) + 2.81 (mA/MHz) × f [sleep mode]
ICC typ = 5.0 (mA) + 2.50 (mA/MHz) × f [normal mode]
ICC typ = 5.0 (mA) + 1.56 (mA/MHz) × f [sleep mode]
523
Table 18-2 DC Characteristics (cont)
Conditions: VCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, VREF = 2.7 V to AVCC,
VSS = AVSS = 0 V*, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications),
Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications)
Item
Schmitt
trigger input
voltages
Input high
voltage
Port A,
P80 to P82,
PB0 to PB3
Symbol
Min
Typ
Max
Unit Test Conditions
VT–
VCC × 0.2
—
—
V
VT+
—
—
VCC × 0.7
V
—
V
VT+ – VT– VCC × 0.07 —
VCC × 0.9
—
VCC + 0.3
V
EXTAL
VCC × 0.7
—
VCC + 0.3
V
Port 7
VCC × 0.7
—
AVCC + 0.3 V
Ports 4, 6, 9,
P83, P84,
PB4 to PB7,
D15 to D8
VCC × 0.7
—
VCC + 0.3
RES, STBY,
NMI, MD2 to
MD0
VIH
V
Note: * If the A/D converter is not used, do not leave the AVCC, AVSS, and VREF pins open.
Connect AVCC and VREF to VCC, and connect AVSS to VSS.
524
Table 18-2 DC Characteristics (cont)
Conditions: VCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, VREF = 2.7 V to AVCC,
VSS = AVSS = 0 V*, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications),
Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications)
Item
Input low
voltage
Output high
voltage
Output low
voltage
Symbol
Min
Typ
Max
VIL
–0.3
—
VCC × 0.1 V
NMI, EXTAL,
ports 4, 6, 7, 9,
P83, P84
PB4 to PB7,
D15 to D8
–0.3
—
VCC × 0.2 V
VCC < 4.0 V
0.8
V
VCC =
4.0 to 5.5 V
All output pins VOH
VCC – 0.5 —
—
V
IOH = –200 µA
(except RESO)
VCC – 1.0 —
—
V
VCC ≤ 4.5 V
IOH = –1 mA
3.5
—
—
V
4.5 V< VCC ≤ 5.5 V
IOH = –1 mA
All output pins VOL
(except RESO)
—
—
0.4
V
IOL = 1.6 mA
Port B,
A19 to A0
—
—
1.0
V
VCC ≤ 4 V
IOL = 5 mA,
4 V < VCC ≤ 5.5 V
IOL = 10 mA
RESO
—
—
0.4
V
IOL = 1.6 mA
—
—
1.0
µA
Vin = 0.5 to
VCC – 0.5 V
—
—
1.0
µA
Vin = 0.5 to
AVCC – 0.5 V
—
—
1.0
µA
Vin = 0.5 to
VCC – 0.5 V
—
—
10.0
µA
10
—
300
µA
RES, STBY,
MD2 to MD0
Input leakage STBY, NMI,
current
RES,
MD2 to MD0
|Iin|
Port 7
Three-state
leakage
current
(off state)
Ports 4, 6,
8 to B, A19 to
A0, D15 to D8
|ITS1|
RESO
Input pull-up Port 4
current
–IP
Unit
Test Conditions
VCC = 2.7 V to
5.5 V,
Vin = 0 V
Note: * If the A/D converter is not used, do not leave the AVCC, AVSS, and VREF pins open.
Connect AVCC and VREF to VCC, and connect AVSS to VSS.
525
Table 18-2 DC Characteristics (cont)
Conditions: VCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, VREF = 2.7 V to AVCC,
VSS = AVSS = 0 V*1, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications),
Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications)
Item
Symbol
Min
Typ
Max
Unit Test Conditions
Cin
—
—
50
pF
—
—
15
Vin = 0 V
f = 1 MHz
Ta = 25°C
—
25
(5.0 V)
31.8
(5.5 V)
mA
f = 8 MHz
Sleep mode
—
15
(5.0 V)
23.0
(5.5 V)
mA
f = 8 MHz
Standby
mode*3
—
0.01
5.0
µA
Ta ≤ 50°C
—
—
20.0
µA
50°C < Ta
—
1.0
2.0
mA
AVCC = 3.0 V
—
1.2
—
mA
AVCC = 5.0 V
—
0.01
5.0
µA
—
0.2
0.4
mA
VREF = 3.0 V
—
0.3
—
mA
VREF = 5.0 V
—
0.01
5.0
µA
2.0
—
—
V
Input
capacitance
NMI
Current
dissipation*2
Normal
operation
All input pins
except NMI
Analog power During A/D
supply current conversion
ICC*4
AICC
Idle
Reference
current
During A/D
conversion
AICC
Idle
RAM standby voltage
VRAM
Notes: 1. If the A/D converter is not used, do not leave the AVCC, AVSS, and VREF pins open.
Connect AVCC and VREF to VCC, and connect AVSS to VSS.
2. Current dissipation values are for VIHmin = VCC – 0.5 V and VILmax = 0.5 V with all output
pins unloaded and the on-chip pull-up transistors in the off state.
3. The values are for VRAM ≤ VCC < 2.7 V, VIHmin = VCC × 0.9, and VILmax = 0.3 V.
4. ICC depends on VCC and f as follows:
ICCmax = 1.0 (mA) + 0.7 (mA/MHz · V) × VCC × f [normal mode]
ICCmax = 1.0 (mA) + 0.5 (mA/MHz · V) × VCC × f [sleep mode]
526
Table 18-2 DC Characteristics (cont)
Conditions: VCC = 3.0 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 3.0 V to 5.5 V, VREF = 3.0 V to AVCC,
VSS = AVSS = 0 V*, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications),
Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications)
Item
Schmitt
trigger input
voltages
Input high
voltage
Input low
voltage
Output high
voltage
Symbol
Min
Typ
Max
Unit Test Conditions
VT–
VCC × 0.2
—
—
V
VT+
—
—
VCC × 0.7 V
—
—
VCC × 0.9
—
VCC + 0.3 V
EXTAL
VCC × 0.7
—
VCC + 0.3 V
Port 7
VCC × 0.7
—
AVCC + 0.3 V
Ports 4, 6, 7,
P83, P84,
PB4 to PB7,
D15 to D8
VCC × 0.7
—
VCC + 0.3 V
–0.3
—
VCC × 0.1 V
NMI, EXTAL,
ports 4, 6, 7, 9,
P83, P84,
PB4 to PB7,
D15 to D8
–0.3
—
VCC × 0.2 V
VCC < 4 V
–0.3
—
0.8
V
4 V ≤ VCC ≤ 5.5 V
All output pins VOH
VCC – 0.5
—
—
V
IOH = –200 µA
(except RESO)
VCC – 1.0
—
—
V
VCC ≤ 4.5 V
IOH = –1 mA
3.5
—
—
V
4.5 V< VCC ≤ 5.5V
Port A,
P80 to P82,
PB0 to PB3
RES, STBY,
NMI, MD2 to
MD0
RES, STBY,
MD2 to MD0
VT+ – VT– VCC × 0.07
VIH
VIL
V
IOH = –1 mA
Note: * If the A/D converter is not used, do not leave the AVCC, AVSS, and VREF pins open.
Connect AVCC and VREF to VCC, and connect AVSS to VSS.
527
Table 18-2 DC Characteristics (cont)
Conditions: VCC = 3.0 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 3.0 V to 5.5 V, VREF = 3.0 V to AVCC ,
VSS = AVSS = 0 V*1, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications),
Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications)
Item
Output low
voltage
Symbol
Min
Typ
Max
Unit
Test Conditions
All output pins VOL
(except RESO)
—
—
0.4
V
IOL = 1.6 mA
Port B,
A19 to A0
—
—
1.0
V
VCC ≤ 4 V, IOL = 5 mA,
4 V < VCC ≤ 5.5 V,
IOL = 10 mA
RESO
—
—
0.4
V
IOL = 1.6 mA
—
—
1.0
µA
Vin = 0.5 to
VCC – 0.5 V
—
—
1.0
µA
Vin = 0.5 to AVCC – 0.5 V
—
—
1.0
µA
Vin = 0.5 to VCC – 0.5 V
—
—
10.0
µA
Input leakage STBY, NMI,
current
RES,
MD2 to MD0
|Iin|
Port 7
Three-state
leakage
current
(off state)
Ports 4, 6,
8 to B, A19 to
A0, D15 to D8
|ITS1|
RESO
Input pull-up Port 4
current
–IP
10
—
300
µA
VCC = 3.0 V to 5.5 V
Vin = 0 V
Input
NMI
capacitance All input pins
except NMI
Cin
—
—
50
pF
—
—
15
Vin = 0 V, f = 1 MHz,
Ta = 25°C
Current
Normal
dissipation*2 operation
ICC*4
—
30
39.5
mA
(5.0 V) (5.5 V)
f = 10 MHz
Sleep mode
—
20
28.5
mA
(5.0 V) (5.5 V)
f = 10 MHz
Standby
mode*3
—
0.01
5.0
µA
Ta ≤ 50°C
—
—
20.0
µA
50°C < Ta
Notes: 1. If the A/D converter is not used, do not leave the AVCC, AVSS, and VREF pins open.
Connect AVCC and VREF to VCC, and connect AVSS to VSS.
2. Current dissipation values are for VIHmin = VCC – 0.5 V and VILmax = 0.5 V with all output
pins unloaded and the on-chip pull-up transistors in the off state.
3. The values are for VRAM ≤ VCC < 3.0 V, VIHmin = VCC × 0.9, and VILmax = 0.3 V.
4. ICC depends on VCC and f as follows:
ICC max = 1.0 (mA) + 0.7 (mA/MHz · V) × VCC × f [normal mode]
ICC max = 1.0 (mA) + 0.5 (mA/MHz · V) × VCC × f [sleep mode]
528
Table 18-2 DC Characteristics (cont)
Conditions: VCC = 3.0 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 3.0 V to 5.5 V, VREF = 3.0 V to AVCC,
VSS = AVSS = 0 V*, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications),
Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications)
Item
Symbol
Min
Typ
Max
Unit Test Conditions
Analog power During A/D
supply current conversion
AICC
—
1.0
2.0
mA
AVCC = 3.0 V
—
1.2
—
mA
AVCC = 5.0 V
—
0.01
5.0
µA
—
0.2
0.4
mA
VREF = 3.0 V
—
0.3
—
mA
VREF = 5.0 V
—
0.01
5.0
µA
2.0
—
—
V
Idle
Reference
current
During A/D
conversion
AICC
Idle
RAM standby voltage
VRAM
Notes: 1. If the A/D converter is not used, do not leave the AVCC, AVSS, and VREF pins open.
Connect AVCC and VREF to VCC, and connect AVSS to VSS.
529
Table 18-3 Permissible Output Currents
Conditions: VCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, VREF = 2.7 V to AVCC,
VSS = AVSS = 0 V, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications),
Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications)
Item
Permissible output
low current (per pin)
Port B, A19 to A0
Permissible output
low current (total)
Total of 28 pins including
port B and A19 to A0
Symbol
Min
Typ
Max
Unit
IOL
—
—
10
mA
—
—
2.0
mA
—
—
80
mA
—
—
120
mA
Other output pins
ΣIOL
Total of all output pins,
including the above
Permissible output
high current (per pin)
All output pins
IOH
—
—
2.0
mA
Permissible output
high current (total)
Total of all output pins
ΣIOH
—
—
40
mA
Notes: 1. To protect chip reliability, do not exceed the output current values in table 18-3.
2. When driving a darlington pair or LED, always insert a current-limiting resistor in the
output line, as shown in figures 18-1 and 18-2.
530
H8/3002
2 kΩ
Port
Darlington pair
Figure 18-1 Darlington Pair Drive Circuit (Example)
H8/3002
Port B
600 Ω
LED
Figure 18-2 LED Drive Circuit (Example)
531
18.2.2 AC Characteristics
Bus timing parameters are listed in table 18-4. Refresh controller bus timing parameters are listed
in table 18-5. Control signal timing parameters are listed in table 18-6. Timing parameters of the
on-chip supporting modules are listed in table 18-7.
Table 18-4 Bus Timing (1)
Condition A:
VCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, VREF = 2.7 V to AVCC,
VSS = AVSS = 0 V, ø = 2 MHz to 8 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications),
Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications)
Condition B:
VCC = 3.0 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 3.0 V to 5.5 V, VREF = 3.0 V to AVCC,
VSS = AVSS = 0 V, ø = 2 MHz to 10 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications),
Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications)
Condition C:
VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, VREF = 4.5 V to AVCC,
VSS = AVSS = 0 V, ø = 2 MHz to 16 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications),
Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications)
Condition D:
VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, VREF = 4.5 V to AVCC,
VSS = AVSS = 0 V, ø = 2 MHz to 17 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications),
Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications)
Condition A Condition B Condition C
8 MHz
Item
Symbol
10 MHz
16 MHz
Condition D
17 MHz
Min
Max
Min
Max
Min
Max
Min
Max
Test
Unit Conditions
Clock cycle time
tCYC
125
500
100
500
62.5
500
58.8
500
ns
Clock low pulse width
tCL
40
—
30
—
20
—
17
—
tcyc
Clock high pulse width
tCH
40
—
30
—
20
—
17
—
Clock rise time
tCR
—
20
—
15
—
10
—
10
Clock fall time
tCF
—
20
—
15
—
10
—
10
Address delay time
tAD
—
60
—
50
—
30
—
25
Address hold time
tAH
25
—
20
—
10
—
10
—
Address strobe delay
time
tASD
—
60
—
40
—
30
—
25
Write strobe delay time
tWSD
—
60
—
50
—
30
—
25
Strobe delay time
tSD
—
60
—
50
—
30
—
25
Write data strobe pulse tWSW1* 85
width 1
—
60
—
35
—
34.8
—
Write data strobe pulse tWSW2* 150
width 2
—
110
—
65
—
66.2
—
Address setup time 1
tAS1
20
—
15
—
10
—
10
—
Address setup time 2
tAS2
80
—
65
—
40
—
38
—
Read data setup time
tRDS
50
—
35
—
20
—
15
—
Read data hold time
tRDH
0
—
0
—
0
—
0
—
532
ns
Figure 18-4,
Figure 18-5
Table 18-4 Bus Timing (cont)
Condition A: VCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, VREF = 2.7 V to AVCC,
VSS = AVSS = 0 V, ø = 2 MHz to 8 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular
specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications)
Condition B: VCC = 3.0 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 3.0 V to 5.5 V, VREF = 3.0 V to AVCC,
VSS = AVSS = 0 V, ø = 2 MHz to 10 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular
specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications)
Condition C: VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, VREF = 4.5 V to AVCC,
VSS = AVSS = 0 V, ø = 2 MHz to 16 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular
specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications)
Condition D: VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, VREF = 4.5 V to AVCC,
VSS = AVSS = 0 V, ø = 2 MHz to 17 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular
specifications), Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications)
Condition A Condition B Condition C Condition D
8 MHz
Item
Symbol
10 MHz
16 MHz
17 MHz
Min
Max
Min
Max
Min
Max
Min
Max
—
75
—
75
—
60
—
55
Write data setup time 1 tWDS1
60
—
65
—
35
—
10
—
Write data setup time 2 tWDS2
15
—
10
—
5
—
-10
—
Write data hold time
tWDH
25
—
20
—
20
—
20
—
Read data access
time 1
tACC1* —
110
—
100
—
55
—
54.2
Read data access
time 2
tACC2* —
230
—
200
—
115
—
113
Read data access
time 3
tACC3* —
55
—
50
—
25
—
22.8
Read data access
time 4
tACC4* —
160
—
150
—
85
—
86.6
Precharge time
tPCH*
85
—
60
—
40
—
37.8
—
Wait setup time
tWTS
40
—
40
—
25
—
25
—
Wait hold time
tWTH
10
—
10
—
5
—
5
—
Bus request setup time
tBRQS
40
—
40
—
40
—
40
—
Bus acknowledge
delay time 1
tBACD1
—
60
—
50
—
30
—
30
Bus acknowledge
delay time 2
tBACD2
—
60
—
50
—
30
—
30
Bus-floating time
tBZD
—
70
—
70
—
40
—
40
Write data delay time
tWDD
Note is on next page.
533
Test
Unit Conditions
ns
Figure 18-4,
Figure 18-5
ns
Figure 18-6
ns
Figure 18-18
Note: * At 8 MHz (condition A), the times below depend as indicated on the clock cycle time.
tACC1 = 1.5 × tCYC – 78 (ns)
tWSW1 = 1.0 × tCYC – 40 (ns)
tACC2 = 2.5 × tCYC – 83 (ns)
tWSW2 = 1.5 × tCYC – 38 (ns)
tACC3 = 1.0 × tCYC – 70 (ns)
tPCH = 1.0 × tCYC – 40 (ns)
tACC4 = 2.0 × tCYC – 90 (ns)
At 10 MHz (condition B), the times below depend as indicated on the clock cycle time.
tACC1 = 1.5 × tCYC – 50 (ns)
tWSW1 = 1.0 × tCYC – 40 (ns)
tACC2 = 2.5 × tCYC – 50 (ns)
tWSW2 = 1.5 × tCYC – 40 (ns)
tACC3 = 1.0 × tCYC – 50 (ns)
tPCH = 1.0 × tCYC – 40 (ns)
tACC4 = 2.0 × tCYC – 50 (ns)
At 16 MHz (condition C), the times below depend as indicated on the clock cycle time.
tACC1 = 1.5 × tCYC – 39 (ns)
tWSW1 = 1.0 × tCYC – 28 (ns)
tACC2 = 2.5 × tCYC – 41 (ns)
tWSW2 = 1.5 × tCYC – 28 (ns)
tACC3 = 1.0 × tCYC – 38 (ns)
tPCH = 1.0 × tCYC – 23 (ns)
tACC4 = 2.0 × tCYC – 40 (ns)
At 17 MHz (condition D), the times below depend as indicated on the clock cycle time.
tACC1 = 1.5 × tCYC – 34 (ns)
tWSW1 = 1.0 × tCYC – 24 (ns)
tACC2 = 2.5 × tCYC – 34 (ns)
tWSW2 = 1.5 × tCYC – 22 (ns)
tACC3 = 1.0 × tCYC – 36 (ns)
tPCH = 1.0 × tCYC – 21 (ns)
tACC4 = 2.0 × tCYC – 31 (ns)
534
Table 18-5 Refresh Controller Bus Timing
Condition A:
VCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, VREF = 2.7 V to AVCC,
VSS = AVSS = 0 V, ø = 2 MHz to 8 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications),
Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications)
Condition B:
VCC = 3.0 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 3.0 V to 5.5 V, VREF = 3.0 V to AVCC,
VSS = AVSS = 0 V, ø = 2 MHz to 8 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications),
Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications)
Condition C:
VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, VREF = 4.5 V to AVCC ,
VSS = AVSS = 0 V, ø = 2 MHz to 16 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications),
Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications)
Condition D:
VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, VREF = 4.5 V to AVCC ,
VSS = AVSS = 0 V, ø = 2 MHz to 17 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications),
Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications)
Condition A Condition B
8 MHz
Item
Symbol Min
10 MHz
Condition C Condition D
16 MHz
17MHz
Max
Min
Max
Min
Max
Min
Max Unit
RAS delay time 1
tRAD1
—
60
—
50
—
30
—
30
RAS delay time 2
tRAD2
—
60
—
50
—
30
—
30
RAS delay time 3
tRAD3
—
60
—
50
—
30
—
30
Row address hold time* tRAH
25
—
20
—
15
—
16.4
—
RAS precharge time*
85
—
70
—
40
—
42.8
—
CAS to RAS precharge tCRP
time*
tRP
85
—
70
—
40
—
42.8
—
CAS pulse width
tCAS
110
—
85
—
40
—
35
—
RAS access time*
tRAC
—
160
—
150
—
85
—
76.6
Address access time
tAA
—
105
—
75
—
55
—
45
CAS access time
tCAC
—
50
—
50
—
25
—
27.8
Write data setup time 3 tWDS3
75
—
50
—
40
—
10
—
CAS setup time*
tCSR
20
—
15
—
15
—
11.4
—
Read strobe delay time tRSD
—
60
—
50
—
30
—
30
ns
Test
Conditions
Figure 18-7
to
Figure 18-13
Note: *At 8 MHz (condition A), the times below depend as indicated on the clock cycle time.
tRAH = 0.5 × tCYC – 38 (ns) tCAC = 1.0 × tCYC – 75 (ns)
tRAC = 2.0 × tCYC – 90 (ns)
tCSR = 0.5 × tCYC – 43 (ns) tRP = tCRP = 1.0 × tCYC – 40 (ns)
At 10 MHz (condition B), the times below depend as indicated on the clock cycle time.
tRAH = 0.5 × tCYC – 30 (ns) tCAC = 1.0 × tCYC – 50 (ns)
tRAC = 2.0 × tCYC – 50 (ns)
tCSR = 0.5 × tCYC – 35 (ns) tRP = tCRP = 1.0 × tCYC – 30 (ns)
At 16 MHz (condition C), the times below depend as indicated on the clock cycle time.
tRAH = 0.5 × tCYC – 16 (ns) tCAC = 1.0 × tCYC – 38 (ns)
tRAC = 2.0 × tCYC – 40 (ns)
tCSR = 0.5 × tCYC – 16 (ns) tRP = tCRP = 1.0 × tCYC – 23 (ns)
At 17 MHz (condition D), the times below depend as indicated on the clock cycle time.
tRAH = 0.5 × tCYC – 13 (ns) tCAC = 1.0 × tCYC – 31 (ns)
tRAC = 2.0 × tCYC – 41 (ns)
tCSR = 0.5 × tCYC – 18 (ns) tRP = tCRP = 1.0 × tCYC – 16 (ns)
535
Table 18-6 Control Signal Timing
Condition A:
VCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, VREF = 2.7 V to AVCC,
VSS = AVSS = 0 V, ø = 2 MHz to 8 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications),
Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications)
Condition B:
VCC = 3.0 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 3.0 V to 5.5 V, VREF = 3.0 V to AVCC,
VSS = AVSS = 0 V, ø = 2 MHz to 10 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications),
Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications)
Condition C:
VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, VREF = 4.5 V to AVCC,
VSS = AVSS = 0 V, ø = 2 MHz to 16 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications),
Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications)
Condition D:
VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, VREF = 4.5 V to AVCC,
VSS = AVSS = 0 V, ø = 2 MHz to 17 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications),
Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications)
Condition A Condition B
8 MHz
Item
Symbol Min
10 MHz
Max
Min
Condition C
16 MHz
Max
Min
Condition D
17 MHz
Max
Min
Max Unit
Test
Conditions
RES setup time
tRESS
200
—
200
—
200
—
200
–
ns
RES pulse width
tRESW
10
—
10
—
10
—
10
–
tCYC
RESO output delay
time
tRESD
—
100
—
100
—
100
–
100
ns
RESO output pulse
width
tRESOW 132
—
132
—
132
—
132
–
tCYC
NMI setup time
(NMI, IRQ5 to IRQ0)
tNMIS
150
—
150
—
150
—
150
–
ns
NMI hold time
(NMI, IRQ5 to IRQ0)
tNMIH
10
—
10
—
10
—
10
–
ns
Interrupt pulse width
(NMI, IRQ2 to IRQ0
when exiting software
standby mode)
tNMIW
200
—
200
—
200
—
200
–
ns
Clock oscillator settling tOSC1
time at reset (crystal)
20
—
20
—
20
—
20
–
ms
Figure 18-19
Clock oscillator settling tOSC2
time in software standby
(crystal)
8
—
8
—
8
—
8
–
ms
Figure 17-1
536
Figure 18-15
Figure 18-16
Figure 18-17
Table 18-7 Timing of On-Chip Supporting Modules
Condition A:
VCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, VREF = 2.7 V to AVCC,
VSS = AVSS = 0 V, ø = 2 MHz to 8 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications),
Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications)
Condition B:
VCC = 3.0 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 3.0 V to 5.5 V, VREF = 3.0 V to AVCC,
VSS = AVSS = 0 V, ø = 2 MHz to 10 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications),
Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications)
Condition C:
VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, VREF = 4.5 V to AVCC,
VSS = AVSS = 0 V, ø = 2 MHz to 16 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications),
Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications)
Condition D:
VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, VREF = 4.5 V to AVCC,
VSS = AVSS = 0 V, ø = 2 MHz to 17 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications),
Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications)
Condition A Condition B Condition C Condition D
8 MHz
Item
Symbol Min
DMAC DREQ setup
time
ITU
16 MHz
17 MHz
Max
Min
Max
Min
Max
Min
Max Unit
tDRQS
40
—
40
—
30
—
30
–
DREQ hold
time
tDRQH
10
—
10
—
10
—
10
–
TEND delay
time 1
tTED1
—
100
—
100
—
50
–
50
TEND delay
time 2
tTED2
—
100
—
100
—
50
–
50
Timer output
delay time
tTOCD
—
100
—
100
—
100
–
100
Timer input
setup time
tTICS
50
—
50
—
50
—
50
–
Timer clock
tTCKS
input setup time
50
—
50
—
50
—
50
–
tTCKWH 1.5
tTCKWL
—
1.5
—
1.5
—
1.5
–
2.5
—
2.5
—
2.5
—
2.5
–
Input AsyntSCYC
clock chronous
cycle
SyntSCYC
chronous
4
—
4
—
4
—
4
–
6
—
6
—
6
—
6
–
Input clock rise tSCKr
time
—
1.5
—
1.5
—
1.5
–
1.5
Input clock fall
time
tSCKf
—
1.5
—
1.5
—
1.5
–
1.5
Input clock
pulse width
tSCKW
0.4
0.6
0.4
0.6
0.4
0.6
0.4
Timer Single
clock edge
pulse
Both
width
edges
SCI
10 MHz
537
ns
Test
Conditions
Figure 18-27
Figure 18-25,
Figure 18-26
ns
Figure 18-21
Figure 18-22
tCYC
0.6 tSCYC
Figure 18-23
Table 18-7 Timing of On-Chip Supporting Modules (cont)
Condition A:
VCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, VREF = 2.7 V to AVCC,
VSS = AVSS = 0 V, ø = 2 MHz to 8 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications),
Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications)
Condition B:
VCC = 3.0 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 3.0 V to 5.5 V, VREF = 3.0 V to AVCC,
VSS = AVSS = 0 V, ø = 2 MHz to 10 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications),
Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications)
Condition C:
VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, VREF = 4.5 V to AVCC,
VSS = AVSS = 0 V, ø = 2 MHz to 16 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications),
Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications)
Condition D:
VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, VREF = 4.5 V to AVCC,
VSS = AVSS = 0 V, ø = 2 MHz to 17 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications),
Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications)
Condition A Condition B Condition C
8 MHz
10 MHz
16 MHz
Symbol Min Max Min Max Min
Max
Item
SCI
Transmit data
tTXD
delay time
Receive data
tRXS
setup time
(synchronous)
Receive
Clock tRXH
data hold input
time (syn- Clock
chronous) output
Ports Output data
tPWD
and delay time
TPC Input data
tPRS
setup time
(synchronous)
Input data
tPRH
hold time
(synchronous)
Condition D
17 MHz
Min Max Unit
—
100
—
100
—
100
–
100
100
—
100
—
100
—
100
–
100
—
100
—
100
—
100
–
0
—
0
—
0
—
0
–
—
100
—
100
—
100
–
100
50
—
50
—
50
—
50
–
50
—
50
—
50
—
50
–
ns
Figure 18-24
ns
Figure 18-20
5V
RL
H8/3002
output pin
C = 90 pF: ports 4, 6, 8,
A19 to A 0 , D15 to D8 ,
ø, AS , RD, HWR , LWR
C = 30 pF: ports 9, A, B
R L = 2.4 kΩ
R H = 12 kΩ
C
RH
Input/output timing measurement levels
• Low: 0.8 V
• High: 2.0 V
Figure 18-3 Output Load Circuit
538
Test
Conditions
18.2.3 A/D Conversion Characteristics
Table 18-8 lists the A/D conversion characteristics.
Table 18-8 A/D Converter Characteristics
Condition A:
VCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 2.7 V to 5.5 V, VREF = 2.7 V to AVCC,
VSS = AVSS = 0 V, ø = 2 MHz to 8 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications),
Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications)
Condition B:
VCC = 3.0 V to 5.5 V, AVCC = 3.0 V to 5.5 V, VREF = 3.0 V to AVCC,
VSS = AVSS = 0 V, ø = 2 MHz to 10 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications),
Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications)
Condition C:
VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, VREF = 4.5 V to AVCC,
VSS = AVSS = 0 V, ø = 2 MHz to 16 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications),
Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications)
Condition D:
VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, VREF = 4.5 V to AVCC,
VSS = AVSS = 0 V, ø = 2 MHz to 17 MHz, Ta = –20°C to +75°C (regular specifications),
Ta = –40°C to +85°C (wide-range specifications)
Condition A
Condition B
Condition C
8 MHz
10 MHz
16 MHz
Condition D
17 MHz
Item
Min Typ Max Min Typ Max Min Typ Max Min Typ Max
Unit
Resolution
10
10
10
bits
Conversion time
—
—
16.8 —
—
13.4 —
—
8.4
—
—
7.8
µs
Analog input
capacitance
—
—
20
—
—
20
—
—
20
—
—
20
pF
Permissible signal- —
source impedance —
—
10*1 —
—
10*1 —
—
10*3 —
—
10*3
kΩ
—
5*2
—
—
5*4
—
—
5*4
10
Nonlinearity error
—
—
±6.0 —
—
±6.0 —
—
±3.0 —
—
±3.0
LSB
Offset error
—
—
±4.0 —
—
±4.0 —
—
±2.0 —
—
±2.0
LSB
Full-scale error
—
—
±4.0 —
—
±4.0 —
—
±2.0 —
—
±2.0
LSB
10
10
10
10
5*5
10
10
10
10
10
Quantization error
—
—
±0.5 —
—
±0.5 —
—
±0.5 —
—
±0.5
LSB
Absolute accuracy
—
—
±8.0 —
—
±8.0 —
—
±4.0 —
—
±4.0
LSB
Notes: 1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
The value is for 4.0 ≤ AVCC ≤ 5.5.
The value is for 2.7 ≤ AVCC < 4.0.
The value is for ø ≤ 12 MHz.
The value is for ø > 12 MHz.
The value is for 3.0 ≤ AVCC < 4.0
539
18.3 Operational Timing
This section shows timing diagrams.
18.3.1 Bus Timing
Bus timing is shown as follows:
•
Basic bus cycle: two-state access
Figure 18-4 shows the timing of the external two-state access cycle.
•
Basic bus cycle: three-state access
Figure 18-5 shows the timing of the external three-state access cycle.
•
Basic bus cycle: three-state access with one wait state
Figure 18-6 shows the timing of the external three-state access cycle with one wait state
inserted.
540
T1
T2
tCYC
tCH
tCL
tCF
tCR
tAD
to A 0
S 3 to CS 0
3
S
tPCH
tASD
tACC3
tSD
tAH
tASD
tACC3
tSD
tAH
tAS1
tPCH
D
ad)
tAS1
tACC1
tRDS
tRDH
to D0
ad)
5
tPCH
tASD
WR, LWR
rite)
tSD
tAH
tAS1
tWSW1
tWDD
tWDS1
tWDH
5 to D0
rite)
Figure 18-4 Basic Bus Cycle: Two-State Access
541
T1
T2
T3
ø
A23 to A0
tACC4
AS
tACC4
RD (read)
tRDS
tACC2
D15 to D0
(read)
tWSD
HWR, LWR
(write)
tWSW2
tAS2
tWDS2
D15 to D0
(write)
Figure 18-5 Basic Bus Cycle: Three-State Access
542
T1
T2
TW
T3
ø
A23 to A0
AS
RD (read)
D15 to D0
(read)
HWR, LWR
(write)
D15 to D0
(write)
tWTS
tWTH
tWTS
tWTH
WAIT
Figure 18-6 Basic Bus Cycle: Three-State Access with One Wait State
543
18.3.2 Refresh Controller Bus Timing
Refresh controller bus timing is shown as follows:
•
DRAM bus timing
Figures 18-7 to 18-12 show the DRAM bus timing in each operating mode.
•
PSRAM bus timing
Figures 18-13 and 18-14 show the pseudo-static RAM bus timing in each operating mode.
T1
ø
T2
tAD
T3
tAD
A9 to A 1
AS
tRAD1
CS3 (RAS)
tRAD3
tRAH
tAS1
tRP
tASD
tAS1
RD (CAS)
HWR (UW),
LWR (LW)
(read)
HWR (UW),
LWR (LW)
(write)
tCAS
tRAC
tASD
tSD
tCRP
tSD
tAA
tCAC
RFSH
tWDH*
tRDS
D15 to D0
(read)
tRDH*
tWDS3
D15 to D0
(write)
Note: * Stipulation from earliest CS3 and RD negate timing.
Figure 18-7 DRAM Bus Timing (Read/Write): Three-State Access
— 2WE Mode —
544
T1
T2
T3
ø
A9 to A1
tASD
tSD
AS
tCSR
tRAD3
CS3 (RAS)
tASD
tRAD2
tSD
tRAD2
tRAD3
RD (CAS)
HWR (UW),
LWR (LW)
RFSH
tCSR
Figure 18-8 DRAM Bus Timing (Refresh Cycle): Three-State Access
— 2WE Mode —
ø
CS3 (RAS)
RD (CAS)
tCSR
tCSR
RFSH
Figure 18-9 DRAM Bus Timing (Self-Refresh Mode)
— 2WE Mode —
545
T1
ø
T2
tAD
T3
tAD
A9 to A 1
AS
tAS1
CS3 (RAS)
tRAD3
tRAD1
tRAH
tRP
tASD
HWR (UCAS),
LWR (LCAS)
tCAS
tAS1
RD (WE)
(read)
tRAC
tCAC
RD (WE)
(write)
tCRP
tSD
tAA
tASD
tSD
RFSH
tWDH
tRDS
tRDH *
D15 to D0
(read)
tWDS3
D15 to D0
(write)
Note: * Stipulation from earliest CS3 and RD negate timing.
Figure 18-10 DRAM Bus Timing (Read/Write): Three-State Access
— 2CAS Mode —
546
T1
T2
T3
ø
A9 to A1
tASD
tSD
AS
tCSR
tRAD3
CS3 (RAS)
tASD
tRAD2
tSD
tRAD2
tRAD3
HWR (UCAS),
LWR (LCAS)
RD (WE)
RFSH
tCSR
Figure 18-11 DRAM Bus Timing (Refresh Cycle): Three-State Access
— 2CAS Mode —
ø
CS3 (RAS)
tCSR
HWR (UCAS),
LWR (LCAS)
tCSR
RFSH
Figure 18-12 DRAM Bus Timing (Self-Refresh Mode)
— 2CAS Mode —
547
T1
T2
T3
tAD
ø
A23 to A 0
AS
tRAD1
tRAD3
tRP
CS3
tAS1
RD (read)
tSD
tRSD
tRDS
D15 to D0
(read)
tWSD
tRDH*
tSD
HWR, LWR
(write)
tWDS2
D15 to D0
(write)
RFSH
Note: * Stipulation from earliest CS3 and RD negate timing.
Figure 18-13 PSRAM Bus Timing (Read/Write): Three-State Access
T1
T2
T3
ø
A23 to A0
AS
CS3, HWR,
LWR, RD
tRAD2
tRAD3
RFSH
Figure 18-14 PSRAM Bus Timing (Refresh Cycle): Three-State Access
548
18.3.3 Control Signal Timing
Control signal timing is shown as follows:
•
Reset input timing
Figure 18-15 shows the reset input timing.
•
Reset output timing
Figure 18-16 shows the reset output timing.
•
Interrupt input timing
Figure 18-17 shows the input timing for NMI and IRQ5 to IRQ0.
•
Bus-release mode timing
Figure 18-18 shows the bus-release mode timing.
ø
tRESS
tRESS
RES
tRESW
Figure 18-15 Reset Input Timing
ø
tRESD
tRESD
RESO
tRESOW
Figure 18-16 Reset Output Timing
549
ø
tNMIS
tNMIH
tNMIS
tNMIH
NMI
IRQ E
tNMIS
IRQ L
IRQ E : Edge-sensitive IRQ i
IRQ L : Level-sensitive IRQ i (i = 0 to 5)
tNMIW
NMI
IRQ j
(j = 0 to 2)
Figure 18-17 Interrupt Input Timing
ø
tBRQS
tBRQS
BREQ
tBACD2
tBACD1
BACK
A23 to A0,
AS, RD,
tBZD
HWR, LWR
Figure 18-18 Bus-Release Mode Timing
550
tBZD
18.3.4 Clock Timing
Clock timing is shown as follows:
•
Oscillator settling timing
Figure 18-19 shows the oscillator settling timing.
ø
VCC
STBY
tOSC1
tOSC1
RES
Figure 18-19 Oscillator Settling Timing
18.3.5 TPC and I/O Port Timing
TPC and I/O port timing is shown as follows.
T1
T2
T3
ø
tPRS
tPRH
Port 4,
6 to B
(read)
tPWD
Port 4,6,
8 to B
(write)
Figure 18-20 TPC and I/O Port Input/Output Timing
551
18.3.6 ITU Timing
ITU timing is shown as follows:
•
ITU input/output timing
Figure 18-21 shows the ITU input/output timing.
•
ITU external clock input timing
Figure 18-22 shows the ITU external clock input timing.
ø
tTOCD
Output
compare*1
tTICS
Input
capture*2
Notes: 1. TIOCA0 to TIOCA4, TIOCB0 to TIOCB4, TOCXA4, TOCXB4
2. TIOCA0 to TIOCA4, TIOCB0 to TIOCB4
Figure 18-21 ITU Input/Output Timing
tTCKS
ø
tTCKS
TCLKA to
TCLKD
tTCKWL
tTCKWH
Figure 18-22 ITU Clock Input Timing
552
18.3.7 SCI Input/Output Timing
SCI timing is shown as follows:
•
SCI input clock timing
Figure 18-23 shows the SCI input clock timing.
•
SCI input/output timing (synchronous mode)
Figure 18-24 shows the SCI input/output timing in synchronous mode.
tSCKW
tSCKr
tSCKf
SCK0, SCK1
tSCYC
Figure 18-23 SCK Input Clock Timing
tSCYC
SCK0, SCK1
tTXD
TxD0, TxD1
(transmit
data)
tRXS
tRXH
RxD0, RxD1
(receive
data)
Figure 18-24 SCI Input/Output Timing in Synchronous Mode
553
18.3.8 DMAC Timing
DMAC timing is shown as follows.
•
DMAC TEND output timing for 2 state access
Figure 18-25 shows the DMAC TEND output timing for 2 state access.
•
DMAC TEND output timing for 3 state access
Figure 18-26 shows the DMAC TEND output timing for 3 state access.
•
DMAC DREQ input timing
Figure 18-27 shows DMAC DREQ input timing.
T1
T2
ø
tTED1
tTED2
TEND
Figure 18-25 DMAC TEND Output Timing/2 State Access
T1
T2
T3
ø
tTED2
tTED1
TEND
Figure 18-26 DMAC TEND Output Timing/3 State Access
554
ø
tDRQS
tDRQH
DREQ
Figure 18-27 DMAC DREQ Input Timing
555
556
Appendix A Instruction Set
A.1 Instruction List
Operand Notation
Symbol
Description
Rd
General destination register
Rs
General source register
Rn
General register
ERd
General destination register (address register or 32-bit register)
ERs
General source register (address register or 32-bit register)
ERn
General register (32-bit register)
(EAd)
Destination operand
(EAs)
Source operand
PC
Program counter
SP
Stack pointer
CCR
Condition code register
N
N (negative) flag in CCR
Z
Z (zero) flag in CCR
V
V (overflow) flag in CCR
C
C (carry) flag in CCR
disp
Displacement
→
Transfer from the operand on the left to the operand on the right, or transition from
the state on the left to the state on the right
+
Addition of the operands on both sides
–
Subtraction of the operand on the right from the operand on the left
×
Multiplication of the operands on both sides
÷
Division of the operand on the left by the operand on the right
∧
Logical AND of the operands on both sides
∨
Logical OR of the operands on both sides
⊕
Exclusive logical OR of the operands on both sides
¬
NOT (logical complement)
( ), < >
Contents of operand
Note: General registers include 8-bit registers (R0H to R7H and R0L to R7L) and 16-bit registers
(R0 to R7 and E0 to E7).
557
Condition Code Notation
Symbol
Description
↕
Changed according to execution result
*
Undetermined (no guaranteed value)
0
Cleared to 0
1
Set to 1
—
Not affected by execution of the instruction
∆
Varies depending on conditions, described in notes
558
Table A-1 Instruction Set
Data transfer instructions
B
#xx:8 → Rd8
MOV.B Rs, Rd
B
Rs8 → Rd8
2
Condition Code
I
C
Advanced
No. of
States *1
—
@@aa
@(d, PC)
@aa
@–ERn/@ERn+
@(d, ERn)
@ERn
2
MOV.B #xx:8, Rd
Rn
Operation
#xx
Mnemonic
Operand Size
Addressing Mode and
Instruction Length (bytes)
Normal
1.
H N
Z
V
— — ↕
↕
0 —
2
— — ↕
↕
0 —
2
MOV.B @ERs, Rd
B
@ERs → Rd8
— — ↕
↕
0 —
4
MOV.B @(d:16, ERs),
Rd
B
@(d:16, ERs) → Rd8
4
— — ↕
↕
0 —
6
MOV.B @(d:24, ERs),
Rd
B
@(d:24, ERs) → Rd8
8
— — ↕
↕
0 —
10
MOV.B @ERs+, Rd
B
@ERs → RD8
ERs32+1 → ERs32
— — ↕
↕
0 —
6
MOV.B @aa:8, Rd
B
@aa:8 → Rd8
2
— — ↕
↕
0 —
4
MOV.B @aa:16, Rd
B
@aa:16 → Rd8
4
— — ↕
↕
0 —
6
MOV.B @aa:24, Rd
B
@aa:24 → Rd8
6
— — ↕
↕
0 —
8
MOV.B Rs, @ERd
B
Rs8 → @ERd
— — ↕
↕
0 —
4
MOV.B Rs, @(d:16,
ERd)
B
Rs8 → @(d:16, ERd)
4
— — ↕
↕
0 —
6
MOV.B Rs, @(d:24,
ERd)
B
Rs8 → @(d:24, ERd)
8
— — ↕
↕
0 —
10
MOV.B Rs, @–ERd
B
ERd32–1 → ERd32
Rs8 → @ERd
— — ↕
↕
0 —
6
MOV.B Rs, @aa:8
B
Rs8 → @aa:8
2
— — ↕
↕
0 —
4
MOV.B Rs, @aa:16
B
Rs8 → @aa:16
4
— — ↕
↕
0 —
6
MOV.B Rs, @aa:24
B
Rs8 → @aa:24
6
— — ↕
↕
0 —
8
MOV.W #xx:16, Rd
W #xx:16 → Rd16
— — ↕
↕
0 —
4
MOV.W Rs, Rd
W Rs16 → Rd16
— — ↕
↕
0 —
2
2
2
2
2
4
2
MOV.W @ERs, Rd
W @ERs → Rd16
— — ↕
↕
0 —
4
MOV.W @(d:16, ERs),
Rd
W @(d:16, ERs) → Rd16
4
— — ↕
↕
0 —
6
MOV.W @(d:24, ERs),
Rd
W @(d:24, ERs) → Rd16
8
— — ↕
↕
0 —
10
MOV.W @ERs+, Rd
W @ERs → Rd16
ERs32+2 → @ERd32
— — ↕
↕
0 —
6
MOV.W @aa:16, Rd
W @aa:16 → Rd16
— — ↕
↕
0 —
6
2
2
4
559
Table A-1 Instruction Set (cont)
W Rs16 → @aa:16
MOV.W Rs, @aa:24
W Rs16 → @aa:24
MOV.L #xx:32, ERd
L
#xx:32 → ERd32
MOV.L ERs, ERd
L
ERs32 → ERd32
H N
Z
V
— — ↕
↕
0 —
8
— — ↕
↕
0 —
4
4
— — ↕
↕
0 —
6
8
— — ↕
↕
0 —
10
— — ↕
↕
0 —
6
4
— — ↕
↕
0 —
6
6
— — ↕
↕
0 —
8
— — ↕
↕
0 —
6
— — ↕
↕
0 —
2
6
2
2
6
2
C
Advanced
MOV.W Rs, @aa:16
Condition Code
I
Normal
W ERd32–2 → ERd32
Rs16 → @ERd
No. of
States *1
—
MOV.W Rs, @–ERd
@@aa
W Rs16 → @(d:24, ERd)
@(d, PC)
MOV.W Rs, @(d:24,
ERd)
@aa
W Rs16 → @(d:16, ERd)
@–ERn/@ERn+
MOV.W Rs, @(d:16,
ERd)
@(d, ERn)
W Rs16 → @ERd
@ERn
W @aa:24 → Rd16
MOV.W Rs, @ERd
Rn
MOV.W @aa:24, Rd
Operation
#xx
Mnemonic
Operand Size
Addressing Mode and
Instruction Length (bytes)
MOV.L @ERs, ERd
L
@ERs → ERd32
— — ↕
↕
0 —
8
MOV.L @(d:16, ERs),
ERd
L
@(d:16, ERs) → ERd32
6
— — ↕
↕
0 —
10
MOV.L @(d:24, ERs),
ERd
L
@(d:24, ERs) → ERd32
10
— — ↕
↕
0 —
14
MOV.L @ERs+, ERd
L
@ERs → ERd32
ERs32+4 → ERs32
— — ↕
↕
0 —
10
MOV.L @aa:16, ERd
L
@aa:16 → ERd32
6
— — ↕
↕
0 —
10
MOV.L @aa:24, ERd
L
@aa:24 → ERd32
8
— — ↕
↕
0 —
12
MOV.L ERs, @ERd
L
ERs32 → @ERd
— — ↕
↕
0 —
8
MOV.L ERs, @(d:16,
ERd)
L
ERs32 → @(d:16, ERd)
6
— — ↕
↕
0 —
10
MOV.L ERs, @(d:24,
ERd)
L
ERs32 → @(d:24, ERd)
10
— — ↕
↕
0 —
14
MOV.L ERs, @–ERd
L
ERd32–4 → ERd32
ERs32 → @ERd
— — ↕
↕
0 —
10
4
4
4
4
MOV.L ERs, @aa:16
L
ERs32 → @aa:16
6
— — ↕
↕
0 —
10
MOV.L ERs, @aa:24
L
ERs32 → @aa:24
8
— — ↕
↕
0 —
12
POP.W Rn
W @SP → Rn16
SP+2 → SP
2 — — ↕
↕
0 —
6
POP.L ERn
L
4 — — ↕
↕
0 —
10
@SP → ERn32
SP+4 → SP
560
Table A-1 Instruction Set (cont)
C
Normal
Condition Code
I
Advanced
No. of
States *1
—
@@aa
@(d, PC)
@aa
@–ERn/@ERn+
@(d, ERn)
@ERn
Rn
Operation
#xx
Mnemonic
Operand Size
Addressing Mode and
Instruction Length (bytes)
H N
Z
V
2 — — ↕
↕
0 —
6
4 — — ↕
↕
0 —
10
PUSH.W Rn
W SP–2 → SP
Rn16 → @SP
PUSH.L ERn
L
SP–4 → SP
ERn32 → @SP
MOVFPE @aa:16,
Rd
B
Cannot be used in the
H8/3002
4
Cannot be used in the H8/3002
MOVTPE Rs,
@aa:16
B
Cannot be used in the
H8/3002
4
Cannot be used in the H8/3002
Arithmetic instructions
L
ERd32+#xx:32 →
ERd32
ADD.L ERs, ERd
L
ERd32+ERs32 →
ERd32
Condition Code
I
H N
Z
V
C
Advanced
ADD.L #xx:32, ERd
No. of
States *1
—
W Rd16+Rs16 → Rd16
@@aa
W Rd16+#xx:16 → Rd16
ADD.W Rs, Rd
@(d, PC)
ADD.W #xx:16, Rd
@aa
2
Rd8+Rs8 → Rd8
@–ERn/@ERn+
Rd8+#xx:8 → Rd8
B
ADD.B Rs, Rd
@(d, ERn)
#xx
B
ADD.B #xx:8, Rd
@ERn
Operation
Mnemonic
Rn
Operand Size
Addressing Mode and
Instruction Length (bytes)
Normal
2.
— ↕
↕
↕
↕
↕
2
2
— ↕
↕
↕
↕
↕
2
— (1) ↕
↕
↕
↕
4
2
— (1) ↕
↕
↕
↕
2
— (2) ↕
↕
↕
↕
6
2
— (2) ↕
↕
↕
↕
2
4
6
ADDX.B #xx:8, Rd
B
Rd8+#xx:8 +C → Rd8
— ↕
↕ (3) ↕
↕
2
ADDX.B Rs, Rd
B
Rd8+Rs8 +C → Rd8
2
— ↕
↕ (3) ↕
↕
2
ADDS.L #1, ERd
L
ERd32+1 → ERd32
2
— — — — — —
2
ADDS.L #2, ERd
L
ERd32+2 → ERd32
2
— — — — — —
2
2
ADDS.L #4, ERd
L
ERd32+4 → ERd32
2
— — — — — —
2
INC.B Rd
B
Rd8+1 → Rd8
2
— — ↕
2
↕
↕ —
INC.W #1, Rd
W Rd16+1 → Rd16
2
— — ↕
↕
↕ —
2
INC.W #2, Rd
W Rd16+2 → Rd16
2
— — ↕
↕
↕ —
2
561
TIable A-1 Instruction Set (cont)
H N
Z
V
C
Normal
Condition Code
I
Advanced
No. of
States *1
—
@@aa
@(d, PC)
@aa
@–ERn/@ERn+
@(d, ERn)
@ERn
Rn
Operation
#xx
Mnemonic
Operand Size
Addressing Mode and
Instruction Length (bytes)
INC.L #1, ERd
L
ERd32+1 → ERd32
2
— — ↕
↕
↕ —
2
INC.L #2, ERd
L
ERd32+2 → ERd32
2
— — ↕
↕
↕ —
2
DAA Rd
B
Rd8 decimal adjust
→ Rd8
2
— *
↕
↕
* —
2
SUB.B Rs, Rd
B
Rd8–Rs8 → Rd8
— ↕
SUB.W #xx:16, Rd
W Rd16–#xx:16 → Rd16
SUB.W Rs, Rd
W Rd16–Rs16 → Rd16
SUB.L #xx:32, ERd
L
ERd32–#xx:32
→ ERd32
SUB.L ERs, ERd
L
ERd32–ERs32
→ ERd32
SUBX.B #xx:8, Rd
B
Rd8–#xx:8–C → Rd8
2
4
2
6
2
2
↕
↕
↕
↕
2
— (1) ↕
↕
↕
↕
4
— (1) ↕
↕
↕
↕
2
— (2) ↕
↕
↕
↕
6
— (2) ↕
↕
↕
↕
2
— ↕
↕ (3) ↕
↕
2
↕ (3) ↕
SUBX.B Rs, Rd
B
Rd8–Rs8–C → Rd8
2
— ↕
↕
2
SUBS.L #1, ERd
L
ERd32–1 → ERd32
2
— — — — — —
2
SUBS.L #2, ERd
L
ERd32–2 → ERd32
2
— — — — — —
2
SUBS.L #4, ERd
L
ERd32–4 → ERd32
2
— — — — — —
2
Rd8–1 → Rd8
DEC.B Rd
B
2
— — ↕
↕
↕ —
2
DEC.W #1, Rd
W Rd16–1 → Rd16
2
— — ↕
↕
↕ —
2
DEC.W #2, Rd
W Rd16–2 → Rd16
2
— — ↕
↕
↕ —
2
DEC.L #1, ERd
L
2
— — ↕
↕
↕ —
2
ERd32–1 → ERd32
DEC.L #2, ERd
L
ERd32–2 → ERd32
2
— — ↕
↕
↕ —
2
DAS.Rd
B
Rd8 decimal adjust
→ Rd8
2
— *
↕
↕
* —
2
MULXU. B Rs, Rd
B
Rd8 × Rs8 → Rd16
(unsigned multiplication)
2
— — — — — —
14
MULXU. W Rs, ERd
W Rd16 × Rs16 → ERd32
(unsigned multiplication)
2
— — — — — —
22
MULXS. B Rs, Rd
B
4
— — ↕
↕ — —
16
MULXS. W Rs, ERd
W Rd16 × Rs16 → ERd32
(signed multiplication)
4
— — ↕
↕ — —
24
DIVXU. B Rs, Rd
B
2
— — (6) (7) — —
14
Rd8 × Rs8 → Rd16
(signed multiplication)
Rd16 ÷ Rs8 → Rd16
(RdH: remainder,
RdL: quotient)
(unsigned division)
562
Table A-1 Instruction Set (cont)
H N
Z
V
C
Normal
Condition Code
I
Advanced
No. of
States *1
—
@@aa
@(d, PC)
@aa
@–ERn/@ERn+
@(d, ERn)
@ERn
Rn
Operation
#xx
Mnemonic
Operand Size
Addressing Mode and
Instruction Length (bytes)
DIVXU. W Rs, ERd
W ERd32 ÷ Rs16 →ERd32
(Ed: remainder,
Rd: quotient)
(unsigned division)
2
— — (6) (7) — —
22
DIVXS. B Rs, Rd
B
Rd16 ÷ Rs8 → Rd16
(RdH: remainder,
RdL: quotient)
(signed division)
4
— — (8) (7) — —
16
DIVXS. W Rs, ERd
W ERd32 ÷ Rs16 → ERd32
(Ed: remainder,
Rd: quotient)
(signed division)
4
— — (8) (7) — —
24
— ↕
↕
↕
↕
↕
2
2
— ↕
↕
↕
↕
↕
2
— (1) ↕
↕
↕
↕
4
2
— (1) ↕
↕
↕
↕
2
— (2) ↕
↕
↕
↕
6
2
— (2) ↕
↕
↕
↕
2
CMP.B #xx:8, Rd
B
Rd8–#xx:8
CMP.B Rs, Rd
B
Rd8–Rs8
CMP.W #xx:16, Rd
W Rd16–#xx:16
CMP.W Rs, Rd
W Rd16–Rs16
CMP.L #xx:32, ERd
L
ERd32–#xx:32
CMP.L ERs, ERd
L
ERd32–ERs32
NEG.B Rd
B
0–Rd8 → Rd8
NEG.W Rd
W 0–Rd16 → Rd16
2
4
6
2
— ↕
↕
↕
↕
↕
2
2
— ↕
↕
↕
↕
↕
2
NEG.L ERd
L
0–ERd32 → ERd32
2
— ↕
↕
↕
↕
↕
2
EXTU.W Rd
W 0 → (<bits 15 to 8>
of Rd16)
2
— — 0
↕
0 —
2
EXTU.L ERd
L
0 → (<bits 31 to 16>
of Rd32)
2
— — 0
↕
0 —
2
EXTS.W Rd
W (<bit 7> of Rd16) →
(<bits 15 to 8> of Rd16)
2
— — ↕
↕
0 —
2
EXTS.L ERd
L
2
— — ↕
↕
0 —
2
(<bit 15> of Rd32) →
(<bits 31 to 16> of
ERd32)
563
Table A-1 Instruction Set (cont)
Logic instructions
AND.L #xx:32, ERd
L
ERd32∧#xx:32 → ERd32
AND.L ERs, ERd
L
ERd32∧ERs32 → ERd32
OR.B #xx:8, Rd
B
Rd8∨#xx:8 → Rd8
OR.B Rs, Rd
B
Rd8∨Rs8 → Rd8
OR.W #xx:16, Rd
W Rd16∨#xx:16 → Rd16
OR.W Rs, Rd
W Rd16∨Rs16 → Rd16
OR.L #xx:32, ERd
L
ERd32∨#xx:32 → ERd32
OR.L ERs, ERd
L
ERd32∨ERs32 → ERd32
XOR.B #xx:8, Rd
B
Rd8⊕#xx:8 → Rd8
XOR.B Rs, Rd
B
Rd8⊕Rs8 → Rd8
4
2
6
4
2
2
4
2
6
4
2
2
XOR.W #xx:16, Rd
W Rd16⊕#xx:16 → Rd16
XOR.W Rs, Rd
W Rd16⊕Rs16 → Rd16
XOR.L #xx:32, ERd
L
ERd32⊕#xx:32 → ERd32
XOR.L ERs, ERd
L
ERd32⊕ERs32 → ERd32
4
¬ Rd8 → Rd8
4
2
6
Condition Code
I
C
Advanced
No. of
States *1
—
W Rd16∧Rs16 → Rd16
@@aa
W Rd16∧#xx:16 → Rd16
AND.W Rs, Rd
@(d, PC)
AND.W #xx:16, Rd
2
@aa
2
Rd8∧Rs8 → Rd8
@–ERn/@ERn+
Rd8∧#xx:8 → Rd8
B
AND.B Rs, Rd
@(d, ERn)
#xx
B
AND.B #xx:8, Rd
@ERn
Operation
Mnemonic
Rn
Operand Size
Addressing Mode and
Instruction Length (bytes)
Normal
3.
H N
Z
V
— — ↕
↕
0 —
2
— — ↕
↕
0 —
2
— — ↕
↕
0 —
4
— — ↕
↕
0 —
2
— — ↕
↕
0 —
6
— — ↕
↕
0 —
4
— — ↕
↕
0 —
2
— — ↕
↕
0 —
2
— — ↕
↕
0 —
4
— — ↕
↕
0 —
2
— — ↕
↕
0 —
6
— — ↕
↕
0 —
4
— — ↕
↕
0 —
2
— — ↕
↕
0 —
2
— — ↕
↕
0 —
4
— — ↕
↕
0 —
2
— — ↕
↕
0 —
6
— — ↕
↕
0 —
4
NOT.B Rd
B
2
— — ↕
↕
0 —
2
NOT.W Rd
W ¬ Rd16 → Rd16
2
— — ↕
↕
0 —
2
NOT.L ERd
L
¬ Rd32 → Rd32
2
— — ↕
↕
0 —
2
564
Table A-1 Instruction Set (cont)
Shift instructions
SHAL.B Rd
B
SHAL.W Rd
W
SHAL.L ERd
L
SHAR.B Rd
B
SHAR.W Rd
W
SHAR.L ERd
L
SHLL.B Rd
B
SHLL.W Rd
W
SHLL.L ERd
L
SHLR.B Rd
B
SHLR.W Rd
W
SHLR.L ERd
L
ROTXL.B Rd
B
ROTXL.W Rd
W
ROTXL.L ERd
L
ROTXR.B Rd
B
ROTXR.W Rd
W
ROTXR.L ERd
L
ROTL.B Rd
B
ROTL.W Rd
W
ROTL.L ERd
L
ROTR.B Rd
B
ROTR.W Rd
W
ROTR.L ERd
L
C
0
MSB
LSB
C
MSB
LSB
C
0
MSB
LSB
0
C
MSB
LSB
C
MSB
LSB
C
MSB
LSB
C
MSB
LSB
C
MSB
LSB
Condition Code
I
H N
Z
V
C
Advanced
No. of
States *1
—
@@aa
@(d, PC)
@aa
@–ERn/@ERn+
@(d, ERn)
@ERn
Operation
Rn
#xx
Mnemonic
Operand Size
Addressing Mode and
Instruction Length (bytes)
Normal
4.
2
— — ↕
↕
↕
↕
2
2
— — ↕
↕
↕
↕
2
2
— — ↕
↕
↕
↕
2
2
— — ↕
↕
0
↕
2
2
— — ↕
↕
0
↕
2
2
— — ↕
↕
0
↕
2
2
— — ↕
↕
0
↕
2
2
— — ↕
↕
0
↕
2
2
— — ↕
↕
0
↕
2
2
— — ↕
↕
0
↕
2
2
— — ↕
↕
0
↕
2
2
— — ↕
↕
0
↕
2
2
— — ↕
↕
0
↕
2
2
— — ↕
↕
0
↕
2
2
— — ↕
↕
0
↕
2
2
— — ↕
↕
0
↕
2
2
— — ↕
↕
0
↕
2
2
— — ↕
↕
0
↕
2
2
— — ↕
↕
0
↕
2
2
— — ↕
↕
0
↕
2
2
— — ↕
↕
0
↕
2
2
— — ↕
↕
0
↕
2
2
— — ↕
↕
0
↕
2
2
— — ↕
↕
0
↕
2
565
Table A-1 Instruction Set (cont)
Bit manipulation instructions
BSET #xx:3, @aa:8
B
(#xx:3 of @aa:8) ← 1
BSET Rn, Rd
B
(Rn8 of Rd8) ← 1
BSET Rn, @ERd
B
(Rn8 of @ERd) ← 1
BSET Rn, @aa:8
B
(Rn8 of @aa:8) ← 1
BCLR #xx:3, Rd
B
(#xx:3 of Rd8) ← 0
BCLR #xx:3, @ERd
B
(#xx:3 of @ERd) ← 0
BCLR #xx:3, @aa:8
B
(#xx:3 of @aa:8) ← 0
BCLR Rn, Rd
B
(Rn8 of Rd8) ← 0
BCLR Rn, @ERd
B
(Rn8 of @ERd) ← 0
BCLR Rn, @aa:8
B
(Rn8 of @aa:8) ← 0
BNOT #xx:3, Rd
B
(#xx:3 of Rd8) ←
¬ (#xx:3 of Rd8)
BNOT #xx:3, @ERd
B
(#xx:3 of @ERd) ←
¬ (#xx:3 of @ERd)
BNOT #xx:3, @aa:8
B
(#xx:3 of @aa:8) ←
¬ (#xx:3 of @aa:8)
BNOT Rn, Rd
B
(Rn8 of Rd8) ←
¬ (Rn8 of Rd8)
BNOT Rn, @ERd
B
(Rn8 of @ERd) ←
¬ (Rn8 of @ERd)
BNOT Rn, @aa:8
B
(Rn8 of @aa:8) ←
¬ (Rn8 of @aa:8)
BTST #xx:3, Rd
B
¬ (#xx:3 of Rd8) → Z
BTST #xx:3, @ERd
B
¬ (#xx:3 of @ERd) → Z
BTST #xx:3, @aa:8
B
¬ (#xx:3 of @aa:8) → Z
BTST Rn, Rd
B
¬ (Rn8 of @Rd8) → Z
BTST Rn, @ERd
B
¬ (Rn8 of @ERd) → Z
BTST Rn, @aa:8
B
¬ (Rn8 of @aa:8) → Z
BLD #xx:3, Rd
B
(#xx:3 of Rd8) → C
2
4
4
2
4
4
2
4
4
2
4
4
2
4
4
2
4
4
2
4
4
2
4
4
2
566
Condition Code
I
H N
Z
V
C
Advanced
No. of
States *1
—
@@aa
@(d, PC)
@aa
(#xx:3 of @ERd) ← 1
@–ERn/@ERn+
(#xx:3 of Rd8) ← 1
B
@(d, ERn)
B
BSET #xx:3, @ERd
@ERn
BSET #xx:3, Rd
Rn
Operation
#xx
Mnemonic
Operand Size
Addressing Mode and
Instruction Length (bytes)
Normal
5.
— — — — — —
2
— — — — — —
8
— — — — — —
8
— — — — — —
2
— — — — — —
8
— — — — — —
8
— — — — — —
2
— — — — — —
8
— — — — — —
8
— — — — — —
2
— — — — — —
8
— — — — — —
8
— — — — — —
2
— — — — — —
8
— — — — — —
8
— — — — — —
2
— — — — — —
8
— — — — — —
8
— — — ↕ — —
2
— — — ↕ — —
6
— — — ↕ — —
6
— — — ↕ — —
2
— — — ↕ — —
6
— — — ↕ — —
6
— — — — — ↕
2
Table A-1 Instruction Set (cont)
BLD #xx:3, @ERd
B (#xx:3 of @ERd) → C
BLD #xx:3, @aa:8
B (#xx:3 of @aa:8) → C
BILD #xx:3, Rd
B ¬ (#xx:3 of Rd8) → C
BILD #xx:3, @ERd
B ¬ (#xx:3 of @ERd) → C
BILD #xx:3, @aa:8
B ¬ (#xx:3 of @aa:8) → C
BST #xx:3, Rd
B C → (#xx:3 of Rd8)
BST #xx:3, @REd
B C → (#xx:3 of @ERd)
BST #xx:3, @aa:8
B C → (#xx:3 of @aa:8)
BIST #xx:3, Rd
B ¬ C → (#xx:3 of Rd8)
BIST #xx:3, @ERd
B ¬ C → (#xx:3 of @ERd24)
BIST #xx:3, @aa:8
B ¬ C → (#xx:3 of @aa:8)
BAND #xx:3, Rd
B C∧(#xx:3 of Rd8) → C
BAND #xx:3, @ERd
B C∧(#xx:3 of @ERd24) → C
BAND #xx:3, @aa:8
B C∧(#xx:3 of @aa:8) → C
BIAND #xx:3, Rd
B C∧¬ (#xx:3 of Rd8) → C
BIAND #xx:3, @ERd
B C∧¬ (#xx:3 of @ERd24) → C
BIAND #xx:3, @aa:8
B C∧¬ (#xx:3 of @aa:8) → C
BOR #xx:3, Rd
B C∨(#xx:3 of Rd8) → C
BOR #xx:3, @ERd
B C∨(#xx:3 of @ERd24) → C
BOR #xx:3, @aa:8
B C∨(#xx:3 of @aa:8) → C
BIOR #xx:3, Rd
B C∨¬ (#xx:3 of Rd8) → C
BIOR #xx:3, @ERd
B C∨¬ (#xx:3 of @ERd24) → C
BIOR #xx:3, @aa:8
B C∨¬ (#xx:3 of @aa:8) → C
BXOR #xx:3, Rd
B C⊕(#xx:3 of Rd8) → C
BXOR #xx:3, @ERd
B C⊕(#xx:3 of @ERd24) → C
BXOR #xx:3, @aa:8
B C⊕(#xx:3 of @aa:8) → C
BIXOR #xx:3, Rd
B C⊕¬ (#xx:3 of Rd8) → C
BIXOR #xx:3, @ERd
B C⊕¬ (#xx:3 of @ERd24) → C
BIXOR #xx:3, @aa:8
B C⊕¬ (#xx:3 of @aa:8) → C
4
4
2
4
4
2
4
4
2
4
4
2
4
4
2
4
4
2
4
4
2
4
4
2
4
4
2
4
4
567
H N
Z
V
C
Normal
Condition Code
I
Advanced
No. of
States *1
—
@@aa
@(d, PC)
@aa
@–ERn/@ERn+
@(d, ERn)
@ERn
Rn
Operation
#xx
Mnemonic
Operand Size
Addressing Mode and
Instruction Length (bytes)
— — — — — ↕
6
— — — — — ↕
6
— — — — — ↕
2
— — — — — ↕
6
— — — — — ↕
6
— — — — — —
2
— — — — — —
8
— — — — — —
8
— — — — — —
2
— — — — — —
8
— — — — — —
8
— — — — — ↕
2
— — — — — ↕
6
— — — — — ↕
6
— — — — — ↕
2
— — — — — ↕
6
— — — — — ↕
6
— — — — — ↕
2
— — — — — ↕
6
— — — — — ↕
6
— — — — — ↕
2
— — — — — ↕
6
— — — — — ↕
6
— — — — — ↕
2
— — — — — ↕
6
— — — — — ↕
6
— — — — — ↕
2
— — — — — ↕
6
— — — — — ↕
6
Table A-1 Instruction Set (cont)
Branching instructions
BRA d:8 (BT d:8)
—
BRA d:16 (BT d:16)
—
BRN d:8 (BF d:8)
—
BRN d:16 (BF d:16)
—
BHI d:8
—
BHI d:16
—
BLS d:8
—
BLS d:16
—
BCC d:8 (BHS d:8)
—
BCC d:16 (BHS d:16)
—
BCS d:8 (BLO d:8)
—
BCS d:16 (BLO d:16)
—
BNE d:8
—
BNE d:16
—
BEQ d:8
—
BEQ d:16
—
BVC d:8
—
BVC d:16
—
BVS d:8
—
BVS d:16
—
BPL d:8
—
BPL d:16
—
BMI d:8
—
BMI d:16
—
BGE d:8
—
BGE d:16
—
BLT d:8
—
BLT d:16
—
BGT d:8
—
BGT d:16
—
If condition Always
is true then
PC ←
PC+d else Never
next;
C∨Z=0
C∨Z=1
C=0
C=1
Z=0
Z=1
V=0
V=1
N=0
N=1
N⊕V = 0
N⊕V = 1
Z ∨ (N⊕V)
=0
568
Condition Code
I
H N
Z
V
C
Advanced
No. of
States *1
—
@@aa
@(d, PC)
@aa
@–ERn/@ERn+
@(d, ERn)
@ERn
Operation
Rn
#xx
Mnemonic
Operand Size
Addressing Mode and
Instruction Length (bytes)
Normal
6.
2
— — — — — —
4
4
— — — — — —
6
2
— — — — — —
4
4
— — — — — —
6
2
— — — — — —
4
4
— — — — — —
6
2
— — — — — —
4
4
— — — — — —
6
2
— — — — — —
4
4
— — — — — —
6
2
— — — — — —
4
4
— — — — — —
6
2
— — — — — —
4
4
— — — — — —
6
2
— — — — — —
4
4
— — — — — —
6
2
— — — — — —
4
4
— — — — — —
6
2
— — — — — —
4
4
— — — — — —
6
2
— — — — — —
4
4
— — — — — —
6
2
— — — — — —
4
4
— — — — — —
6
2
— — — — — —
4
4
— — — — — —
6
2
— — — — — —
4
4
— — — — — —
6
2
— — — — — —
4
4
— — — — — —
6
Table A-1 Instruction Set (cont)
Z ∨ (N⊕V)
=1
I
H N
Z
V
Normal
Condition Code
Advanced
No. of
States *1
—
@@aa
@(d, PC)
@aa
@–ERn/@ERn+
@(d, ERn)
@ERn
Branch
Condition
Rn
Operation
#xx
Mnemonic
Operand Size
Addressing Mode and
Instruction Length (bytes)
C
BLE d:8
—
BLE d:16
—
JMP @ERn
— PC ← ERn
JMP @aa:24
— PC ← aa:24
JMP @@aa:8
— PC ← @aa:8
— — — — — —
8
10
BSR d:8
— PC → @–SP
PC ← PC+d:8
2
— — — — — —
6
8
BSR d:16
— PC → @–SP
PC ← PC+d:16
4
— — — — — —
8
10
JSR @ERn
— PC → @–SP
PC ← @ERn
— — — — — —
6
8
JSR @aa:24
— PC → @–SP
PC ← @aa:24
— — — — — —
8
10
JSR @@aa:8
— PC → @–SP
PC ← @aa:8
— — — — — —
8
12
RTS
— PC ← @SP+
2 — — — — — —
8
10
If condition
is true then
PC ←
PC+d else
next;
2
— — — — — —
4
4
— — — — — —
6
2
4
2
2
4
2
569
— — — — — —
4
— — — — — —
6
Table A-1 Instruction Set (cont)
7.
System control instructions
C
Normal
Advanced
No. of
States *1
2 — — — — — —
14
16
Condition Code
—
@@aa
@(d, PC)
@aa
@–ERn/@ERn+
@(d, ERn)
@ERn
Rn
Operation
#xx
Mnemonic
Operand Size
Addressing Mode and
Instruction Length (bytes)
I
H N
Z
V
TRAPA #x:2
— PC → @–SP
CCR → @–SP
<vector> → PC
RTE
— CCR ← @SP+
PC ← @SP+
↕
↕
10
SLEEP
— Transition to powerdown state
— — — — — —
2
LDC #xx:8, CCR
B
#xx:8 → CCR
↕
↕
↕
↕
↕
↕
2
LDC Rs, CCR
B
Rs8 → CCR
↕
↕
↕
↕
↕
↕
2
LDC @ERs, CCR
W @ERs → CCR
↕
↕
↕
↕
↕
↕
6
LDC @(d:16, ERs),
CCR
W @(d:16, ERs) → CCR
6
↕
↕
↕
↕
↕
↕
8
LDC @(d:24, ERs),
CCR
W @(d:24, ERs) → CCR
10
↕
↕
↕
↕
↕
↕
12
LDC @ERs+, CCR
W @ERs → CCR
ERs32+2 → ERs32
↕
↕
↕
↕
↕
↕
8
LDC @aa:16, CCR
W @aa:16 → CCR
6
↕
↕
↕
↕
↕
↕
8
LDC @aa:24, CCR
W @aa:24 → CCR
8
↕
↕
↕
↕
↕
↕
10
— — — — — —
2
— — — — — —
6
2
2
4
4
CCR → Rd8
2
↕
↕
↕
↕
STC CCR, Rd
B
STC CCR, @ERd
W CCR → @ERd
STC CCR, @(d:16,
ERd)
W CCR → @(d:16, ERd)
6
— — — — — —
8
STC CCR, @(d:24,
ERd)
W CCR → @(d:24, ERd)
10
— — — — — —
12
STC CCR, @–ERd
W ERd32–2 → ERd32
CCR → @ERd
— — — — — —
8
STC CCR, @aa:16
W CCR → @aa:16
6
— — — — — —
8
STC CCR, @aa:24
W CCR → @aa:24
8
— — — — — —
10
ANDC #xx:8, CCR
B
CCR∧#xx:8 → CCR
2
↕
↕
↕
↕
↕
↕
2
ORC #xx:8, CCR
B
CCR∨#xx:8 → CCR
2
↕
↕
↕
↕
↕
↕
2
XORC #xx:8, CCR
B
CCR⊕#xx:8 → CCR
2
↕
↕
↕
↕
↕
↕
2
NOP
— PC ← PC+2
2 — — — — — —
2
4
4
570
Table A-1 Instruction Set (cont)
Block transfer instructions
Condition Code
I
H N
Z
V
C
EEPMOV. B
— if R4L ≠ 0 then
repeat @R5 → @R6
R5+1 → R5
R6+1 → R6
R4L–1 → R4L
until
R4L=0
else next
4 — — — — — —
8+
4n*2
EEPMOV. W
— if R4 ≠ 0 then
repeat @R5 → @R6
R5+1 → R5
R6+1 → R6
R4L–1 → R4
until
R4=0
else next
4 — — — — — —
8+
4n*2
Notes: 1. The number of states is the number of states required for execution when the instruction and its
operands are located in on-chip memory. For other cases see section A.3, Number of States
Required for Execution.
2. n is the value set in register R4L or R4.
(1) Set to 1 when a carry or borrow occurs at bit 11; otherwise cleared to 0.
(2) Set to 1 when a carry or borrow occurs at bit 27; otherwise cleared to 0.
(3) Retains its previous value when the result is zero; otherwise cleared to 0.
(4) Set to 1 when the adjustment produces a carry; otherwise retains its previous value.
(5) The number of states required for execution of an instruction that transfers data in
synchronization with the E clock is variable.
(6) Set to 1 when the divisor is negative; otherwise cleared to 0.
(7) Set to 1 when the divisor is zero; otherwise cleared to 0.
(8) Set to 1 when the quotient is negative; otherwise cleared to 0.
571
Advanced
No. of
States *1
—
@@aa
@(d, PC)
@aa
@–ERn/@ERn+
@(d, ERn)
@ERn
Rn
Operation
#xx
Mnemonic
Operand Size
Addressing Mode and
Instruction Length (bytes)
Normal
8.
AH
MULXU
5
572
STC
Table A.2
(2)
LDC
3
SUBX
OR
XOR
AND
MOV
C
D
E
F
BILD
BIST
BLD
BST
TRAPA
BEQ
B
BIAND
BAND
AND
RTE
BNE
CMP
BIXOR
BXOR
XOR
BSR
BCS
A
BIOR
BOR
OR
RTS
BCC
MOV.B
Table A.2
(2)
LDC
7
ADDX
BTST
DIVXU
BLS
AND.B
ANDC
6
9
BCLR
MULXU
BHI
XOR.B
XORC
5
ADD
BNOT
DIVXU
BRN
OR.B
ORC
4
MOV
MOV
BVS
9
B
JMP
BPL
BMI
MOV
Table A.2 Table A.2
(2)
(2)
Table A.2 Table A.2
(2)
(2)
A
Table A.2 Table A.2
EEPMOV
(2)
(2)
SUB
ADD
Table A.2
(2)
BVC
8
BSR
BGE
C
CMP
MOV
Instruction when most significant bit of BH is 1.
Instruction when most significant bit of BH is 0.
8
7
BSET
BRA
6
2
1
1st byte 2nd byte
AH AL BH BL
Table A.2 Table A.2 Table A.2 Table A.2
(2)
(2)
(2)
(2)
NOP
0
4
3
2
1
0
AL
Instruction code:
Table A–2 Operation Code Map (1)
E
JSR
BGT
SUBX
ADDX
Table A.2
(3)
BLT
D
BLE
Table A.2
(2)
Table A.2
(2)
F
A.2 Operation Code Map
573
INC
ADDS
DAA
0A
0B
0F
SUBS
DAS
BRA
MOV
MOV
1F
58
79
7A
1
ADD
ADD
CMP
CMP
BHI
2
SUB
SUB
BLS
NOT
ROTXR
ROTXL
SHLR
SHLL
3
4
OR
OR
BCC
LDC/STC
1st byte 2nd byte
AH AL BH BL
BRN
NOT
17
1B
ROTXR
13
DEC
ROTXL
12
1A
SHLR
11
SHLL
MOV
01
10
0
BH
AH AL
Instruction code:
Table A–2 Operation Code Map (2)
XOR
XOR
BCS
DEC
EXTU
INC
5
AND
AND
BNE
6
BEQ
DEC
EXTU
INC
7
BVC
SUBS
NEG
9
BVS
ROTR
ROTL
SHAR
SHAL
ADDS
SLEEP
8
BPL
A
MOV
BMI
NEG
CMP
SUB
ROTR
ROTL
SHAR
C
D
BGE
BLT
DEC
EXTS
INC
Table A.2 Table A.2
(3)
(3)
ADD
SHAL
B
BGT
E
BLE
DEC
EXTS
INC
Table A.2
(3)
F
574
C
DIVXS
3
BSET
7Faa7 * 2
BNOT
BNOT
BCLR
BCLR
Notes: 1. r is the register designation field.
2. aa is the absolute address field.
BSET
7Faa6 * 2
BTST
BCLR
7Eaa7 * 2
BNOT
BTST
BSET
7Dr07 * 1
7Eaa6 * 2
BSET
7Dr06 * 1
BTST
BCLR
MULXS
2
7Cr07 * 1
BNOT
DIVXS
1
BTST
MULXS
0
BIOR
BOR
BIOR
BOR
OR
4
BIXOR
BXOR
BIXOR
BXOR
XOR
5
BIAND
BAND
BIAND
BAND
AND
6
7
BIST
BILD
BST
BLD
BIST
BILD
BST
BLD
1st byte 2nd byte 3rd byte 4th byte
AH AL BH BL CH CL DH DL
7Cr06 * 1
01F06
01D05
01C05
01406
AH
ALBH
BLCH
Instruction code:
Table A–2 Operation Code Map (3)
8
LDC
STC
9
A
LDC
STC
B
C
LDC
STC
D
E
LDC
STC
F
Instruction when most significant bit of DH is 1.
Instruction when most significant bit of DH is 0.
A.3 Number of States Required for Execution
The tables in this section can be used to calculate the number of states required for instruction
execution by the H8/300H CPU. Table A-3 indicates the number of instruction fetch, data
read/write, and other cycles occurring in each instruction. Table A-2 indicates the number of states
required per cycle according to the bus size. The number of states required for execution of an
instruction can be calculated from these two tables as follows:
Number of states = I × SI + J × SJ + K × SK + L × SL + M × SM + N × SN
Examples of Calculation of Number of States Required for Execution
Examples: Advanced mode, stack located in external address space, on-chip supporting modules
accessed with 8-bit bus width, external devices accessed in three states with one wait state and
16-bit bus width.
BSET #0, @FFFFC7:8
From table A-4, I = L = 2 and J = K = M = N = 0
From table A-3, SI = 4 and SL = 3
Number of states = 2 × 4 + 2 × 3 = 14
JSR @@30
From table A-4, I = J = K = 2 and L = M = N = 0
From table A-3, SI = SJ = SK = 4
Number of states = 2 × 4 + 2 × 4 + 2 × 4 = 24
575
Table A-3 Number of States per Cycle
Access Conditions
External Device
On-Chip Supporting Module
Cycle
8-Bit Bus
16-Bit Bus
On-Chip
Memory
8-Bit
Bus
16-Bit
Bus
2-State 3-State 2-State 3-State
Access Access Access Access
2
6
3
4
6 + 2m
Instruction fetch
SI
Branch address read
SJ
Stack operation
SK
Byte data access
SL
3
2
3+m
Word data access
SM
6
4
6 + 2m
Internal operation
SN 1
Legend
m: Number of wait states inserted into external device access
576
2
3+m
Table A-4 Number of Cycles per Instruction
Instruction Mnemonic
Instruction Branch
Stack
Byte Data Word Data Internal
Fetch
Addr. Read Operation Access
Access
Operation
I
J
K
L
M
N
ADD
ADD.B #xx:8, Rd
ADD.B Rs, Rd
ADD.W #xx:16, Rd
ADD.W Rs, Rd
ADD.L #xx:32, ERd
ADD.L ERs, ERd
1
1
2
1
3
1
ADDS
ADDS #1/2/4, ERd
1
ADDX
ADDX #xx:8, Rd
ADDX Rs, Rd
1
1
AND
AND.B #xx:8, Rd
AND.B Rs, Rd
AND.W #xx:16, Rd
AND.W Rs, Rd
AND.L #xx:32, ERd
AND.L ERs, ERd
1
1
2
1
3
2
ANDC
ANDC #xx:8, CCR
1
BAND
BAND #xx:3, Rd
BAND #xx:3, @ERd
BAND #xx:3, @aa:8
1
2
2
BRA d:8 (BT d:8)
BRN d:8 (BF d:8)
BHI d:8
BLS d:8
BCC d:8 (BHS d:8)
BCS d:8 (BLO d:8)
BNE d:8
BEQ d:8
BVC d:8
BVS d:8
BPL d:8
BMI d:8
BGE d:8
BLT d:8
BGT d:8
BLE d:8
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Bcc
1
1
577
Table A-4 Number of Cycles per Instruction (cont)
Instruction Mnemonic
Instruction Branch
Stack
Byte Data Word Data Internal
Fetch
Addr. Read Operation Access
Access
Operation
I
J
K
L
M
N
Bcc
BRA d:16 (BT d:16)
BRN d:16 (BF d:16)
BHI d:16
BLS d:16
BCC d:16 (BHS d:16)
BCS d:16 (BLO d:16)
BNE d:16
BEQ d:16
BVC d:16
BVS d:16
BPL d:16
BMI d:16
BGE d:16
BLT d:16
BGT d:16
BLE d:16
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
BCLR
BCLR #xx:3, Rd
BCLR #xx:3, @ERd
BCLR #xx:3, @aa:8
BCLR Rn, Rd
BCLR Rn, @ERd
BCLR Rn, @aa:8
1
2
2
1
2
2
BIAND #xx:3, Rd
BIAND #xx:3, @ERd
BIAND #xx:3, @aa:8
1
2
2
1
1
BILD #xx:3, Rd
BILD #xx:3, @ERd
BILD #xx:3, @aa:8
1
2
2
1
1
BIOR #xx:8, Rd
BIOR #xx:8, @ERd
BIOR #xx:8, @aa:8
1
2
2
1
1
BIST #xx:3, Rd
BIST #xx:3, @ERd
BIST #xx:3, @aa:8
1
2
2
2
2
BIXOR #xx:3, Rd
BIXOR #xx:3, @ERd
BIXOR #xx:3, @aa:8
1
2
2
1
1
BLD #xx:3, Rd
BLD #xx:3, @ERd
BLD #xx:3, @aa:8
1
2
2
1
1
BIAND
BILD
BIOR
BIST
BIXOR
BLD
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
578
Table A-4 Number of Cycles per Instruction (cont)
Instruction Branch
Stack
Byte Data Word Data Internal
Fetch
Addr. Read Operation Access
Access
Operation
I
J
K
L
M
N
Instruction Mnemonic
BNOT
BOR
BSET
BSR
BNOT #xx:3, Rd
BNOT #xx:3, @ERd
BNOT #xx:3, @aa:8
BNOT Rn, Rd
BNOT Rn, @ERd
BNOT Rn, @aa:8
1
2
2
1
2
2
2
2
BOR #xx:3, Rd
BOR #xx:3, @ERd
BOR #xx:3, @aa:8
1
2
2
1
1
BSET #xx:3, Rd
BSET #xx:3, @ERd
BSET #xx:3, @aa:8
BSET Rn, Rd
BSET Rn, @ERd
BSET Rn, @aa:8
1
2
2
1
2
2
BSR d:8
BSR d:16
BST
2
2
2
1
Advanced
2
2
Normal*1
2
1
2
Advanced
2
2
2
1
2
2
BTST #xx:3, Rd
BTST #xx:3, @ERd
BTST #xx:3, @aa:8
BTST Rn, Rd
BTST Rn, @ERd
BTST Rn, @aa:8
1
2
2
1
2
2
BXOR #xx:3, Rd
BXOR #xx:3, @ERd
BXOR #xx:3, @aa:8
1
2
2
CMP
CMP.B #xx:8, Rd
CMP.B Rs, Rd
CMP.W #xx:16, Rd
CMP.W Rs, Rd
CMP.L #xx:32, ERd
CMP.L ERs, ERd
1
1
2
1
3
1
DAA
DAA Rd
1
DAS
DAS Rd
1
BXOR
2
2
Normal*1
BST #xx:3, Rd
BST #xx:3, @ERd
BST #xx:3, @aa:8
BTST
2
2
2
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
579
Table A-4 Number of Cycles per Instruction (cont)
Instruction Branch
Stack
Byte Data Word Data Internal
Fetch
Addr. Read Operation Access
Access
Operation
I
J
K
L
M
N
Instruction Mnemonic
DEC
DEC.B Rd
DEC.W #1/2, Rd
DEC.L #1/2, ERd
1
1
1
DIVXS
DIVXS.B Rs, Rd
DIVXS.W Rs, ERd
2
2
12
20
DIVXU
DIVXU.B Rs, Rd
DIVXU.W Rs, ERd
1
1
12
20
EEPMOV
EEPMOV.B
EEPMOV.W
2
2
EXTS
EXTS.W Rd
EXTS.L ERd
1
1
EXTU
EXTU.W Rd
EXTU.L ERd
1
1
INC
INC.B Rd
INC.W #1/2, Rd
INC.L #1/2, ERd
1
1
1
JMP
JMP @ERn
2
JMP @aa:24
2
JSR
2n + 2*2
2n + 2*2
2
JMP @@aa:8 Normal*1 2
1
Advanced 2
2
JSR @ERn
2
2
Normal*1 2
1
Advanced 2
2
JSR @aa:24 Normal*1 2
1
2
2
2
Advanced 2
LDC
JSR @@aa:8 Normal*1 2
1
1
Advanced 2
2
2
LDC #xx:8, CCR
LDC Rs, CCR
LDC @ERs, CCR
LDC @(d:16, ERs), CCR
LDC @(d:24, ERs), CCR
LDC @ERs+, CCR
LDC @aa:16, CCR
LDC @aa:24, CCR
1
1
2
3
5
2
3
4
1
1
1
1
1
1
580
2
Table A-4 Number of Cycles per Instruction (cont)
Instruction Mnemonic
MOV
MOV.B #xx:8, Rd
MOV.B Rs, Rd
MOV.B @ERs, Rd
MOV.B @(d:16, ERs), Rd
MOV.B @(d:24, ERs), Rd
MOV.B @ERs+, Rd
MOV.B @aa:8, Rd
MOV.B @aa:16, Rd
MOV.B @aa:24, Rd
MOV.B Rs, @ERd
MOV.B Rs, @(d:16, ERd)
MOV.B Rs, @(d:24, ERd)
MOV.B Rs, @–ERd
MOV.B Rs, @aa:8
MOV.B Rs, @aa:16
MOV.B Rs, @aa:24
MOV.W #xx:16, Rd
MOV.W Rs, Rd
MOV.W @ERs, Rd
MOV.W @(d:16, ERs), Rd
MOV.W @(d:24, ERs), Rd
MOV.W @ERs+, Rd
MOV.W @aa:16, Rd
MOV.W @aa:24, Rd
MOV.W Rs, @ERd
MOV.W Rs, @(d:16, ERd)
MOV.W Rs, @(d:24, ERd)
MOV.W Rs, @–ERd
MOV.W Rs, @aa:16
MOV.W Rs, @aa:24
MOV.L #xx:32, ERd
MOV.L ERs, ERd
MOV.L @ERs, ERd
MOV.L @(d:16, ERs), ERd
MOV.L @(d:24, ERs), ERd
MOV.L @ERs+, ERd
MOV.L @aa:16, ERd
MOV.L @aa:24, ERd
MOV.L ERs, @ERd
MOV.L ERs, @(d:16, ERd)
MOV.L ERs, @(d:24, ERd)
MOV.L ERs, @–ERd
MOV.L ERs, @aa:16
MOV.L ERs, @aa:24
Instruction Branch
Stack
Byte Data Word Data Internal
Fetch
Addr. Read Operation Access
Access
Operation
I
J
K
L
M
N
1
1
1
2
4
1
1
2
3
1
2
4
1
1
2
3
2
1
1
2
4
1
2
3
1
2
4
1
2
3
3
1
2
3
5
2
3
4
2
3
5
2
3
4
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
581
2
2
2
2
Table A-4 Number of Cycles per Instruction (cont)
Instruction Branch
Stack
Byte Data Word Data Internal
Fetch
Addr. Read Operation Access
Access
Operation
I
J
K
L
M
N
Instruction Mnemonic
MOVFPE
MOVFPE @aa:16, Rd*3 2
@aa:16*3
1
MOVTPE
MOVTPE Rs,
MULXS
MULXS.B Rs, Rd
MULXS.W Rs, ERd
2
2
2
1
12
20
MULXU
MULXU.B Rs, Rd
MULXU.W Rs, ERd
1
1
12
20
NEG
NEG.B Rd
NEG.W Rd
NEG.L ERd
1
1
1
NOP
NOP
1
NOT
NOT.B Rd
NOT.W Rd
NOT.L ERd
1
1
1
OR
OR.B #xx:8, Rd
OR.B Rs, Rd
OR.W #xx:16, Rd
OR.W Rs, Rd
OR.L #xx:32, ERd
OR.L ERs, ERd
1
1
2
1
3
2
ORC
ORC #xx:8, CCR
1
POP
POP.W Rn
POP.L ERn
1
2
1
2
2
2
PUSH
PUSH.W Rn
PUSH.L ERn
1
2
1
2
2
2
ROTL
ROTL.B Rd
ROTL.W Rd
ROTL.L ERd
1
1
1
ROTR
ROTR.B Rd
ROTR.W Rd
ROTR.L ERd
1
1
1
ROTXL
ROTXL.B Rd
ROTXL.W Rd
ROTXL.L ERd
1
1
1
ROTXR
ROTXR.B Rd
ROTXR.W Rd
ROTXR.L ERd
1
1
1
RTE
RTE
2
2
582
2
Table A-4 Number of Cycles per Instruction (cont)
Instruction Branch
Stack
Byte Data Word Data Internal
Fetch
Addr. Read Operation Access
Access
Operation
I
J
K
L
M
N
Instruction Mnemonic
Normal*1
RTS
RTS
2
1
2
SHAL
SHAL.B Rd
SHAL.W Rd
SHAL.L ERd
Advanced 2
1
1
1
2
2
SHAR
SHAR.B Rd
SHAR.W Rd
SHAR.L ERd
1
1
1
SHLL
SHLL.B Rd
SHLL.W Rd
SHLL.L ERd
1
1
1
SHLR
SHLR.B Rd
SHLR.W Rd
SHLR.L ERd
1
1
1
SLEEP
SLEEP
1
STC
STC CCR, Rd
1
STC CCR, @ERd
2
STC CCR, @(d:16, ERd) 3
STC CCR, @(d:24, ERd) 5
STC CCR, @–ERd
2
STC CCR, @aa:16
3
STC CCR, @aa:24
4
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
SUB
SUB.B Rs, Rd
SUB.W #xx:16, Rd
SUB.W Rs, Rd
SUB.L #xx:32, ERd
SUB.L ERs, ERd
1
2
1
3
1
SUBS
SUBS #1/2/4, ERd
1
SUBX
SUBX #xx:8, Rd
SUBX Rs, Rd
1
1
TRAPA
TRAPA #x:2 Normal*1
2
1
2
4
Advanced 2
2
2
4
XOR
XOR.B #xx:8, Rd
XOR.B Rs, Rd
XOR.W #xx:16, Rd
XOR.W Rs, Rd
XOR.L #xx:32, ERd
XOR.L ERs, ERd
1
1
2
1
3
2
XORC
XORC #xx:8, CCR
1
Notes: 1. Normal mode is not available in the H8/3002.
2. n is the value set in register R4L or R4. The source and destination are accessed n + 1 times each.
3. Not available in the H8/3002.
583
Appendix B Internal I/O Register
B.1 Addresses
Address Register
(low)
Name
Data
Bus
Width
Bit Names
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Module Name
H'1C
H'1D
H'1E
H'1F
H'20
MAR0AR
8
H'21
MAR0AE
8
H'22
MAR0AH
8
H'23
MAR0AL
8
H'24
ETCR0AH 8
H'25
ETCR0AL
H'26
IOAR0A
8
H'27
DTCR0A
8
DMAC
channel 0A
8
H'28
MAR0BR
8
H'29
MAR0BE
8
H'2A
MAR0BH
8
H'2B
MAR0BL
8
H'2C
ETCR0BH 8
H'2D
ETCR0BL
8
H'2E
IOAR0B
8
H'2F
DTCR0B
8
DTE
DTSZ
DTID
RPE
DTIE
DTS2A
DTS1A
DTS0A
Short
address
mode
DTE
DTSZ
SAID
SAIDE
DTIE
DTS2A
DTS1A
DTS0A
Full
address
mode
DMAC
channel 0B
DTE
DTSZ
DTID
RPE
DTIE
DTS2B
DTS1B
DTS0B
Short
address
mode
DTME
—
DAID
DAIDE
TMS
DTS2B
DTS1B
DTS0B
Full
address
mode
Legend
DMAC: DMA controller
(Continued on next page)
584
(Continued from preceding page)
Address Register
(low)
Name
Data
Bus
Width
H'30
MAR1AR
8
H'31
MAR1AE
8
H'32
MAR1AH
8
H'33
MAR1AL
8
H'34
ETCR1AH 8
H'35
ETCR1AL
H'36
IOAR1A
8
H'37
DTCR1A
8
Bit Names
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Module Name
DMAC
channel 1A
8
H'38
MAR1BR
8
H'39
MAR1BE
8
H'3A
MAR1BH
8
H'3B
MAR1BL
8
H'3C
ETCR1BH 8
H'3D
ETCR1BL
8
H'3E
IOAR1B
8
H'3F
DTCR1B
8
DTE
DTSZ
DTID
RPE
DTIE
DTS2A
DTS1A
DTS0A
Short
address
mode
DTE
DTSZ
SAID
SAIDE
DTIE
DTS2A
DTS1A
DTS0A
Full
address
mode
DMAC
channel 1B
DTE
DTSZ
DTID
RPE
DTIE
DTS2B
DTS1B
DTS0B
Short
address
mode
DTME
—
DAID
DAIDE
TMS
DTS2B
DTS1B
DTS0B
Full
address
mode
Legend
DMAC: DMA controller
(Continued on next page)
585
(Continued from preceding page)
Address Register
(low)
Name
Data
Bus
Width
Bit Names
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
H'40
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'41
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'42
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'43
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'44
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'45
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'46
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'47
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'48
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'49
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'4A
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'4B
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'4C
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'4D
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'4E
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'4F
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'50
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'51
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'52
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'53
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'54
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'55
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'56
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'57
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'58
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'59
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'5A
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'5B
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'5C
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'5D
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'5E
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'5F
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Module Name
(Continued on next page)
586
(Continued from preceding page)
Address Register
(low)
Name
Data
Bus
Width
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Module Name
H'60
TSTR
8
—
—
—
STR4
STR3
STR2
STR1
STR0
H'61
TSNC
8
—
—
—
SYNC4 SYNC3 SYNC2 SYNC1 SYNC0
ITU
(all channels)
H'62
TMDR
8
—
MDF
FDIR
PWM4
PWM3
PWM2
PWM1
PWM0
H'63
TFCR
8
—
—
CMD1
CMD0
BFB4
BFA4
BFB3
BFA3
H'64
TCR0
8
—
CCLR1
CCLR0
CKEG1 CKEG0 TPSC2
TPSC1
TPSC0
H'65
TIOR0
8
—
IOB2
IOB1
IOB0
—
IOA2
IOA1
IOA0
Bit Names
H'66
TIER0
8
—
—
—
—
—
OVIE
IMIEB
IMIEA
H'67
TSR0
8
—
—
—
—
—
OVF
IMFB
IMFA
H'68
TCNT0H
16
H'69
TCNT0L
H'6A
GRA0H
H'6B
GRA0L
H'6C
GRB0H
H'6D
GRB0L
H'6E
TCR1
8
—
CCLR1
CCLR0
CKEG1 CKEG0 TPSC2
TPSC1
TPSC0
H'6F
TIOR1
8
—
IOB2
IOB1
IOB0
IOA1
IOA0
ITU channel 0
16
16
—
IOA2
H'70
TIER1
8
—
—
—
—
—
OVIE
IMIEB
IMIEA
H'71
TSR1
8
—
—
—
—
—
OVF
IMFB
IMFA
H'72
TCNT1H
16
H'73
TCNT1L
H'74
GRA1H
H'75
GRA1L
H'76
GRB1H
H'77
GRB1L
H'78
TCR2
8
—
CCLR1
CCLR0
CKEG1 CKEG0 TPSC2
TPSC1
TPSC0
H'79
TIOR2
8
—
IOB2
IOB1
IOB0
IOA1
IOA0
ITU channel 1
16
16
—
IOA2
H'7A
TIER2
8
—
—
—
—
—
OVIE
IMIEB
IMIEA
H'7B
TSR2
8
—
—
—
—
—
OVF
IMFB
IMFA
H'7C
TCNT2H
16
H'7D
TCNT2L
H'7E
GRA2H
H'7F
GRA2L
H'80
GRB2H
H'81
GRB2L
ITU channel 2
16
16
Legend
ITU: 16-bit integrated timer unit
(Continued on next page)
587
(Continued from preceding page)
Address Register
(low)
Name
Data
Bus
Width
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 1
Bit 0
Module Name
H'82
TCR3
8
—
CCLR1
CCLR0
CKEG1 CKEG0 TPSC2
TPSC1
TPSC0
ITU channel 3
H'83
TIOR3
8
—
IOB2
IOB1
IOB0
—
IOA2
IOA1
IOA0
Bit Names
Bit 3
Bit 2
H'84
TIER3
8
—
—
—
—
—
OVIE
IMIEB
IMIEA
H'85
TSR3
8
—
—
—
—
—
OVF
IMFB
IMFA
H'86
TCNT3H
16
H'87
TCNT3L
H'88
GRA3H
H'89
GRA3L
H'8A
GRB3H
H'8B
GRB3L
H'8C
BRA3H
H'8D
BRA3L
H'8E
BRB3H
H'8F
BRB3L
H'90
TOER
8
—
—
EXB4
EXA4
EB3
EB4
EA4
EA3
H'91
TOCR
8
—
—
—
XTGD
—
—
OLS4
OLS3
ITU
(all channels)
H'92
TCR4
8
—
CCLR1
CCLR0
CKEG1 CKEG0 TPSC2
TPSC1
TPSC0
ITU channel 4
H'93
TIOR4
8
—
IOB2
IOB1
IOB0
IOA1
IOA0
16
16
16
16
—
IOA2
H'94
TIER4
8
—
—
—
—
—
OVIE
IMIEB
IMIEA
H'95
TSR4
8
—
—
—
—
—
OVF
IMFB
IMFA
H'96
TCNT4H
16
H'97
TCNT4L
H'98
GRA4H
H'99
GRA4L
H'9A
GRB4H
H'9B
GRB4L
H'9C
BRA4H
H'9D
BRA4L
H'9E
BRB4H
H'9F
BRB4L
16
16
16
16
Legend
ITU: 16-bit integrated timer unit
(Continued on next page)
588
(Continued from preceding page)
Address Register
(low)
Name
Data
Bus
Width
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
H'A0
TPMR
8
—
—
—
—
G3NOV G2NOV G1NOV G0NOV
H'A1
TPCR
8
G3CMS1 G3CMS0 G2CMS1 G2CMS0 G1CMS1 G1CMS0 G0CMS1 G0CMS0
H'A2
NDERB
8
NDER15 NDER14 NDER13 NDER12 NDER11 NDER10 NDER9 NDER8
H'A3
NDERA
8
NDER7 NDER6 NDER5 NDER4 NDER3 NDER2 NDER1 NDER0
H'A4
NDRB*1
8
NDR15
NDR14
NDR13
NDR12
NDR11
NDR10
NDR9
NDR8
8
NDR15
NDR14
NDR13
NDR12
—
—
—
—
8
NDR7
NDR6
NDR5
NDR4
NDR3
NDR2
NDR1
NDR0
8
NDR7
NDR6
NDR5
NDR4
—
—
—
—
8
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
8
—
—
—
—
NDR11
NDR10
NDR9
NDR8
8
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'A5
H'A6
NDRA*1
NDRB*1
Bit Names
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
H'A7
NDRA*1
8
—
—
—
—
NDR3
NDR2
NDR1
NDR0
H'A8
TCSR*2
8
OVF
WT/IT
TME
—
—
CKS2
CKS1
CKS0
H'A9
TCNT*2
8
H'AA
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'AB
RSTCSR*3 8
WRST
RSTOE —
—
—
—
—
—
Module Name
TPC
WDT
H'AC
RFSHCR
8
SRFMD PSRAME DRAME CAS/WE M9/M8
RFSHE —
RCYCE
H'AD
RTMCSR
8
CMF
CMIE
CKS2
CKS1
CKS0
—
—
—
Refresh
controller
H'AE
RTCNT
8
H'AF
RTCOR
8
H'B0
SMR
8
C/A
CHR
PE
O/E
STOP
MP
CKS1
CKS0
SCI channel 0
H'B1
BRR
8
H'B2
SCR
8
TIE
RIE
TE
RE
MPIE
TEIE
CKE1
CKE0
H'B3
TDR
8
H'B4
SSR
8
TDRE
RDRF
ORER
FER
PER
TEND
MPB
MPBT
H'B5
RDR
8
H'B6
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'B7
Notes:
1.
The address depends on the output trigger setting.
2. For write access to TCSR and TCNT, see section 12.2.4, Notes on Register Access.
3. For write access to RSTCSR, see section 12.2.4, Notes on Register Access.
Legend
TPC: Programmable timing pattern controller
WDT: Watchdog timer
SCI: Serial communication interface
(Continued on next page)
589
(Continued from preceding page)
Address Register
(low)
Name
Data
Bus
Width
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Module Name
H'B8
SMR
8
C/A
CHR
PE
O/E
STOP
MP
CKS1
CKS0
SCI channel 1
H'B9
BRR
8
H'BA
SCR
8
TIE
RIE
TE
RE
MPIE
TEIE
CKE1
CKE0
H'BB
TDR
8
H'BC
SSR
8
TDRE
RDRF
ORER
FER
PER
TEND
MPB
MPBT
H'BD
RDR
8
H'BE
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'C0
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'C1
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'C2
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'C3
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'C4
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'C5
P4DDR
H'C6
—
H'C7
P4DR
H'C8
—
Bit Names
H'BF
H'C9
P6DDR
H'CA
—
8
8
8
8
P47DDR P46DDR P45DDR P44DDR P43DDR P42DDR P41DDR P40DDR
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
P47
P46
P45
P44
P43
P42
P41
P40
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
P66DDR P65DDR P64DDR P63DDR P62DDR P61DDR P60DDR
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
P66
P65
P64
P63
P62
P61
P60
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Port 4
Port 4
Port 6
Port 6
H'CB
P6DR
H'CC
—
H'CD
P8DDR
8
—
—
—
P84DDR P83DDR P82DDR P81DDR P80DDR
Port 8
H'CE
P7DR
8
P77
P76
P75
P74
P73
P72
P71
P70
Port 7
H'CF
P8DR
8
—
—
—
P84
P83
P82
P81
P80
H'D0
P9DDR
8
—
—
P95DDR P94DDR P93DDR P92DDR P91DDR P90DDR
Port 8
Port 9
H'D1
PADDR
8
PA7DDR PA6DDR PA5DDR PA4DDR PA3DDR PA2DDR PA1DDR PA0DDR
H'D2
P9DR
8
—
—
P95
P94
P93
P92
P91
P90
Port 9
H'D3
PADR
8
PA7
PA6
PA5
PA4
PA3
PA2
PA1
PA0
Port A
H'D4
PBDDR
8
PB7DDR PB6DDR PB5DDR PB4DDR PB3DDR PB2DDR PB1DDR PB0DDR
H'D5
—
H'D6
PBDR
H'D7
—
8
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
PB7
PB6
PB5
PB4
PB3
PB2
PB1
PB0
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Port A
Port B
Port B
Legend
SCI: Serial communication interface
(Continued on next page)
590
(Continued from preceding page)
Address Register
(low)
Name
Data
Bus
Width
Bit Names
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'D8
—
H'D9
—
H'DA
P4PCR
H'DB
—
P47PCR P46PCR P45PCR P44PCR P43PCR P42PCR P41PCR P40PCR
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'DC
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'DD
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'DE
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'DF
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'E0
ADDRAH
8
AD9
AD8
AD7
AD6
AD5
AD4
AD3
AD2
H'E1
ADDRAL
8
AD1
AD0
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'E2
ADDRBH
8
AD9
AD8
AD7
AD6
AD5
AD4
AD3
AD2
H'E3
ADDRBL
8
AD1
AD0
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'E4
ADDRCH
8
AD9
AD8
AD7
AD6
AD5
AD4
AD3
AD2
H'E5
ADDRCL
8
AD1
AD0
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'E6
ADDRDH
8
AD9
AD8
AD7
AD6
AD5
AD4
AD3
AD2
H'E7
ADDRDL
8
AD1
AD0
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'E8
ADCSR
8
ADF
ADIE
ADST
SCAN
CKS
CH2
CH1
CH0
H'E9
ADCR
8
TRGE
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'EA
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'EB
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'EC
ABWCR
8
ABW7
ABW6
ABW5
ABW4
ABW3
ABW2
ABW1
ABW0
H'ED
ASTCR
8
AST7
AST6
AST5
AST4
AST3
AST2
AST1
AST0
H'EE
WCR
8
—
—
—
—
WMS1
WMS0
WC1
WC0
H'EF
WCER
8
WCE7
WCE6
WCE5
WCE4
WCE3
WCE2
WCE1
WCE0
8
Module Name
Port 4
A/D
Bus controller
Legend
A/D: A/D converter
(Continued on next page)
591
(Continued from preceding page)
Address Register
(low)
Name
H'F0
Data
Bus
Width
—
Bit Names
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'F1
MDCR
8
—
—
—
—
—
MDS2
MDS1
MDS0
H'F2
SYSCR
8
SSBY
STS2
STS1
STS0
UE
NMIEG
—
RAME
H'F3
BRCR
8
A23E
A22E
A21E
—
—
—
—
BRLE
H'F4
ISCR
8
—
—
IRQ5SC IRQ4SC IRQ3SC IRQ2SC IRQ1SC IRQ0SC
H'F5
IER
8
—
—
IRQ5E
IRQ4E
IRQ3E
IRQ2E
IRQ1E
IRQ0E
H'F6
ISR
8
—
—
IRQ5F
IRQ4F
IRQ3F
IRQ2F
IRQ1F
IRQ0F
H'F7
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'F8
IPRA
8
IPRA7
IPRA6
IPRA5
IPRA4
IPRA3
IPRA2
IPRA1
IPRA0
H'F9
IPRB
8
IPRB7
IPRB6
IPRB5
—
IPRB3
IPRB2
IPRB1
—
H'FA
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'FB
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'FD
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'FE
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'FF
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
H'FC
592
Module Name
System control
Bus controller
IInterrupt
controller
Interrupt
controller
B.2 Function
Register
acronym
Register
name
TSTR Timer Start Register
Address to which
the register is mapped
H'60
Name of on-chip
supporting
module
ITU (all channels)
Bit
numbers
Bit
Initial bit
values
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
—
—
STR4
STR3
STR2
STR1
STR0
Initial value
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
—
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Names of the
bits. Dashes
(—) indicate
reserved bits.
Possible types of access
R
Read only
W
Write only
Counter start 0
0 TCNT0 is halted
1 TCNT0 is counting
R/W Read and write
Counter start 1
0 TCNT1 is halted
1 TCNT1 is counting
Full name
of bit
Counter start 2
0 TCNT2 is halted
1 TCNT2 is counting
Counter start 3
0 TCNT3 is halted
1 TCNT3 is counting
Counter start 4
0 TCNT4 is halted
1 TCNT4 is counting
593
Descriptions
of bit settings
MAR0A R/E/H/L—Memory Address Register 0A R/E/H/L
23
H'20, H'21,
H'22, H'23
22
21
Bit
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read/Write
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
— R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Initial value
Read/Write
15
14
13
12
11
19
18
17
16
Undetermined
MAR0AR
Bit
20
DMAC0
MAR0AE
10
9
Undetermined
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Undetermined
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
MAR0AH
MAR0AL
Source or destination address
594
ETCR0A H/L—Execute Transfer Count Register 0A H/L
•
H'24, H'25
DMAC0
Short address mode
I/O mode and idle mode
Bit
14
15
12
13
10
11
8
9
6
7
4
5
2
3
0
1
Initial value
Undetermined
Read/Write
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Transfer counter
Repeat mode
Bit
7
6
5
Initial value
Read/Write
4
3
2
1
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
2
1
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
Undetermined
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
ETCR0AH
Transfer counter
Bit
7
6
5
R/W
R/W
R/W
Initial value
Read/Write
4
3
Undetermined
R/W
R/W
ETCR0AL
Initial count
595
ETCR0A H/L—Execute Transfer Count Register 0A H/L
(cont)
•
H'24, H'25
DMAC0
Full address mode
Normal mode
Bit
14
15
12
13
10
11
8
9
6
7
4
5
2
3
0
1
Initial value
Undetermined
Read/Write
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Transfer counter
Block transfer mode
Bit
7
6
5
Initial value
Read/Write
4
3
2
1
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
2
1
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
Undetermined
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
ETCR0AH
Block size counter
Bit
7
6
5
R/W
R/W
R/W
Initial value
Read/Write
4
3
Undetermined
R/W
R/W
ETCR0AL
Initial block size
596
IOAR0A—I/O Address Register 0A
Bit
7
6
H'26
5
Initial value
Read/Write
4
3
DMAC0
2
1
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
Undetermined
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Short address mode: source or destination address
Full address mode: not used
597
DTCR0A—Data Transfer Control Register 0A
•
H'27
DMAC0
Short address mode
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
DTE
DTSZ
DTID
RPE
DTIE
DTS2A
DTS1A
DTS0A
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Data transfer select 2A to 0A
Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
DTS2A DTS1A DTS0A Data Transfer Activation Source
0
0
Compare match/input capture A interrupt from ITU channel 0
0
1
Compare match/input capture A interrupt from ITU channel 1
0
Compare match/input capture A interrupt from ITU channel 2
1
1
Compare match/input capture A interrupt from ITU channel 3
0
SCI0 transmit-data-empty interrupt
0
1
1
SCI0 receive-data-full interrupt
Transfer in full address mode
1
–
Data transfer interrupt enable
0 Interrupt requested by DTE bit is disabled
1 Interrupt requested by DTE bit is enabled
Repeat enable
RPE DTIE Description
0
0
I/O mode
1
1
Repeat mode
0
Idle mode
1
Data transfer increment/decrement
0 Incremented: If DTSZ = 0, MAR is incremented by 1 after each transfer
If DTSZ = 1, MAR is incremented by 2 after each transfer
1 Decremented: If DTSZ = 0, MAR is decremented by 1 after each transfer
If DTSZ = 1, MAR is decremented by 2 after each transfer
Data transfer size
0 Byte-size transfer
1 Word-size transfer
Data transfer enable
0 Data transfer is disabled
1 Data transfer is enabled
598
DTCR0A—Data Transfer Control Register 0A
(cont)
•
H'27
DMAC0
Full address mode
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
DTE
DTSZ
SAID
SAIDE
DTIE
DTS2A
DTS1A
DTS0A
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Data transfer select 0A
0 Normal mode
1 Block transfer mode
Data transfer select 2A and 1A
Set both bits to 1
Data transfer interrupt enable
0 Interrupt request by DTE bit is disabled
1 Interrupt request by DTE bit is enabled
Source address increment/decrement
Source address increment/decrement enable
Bit 5 Bit 4
Description
SAID SAIDE
0
0
MARA is held fixed
1
Incremented: If DTSZ = 0, MARA is incremented by 1 after each transfer
If DTSZ = 1, MARA is incremented by 2 after each transfer
1
0
MARA is held fixed
1
Decremented: If DTSZ = 0, MARA is decremented by 1 after each transfer
If DTSZ = 1, MARA is decremented by 2 after each transfer
Data transfer size
0 Byte-size transfer
1 Word-size transfer
Data transfer enable
0 Data transfer is disabled
1 Data transfer is enabled
599
MAR0B R/E/H/L—Memory Address Register 0B R/E/H/L
23
H'28, H'29,
H'2A, H'2B
22
21
Bit
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read/Write
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
— R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Initial value
Read/Write
15
14
13
12
11
19
18
17
16
Undetermined
MAR0BR
Bit
20
DMAC0
MAR0BE
10
9
Undetermined
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Undetermined
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
MAR0BH
MAR0BL
Source or destination address
600
ETCR0B H/L—Execute Transfer Count Register 0B H/L
•
H'2C, H'2D
DMAC0
Short address mode
I/O mode and idle mode
Bit
14
15
12
13
10
11
8
9
6
7
4
5
2
3
0
1
Initial value
Undetermined
Read/Write
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Transfer counter
Repeat mode
Bit
7
6
5
Initial value
Read/Write
4
3
2
1
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
2
1
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
Undetermined
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
ETCR0BH
Transfer counter
Bit
7
6
5
R/W
R/W
R/W
Initial value
Read/Write
4
3
Undetermined
R/W
R/W
ETCR0BL
Initial count
601
ETCR0B H/L—Execute Transfer Count Register 0B H/L
(cont)
•
H'2C, H'2D
DMAC0
Full address mode
Normal mode
Bit
14
15
12
13
10
11
8
9
6
7
4
5
2
3
0
1
Initial value
Undetermined
Read/Write
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Not used
Block transfer mode
Bit
14
15
12
13
10
11
8
9
6
7
4
5
2
3
0
1
Initial value
Undetermined
Read/Write
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Block transfer counter
IOAR0B—I/O Address Register 0B
Bit
7
6
H'2E
5
Initial value
Read/Write
4
3
DMAC0
2
1
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
Undetermined
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Short address mode: source or destination address
Full address mode: not used
602
DTCR0B—Data Transfer Control Register 0B
•
H'2F
DMAC0
Short address mode
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
DTE
DTSZ
DTID
RPE
DTIE
DTS2B
DTS1B
DTS0B
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Data transfer select 2B to 0B
Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
DTS2B DTS1B DTS0B Data Transfer Activation Source
0
0
Compare match/input capture A interrupt from ITU channel 0
0
1
Compare match/input capture A interrupt from ITU channel 1
0
Compare match/input capture A interrupt from ITU channel 2
1
1
Compare match/input capture A interrupt from ITU channel 3
0
SCI0 transmit-data-empty interrupt
0
1
1
SCI0 receive-data-full interrupt
Falling edge of DREQ input
0
1
1
Low level of DREQ input
Data transfer interrupt enable
0 Interrupt requested by DTE bit is disabled
1 Interrupt requested by DTE bit is enabled
Repeat enable
RPE DTIE Description
0
0
I/O mode
1
0
1
Repeat mode
1
Idle mode
Data transfer increment/decrement
0 Incremented: If DTSZ = 0, MAR is incremented by 1 after each transfer
If DTSZ = 1, MAR is incremented by 2 after each transfer
1 Decremented: If DTSZ = 0, MAR is decremented by 1 after each transfer
If DTSZ = 1, MAR is decremented by 2 after each transfer
Data transfer size
0 Byte-size transfer
1 Word-size transfer
Data transfer enable
0 Data transfer is disabled
1 Data transfer is enabled
603
DTCR0B—Data Transfer Control Register 0B
•
H'2F
DMAC0
Full address mode
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
DTME
—
DAID
DAIDE
TMS
DTS2B
DTS1B
DTS0B
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Data transfer select 2B to 0B
Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
Data Transfer Activation Source
DTS2B DTS1B DTS0B Normal Mode
Block Transfer Mode
0
0
0
Auto-request
Compare match/input capture
(burst mode)
A from ITU channel 0
Not available
Compare match/input capture
1
A from ITU channel 1
Compare match/input capture
Auto-request
0
1
A from ITU channel 2
(cycle-steal mode)
Compare match/input capture
Not available
1
A from ITU channel 3
Not available
1
0
Not available
0
Not available
Not available
1
Falling edge of DREQ
Falling edge of DREQ
1
0
1
Low level input at DREQ Not available
Transfer mode select
0 Destination is the block area in block transfer mode
1 Source is the block area in block transfer mode
Destination address increment/decrement
Destination address increment/decrement enable
Bit 5 Bit 4
Description
DAID DAIDE
0
0
MARB is held fixed
1
Incremented: If DTSZ = 0, MARB is incremented by 1 after each transfer
If DTSZ = 1, MARB is incremented by 2 after each transfer
1
0
MARB is held fixed
1
Decremented: If DTSZ = 0, MARB is decremented by 1 after each transfer
If DTSZ = 1, MARB is decremented by 2 after each transfer
Data transfer master enable
0 Data transfer is disabled
1 Data transfer is enabled
604
MAR1A R/E/H/L—Memory Address Register 1A R/E/H/L
23
H'30, H'31,
H'32, H'33
22
21
Bit
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read/Write
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
— R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Initial value
Read/Write
15
14
13
12
11
19
18
17
16
Undetermined
MAR1AR
Bit
20
DMAC1
MAR1AE
10
9
Undetermined
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Undetermined
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
MAR1AH
MAR1AL
Note: Bit functions are the same as for DMAC0.
605
ETCR1A H/L—Execute Transfer Count Register 1A H/L
Bit
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
H'34, H'35
6
5
4
DMAC1
3
2
1
0
Initial value
Undetermined
Read/Write
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Bit
7
6
5
R/W
R/W
R/W
4
Initial value
Read/Write
3
2
1
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
2
1
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
Undetermined
R/W
R/W
ETCR1AH
Bit
7
6
5
4
Initial value
Read/Write
3
Undetermined
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
ETCR1AL
Note: Bit functions are the same as for DMAC0.
IOAR1A—I/O Address Register 1A
Bit
7
6
H'36
5
4
Initial value
Read/Write
3
DMAC1
2
1
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
Undetermined
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Note: Bit functions are the same as for DMAC0.
606
R/W
DTCR1A—Data Transfer Control Register 1A
•
DMAC1
Short address mode
Bit
•
H'37
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
DTE
DTSZ
SAID
SAIDE
DTIE
DTS2A
DTS1A
DTS0A
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
DTE
DTSZ
SAID
SAIDE
DTIE
DTS2A
DTS1A
DTS0A
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Full address mode
Bit
Note: Bit functions are the same as for DMAC0.
MAR1B R/E/H/L—Memory Address Register 1B R/E/H/L
23
H'38, H'39,
H'3A, H'3B
22
21
Bit
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read/Write
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
— R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Initial value
Read/Write
15
14
13
12
11
19
18
17
16
Undetermined
MAR1BR
Bit
20
DMAC1
MAR1BE
10
9
Undetermined
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Undetermined
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
MAR1BH
MAR1BL
Note: Bit functions are the same as for DMAC0.
607
ETCR1B H/L—Execute Transfer Count Register 1B H/L
Bit
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
H'3C, H'3D
7
6
5
4
DMAC1
3
2
1
0
Initial value
Undetermined
Read/Write
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Bit
7
6
5
R/W
R/W
R/W
4
Initial value
Read/Write
3
2
1
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
2
1
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
Undetermined
R/W
R/W
ETCR1BH
Bit
7
6
5
4
Initial value
Read/Write
3
Undetermined
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
ETCR1BL
Note: Bit functions are the same as for DMAC0.
IOAR1B—I/O Address Register 1B
Bit
7
6
H'3E
5
4
Initial value
Read/Write
3
DMAC1
2
1
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
Undetermined
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Note: Bit functions are the same as for DMAC0.
608
R/W
DTCR1B—Data Transfer Control Register 1B
•
H'3F
DMAC1
Short address mode
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
DTE
DTSZ
DTID
RPE
DTIE
DTS2B
DTS1B
DTS0B
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
•
Full address mode
Bit
DTME
—
DAID
DAIDE
TMS
DTS2B
DTS1B
DTS0B
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Note: Bit functions are the same as for DMAC0.
609
TSTR—Timer Start Register
Bit
H'60
ITU (all channels)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
—
—
STR4
STR3
STR2
STR1
STR0
Initial value
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
—
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Counter start 0
0 TCNT0 is halted
1 TCNT0 is counting
Counter start 1
0 TCNT1 is halted
1 TCNT1 is counting
Counter start 2
0 TCNT2 is halted
1 TCNT2 is counting
Counter start 3
0 TCNT3 is halted
1 TCNT3 is counting
Counter start 4
0 TCNT4 is halted
1 TCNT4 is counting
610
TSNC—Timer Synchro Register
Bit
H'61
ITU (all channels)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
—
—
SYNC4
SYNC3
SYNC2
SYNC1
SYNC0
Initial value
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
—
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Timer sync 0
0 TCNT0 operates independently
1 TCNT0 is synchronized
Timer sync 1
0 TCNT1 operates independently
1 TCNT1 is synchronized
Timer sync 2
0 TCNT2 operates independently
1 TCNT2 is synchronized
Timer sync 3
0 TCNT3 operates independently
1 TCNT3 is synchronized
Timer sync 4
0 TCNT4 operates independently
1 TCNT4 is synchronized
611
TMDR—Timer Mode Register
Bit
H'62
ITU (all channels)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
MDF
FDIR
PWM4
PWM3
PWM2
PWM1
PWM0
Initial value
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
PWM mode 0
0 Channel 0 operates normally
1 Channel 0 operates in PWM mode
PWM mode 1
0 Channel 1 operates normally
1 Channel 1 operates in PWM mode
PWM mode 2
0 Channel 2 operates normally
1 Channel 2 operates in PWM mode
PWM mode 3
0 Channel 3 operates normally
1 Channel 3 operates in PWM mode
PWM mode 4
0 Channel 4 operates normally
1 Channel 4 operates in PWM mode
Flag direction
0 OVF is set to 1 in TSR2 when TCNT2 overflows or underflows
1 OVF is set to 1 in TSR2 when TCNT2 overflows
Phase counting mode flag
0 Channel 2 operates normally
1 Channel 2 operates in phase counting mode
612
TFCR—Timer Function Control Register
Bit
H'63
ITU (all channels)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
—
CMD1
CMD0
BFB4
BFA4
BFB3
BFA3
Initial value
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Buffer mode A3
0 GRA3 operates normally
1 GRA3 is buffered by BRA3
Buffer mode B3
0 GRB3 operates normally
1 GRB3 is buffered by BRB3
Buffer mode A4
0 GRA4 operates normally
1 GRA4 is buffered by BRA4
Buffer mode B4
0 GRB4 operates normally
1 GRB4 is buffered by BRB4
Combination mode 1 and 0
Bit 5 Bit 4
CMD1 CMD0 Operating Mode of Channels 3 and 4
0
0
Channels 3 and 4 operate normally
1
0
1
Channels 3 and 4 operate together in complementary PWM mode
1
Channels 3 and 4 operate together in reset-synchronized PWM mode
613
TCR0—Timer Control Register 0
Bit
H'64
7
6
5
4
3
ITU0
2
1
0
—
CCLR1
CCLR0
TPSC2
TPSC1
TPSC0
Initial value
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CKEG1 CKEG0
Timer prescaler 2 to 0
Bit 2
Bit 0
Bit 1
TPSC2 TPSC1 TPSC0
0
0
0
1
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
1
TCNT Clock Source
Internal clock: ø
Internal clock: ø/2
Internal clock: ø/4
Internal clock: ø/8
External clock A: TCLKA input
External clock B: TCLKB input
External clock C: TCLKC input
External clock D: TCLKD input
Clock edge 1 and 0
Bit 4 Bit 3
CKEG1 CKEG0
0
0
1
1
—
Counted Edges of External Clock
Rising edges counted
Falling edges counted
Both edges counted
Counter clear 1 and 0
Bit 6
Bit 5
CCLR1 CCLR0 TCNT Clear Source
0
0
TCNT is not cleared
1
TCNT is cleared by GRA compare match or input capture
1
0
TCNT is cleared by GRB compare match or input capture
1
Synchronous clear: TCNT is cleared in synchronization
with other synchronized timers
614
TIOR0—Timer I/O Control Register 0
Bit
H'65
ITU0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
IOB2
IOB1
IOB0
—
IOA2
IOA1
IOA0
Initial value
1
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
I/O control A2 to A0
Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
IOA2 IOA1 IOA0
0
0
0
1
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
1
I/O control B2 to B0
Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4
IOB2 IOB1 IOB0
0
0
0
1
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
1
GRA Function
GRA is an output
compare register
GRA is an input
capture register
GRB Function
GRB is an output
compare register
GRB is an input
capture register
No output at compare match
0 output at GRA compare match*1
1 output at GRA compare match*1
Output toggles at GRA compare match*1,*2
GRA captures rising edge of input
GRA captures falling edge of input
GRA captures both edges of input
No output at compare match
0 output at GRB compare match*1
1 output at GRB compare match*1
Output toggles at GRB compare match*1,*2
GRB captures rising edge of input
GRB captures falling edge of input
GRB captures both edges of input
Notes: 1. After a reset, the output is 0 until the first compare match.
2. Channel 2 output cannot be toggled by compare match.
This setting selects 1output instead.
615
TIER0—Timer Interrpt Enable Register 0
Bit
H'66
ITU0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
—
—
—
—
OVIE
IMIEB
IMIEA
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
—
—
—
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
Input capture/compare match interrupt enable A
0 IMIA interrupt requested by IMFA flag is disabled
1 IMIA interrupt requested by IMFA flag is enabled
Input capture/compare match interrupt enable B
0 IMIB interrupt requested by IMFB flag is disabled
1 IMIB interrupt requested by IMFB flag is enabled
Overflow interrupt enable
0 OVI interrupt requested by OVF flag is disabled
1 OVI interrupt requested by OVF flag is enabled
616
TSR0—Timer Status Register 0
Bit
H'67
ITU0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
—
—
—
—
OVF
IMFB
IMFA
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
—
—
—
—
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
Input capture/compare match flag A
0 [Clearing condition]
Read IMFA when IMFA = 1, then write 0 in IMFA
DMAC activated by IMIA interrupt (channels 0 to 3 only).
1 [Setting conditions]
TCNT = GRA when GRA functions as an output compare
register.
TCNT value is transferred to GRA by an input capture
signal, when GRA functions as an input capture register.
Input capture/compare match flag B
0 [Clearing condition]
Read IMFB when IMFB = 1, then write 0 in IMFB
1 [Setting conditions]
TCNT = GRB when GRB functions as an output compare
register.
TCNT value is transferred to GRB by an input capture
signal, when GRB functions as an input capture register.
Overflow flag
0 [Clearing condition]
Read OVF when OVF = 1, then write 0 in OVF
1 [Setting condition]
TCNT overflowed from H'FFFF to H'0000
Note: * Only 0 can be written, to clear the flag.
617
CNT0—Timer Counter 0 H/L
H'68, H'69
ITU0
Bit
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Up-counter
GRA0 H/L—General Register A0 H/L
H'6A, H'6B
ITU0
Bit
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read/Write
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Output compare or input capture register
GRB0 H/L—General Register B0 H/L
H'6C, H'6D
ITU0
Bit
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read/Write
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Output compare or input capture register
TCR1—Timer Control Register 1
Bit
H'6E
7
6
5
—
CCLR1
CCLR0
Initial value
1
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
4
3
2
1
0
TPSC2
TPSC1
TPSC0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CKEG1 CKEG0
Note: Bit functions are the same as for ITU0.
618
ITU1
TCR1—Timer Control Register 1
Bit
H'6E
ITU1
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
IOB2
IOB1
IOB0
—
IOA2
IOA1
IOA0
Initial value
1
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
Note: Bit functions are the same as for ITU0.
TIERI—Timer Interrupt Enable Register 1
Bit
H'70
ITU1
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
—
—
—
—
OVIE
IMIEB
IMIEA
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
—
—
—
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
Note: Bit functions are the same as for ITU0.
TSR1—Timer Status Register 1
Bit
H'71
ITU1
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
—
—
—
—
OVF
IMFB
IMFA
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
—
—
—
—
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
Notes: Bit functions are the same as for ITU0.
* Only 0 can be written, to clear the flag.
TCNT1 H/L—Timer Counter 1 H/L
H'72,H'73
ITU1
Bit
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Note: Bit functions are the same as for ITU0.
619
GRA1 H/L—General Register A 1 H/L
H'74,H'75
ITU1
Bit
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read/Write
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Note: Bit functions are the same as for ITU0.
GRB1 H/L—General Register B 1 H/L
H'76,H'77
ITU1
Bit
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read/Write
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Note: Bit functions are the same as for ITU0.
TCR2—Timer Control Register 2
Bit
H'78
7
6
5
4
3
ITU2
2
1
0
—
CCLR1
CCLR0
TPSC2
TPSC1
TPSC0
Initial value
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CKEG1 CKEG0
Notes: 1. Bit functions are the same as for ITU0.
2. When channel 2 is used in phase counting mode, the counter clock source selection by
bits CKEG1 and CKEG0 and TPSC2 to TPSC0 is ignored.
620
TIOR2—Timer I/O Control Register 2
Bit
H'79F
ITU2
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
IOB2
IOB1
IOB0
—
IOA2
IOA1
IOA0
Initial value
1
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
Note: Bit functions are the same as for ITU0.
621
TIER2 H/L—Timer Interrupt Enable Register 2
Bit
H'7A
ITU2
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
—
—
—
—
OVIE
IMIEB
IMIEA
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
—
—
—
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
Note: Bit functions are the same as for ITU0.
TSR2—Timer Status Register 2
Bit
H'7B
ITU2
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
—
—
—
—
OVF
IMFB
IMFA
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
—
—
—
—
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
Bit functions are the
same as for ITU0.
Overflow flag
0 [Clearing condition]
Read OVF when OVF = 1, then write 0 in OVF
1 [Setting condition]
TCNT overflowed from H'FFFF to H'0000 or underflowed from
H'0000 to H'FFFF
Note: * Only 0 can be written, to clear the flag.
TCNT2 H/L—Timer Counter 2 H/L
H'7C, H'7D
ITU2
Bit
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Phase counting mode: up/down counter
Other modes:
up-counter
622
GRA2 H/L—General Register A2 H/L
H'7E, H'7F
ITU2
Bit
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read/Write
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Note: Bit functions are the same as for ITU0.
GRB2 H/L—General Register B2 H/L
H'80, H'81
ITU2
Bit
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read/Write
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Note: Bit functions are the same as for ITU0.
TCR3—Timer Control Register 3
Bit
H'82
ITU3
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
CCLR1
CCLR0
CKEG1
CLEG0
TPSC2
TPSC1
TPSC0
Initial value
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Note: Bit functions are the same as for ITU0.
TIOR3—Timer I/O Control Register 3
Bit
H'83
ITU3
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
IOB2
IOB1
IOB0
—
IOA2
IOA1
IOA0
Initial value
1
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
Note: Bit functions are the same as for ITU0.
623
TIER2—Timer Interrupt Enable Register 3
Bit
H'84
ITU3
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
—
—
—
—
OVIE
IMIEB
IMIEA
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
—
—
—
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
Note: Bit functions are the same as for ITU0.
TSR3—Timer Status Register 3
Bit
H'85
ITU3
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
—
—
—
—
OVF
IMFB
IMFA
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
—
—
—
—
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
Bit functions are the
same as for ITU0
Overflow flag
0 [Clearing condition]
Read OVF when OVF = 1, then write 0 in OVF
1 [Setting condition]
TCNT overflowed from H'FFFF to H'0000 or underflowed from
H'0000 to H'FFFF
Note: * Only 0 can be written, to clear the flag.
TCNT3 H/L—Timer Counter 3 H/L
H'86, H'87
ITU3
Bit
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Complementary PWM mode: up/down counter
Other modes:
up-counter
624
GRA3 H/L—General Register A3 H/L
H'88,H'89
ITU3
Bit
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read/Write
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Output compare or input capture register (can be buffered)
GRB3 H/L—General Register B3 H/L
H'8A,H'8B
ITU3
Bit
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read/Write
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Output compare or input capture register (can be buffered)
BRA3 H/L—Buffer Register A3 H/L
Bit
Initial value
Read/Write
H'8C, H'8D
ITU3
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Used to buffer GRA
BRB3 H/L—Buffer Register B3 H/L
H'8E, H'8F
ITU3
Bit
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read/Write
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Used to buffer GRB
625
TOER—Timer Output Enable Register
Bit
H'90
ITU (all channels)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
—
EXB4
EXA4
EB3
EB4
EA4
EA3
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read/Write
—
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Master enable TIOCA3
0 TIOCA 3 output is disabled regardless of TIOR3, TMDR, and TFCR settings
1 TIOCA 3 is enabled for output according to TIOR3, TMDR, and TFCR settings
Master enable TIOCA4
0 TIOCA 4 output is disabled regardless of TIOR4, TMDR, and TFCR settings
1 TIOCA 4 is enabled for output according to TIOR4, TMDR, and TFCR settings
Master enable TIOCB4
0 TIOCB4 output is disabled regardless of TIOR4 and TFCR settings
1 TIOCB4 is enabled for output according to TIOR4 and TFCR settings
Master enable TIOCB3
0 TIOCB 3 output is disabled regardless of TIOR3 and TFCR settings
1 TIOCB 3 is enabled for output according to TIOR3 and TFCR settings
Master enable TOCXA4
0 TOCXA 4 output is disabled regardless of TFCR settings
1 TOCXA 4 is enabled for output according to TFCR settings
Master enable TOCXB4
0 TOCXB4 output is disabled regardless of TFCR settings
1 TOCXB4 is enabled for output according to TFCR settings
626
TOCR—Timer Output Control Register
Bit
H'91
ITU (all channels)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
—
—
XTGD
—
—
OLS4
OLS3
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read/Write
—
—
—
R/W
—
—
R/W
R/W
Output level select 3
0 TIOCB 3 , TOCXA 4 , and TOCXB 4 outputs are inverted
1 TIOCB 3 , TOCXA 4 , and TOCXB 4 outputs are not inverted
Output level select 4
0 TIOCA 3 , TIOCA 4, and TIOCB4 outputs are inverted
1 TIOCA 3 , TIOCA 4, and TIOCB4 outputs are not inverted
External trigger disable
0 Input capture A in channel 1 is used as an external trigger signal in
reset-synchronized PWM mode and complementary PWM mode *
1 External triggering is disabled
Note: * When an external trigger occurs, bits 5 to 0 in TOER are cleared to 0, disabling ITU
output.
627
TCR4—Timer Control Register 4
Bit
H'92
7
6
5
4
3
ITU4
2
1
0
—
CCLR1
CCLR0
TPSC2
TPSC1
TPSC0
Initial value
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
CKEG1 CKEG0
Note: Bit functions are the same as for ITU0.
TIOR4—Timer I/O Control Register 4
Bit
H'93
ITU4
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
IOB2
IOB1
IOB0
—
IOA2
IOA1
IOA0
Initial value
1
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
Note: Bit functions are the same as for ITU0.
TIER4—Timer Interrupt Enable Register 4
Bit
H'94
ITU4
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
—
—
—
—
OVIE
IMIEB
IMIEA
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
—
—
—
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
Note: Bit functions are the same as for ITU0.
TSR4—Timer Status Register 4
Bit
H'95
ITU4
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
—
—
—
—
OVF
IMFB
IMFA
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
—
—
—
—
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
Notes: Bit functions are the same as for ITU3.
* Only 0 can be written, to clear the flag.
628
TCNT4 H/L—Timer Counter 4 H/L
H'96, H'97
ITU4
Bit
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Note: Bit functions are the same as for ITU3.
GRA4 H/L—General Register A4 H/L
H'98, H'99
ITU4
Bit
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read/Write
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Note: Bit functions are the same as for ITU3.
GRB4 H/L—General Register B4 H/L
H'9A, H'9B
ITU4
Bit
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read/Write
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Note: Bit functions are the same as for ITU3.
BRA4 H/L—Buffer Register A4 H/L
Bit
Initial value
Read/Write
H'9C, H'9D
ITU4
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Note: Bit functions are the same as for ITU3.
629
BRB4 H/L—Buffer Register B4 H/L
H'9E, H'9F
ITU4
Bit
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read/Write
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Note: Bit functions are the same as for ITU3.
TPMR—TPC Output Mode Register
Bit
H'A0
7
6
5
4
3
2
TPC
0
1
—
—
—
—
Initial value
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
—
—
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
G3NOV G2NOV
G1NOV G0NOV
Group 0 non-overlap
0 Normal TPC output in group 0.
Output values change at compare match A in the selected ITU channel.
1 Non-overlapping TPC output in group 0, controlled by compare match
A and B in the selected ITU channel
Group 1 non-overlap
0 Normal TPC output in group 1.
Output values change at compare match A in the selected ITU channel.
1 Non-overlapping TPC output in group 1, controlled by compare match
A and B in the selected ITU channel
Group 2 non-overlap
0 Normal TPC output in group 2.
Output values change at compare match A in the selected ITU channel.
1 Non-overlapping TPC output in group 2, controlled by compare match
A and B in the selected ITU channel
Group 3 non-overlap
0 Normal TPC output in group 3.
Output values change at compare match A in the selected ITU channel.
1 Non-overlapping TPC output in group 3, controlled by compare match
A and B in the selected ITU channel
630
TPCR—TPC Output Control Register
Bit
7
6
5
H'A1
4
3
2
TPC
1
0
G3CMS1 G3CMS0 G2CMS1 G2CMS0 G1CMS1 G1CMS0 G0CMS1 G0CMS0
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Group 0 compare match select 1 and 0
Bit 1
Bit 0
G0CMS1 G0CMS0
0
0
1
1
0
1
ITU Channel Selected as Output Trigger
TPC output group 0 (TP3 to TP0) is triggered by compare match in ITU channel 0
TPC output group 0 (TP3 to TP0) is triggered by compare match in ITU channel 1
TPC output group 0 (TP3 to TP0) is triggered by compare match in ITU channel 2
TPC output group 0 (TP3 to TP0) is triggered by compare match in ITU channel 3
Group 1 compare match select 1 and 0
Bit 3
Bit 2
G1CMS1 G1CMS0
0
0
1
1
0
1
ITU Channel Selected as Output Trigger
TPC output group 1 (TP7 to TP4 ) is triggered by compare match in ITU channel 0
TPC output group 1 (TP7 to TP4 ) is triggered by compare match in ITU channel 1
TPC output group 1 (TP7 to TP4 ) is triggered by compare match in ITU channel 2
TPC output group 1 (TP7 to TP4 ) is triggered by compare match in ITU channel 3
Group 2 compare match select 1 and 0
Bit 5
Bit 4
G2CMS1 G2CMS0
0
0
1
1
0
1
ITU Channel Selected as Output Trigger
TPC output group 2 (TP11 to TP8 ) is triggered by compare match in ITU channel 0
TPC output group 2 (TP11 to TP8 ) is triggered by compare match in ITU channel 1
TPC output group 2 (TP11 to TP8 ) is triggered by compare match in ITU channel 2
TPC output group 2 (TP11 to TP8 ) is triggered by compare match in ITU channel 3
Group 3 compare match select 1 and 0
Bit 7
Bit 6
G3CMS1 G3CMS0
0
0
1
1
0
1
ITU Channel Selected as Output Trigger
TPC output group 3 (TP15 to TP12) is triggered by compare match in ITU channel 0
TPC output group 3 (TP15 to TP12) is triggered by compare match in ITU channel 1
TPC output group 3 (TP15 to TP12) is triggered by compare match in ITU channel 2
TPC output group 3 (TP15 to TP12) is triggered by compare match in ITU channel 3
631
NDERB—Next Data Enable Register B
Bit
7
6
H'A2
5
4
3
2
TPC
1
NDER15 NDER14 NDER13 NDER12 NDER11 NDER10 NDER9
0
NDER8
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Next data enable 15 to 8
Bits 7 to 0
NDER15 to NDER8 Description
0
TPC outputs TP15 to TP8 are disabled
(NDR15 to NDR8 are not transferred to PB 7 to PB 0 )
TPC outputs TP15 to TP8 are enabled
1
(NDR15 to NDR8 are transferred to PB 7 to PB 0 )
NDERA—Next Data Enable Register A
Bit
7
6
5
NDER7
NDER6
NDER5
H'A3
4
3
NDER4 NDER3
TPC
2
1
0
NDER2
NDER1
NDER0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Next data enable 7 to 0
Bits 7 to 0
NDER7 to NDER0 Description
0
TPC outputs TP 7 to TP0 are disabled
(NDR7 to NDR0 are not transferred to PA 7 to PA 0)
TPC outputs TP 7 to TP0 are enabled
1
(NDR7 to NDR0 are transferred to PA 7 to PA 0)
632
NDRB—Next Data Register B
•
H'A4/H'A6
TPC
Same output trigger for TPC output groups 2 and 3
Address H'FFA4
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
NDR15
NDR14
NDR13
NDR12
NDR11
NDR10
NDR9
NDR8
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Store the next output data for
TPC output group 3
Store the next output data for
TPC output group 2
Address H'FFA6
Bit
•
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read/Write
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Different output triggers for TPC output groups 2 and 3
Address H'FFA4
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
NDR15
NDR14
NDR13
NDR12
—
—
—
—
Initial value
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
—
—
—
—
Store the next output data for
TPC output group 3
Address H'FFA6
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
—
—
—
NDR11
NDR10
NDR9
NDR8
Initial value
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
—
—
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Store the next output data for
TPC output group 2
633
NDRA—Next Data Register A
•
H'A5/H'A7
TPC
Same output trigger for TPC output groups 0 and 1
Address H'FFA5
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
NDR7
NDR6
NDR5
NDR4
NDR3
NDR2
NDR1
NDR0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Store the next output data for
TPC output group 1
Store the next output data for
TPC output group 0
Address H'FFA7
Bit
•
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read/Write
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Different output triggers for TPC output groups 0 and 1
Address H'FFA5
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
NDR7
NDR6
NDR5
NDR4
—
—
—
—
Initial value
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
—
—
—
—
Store the next output data for
TPC output group 1
Address H'FFA7
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
—
—
—
NDR3
NDR2
NDR1
NDR0
Initial value
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
—
—
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Store the next output data for
TPC output group 0
634
TCSR—Timer Control/Status Register
Bit
H'A8
WDT
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
OVF
WT/ IT
TME
—
—
CKS2
CKS1
CKS0
Initial value
0
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/(W)*
R/W
R/W
—
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
Timer enable
0 Timer disabled
• TCNT is initialized to H'00 and halted
1 Timer enabled
• TCNT is counting
Timer mode select
0 Interval timer: requests interval timer interrupts
1 Watchdog timer: generates a reset signal
Overflow flag
0 [Clearing condition]
Read OVF when OVF = 1, then write 0 in OVF
1 [Setting condition]
TCNT changes from H'FF to H'00
Note: * Only 0 can be written, to clear the flag.
635
Clock select 2 to 0
0
0
0
1
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
1
ø/2
ø/32
ø/64
ø/128
ø/256
ø/512
ø/2048
ø/4096
TCNT—Timer Counter
Bit
7
H'A9 (read),
H'A8 (write)
6
5
4
3
2
WDT
1
0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Count value
RSTCSR—Reset Control/Status Register
Bit
H'AB (read),
H'AA (write)
WDT
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
WRST
RSTOE
—
—
—
—
—
—
Initial value
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read/Write
R/(W)*
R/W
—
—
—
—
—
—
Reset output enable
0 Reset signal is not output externally
1 Reset signal is output externally
Watchdog timer reset
0 [Clearing condition]
Reset signal input at RES pin.
Reading WRST when WRST=1, then writing 0 in WRST.
1 [Setting condition]
TCNT overflow generates a reset signal
Note: * Only 0 can be written in bit 7, to clear the flag.
636
RFSHCR—Refresh Control Register
Bit
7
6
H'AC
5
4
SRFMD PSRAME DRAME CAS/WE
Refresh controller
3
2
1
0
M9/M8
RFSHE
—
RCYCE
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
—
R/W
Refresh cycle enable
0 Refresh cycles are disabled
1 Refresh cycles are enabled for area 3
Refresh pin enable
0 Refresh signal output at the RFSH pin is disabled
1 Refresh signal output at the RFSH pin is enabled
Address multiplex mode select
0 8-bit column address mode
1 9-bit column address mode
Strobe mode select
0 2 WE mode
1 2 CAS mode
PSRAM enable, DRAM enable
Bit 6
Bit 5
PSRAME DRAME RAM Interface
0
Can be used as an interval timer
0
(DRAM and PSRAM cannot be directly connected)
1
1
0
1
DRAM can be directly connected
PSRAM can be directly connected
Illegal setting
Self-refresh mode
0 DRAM or PSRAM self-refresh is disabled in software standby mode
1 DRAM or PSRAM self-refresh is enabled in software standby mode
637
RTMCSR—Refresh Timer Control/Status Register
Bit
H'AD
Refresh controller
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
CMF
CMIE
CKS2
CKS1
CKS0
—
—
—
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
Read/Write
R/(W)*
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
—
—
—
Clock select 2 to 0
Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3
CKS2 CKS1 CKS0
0
0
0
1
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
1
Counter Clock Source
Clock input is disabled
ø/2
ø/8
ø/32
ø/128
ø/512
ø/2048
ø/4096
Compare match interrupt enable
0 The CMI interrupt requested by CMF is disabled
1 The CMI interrupt requested by CMF is enabled
Compare match flag
0 [Clearing condition]
Read CMF when CMF = 1, then write 0 in CMF
1 [Setting condition]
RTCNT = RTCOR
Note: * Only 0 can be written, to clear the flag.
638
RTCNT—Refresh Timer Counter
H'AE
Refresh controller
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Count value
RTCOR—Refresh Time Constant Register
Bit
7
6
5
H'AF
4
3
2
Refresh controller
1
0
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Interval at which RTCNT is cleared
639
SMR—Serial Mode Register
H'B0
SCI0
7
6
5
7
3
2
1
0
C/ A
CHR
PE
O/ E
STOP
MP
CKS1
CKS0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Bit
Multiprocessor mode
0 Multiprocessor function disabled
1 Multiprocessor format selected
Stop bit length
0 One stop bit
1 Two stop bits
Parity mode
0 Even parity
1 Odd parity
Parity enable
0 Parity bit is not added or checked
1 Parity bit is added and checked
Character length
0 8-bit data
1 7-bit data
Communication mode
0 Asynchronous mode
1 Synchronous mode
640
Clock select 1 and 0
Bit 1 Bit 0
CKS1 CKS0 Clock Source
0
0
ø clock
1
ø/4 clock
ø/16 clock
0
1
ø/64 clock
1
BRR—Bit Rate Register
H'B1
SCI0
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Serial communication bit rate setting
641
SCR—Serial Control Register
Bit
H'B2
SCI0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TIE
RIE
TE
RE
MPIE
TEIE
CKE1
CKE0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Clock enable 1 and 0
Bit 1 Bit 0
CKE1 CKE0 Clock Selection and Output
0
Asynchronous mode Internal clock, SCK pin available for generic
0
input/output
Synchronous mode Internal clock, SCK pin used for serial clock output
Asynchronous mode Internal clock, SCK pin used for clock output
1
Synchronous mode Internal clock, SCK pin used for serial clock output
Asynchronous mode External clock, SCK pin used for clock input
1
0
Synchronous mode External clock, SCK pin used for serial clock input
Asynchronous mode External clock, SCK pin used for clock input
1
Synchronous mode External clock, SCK pin used for serial clock input
Transmit-end interrupt enable
0 Transmit-end interrupt requests (TEI) are disabled
1 Transmit-end interrupt requests (TEI) are enabled
Multiprocessor interrupt enable
0 Multiprocessor interrupts are disabled (normal receive operation)
1 Multiprocessor interrupts are enabled
Transmit enable
0 Transmitting is disabled
1 Transmitting is enabled
Receive enable
0 Transmitting is disabled
1 Transmitting is enabled
Receive interrupt enable
0 Receive-end (RXI) and receive-error (ERI) interrupt requests are disabled
1 Receive-end (RXI) and receive-error (ERI) interrupt requests are enabled
Transmit interrupt enable
0 Transmit-data-empty interrupt request (TXI) is disabled
1 Transmit-data-empty interrupt request (TXI) is enabled
642
TDR—Transmit Data Register
Bit
7
6
H'B3
5
4
3
2
SCI0
1
0
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Serial transmit data
643
SSR—Serial Status Register
Bit
H'B4
SCI0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TDRE
RDRF
ORER
FER
PER
TEND
MPB
MPBT
Initial value
1
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
Read/Write
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R
R
R/W
Multiprocessor bit
0 Multiprocessor bit value in
receive data is 0
1
Transmit end
Multiprocessor bit value in
receive data is 1
0
[Clearing conditions]
Read TDRE when TDRE = 1, then write 0 in TDRE.
The DMAC writes data in TDR.
1
[Setting conditions]
Reset or transition to standby mode.
TE is cleared to 0 in SCR. TDRE is 1 when
last bit of 1-byte serial character is transmitted.
Multiprocessor bit transfer
0 Multiprocessor bit value in
transmit data is 0
1
Multiprocessor bit value in
transmit data is 1
Parity error
Framing error
0
[Clearing conditions]
Reset or transition to standby mode.
Read FER when FER = 1, then write 0
in FER.
1
[Setting condition]
Framing error (stop bit is 0)
0
[Clearing conditions]
Reset or transition to standby mode.
Read PER when PER = 1, then write 0 in
PER.
1
[Setting condition]
Parity error: (parity of receive data does not
match parity setting of O/ E bit in SMR)
Overrun error
Receive data register full
0
1
[Clearing conditions]
Reset or transition to standby mode.
Read RDRF when RDRF = 1, then write 0 in
RDRF.
The DMAC reads data from RDR.
[Setting condition]
Serial data is received normally and transferred
from RSR to RDR
Transmit data register empty
0
[Clearing conditions]
Read TDRE when TDRE = 1, then write 0 in TDRE.
The DMAC writes data in TDR.
1
[Setting conditions]
Reset or transition to standby mode.
TE is 0 in SCR
Data is transferred from TDR to TSR, enabling new
data to be written in TDR.
Note: * Only 0 can be written, to clear the flag.
644
0
[Clearing conditions]
Reset or transition to standby mode.
Read ORER when ORER = 1, then write 0 in
ORER.
1
[Setting condition]
Overrun error (reception of next serial data
ends when RDRF = 1)
RDR—Receive Data Register
H'B5
SCI0
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Serial receive data
SMR—Serial Mode Register
Bit
H'B8
SCI1
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
C/ A
CHR
PE
O/ E
STOP
MP
CKS1
CKS0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Note: Bit functions are the same as for SCI0.
BRR—Bit Rate Register
H'B9
SCI1
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Note: Bit functions are the same as for SCI0.
SCR—Serial Control Register
Bit
H'BA
SCI1
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TIE
RIE
TE
RE
MPIE
TEIE
CKE1
CKE0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Note: Bit functions are the same as for SCI0.
645
TDR—Transmit Data Register
H'BB
SCI1
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Note: Bit functions are the same as for SCI0.
SSR—Serial Status Register
Bit
H'BC
SCI1
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TDRE
RDRF
ORER
FER
PER
TEND
MPB
MPBT
Initial value
1
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
Read/Write
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R
R
R/W
Notes: Bit functions are the same as for SCI0.
* Only 0 can be written, to clear the flag.
RDR—Receive Data Register
H'BD
SCI1
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Note: Bit functions are the same as for SCI0.
646
P4DDR—Port 4 Data Direction Register
Bit
7
6
H'C5
5
4
3
2
Port 4
1
0
P4 7 DDR P4 6 DDR P4 5 DDR P4 4 DDR P4 3 DDR P4 2 DDR P4 1 DDR P4 0 DDR
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
Port 4 input/output select
0 Generic input pin
1 Generic output pin
P4DR—Port 4 Data Register
Bit
H'C7
Port 4
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P4 7
P4 6
P4 5
P4 4
P4 3
P4 2
P4 1
P4 0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Data for port 4 pins
P6DDR—Port 6 Data Direction Register
Bit
7
—
6
5
H'C9
4
3
2
Port 6
1
0
P6 6 DDR P6 5 DDR P6 4 DDR P6 3 DDR P6 2 DDR P6 1 DDR P6 0 DDR
Initial value
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
Port 6 input/output select
0 Generic input
1 Generic output
647
P6DR—Port 6 Data Register
Bit
H'CB
Port 6
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
P6 6
P6 5
P6 4
P6 3
P6 2
P6 1
P6 0
Initial value
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Data for port 6 pins
P8DDR—Port 8 Data Direction Register
Bit
H'CD
7
6
5
—
—
—
Initial value
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
—
—
W
W
W
W
W
4
3
1
0
P8 4 DDR P8 3 DDR P8 2 DDR P8 1 DDR P8 0 DDR
Port 8 input/output select
0 Generic input
1 CS output
Port 8 input/output select
0 Generic input
1 Generic output
P7DR—Port 7 Data Register
Bit
2
Port 8
H'CE
Port 7
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P77
P76
P75
P74
P73
P72
P71
P70
Initial value
—*
—*
—*
—*
—*
—*
—*
—*
Read/Write
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Data for port 7 pins
Note: * Determined by pins P7 7 to P7 0 .
648
P8DR—Port 8 Data Register
Bit
H'CF
Port 8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
—
—
P8 4
P8 3
P8 2
P8 1
P8 0
Initial value
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
—
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Data for port 8 pins
P9DDR—Port 9 Data Direction Register
Bit
H'D0
4
7
6
—
—
Initial value
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
—
W
W
W
W
W
W
5
3
Port 9
2
1
0
P9 5 DDR P9 4 DDR P9 3 DDR P9 2 DDR P9 1 DDR P9 0 DDR
Port 9 input/output select
0 Generic input
1 Generic output
PADDR—Port A Data Direction Register
Bit
7
6
H'D1
5
4
3
2
Port A
1
0
PA7 DDR PA6 DDR PA5 DDR PA4 DDR PA3 DDR PA2 DDR PA1 DDR PA0 DDR
Modes Initial value 0
1, 2
Read/Write W
Modes Initial value 1
3, 4
Read/Write —
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
Port A input/output select
0 Generic input
1 Generic output
649
P9DR—Port 9 Data Register
Bit
H'D2
Port 9
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
—
P9 5
P9 4
P9 3
P9 2
P9 1
P9 0
Initial value
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Data for port 9 pins
PADR—Port A Data Register
Bit
H'D3
Port A
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PA 7
PA 6
PA 5
PA 4
PA 3
PA 2
PA 1
PA 0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Data for port A pins
PBDDR—Port B Data Direction Register
Bit
7
6
5
H'D4
4
3
2
Port B
1
0
PB7 DDR PB6 DDR PB5 DDR PB4 DDR PB3 DDR PB2 DDR PB1 DDR PB0 DDR
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
Port B input/output select
0 Generic input
1 Generic output
650
PBDR—Port B Data Register
Bit
H'D6
Port B
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PB 7
PB 6
PB 5
PB 4
PB 3
PB 2
PB 1
PB 0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Data for port B pins
P4PCR—Port 4 Input Pull-Up Control Register
Bit
7
6
5
H'DA
4
3
Port 4
2
1
0
P4 7 PCR P4 6 PCR P4 5 PCR P4 4 PCR P4 3 PCR P4 2 PCR P4 1 PCR P4 0 PCR
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Port 4 input pull-up control 7 to 0
0 Input pull-up transistor is off
1 Input pull-up transistor is on
Note: Valid when the corresponding P4DDR bit is cleared to 0 (designating generic input).
ADDRA H/L—A/D Data Register A H/L
Bit
14
12
H'E0, H'E1
10
8
6
A/D
5
4
3
2
1
0
AD9 AD8 AD7 AD6 AD5 AD4 AD3 AD2 AD1 AD0 —
—
—
—
—
—
15
13
11
9
7
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
ADDRAH
ADDRAL
A/D conversion data
10-bit data giving an
A/D conversion result
651
ADDRB H/L—A/D Data Register B H/L
Bit
14
12
H'E2, H'E3
10
8
6
A/D
5
4
3
2
1
0
AD9 AD8 AD7 AD6 AD5 AD4 AD3 AD2 AD1 AD0 —
—
—
—
—
—
15
13
11
9
7
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
ADDRBH
ADDRBL
A/D conversion data
10-bit data giving an
A/D conversion result
ADDRC H/L—A/D Data Register C H/L
Bit
14
12
H'E4, H'E5
10
8
6
A/D
5
4
3
2
1
0
AD9 AD8 AD7 AD6 AD5 AD4 AD3 AD2 AD1 AD0 —
15
13
11
9
7
—
—
—
—
—
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
ADDRCH
ADDRCL
A/D conversion data
10-bit data giving an
A/D conversion result
ADDRD H/L—A/D Data Register D H/L
Bit
14
12
10
H'E6, H'E7
8
6
A/D
5
4
3
2
1
0
AD9 AD8 AD7 AD6 AD5 AD4 AD3 AD2 AD1 AD0 —
—
—
—
—
—
15
13
11
9
7
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
ADDRDH
ADDRDL
A/D conversion data
10-bit data giving an
A/D conversion result
652
ADCR—A/D Control Register
Bit
H'E9
A/D
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TRGE
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Initial value
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read/Write
R/W
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Trigger enable
0 A/D conversion cannot be externally triggered
1 A/D conversion starts at the fall of the external trigger signal (ADTRG )
653
ADCSR—A/D Control/Status Register
Bit
H'E8
A/D
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
ADF
ADIE
ADST
SCAN
CKS
CH2
CH1
CH0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/(W)*
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Clock select
0 Conversion time = 266 states (maximum)
1 Conversion time = 134 states (maximum)
Scan mode
0 Single mode
1 Scan mode
Channel select 2 to 0
Channel
Group
Selection
Selection
CH2
CH1
CH0
0
0
0
1
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
1
Description
Single Mode Scan Mode
AN 0
AN 0
AN 1
AN 0, AN 1
AN 2
AN 0 to AN 2
AN 3
AN 0 to AN 3
AN 4
AN 4
AN 5
AN 4, AN 5
AN 6
AN 4 to AN 6
AN 7
AN 4 to AN 7
A/D start
0 A/D conversion is stopped
1 Single mode: A/D conversion starts; ADST is automatically cleared to 0 when
conversion ends
Scan mode: A/D conversion starts and continues, cycling among the selected
channels, until ADST is cleared to 0 by software, by a reset, or by a
transition to standby mode
A/D interrupt enable
0 A/D end interrupt request is disabled
1 A/D end interrupt request is enabled
A/D end flag
0 [Clearing condition]
Read ADF while ADF = 1, then write 0 in ADF
1 [Setting conditions]
Single mode: A/D conversion ends
Scan mode: A/D conversion ends in all selected channels
Note: * Only 0 can be written, to clear flag.
654
ABWCR—Bus Width Control Register
Bit
Bus controller
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
ABW7
ABW6
ABW5
ABW4
ABW3
ABW2
ABW1
ABW0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Mode 1, 3
Initial
value Mode 2, 4
Read/Write
H'EC
Area 7 to 0 bus width control
Bits 7 to 0
AWB7 to AWB0
Bus Width of Access Area
0
Areas 7 to 0 are 16-bit access areas
Areas 7 to 0 are 8-bit access areas
1
ASTCR—Access State Control Register
Bit
H'ED
Bus controller
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
AST7
AST6
AST5
AST4
AST3
AST2
AST1
AST0
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Area 7 to 0 access state control
Bits 7 to 0
AST7 to AST0
Number of States in Access Cycle
0
Areas 7 to 0 are two-state access areas
Areas 7 to 0 are three-state access areas
1
655
WCR—Wait Control Register
Bit
H'EE
Bus controller
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
—
—
—
WMS1
WMS0
WC1
WC0
Initial value
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
Read/Write
—
—
—
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Wait mode select 1 and 0
Bit 3 Bit 2
WMS1 WMS0 Wait Mode
0
0
Programmable wait mode
1
No wait states inserted by
wait-state controller
1
0
1
Wait count 1 and 0
Bit 1 Bit 0
WC1 WC0 Number of Wait States
0
0
No wait states inserted by
wait-state controller
Pin wait mode 1
Pin auto-wait mode
1
0
1
1
WCER—Wait Controller Enable Register
Bit
1 state inserted
2 states inserted
3 states inserted
H'EF
Bus controller
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
WCE7
WCE6
WCE5
WCE4
WCE3
WCE2
WCE1
WCE0
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Wait state controller enable 7 to 0
0 Wait-state control is disabled (pin wait mode 0)
1 Wait-state control is enabled
656
MDCR—Mode Control Register
Bit
H'F1
System control
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
—
—
—
—
MDS2
MDS1
MDS0
Initial value
1
1
0
0
0
—*
—*
—*
Read/Write
—
—
—
—
—
R
R
R
Mode select 2 to 0
Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
MD2 MD1 MD0
0
0
0
1
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
1
Note: * Determined by the state of the mode pins (MD 2 to MD0 ).
657
Operating mode
—
Mode 1
Mode 2
Mode 3
Mode 4
—
—
—
SYSCR—System Control Register
Bit
H'F2
System control
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
SSBY
STS2
STS1
STS0
UE
NMIEG
—
RAME
Initial value
0
0
0
0
1
0
1
1
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
—
R/W
RAM enable
0 On-chip RAM is disabled
1 On-chip RAM is enabled
NMI edge select
0 An interrupt is requested at the falling edge of NMI
1 An interrupt is requested at the rising edge of NMI
User bit enable
0 CCR bit 6 (UI) is used as an interrupt mask bit
1 CCR bit 6 (UI) is used as a user bit
Standby timer select 2 to 0
Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4
STS2 STS1 STS0 Standby Timer
0
0
0
Waiting time = 8192 states
1
Waiting time = 16384 states
0
Waiting time = 32768 states
1
1
Waiting time = 65536 states
Waiting time = 131072 states
0
—
1
—
Illegal setting
1
Software standby
0 SLEEP instruction causes transition to sleep mode
1 SLEEP instruction causes transition to software standby mode
658
BRCR—Bus Release Control Register
H'F3
Bus controller
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
A23E
A22E
A21E
—
—
—
—
BRLE
Bit
Modes Initial value 1
1, 2
Read/Write —
Modes Initial value 1
3, 4
Read/Write R/W
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
—
—
—
—
—
—
R/W
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
R/W
R/W
—
—
—
—
R/W
Bus release enable
0 The bus cannot be released to an external device
1 The bus can be released to an external device
Address 23 to 21 enable
0 Address output
1 Other input/output
ISCR—IRQ Sense Control Register
Bit
H'F4
Interrupt controller
7
6
—
—
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
5
4
3
2
1
0
IRQ5SC IRQ4SC IRQ3SC IRQ2SC IRQ1SC IRQ0SC
IRQ 5 to IRQ 0 sense control
0 Interrupts are requested when IRQ 5 to IRQ 0 inputs are low
1 Interrupts are requested by falling-edge input at IRQ 5 to IRQ0
IER—IRQ Enable Register
Bit
H'F5
Interrupt controller
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
—
IRQ5E
IRQ4E
IRQ3E
IRQ2E
IRQ1E
IRQ0E
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/(W)
R/(W)
R/(W)
R/(W)
R/(W)
R/(W)
R/(W)
R/(W)
IRQ5 to IRQ 0 enable
0 IRQ 5 to IRQ 0 interrupts are disabled
1 IRQ 5 to IRQ 0 interrupts are enabled
659
ISR—IRQ Status Register
Bit
H'F6
Interrupt controller
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
—
—
IRQ5F
IRQ4F
IRQ3F
IRQ2F
IRQ1F
IRQ0F
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
—
—
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
IRQ 5 to IRQ 0 flags
Bits 5 to 0
IRQ5F to IRQ0F
0
1
Setting and Clearing Conditions
[Clearing conditions]
Read IRQnF when IRQnF = 1, then write 0 in IRQnF.
IRQnSC = 0, IRQn input is high, and interrupt exception
handling is carried out.
IRQnSC = 1 and IRQn interrupt exception handling is
carried out.
[Setting conditions]
IRQnSC = 0 and IRQn input is low.
IRQnSC = 1 and IRQn input changes from high to low.
(n = 5 to 0)
Note: * Only 0 can be written, to clear the flag.
660
IPRA—Interrupt Priority Register A
Bit
H'F8
Interrupt controller
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
IPRA7
IPRA6
IPRA5
IPRA4
IPRA3
IPRA2
IPRA1
IPRA0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Priority level A7 to A0
0 Priority level 0 (low priority)
1 Priority level 1 (high priority)
•
Interrupt sources controlled by each bit
Interrupt
source
Bit 7
IPRA7
Bit 6
IPRA6
Bit 5
IPRA5
Bit 4
IPRA4
Bit 3
IPRA3
IRQ0
IRQ1
IRQ2,
IRQ3
IRQ4,
IRQ5
WDT,
ITU
Refresh chanconnel 0
troller
IPRB—Interrupt Priority Register B
Bit
Bit 2
IPRA2
H'F9
Bit 1
IPRA1
Bit 0
IPRA0
ITU
channel 1
ITU
channel 2
Interrupt controller
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
IPRB7
IPRB6
IPRB5
—
IPRB3
IPRB2
IPRB1
—
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Reserved bits
Priority level B7 to B5, B3 to B1
0 Priority level 0 (low priority)
1 Priority level 1 (high priority)
•
Interrupt sources controlled by each bit
Interrupt
source
Bit 7
IPRB7
Bit 6
IPRB6
Bit 5
IPRB5
Bit 4
—
Bit 3
IPRB3
Bit 2
IPRB2
Bit 1
IPRB1
Bit 0
—
ITU
channel 3
ITU
channel 4
DMAC
—
SCI
channel 0
SCI
channel 1
A/D
converter
—
661
Appendix C I/O Port Block Diagrams
8-bit bus mode
16-bit bus mode
C.1 Port 4 Block Diagram
Q
D
P4 n PCR
C
RP4P
WP4P
Reset
R
Q
Write to external
address
D
P4 n DDR
C
WP4D
Reset
R
Q
P4 n
D
P4n DR
C
WP4
RP4
Read external
address
WP4P: Write to P4PCR
RP4P: Read P4PCR
WP4D: Write to P4DDR
WP4: Write to port 4
RP4: Read port 4
n = 0 to 7
Figure C-1 Port 4 Block Diagram
662
Internal data bus (lower)
R
Internal data bus (upper)
Reset
C.2 Port 6 Block Diagrams
R
Q
D
P60 DDR
C
WP6D
Reset
Internal data bus
Reset
Bus controller
WAIT
input
enable
R
P6 0
Q
D
P60 DR
C
WP6
RP6
Bus controller
WAIT
input
WP6D: Write to P6DDR
WP6: Write to port 6
RP6: Read port 6
Figure C-2 (a) Port 6 Block Diagram (Pin P60)
663
R
Q
D
P6 1 DDR
C
WP6D
Reset
Internal data bus
Reset
Bus
controller
Bus release
enable
R
P6 1
Q
D
P61 DR
C
WP6
RP6
BREQ input
WP6D: Write to P6DDR
WP6: Write to port 6
RP6: Read port 6
Figure C-2 (b) Port 6 Block Diagram (Pin P61)
664
R
Q
D
P6 2 DDR
C
WP6D
Reset
Internal data bus
Reset
R
Q
P6 2
D
P62 DR
C
WP6
Bus controller
Bus release
enable
BACK
output
RP6
WP6D: Write to P6DDR
WP6: Write to port 6
RP6: Read port 6
Figure C-2 (c) Port 6 Block Diagram (Pin P62)
665
RP7
P7n
Internal data bus
C.3 Port 7 Block Diagram
A/D converter
Analog input
RP7: Read port 7
n = 0 to 7
Input enable
Figure C-3 Port 7 Block Diagram (Pin P7n)
666
C.4 Port 8 Block Diagrams
Reset
Q
D
P8 0 DDR
C
WP8D
Reset
Internal data bus
R
R
Q
P8 0
D
P80 DR
C
WP8
Refresh
controller
Output
enable
RFSH
output
RP8
Interrupt
controller
WP8D: Write to P8DDR
WP8: Write to port 8
RP8: Read port 8
IRQ 0
input
Figure C-4 (a) Port 8 Block Diagram (Pin P80)
667
R
Q
D
P8 n DDR
C
WP8D
P8 n
Internal data bus
Reset
Reset
R
Q
Bus controller
CS 1
CS 2
CS 3
output
D
P8n DR
C
WP8
RP8
Interrupt
controller
IRQ 1
IRQ 2
IRQ 3 input
WP8D Write to P8DDR
WP8: Write to port 8
RP8: Read port 8
n = 1 to 3
Figure C-4 (b) Port 8 Block Diagram (Pins P81, P82, P83)
668
S
Q
D
P8 4 DDR
C
WP8D
P8 4
Reset
R
Q
D
P84 DR
C
WP8
RP8
WP8D: Write to P8DDR
WP8: Write to port 8
RP8: Read port 8
Figure C-4 (c) Port 8 Block Diagram (Pin P84)
669
Internal data bus
Reset
Bus controller
CS 0
output
C.5 Port 9 Block Diagrams
Reset
Q
D
P9 n DDR
C
WP9D
Reset
Internal data bus
R
R
Q
P9 n
D
P9n DR
C
WP9
RP9
WP9D: Write to P9DDR
WP9: Write to port 9
RP9: Read port 9
n = 0 and 1
Figure C-5 (a) Port 9 Block Diagram (Pins P90, P91)
670
SCI
Output
enable
Serial
transmit
data
R
Q
D
P9 n DDR
C
WP9D
Reset
Internal data bus
Reset
SCI
Input enable
R
P9 n
Q
D
P9n DR
C
WP9
RP9
Serial receive
data
WP9D: Write to P9DDR
WP9: Write to port 9
RP9: Read port 9
n = 2 and 3
Figure C-5 (b) Port 9 Block Diagram (Pins P92, P93)
671
R
Q
D
P9 n DDR
C
WP9D
Reset
Internal data bus
Reset
SCI
Clock input
enable
R
Q
P9 n
D
P9n DR
C
WP9
Clock output
enable
Clock output
RP9
Clock input
WP9D: Write to P9DDR
WP9: Write to port 9
RP9: Read port 9
n = 4 and 5
Interrupt
controller
IRQ 4 or IRQ 5
input
Figure C-5 (c) Port 9 Block Diagram (Pins P94, P95)
672
C.6 Port A Block Diagrams
Internal data bus
Reset
R
Q
D
PA n DDR
C
WPAD
Reset
TPC
output
enable
R
Q
PAn
TPC
D
PA n DR
C
Next data
WPA
Output
trigger
DMA controller
Output
enable
Transfer
end output
ITU
RPA
Counter
clock input
WPAD: Write to PADDR
WPA: Write to port A
RPA: Read port A
n = 0 and 1
Figure C-6 (a) Port A Block Diagram (Pins PA0, PA1)
673
Internal data bus
Reset
R
Q
D
PA n DDR
C
WPAD
Reset
TPC
output
enable
R
Q
PAn
TPC
D
PAn DR
C
Next
data
WPA
Output
trigger
ITU
Output
enable
Compare
match
output
RPA
Input
capture
Counter
clock
input
WPAD: Write to PADDR
WPA: Write to port A
RPA: Read port A
n = 2 and 3
Figure C-6 (b) Port A Block Diagram (Pins PA2, PA3)
674
Internal data bus
External bus released
Address output enable*
Mode 3, 4
Reset
R
Q
D
PA n DDR
C
Internal address bus
Software standby
TPC
WPAD
TPC
output
enable
Reset
R
PAn
Q
D
Next
data
PA n DR
C
WPA
Output
trigger
ITU
Output
enable
Compare
match
output
RPA
WPAD: Write to PADDR
WPA: Write to port A
RPA: Read port A
n = 4 to 7
Note: * The PA 7 address output enable signal is always 1 in modes 3 and 4.
Figure C-6 (c) Port A Block Diagram (Pins PA4 to PA7)
675
Input
capture
C.7 Port B Block Diagrams
Reset
Q
Internal data bus
R
D
PB n DDR
C
WPBD
Reset
TPC output
enable
R
Q
PBn
TPC
D
PB n DR
C
Next data
WPB
Output trigger
ITU
Output enable
Compare
match output
RPB
Input
capture
WPBD: Write to PBDDR
WPB: Write to port B
RPB: Read port B
n = 0 to 3
Figure C-7 (a) Port B Block Diagram (Pins PB0 to PB3)
676
Internal data bus
Reset
R
Q
D
PB n DDR
C
TPC
WPBD
Reset
TPC output
enable
R
Q
PBn
D
PB n DR
C
Next data
WPB
Output trigger
ITU
Output enable
Compare
match output
RPB
WPBD: Write to PBDDR
WPB: Write to port B
RPB: Read port B
n = 4 and 5
Figure C-7 (b) Port B Block Diagram (Pins PB4, PB5)
677
Internal data bus
Reset
R
Q
PB 6 DDR
D
C
WPBD
TPC
Reset
TPC
output
enable
R
PB6
Q
PB6 DR
D
Next data
C
WPB
Output
trigger
DMAC
RPB
DREQ 0
input
WPBD: Write to PBDDR
WPB: Write to port B
RPB: Read port B
Figure C-7 (c) Port B Block Diagram (Pin PB6)
678
Internal data bus
Reset
R
Q
PB 7 DDR
D
C
WPBD
TPC
Reset
TPC
output
enable
R
PB7
Q
PB7 DR
D
Next data
C
WPB
Output
trigger
DMAC
RPB
DREQ 1
input
WPBD: Write to PBDDR
WPB: Write to port B
RPB: Read port B
A/D converter
ADTRG
input
Figure C-7 (d) Port B Block Diagram (Pin PB7)
679
Appendix D Pin States
D.1 Port States in Each Mode
Table D-1 Port States
Hardware Software
Standby Standby
Mode
Mode
BusReleased
Mode
Program
Execution
Sleep Mode
Pin
Name
Mode
Reset
State
ø
—
Clock output T
H
Clock output Clock output
RESO
—
T*2
T
T
T
RESO
A19 to A0
1 to 4
L
T
T
T
A19 to A0
D15 to D8
1 to 4
T
T
T
T
D15 to D0
AS, RD,
HWR, LWR
1 to 4
H
T
T
T
AS, RD,
HWR, LWR
P47 to P40
1 to 4
T
T
keep
keep
I/O port
T
T
D7 to D0
keep
I/O port*1
WAIT
D7 to D0
8-bit bus
16-bit bus
P60
1 to 4
T
T
keep
P61
1 to 4
T
T
(BRLE = 0) T
keep
(BRLE = 1)
T
I/O port
BREQ
P62
1 to 4
T
T
(BRLE = 0)
keep
L
(BRLE = 1)
H
I/O port
(BRLE = 0)
or BACK
(BRLE = 1)
P77 to P70
1 to 4
T
T
T
Input port
T
Note: *1 Do not set the DDR bit to 1.
*2 Low output only when WDT overflow causes a reset.
Legend
H:
High
L:
Low
T:
High-impedance state
keep: Input pins are in the high-impedance state; output pins maintain their previous state.
DDR: Data direction register bit
680
Table D-1 Port States (cont)
Mode
Reset
State
Hardware Software
Standby Standby
Mode
Mode
BusReleased
Mode
Program
Execution
Sleep Mode
P80
1 to 4
T
T
(RFSHE = 0)
keep
(RFSHE = 1)
RFSH
(RFSHE = 0)
keep
(RFSHE = 1)
H
I/O port
(RFSHE = 0)
or RFSH
(RFSHE = 1)
P83 to P81
1 to 4
T
T
(DDR = 0)
T
(DDR = 1)
H
keep
Input port
(DDR = 0) or
CS3 to CS1
(DDR = 1)
P84
1 to 4
L
T
(DDR = 0)
T
(DDR = 1)
L
keep
Input port
(DDR = 0)
or CS0
(DDR = 1)
P95 to P90
1 to 4
T
T
keep
keep
I/O port
PA3 to PA0
1 to 4
T
T
keep
keep
I/O port
PA6 to PA4
1, 2
T
T
keep
keep
I/O port
3, 4
T
T
I/O port*1
I/O port*2
A23, A22, A21
(A23E/A22E/
A21E = 0)
or I/O port
(A23E/A22E/
A21E = 1)
1, 2
T
T
keep
keep
3, 4
T
T
I/O port*1
I/O port*2
I/O port
A
1 to 4
T
T
keep
keep
I/O port
Pin
Name
PA7
PB7 to PB0
20
Notes: 1. The pin state depends on the DDR bit.
2. The pin state depends on the ITU output enable and DDR bits.
Legend
H:
High
L:
Low
T:
High-impedance state
keep: Input pins are in the high-impedance state; output pins maintain their previous state.
DDR: Data direction register bit
681
D.2 Pin States at Reset
Reset in T1 State: Figure D-1 is a timing diagram for the case in which RES goes low during the
T1 state of an external memory access cycle. As soon as RES goes low, all ports are initialized to
the input state. AS, RD, HWR, and LWR go high, and the data bus goes to the high-impedance
state. The address bus is initialized to the low output level 0.5 state after the low level of RES is
sampled. Sampling of RES takes place at the fall of the system clock (ø).
Access to external address
T1
T2
T3
ø
RES
Internal
reset signal
H'000000
Address bus
CS 0
High impedance
CS 3 to CS1
AS
High
RD (read access)
High
HWR, LWR
(write access)
High
High impedance
Data bus
(write access)
High impedance
I/O port
Figure D-1 Reset during Memory Access (Reset during T1 State)
682
Reset in T2 State: Figure D-2 is a timing diagram for the case in which RES goes low during the
T2 state of an external memory access cycle. As soon as RES goes low, all ports are initialized to
the input state. AS, RD, HWR, and LWR go high, and the data bus goes to the high-impedance
state. The address bus is initialized to the low output level 0.5 state after the low level of RES is
sampled. The same timing applies when a reset occurs during a wait state (TW).
Access to external address
T2
T1
T3
ø
RES
Internal
reset signal
H'000000
Address bus
CS 0
High impedance
CS 3 to CS1
AS
RD (read access)
HWR, LWR
(write access)
High impedance
Data bus
(write access)
High impedance
I/O port
Figure D-2 Reset during Memory Access (Reset during T2 State)
683
Reset in T3 State: Figure D-3 is a timing diagram for the case in which RES goes low during the
T3 state of an external memory access cycle. As soon as RES goes low, all ports are initialized to
the input state. AS, RD, HWR, and LWR go high, and the data bus goes to the high-impedance
state. The address bus outputs are held during the T3 state.The same timing applies when a reset
occurs in the T2 state of an access cycle to a two-state-access area.
Access to external address
T2
T1
T3
ø
RES
Internal
reset signal
H'000000
Address bus
CS 0
High impedance
CS 3 to CS1
AS
RD (read access)
HWR, LWR
(write access)
High impedance
Data bus
(write access)
High impedance
I/O port
Figure D-3 Reset during Memory Access (Reset during T3 State)
684
Appendix E Timing of Transition to and Recovery from
Hardware Standby Mode
Timing of Transition to Hardware Standby Mode
(1) To retain RAM contents with the RAME bit set to 1 in SYSCR, drive the RES signal low 10
system clock cycles before the STBY signal goes low, as shown below. RES must remain low
until STBY goes low (minimum delay from STBY low to RES high: 0 ns).
STBY
t1 ≥ 10tCYC
t2 ≥ 0 ns
RES
(2) To retain RAM contents with the RAME bit cleared to 0 in SYSCR, or when RAM contents
do not need to be retained, RES does not have to be driven low as in (1).
Timing of Recovery from Hardware Standby Mode: Drive the RES signal low approximately
100 ns before STBY goes high.
STBY
t ≥ 100 ns
RES
685
tOSC
Appendix F Package Dimensions
Figures F-1, F-2 and F-3 show the H8/3002 package dimensions.
Unit: mm
16.0 ± 0.3
14
75
51
50
100
26
0.10
0.17 ± 0.05
0.15 ± 0.04
0.08 M
1.0
2.70
25
0.12 +0.13
–0.12
1
0.22 ± 0.05
0.20 ± 0.04
3.05 Max
0.5
16.0 ± 0.3
76
1.0
0° – 8°
0.5 ± 0.2
Dimension including the plating thickness
Base material dimension
Figure F-1 Package Dimensions (FP-100B)
686
Unit: mm
16.0 ± 0.3
14
75
51
50
100
26
0.10
0.17 ± 0.05
0.15 ± 0.04
0.08 M
1.0
2.70
25
0.12 +0.13
–0.12
1
0.22 ± 0.05
0.20 ± 0.04
3.05 Max
0.5
16.0 ± 0.3
76
1.0
0° – 8°
0.5 ± 0.2
Dimension including the plating thickness
Base material dimension
Figure F-2 Package Dimensions (TFP-100B)
687
Unit: mm
24.8 ± 0.4
20
51
50
100
31
M
0.58
0.15
2.70
0.13
0.17 ± 0.05
0.15 ± 0.04
30
0.20 +0.10
–0.20
1
0.32 ± 0.08
0.30 ± 0.06
3.10 Max
0.65
81
14
18.8 ± 0.4
80
Dimension including the plating thickness
Base material dimension
Figure F-3 Package Dimensions (FP-100A)
688
2.4
0.83
0° – 10°
1.2 ± 0.2
Similar pages